You can not select more than 25 topics Topics must start with a letter or number, can include dashes ('-') and can be up to 35 characters long.

25448 lines
677KB

  1. @chapter Filtering Introduction
  2. @c man begin FILTERING INTRODUCTION
  3. Filtering in FFmpeg is enabled through the libavfilter library.
  4. In libavfilter, a filter can have multiple inputs and multiple
  5. outputs.
  6. To illustrate the sorts of things that are possible, we consider the
  7. following filtergraph.
  8. @verbatim
  9. [main]
  10. input --> split ---------------------> overlay --> output
  11. | ^
  12. |[tmp] [flip]|
  13. +-----> crop --> vflip -------+
  14. @end verbatim
  15. This filtergraph splits the input stream in two streams, then sends one
  16. stream through the crop filter and the vflip filter, before merging it
  17. back with the other stream by overlaying it on top. You can use the
  18. following command to achieve this:
  19. @example
  20. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf "split [main][tmp]; [tmp] crop=iw:ih/2:0:0, vflip [flip]; [main][flip] overlay=0:H/2" OUTPUT
  21. @end example
  22. The result will be that the top half of the video is mirrored
  23. onto the bottom half of the output video.
  24. Filters in the same linear chain are separated by commas, and distinct
  25. linear chains of filters are separated by semicolons. In our example,
  26. @var{crop,vflip} are in one linear chain, @var{split} and
  27. @var{overlay} are separately in another. The points where the linear
  28. chains join are labelled by names enclosed in square brackets. In the
  29. example, the split filter generates two outputs that are associated to
  30. the labels @var{[main]} and @var{[tmp]}.
  31. The stream sent to the second output of @var{split}, labelled as
  32. @var{[tmp]}, is processed through the @var{crop} filter, which crops
  33. away the lower half part of the video, and then vertically flipped. The
  34. @var{overlay} filter takes in input the first unchanged output of the
  35. split filter (which was labelled as @var{[main]}), and overlay on its
  36. lower half the output generated by the @var{crop,vflip} filterchain.
  37. Some filters take in input a list of parameters: they are specified
  38. after the filter name and an equal sign, and are separated from each other
  39. by a colon.
  40. There exist so-called @var{source filters} that do not have an
  41. audio/video input, and @var{sink filters} that will not have audio/video
  42. output.
  43. @c man end FILTERING INTRODUCTION
  44. @chapter graph2dot
  45. @c man begin GRAPH2DOT
  46. The @file{graph2dot} program included in the FFmpeg @file{tools}
  47. directory can be used to parse a filtergraph description and issue a
  48. corresponding textual representation in the dot language.
  49. Invoke the command:
  50. @example
  51. graph2dot -h
  52. @end example
  53. to see how to use @file{graph2dot}.
  54. You can then pass the dot description to the @file{dot} program (from
  55. the graphviz suite of programs) and obtain a graphical representation
  56. of the filtergraph.
  57. For example the sequence of commands:
  58. @example
  59. echo @var{GRAPH_DESCRIPTION} | \
  60. tools/graph2dot -o graph.tmp && \
  61. dot -Tpng graph.tmp -o graph.png && \
  62. display graph.png
  63. @end example
  64. can be used to create and display an image representing the graph
  65. described by the @var{GRAPH_DESCRIPTION} string. Note that this string must be
  66. a complete self-contained graph, with its inputs and outputs explicitly defined.
  67. For example if your command line is of the form:
  68. @example
  69. ffmpeg -i infile -vf scale=640:360 outfile
  70. @end example
  71. your @var{GRAPH_DESCRIPTION} string will need to be of the form:
  72. @example
  73. nullsrc,scale=640:360,nullsink
  74. @end example
  75. you may also need to set the @var{nullsrc} parameters and add a @var{format}
  76. filter in order to simulate a specific input file.
  77. @c man end GRAPH2DOT
  78. @chapter Filtergraph description
  79. @c man begin FILTERGRAPH DESCRIPTION
  80. A filtergraph is a directed graph of connected filters. It can contain
  81. cycles, and there can be multiple links between a pair of
  82. filters. Each link has one input pad on one side connecting it to one
  83. filter from which it takes its input, and one output pad on the other
  84. side connecting it to one filter accepting its output.
  85. Each filter in a filtergraph is an instance of a filter class
  86. registered in the application, which defines the features and the
  87. number of input and output pads of the filter.
  88. A filter with no input pads is called a "source", and a filter with no
  89. output pads is called a "sink".
  90. @anchor{Filtergraph syntax}
  91. @section Filtergraph syntax
  92. A filtergraph has a textual representation, which is recognized by the
  93. @option{-filter}/@option{-vf}/@option{-af} and
  94. @option{-filter_complex} options in @command{ffmpeg} and
  95. @option{-vf}/@option{-af} in @command{ffplay}, and by the
  96. @code{avfilter_graph_parse_ptr()} function defined in
  97. @file{libavfilter/avfilter.h}.
  98. A filterchain consists of a sequence of connected filters, each one
  99. connected to the previous one in the sequence. A filterchain is
  100. represented by a list of ","-separated filter descriptions.
  101. A filtergraph consists of a sequence of filterchains. A sequence of
  102. filterchains is represented by a list of ";"-separated filterchain
  103. descriptions.
  104. A filter is represented by a string of the form:
  105. [@var{in_link_1}]...[@var{in_link_N}]@var{filter_name}@@@var{id}=@var{arguments}[@var{out_link_1}]...[@var{out_link_M}]
  106. @var{filter_name} is the name of the filter class of which the
  107. described filter is an instance of, and has to be the name of one of
  108. the filter classes registered in the program optionally followed by "@@@var{id}".
  109. The name of the filter class is optionally followed by a string
  110. "=@var{arguments}".
  111. @var{arguments} is a string which contains the parameters used to
  112. initialize the filter instance. It may have one of two forms:
  113. @itemize
  114. @item
  115. A ':'-separated list of @var{key=value} pairs.
  116. @item
  117. A ':'-separated list of @var{value}. In this case, the keys are assumed to be
  118. the option names in the order they are declared. E.g. the @code{fade} filter
  119. declares three options in this order -- @option{type}, @option{start_frame} and
  120. @option{nb_frames}. Then the parameter list @var{in:0:30} means that the value
  121. @var{in} is assigned to the option @option{type}, @var{0} to
  122. @option{start_frame} and @var{30} to @option{nb_frames}.
  123. @item
  124. A ':'-separated list of mixed direct @var{value} and long @var{key=value}
  125. pairs. The direct @var{value} must precede the @var{key=value} pairs, and
  126. follow the same constraints order of the previous point. The following
  127. @var{key=value} pairs can be set in any preferred order.
  128. @end itemize
  129. If the option value itself is a list of items (e.g. the @code{format} filter
  130. takes a list of pixel formats), the items in the list are usually separated by
  131. @samp{|}.
  132. The list of arguments can be quoted using the character @samp{'} as initial
  133. and ending mark, and the character @samp{\} for escaping the characters
  134. within the quoted text; otherwise the argument string is considered
  135. terminated when the next special character (belonging to the set
  136. @samp{[]=;,}) is encountered.
  137. The name and arguments of the filter are optionally preceded and
  138. followed by a list of link labels.
  139. A link label allows one to name a link and associate it to a filter output
  140. or input pad. The preceding labels @var{in_link_1}
  141. ... @var{in_link_N}, are associated to the filter input pads,
  142. the following labels @var{out_link_1} ... @var{out_link_M}, are
  143. associated to the output pads.
  144. When two link labels with the same name are found in the
  145. filtergraph, a link between the corresponding input and output pad is
  146. created.
  147. If an output pad is not labelled, it is linked by default to the first
  148. unlabelled input pad of the next filter in the filterchain.
  149. For example in the filterchain
  150. @example
  151. nullsrc, split[L1], [L2]overlay, nullsink
  152. @end example
  153. the split filter instance has two output pads, and the overlay filter
  154. instance two input pads. The first output pad of split is labelled
  155. "L1", the first input pad of overlay is labelled "L2", and the second
  156. output pad of split is linked to the second input pad of overlay,
  157. which are both unlabelled.
  158. In a filter description, if the input label of the first filter is not
  159. specified, "in" is assumed; if the output label of the last filter is not
  160. specified, "out" is assumed.
  161. In a complete filterchain all the unlabelled filter input and output
  162. pads must be connected. A filtergraph is considered valid if all the
  163. filter input and output pads of all the filterchains are connected.
  164. Libavfilter will automatically insert @ref{scale} filters where format
  165. conversion is required. It is possible to specify swscale flags
  166. for those automatically inserted scalers by prepending
  167. @code{sws_flags=@var{flags};}
  168. to the filtergraph description.
  169. Here is a BNF description of the filtergraph syntax:
  170. @example
  171. @var{NAME} ::= sequence of alphanumeric characters and '_'
  172. @var{FILTER_NAME} ::= @var{NAME}["@@"@var{NAME}]
  173. @var{LINKLABEL} ::= "[" @var{NAME} "]"
  174. @var{LINKLABELS} ::= @var{LINKLABEL} [@var{LINKLABELS}]
  175. @var{FILTER_ARGUMENTS} ::= sequence of chars (possibly quoted)
  176. @var{FILTER} ::= [@var{LINKLABELS}] @var{FILTER_NAME} ["=" @var{FILTER_ARGUMENTS}] [@var{LINKLABELS}]
  177. @var{FILTERCHAIN} ::= @var{FILTER} [,@var{FILTERCHAIN}]
  178. @var{FILTERGRAPH} ::= [sws_flags=@var{flags};] @var{FILTERCHAIN} [;@var{FILTERGRAPH}]
  179. @end example
  180. @anchor{filtergraph escaping}
  181. @section Notes on filtergraph escaping
  182. Filtergraph description composition entails several levels of
  183. escaping. See @ref{quoting_and_escaping,,the "Quoting and escaping"
  184. section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils} for more
  185. information about the employed escaping procedure.
  186. A first level escaping affects the content of each filter option
  187. value, which may contain the special character @code{:} used to
  188. separate values, or one of the escaping characters @code{\'}.
  189. A second level escaping affects the whole filter description, which
  190. may contain the escaping characters @code{\'} or the special
  191. characters @code{[],;} used by the filtergraph description.
  192. Finally, when you specify a filtergraph on a shell commandline, you
  193. need to perform a third level escaping for the shell special
  194. characters contained within it.
  195. For example, consider the following string to be embedded in
  196. the @ref{drawtext} filter description @option{text} value:
  197. @example
  198. this is a 'string': may contain one, or more, special characters
  199. @end example
  200. This string contains the @code{'} special escaping character, and the
  201. @code{:} special character, so it needs to be escaped in this way:
  202. @example
  203. text=this is a \'string\'\: may contain one, or more, special characters
  204. @end example
  205. A second level of escaping is required when embedding the filter
  206. description in a filtergraph description, in order to escape all the
  207. filtergraph special characters. Thus the example above becomes:
  208. @example
  209. drawtext=text=this is a \\\'string\\\'\\: may contain one\, or more\, special characters
  210. @end example
  211. (note that in addition to the @code{\'} escaping special characters,
  212. also @code{,} needs to be escaped).
  213. Finally an additional level of escaping is needed when writing the
  214. filtergraph description in a shell command, which depends on the
  215. escaping rules of the adopted shell. For example, assuming that
  216. @code{\} is special and needs to be escaped with another @code{\}, the
  217. previous string will finally result in:
  218. @example
  219. -vf "drawtext=text=this is a \\\\\\'string\\\\\\'\\\\: may contain one\\, or more\\, special characters"
  220. @end example
  221. @chapter Timeline editing
  222. Some filters support a generic @option{enable} option. For the filters
  223. supporting timeline editing, this option can be set to an expression which is
  224. evaluated before sending a frame to the filter. If the evaluation is non-zero,
  225. the filter will be enabled, otherwise the frame will be sent unchanged to the
  226. next filter in the filtergraph.
  227. The expression accepts the following values:
  228. @table @samp
  229. @item t
  230. timestamp expressed in seconds, NAN if the input timestamp is unknown
  231. @item n
  232. sequential number of the input frame, starting from 0
  233. @item pos
  234. the position in the file of the input frame, NAN if unknown
  235. @item w
  236. @item h
  237. width and height of the input frame if video
  238. @end table
  239. Additionally, these filters support an @option{enable} command that can be used
  240. to re-define the expression.
  241. Like any other filtering option, the @option{enable} option follows the same
  242. rules.
  243. For example, to enable a blur filter (@ref{smartblur}) from 10 seconds to 3
  244. minutes, and a @ref{curves} filter starting at 3 seconds:
  245. @example
  246. smartblur = enable='between(t,10,3*60)',
  247. curves = enable='gte(t,3)' : preset=cross_process
  248. @end example
  249. See @code{ffmpeg -filters} to view which filters have timeline support.
  250. @c man end FILTERGRAPH DESCRIPTION
  251. @anchor{commands}
  252. @chapter Changing options at runtime with a command
  253. Some options can be changed during the operation of the filter using
  254. a command. These options are marked 'T' on the output of
  255. @command{ffmpeg} @option{-h filter=<name of filter>}.
  256. The name of the command is the name of the option and the argument is
  257. the new value.
  258. @anchor{framesync}
  259. @chapter Options for filters with several inputs (framesync)
  260. @c man begin OPTIONS FOR FILTERS WITH SEVERAL INPUTS
  261. Some filters with several inputs support a common set of options.
  262. These options can only be set by name, not with the short notation.
  263. @table @option
  264. @item eof_action
  265. The action to take when EOF is encountered on the secondary input; it accepts
  266. one of the following values:
  267. @table @option
  268. @item repeat
  269. Repeat the last frame (the default).
  270. @item endall
  271. End both streams.
  272. @item pass
  273. Pass the main input through.
  274. @end table
  275. @item shortest
  276. If set to 1, force the output to terminate when the shortest input
  277. terminates. Default value is 0.
  278. @item repeatlast
  279. If set to 1, force the filter to extend the last frame of secondary streams
  280. until the end of the primary stream. A value of 0 disables this behavior.
  281. Default value is 1.
  282. @end table
  283. @c man end OPTIONS FOR FILTERS WITH SEVERAL INPUTS
  284. @chapter Audio Filters
  285. @c man begin AUDIO FILTERS
  286. When you configure your FFmpeg build, you can disable any of the
  287. existing filters using @code{--disable-filters}.
  288. The configure output will show the audio filters included in your
  289. build.
  290. Below is a description of the currently available audio filters.
  291. @section acompressor
  292. A compressor is mainly used to reduce the dynamic range of a signal.
  293. Especially modern music is mostly compressed at a high ratio to
  294. improve the overall loudness. It's done to get the highest attention
  295. of a listener, "fatten" the sound and bring more "power" to the track.
  296. If a signal is compressed too much it may sound dull or "dead"
  297. afterwards or it may start to "pump" (which could be a powerful effect
  298. but can also destroy a track completely).
  299. The right compression is the key to reach a professional sound and is
  300. the high art of mixing and mastering. Because of its complex settings
  301. it may take a long time to get the right feeling for this kind of effect.
  302. Compression is done by detecting the volume above a chosen level
  303. @code{threshold} and dividing it by the factor set with @code{ratio}.
  304. So if you set the threshold to -12dB and your signal reaches -6dB a ratio
  305. of 2:1 will result in a signal at -9dB. Because an exact manipulation of
  306. the signal would cause distortion of the waveform the reduction can be
  307. levelled over the time. This is done by setting "Attack" and "Release".
  308. @code{attack} determines how long the signal has to rise above the threshold
  309. before any reduction will occur and @code{release} sets the time the signal
  310. has to fall below the threshold to reduce the reduction again. Shorter signals
  311. than the chosen attack time will be left untouched.
  312. The overall reduction of the signal can be made up afterwards with the
  313. @code{makeup} setting. So compressing the peaks of a signal about 6dB and
  314. raising the makeup to this level results in a signal twice as loud than the
  315. source. To gain a softer entry in the compression the @code{knee} flattens the
  316. hard edge at the threshold in the range of the chosen decibels.
  317. The filter accepts the following options:
  318. @table @option
  319. @item level_in
  320. Set input gain. Default is 1. Range is between 0.015625 and 64.
  321. @item mode
  322. Set mode of compressor operation. Can be @code{upward} or @code{downward}.
  323. Default is @code{downward}.
  324. @item threshold
  325. If a signal of stream rises above this level it will affect the gain
  326. reduction.
  327. By default it is 0.125. Range is between 0.00097563 and 1.
  328. @item ratio
  329. Set a ratio by which the signal is reduced. 1:2 means that if the level
  330. rose 4dB above the threshold, it will be only 2dB above after the reduction.
  331. Default is 2. Range is between 1 and 20.
  332. @item attack
  333. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to rise above the threshold before gain
  334. reduction starts. Default is 20. Range is between 0.01 and 2000.
  335. @item release
  336. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to fall below the threshold before
  337. reduction is decreased again. Default is 250. Range is between 0.01 and 9000.
  338. @item makeup
  339. Set the amount by how much signal will be amplified after processing.
  340. Default is 1. Range is from 1 to 64.
  341. @item knee
  342. Curve the sharp knee around the threshold to enter gain reduction more softly.
  343. Default is 2.82843. Range is between 1 and 8.
  344. @item link
  345. Choose if the @code{average} level between all channels of input stream
  346. or the louder(@code{maximum}) channel of input stream affects the
  347. reduction. Default is @code{average}.
  348. @item detection
  349. Should the exact signal be taken in case of @code{peak} or an RMS one in case
  350. of @code{rms}. Default is @code{rms} which is mostly smoother.
  351. @item mix
  352. How much to use compressed signal in output. Default is 1.
  353. Range is between 0 and 1.
  354. @end table
  355. @subsection Commands
  356. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  357. @section acontrast
  358. Simple audio dynamic range compression/expansion filter.
  359. The filter accepts the following options:
  360. @table @option
  361. @item contrast
  362. Set contrast. Default is 33. Allowed range is between 0 and 100.
  363. @end table
  364. @section acopy
  365. Copy the input audio source unchanged to the output. This is mainly useful for
  366. testing purposes.
  367. @section acrossfade
  368. Apply cross fade from one input audio stream to another input audio stream.
  369. The cross fade is applied for specified duration near the end of first stream.
  370. The filter accepts the following options:
  371. @table @option
  372. @item nb_samples, ns
  373. Specify the number of samples for which the cross fade effect has to last.
  374. At the end of the cross fade effect the first input audio will be completely
  375. silent. Default is 44100.
  376. @item duration, d
  377. Specify the duration of the cross fade effect. See
  378. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  379. for the accepted syntax.
  380. By default the duration is determined by @var{nb_samples}.
  381. If set this option is used instead of @var{nb_samples}.
  382. @item overlap, o
  383. Should first stream end overlap with second stream start. Default is enabled.
  384. @item curve1
  385. Set curve for cross fade transition for first stream.
  386. @item curve2
  387. Set curve for cross fade transition for second stream.
  388. For description of available curve types see @ref{afade} filter description.
  389. @end table
  390. @subsection Examples
  391. @itemize
  392. @item
  393. Cross fade from one input to another:
  394. @example
  395. ffmpeg -i first.flac -i second.flac -filter_complex acrossfade=d=10:c1=exp:c2=exp output.flac
  396. @end example
  397. @item
  398. Cross fade from one input to another but without overlapping:
  399. @example
  400. ffmpeg -i first.flac -i second.flac -filter_complex acrossfade=d=10:o=0:c1=exp:c2=exp output.flac
  401. @end example
  402. @end itemize
  403. @section acrossover
  404. Split audio stream into several bands.
  405. This filter splits audio stream into two or more frequency ranges.
  406. Summing all streams back will give flat output.
  407. The filter accepts the following options:
  408. @table @option
  409. @item split
  410. Set split frequencies. Those must be positive and increasing.
  411. @item order
  412. Set filter order, can be @var{2nd}, @var{4th} or @var{8th}.
  413. Default is @var{4th}.
  414. @end table
  415. @section acrusher
  416. Reduce audio bit resolution.
  417. This filter is bit crusher with enhanced functionality. A bit crusher
  418. is used to audibly reduce number of bits an audio signal is sampled
  419. with. This doesn't change the bit depth at all, it just produces the
  420. effect. Material reduced in bit depth sounds more harsh and "digital".
  421. This filter is able to even round to continuous values instead of discrete
  422. bit depths.
  423. Additionally it has a D/C offset which results in different crushing of
  424. the lower and the upper half of the signal.
  425. An Anti-Aliasing setting is able to produce "softer" crushing sounds.
  426. Another feature of this filter is the logarithmic mode.
  427. This setting switches from linear distances between bits to logarithmic ones.
  428. The result is a much more "natural" sounding crusher which doesn't gate low
  429. signals for example. The human ear has a logarithmic perception,
  430. so this kind of crushing is much more pleasant.
  431. Logarithmic crushing is also able to get anti-aliased.
  432. The filter accepts the following options:
  433. @table @option
  434. @item level_in
  435. Set level in.
  436. @item level_out
  437. Set level out.
  438. @item bits
  439. Set bit reduction.
  440. @item mix
  441. Set mixing amount.
  442. @item mode
  443. Can be linear: @code{lin} or logarithmic: @code{log}.
  444. @item dc
  445. Set DC.
  446. @item aa
  447. Set anti-aliasing.
  448. @item samples
  449. Set sample reduction.
  450. @item lfo
  451. Enable LFO. By default disabled.
  452. @item lforange
  453. Set LFO range.
  454. @item lforate
  455. Set LFO rate.
  456. @end table
  457. @section acue
  458. Delay audio filtering until a given wallclock timestamp. See the @ref{cue}
  459. filter.
  460. @section adeclick
  461. Remove impulsive noise from input audio.
  462. Samples detected as impulsive noise are replaced by interpolated samples using
  463. autoregressive modelling.
  464. @table @option
  465. @item w
  466. Set window size, in milliseconds. Allowed range is from @code{10} to
  467. @code{100}. Default value is @code{55} milliseconds.
  468. This sets size of window which will be processed at once.
  469. @item o
  470. Set window overlap, in percentage of window size. Allowed range is from
  471. @code{50} to @code{95}. Default value is @code{75} percent.
  472. Setting this to a very high value increases impulsive noise removal but makes
  473. whole process much slower.
  474. @item a
  475. Set autoregression order, in percentage of window size. Allowed range is from
  476. @code{0} to @code{25}. Default value is @code{2} percent. This option also
  477. controls quality of interpolated samples using neighbour good samples.
  478. @item t
  479. Set threshold value. Allowed range is from @code{1} to @code{100}.
  480. Default value is @code{2}.
  481. This controls the strength of impulsive noise which is going to be removed.
  482. The lower value, the more samples will be detected as impulsive noise.
  483. @item b
  484. Set burst fusion, in percentage of window size. Allowed range is @code{0} to
  485. @code{10}. Default value is @code{2}.
  486. If any two samples detected as noise are spaced less than this value then any
  487. sample between those two samples will be also detected as noise.
  488. @item m
  489. Set overlap method.
  490. It accepts the following values:
  491. @table @option
  492. @item a
  493. Select overlap-add method. Even not interpolated samples are slightly
  494. changed with this method.
  495. @item s
  496. Select overlap-save method. Not interpolated samples remain unchanged.
  497. @end table
  498. Default value is @code{a}.
  499. @end table
  500. @section adeclip
  501. Remove clipped samples from input audio.
  502. Samples detected as clipped are replaced by interpolated samples using
  503. autoregressive modelling.
  504. @table @option
  505. @item w
  506. Set window size, in milliseconds. Allowed range is from @code{10} to @code{100}.
  507. Default value is @code{55} milliseconds.
  508. This sets size of window which will be processed at once.
  509. @item o
  510. Set window overlap, in percentage of window size. Allowed range is from @code{50}
  511. to @code{95}. Default value is @code{75} percent.
  512. @item a
  513. Set autoregression order, in percentage of window size. Allowed range is from
  514. @code{0} to @code{25}. Default value is @code{8} percent. This option also controls
  515. quality of interpolated samples using neighbour good samples.
  516. @item t
  517. Set threshold value. Allowed range is from @code{1} to @code{100}.
  518. Default value is @code{10}. Higher values make clip detection less aggressive.
  519. @item n
  520. Set size of histogram used to detect clips. Allowed range is from @code{100} to @code{9999}.
  521. Default value is @code{1000}. Higher values make clip detection less aggressive.
  522. @item m
  523. Set overlap method.
  524. It accepts the following values:
  525. @table @option
  526. @item a
  527. Select overlap-add method. Even not interpolated samples are slightly changed
  528. with this method.
  529. @item s
  530. Select overlap-save method. Not interpolated samples remain unchanged.
  531. @end table
  532. Default value is @code{a}.
  533. @end table
  534. @section adelay
  535. Delay one or more audio channels.
  536. Samples in delayed channel are filled with silence.
  537. The filter accepts the following option:
  538. @table @option
  539. @item delays
  540. Set list of delays in milliseconds for each channel separated by '|'.
  541. Unused delays will be silently ignored. If number of given delays is
  542. smaller than number of channels all remaining channels will not be delayed.
  543. If you want to delay exact number of samples, append 'S' to number.
  544. If you want instead to delay in seconds, append 's' to number.
  545. @item all
  546. Use last set delay for all remaining channels. By default is disabled.
  547. This option if enabled changes how option @code{delays} is interpreted.
  548. @end table
  549. @subsection Examples
  550. @itemize
  551. @item
  552. Delay first channel by 1.5 seconds, the third channel by 0.5 seconds and leave
  553. the second channel (and any other channels that may be present) unchanged.
  554. @example
  555. adelay=1500|0|500
  556. @end example
  557. @item
  558. Delay second channel by 500 samples, the third channel by 700 samples and leave
  559. the first channel (and any other channels that may be present) unchanged.
  560. @example
  561. adelay=0|500S|700S
  562. @end example
  563. @item
  564. Delay all channels by same number of samples:
  565. @example
  566. adelay=delays=64S:all=1
  567. @end example
  568. @end itemize
  569. @section aderivative, aintegral
  570. Compute derivative/integral of audio stream.
  571. Applying both filters one after another produces original audio.
  572. @section aecho
  573. Apply echoing to the input audio.
  574. Echoes are reflected sound and can occur naturally amongst mountains
  575. (and sometimes large buildings) when talking or shouting; digital echo
  576. effects emulate this behaviour and are often used to help fill out the
  577. sound of a single instrument or vocal. The time difference between the
  578. original signal and the reflection is the @code{delay}, and the
  579. loudness of the reflected signal is the @code{decay}.
  580. Multiple echoes can have different delays and decays.
  581. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  582. @table @option
  583. @item in_gain
  584. Set input gain of reflected signal. Default is @code{0.6}.
  585. @item out_gain
  586. Set output gain of reflected signal. Default is @code{0.3}.
  587. @item delays
  588. Set list of time intervals in milliseconds between original signal and reflections
  589. separated by '|'. Allowed range for each @code{delay} is @code{(0 - 90000.0]}.
  590. Default is @code{1000}.
  591. @item decays
  592. Set list of loudness of reflected signals separated by '|'.
  593. Allowed range for each @code{decay} is @code{(0 - 1.0]}.
  594. Default is @code{0.5}.
  595. @end table
  596. @subsection Examples
  597. @itemize
  598. @item
  599. Make it sound as if there are twice as many instruments as are actually playing:
  600. @example
  601. aecho=0.8:0.88:60:0.4
  602. @end example
  603. @item
  604. If delay is very short, then it sounds like a (metallic) robot playing music:
  605. @example
  606. aecho=0.8:0.88:6:0.4
  607. @end example
  608. @item
  609. A longer delay will sound like an open air concert in the mountains:
  610. @example
  611. aecho=0.8:0.9:1000:0.3
  612. @end example
  613. @item
  614. Same as above but with one more mountain:
  615. @example
  616. aecho=0.8:0.9:1000|1800:0.3|0.25
  617. @end example
  618. @end itemize
  619. @section aemphasis
  620. Audio emphasis filter creates or restores material directly taken from LPs or
  621. emphased CDs with different filter curves. E.g. to store music on vinyl the
  622. signal has to be altered by a filter first to even out the disadvantages of
  623. this recording medium.
  624. Once the material is played back the inverse filter has to be applied to
  625. restore the distortion of the frequency response.
  626. The filter accepts the following options:
  627. @table @option
  628. @item level_in
  629. Set input gain.
  630. @item level_out
  631. Set output gain.
  632. @item mode
  633. Set filter mode. For restoring material use @code{reproduction} mode, otherwise
  634. use @code{production} mode. Default is @code{reproduction} mode.
  635. @item type
  636. Set filter type. Selects medium. Can be one of the following:
  637. @table @option
  638. @item col
  639. select Columbia.
  640. @item emi
  641. select EMI.
  642. @item bsi
  643. select BSI (78RPM).
  644. @item riaa
  645. select RIAA.
  646. @item cd
  647. select Compact Disc (CD).
  648. @item 50fm
  649. select 50µs (FM).
  650. @item 75fm
  651. select 75µs (FM).
  652. @item 50kf
  653. select 50µs (FM-KF).
  654. @item 75kf
  655. select 75µs (FM-KF).
  656. @end table
  657. @end table
  658. @section aeval
  659. Modify an audio signal according to the specified expressions.
  660. This filter accepts one or more expressions (one for each channel),
  661. which are evaluated and used to modify a corresponding audio signal.
  662. It accepts the following parameters:
  663. @table @option
  664. @item exprs
  665. Set the '|'-separated expressions list for each separate channel. If
  666. the number of input channels is greater than the number of
  667. expressions, the last specified expression is used for the remaining
  668. output channels.
  669. @item channel_layout, c
  670. Set output channel layout. If not specified, the channel layout is
  671. specified by the number of expressions. If set to @samp{same}, it will
  672. use by default the same input channel layout.
  673. @end table
  674. Each expression in @var{exprs} can contain the following constants and functions:
  675. @table @option
  676. @item ch
  677. channel number of the current expression
  678. @item n
  679. number of the evaluated sample, starting from 0
  680. @item s
  681. sample rate
  682. @item t
  683. time of the evaluated sample expressed in seconds
  684. @item nb_in_channels
  685. @item nb_out_channels
  686. input and output number of channels
  687. @item val(CH)
  688. the value of input channel with number @var{CH}
  689. @end table
  690. Note: this filter is slow. For faster processing you should use a
  691. dedicated filter.
  692. @subsection Examples
  693. @itemize
  694. @item
  695. Half volume:
  696. @example
  697. aeval=val(ch)/2:c=same
  698. @end example
  699. @item
  700. Invert phase of the second channel:
  701. @example
  702. aeval=val(0)|-val(1)
  703. @end example
  704. @end itemize
  705. @anchor{afade}
  706. @section afade
  707. Apply fade-in/out effect to input audio.
  708. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  709. @table @option
  710. @item type, t
  711. Specify the effect type, can be either @code{in} for fade-in, or
  712. @code{out} for a fade-out effect. Default is @code{in}.
  713. @item start_sample, ss
  714. Specify the number of the start sample for starting to apply the fade
  715. effect. Default is 0.
  716. @item nb_samples, ns
  717. Specify the number of samples for which the fade effect has to last. At
  718. the end of the fade-in effect the output audio will have the same
  719. volume as the input audio, at the end of the fade-out transition
  720. the output audio will be silence. Default is 44100.
  721. @item start_time, st
  722. Specify the start time of the fade effect. Default is 0.
  723. The value must be specified as a time duration; see
  724. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  725. for the accepted syntax.
  726. If set this option is used instead of @var{start_sample}.
  727. @item duration, d
  728. Specify the duration of the fade effect. See
  729. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  730. for the accepted syntax.
  731. At the end of the fade-in effect the output audio will have the same
  732. volume as the input audio, at the end of the fade-out transition
  733. the output audio will be silence.
  734. By default the duration is determined by @var{nb_samples}.
  735. If set this option is used instead of @var{nb_samples}.
  736. @item curve
  737. Set curve for fade transition.
  738. It accepts the following values:
  739. @table @option
  740. @item tri
  741. select triangular, linear slope (default)
  742. @item qsin
  743. select quarter of sine wave
  744. @item hsin
  745. select half of sine wave
  746. @item esin
  747. select exponential sine wave
  748. @item log
  749. select logarithmic
  750. @item ipar
  751. select inverted parabola
  752. @item qua
  753. select quadratic
  754. @item cub
  755. select cubic
  756. @item squ
  757. select square root
  758. @item cbr
  759. select cubic root
  760. @item par
  761. select parabola
  762. @item exp
  763. select exponential
  764. @item iqsin
  765. select inverted quarter of sine wave
  766. @item ihsin
  767. select inverted half of sine wave
  768. @item dese
  769. select double-exponential seat
  770. @item desi
  771. select double-exponential sigmoid
  772. @item losi
  773. select logistic sigmoid
  774. @item nofade
  775. no fade applied
  776. @end table
  777. @end table
  778. @subsection Examples
  779. @itemize
  780. @item
  781. Fade in first 15 seconds of audio:
  782. @example
  783. afade=t=in:ss=0:d=15
  784. @end example
  785. @item
  786. Fade out last 25 seconds of a 900 seconds audio:
  787. @example
  788. afade=t=out:st=875:d=25
  789. @end example
  790. @end itemize
  791. @section afftdn
  792. Denoise audio samples with FFT.
  793. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  794. @table @option
  795. @item nr
  796. Set the noise reduction in dB, allowed range is 0.01 to 97.
  797. Default value is 12 dB.
  798. @item nf
  799. Set the noise floor in dB, allowed range is -80 to -20.
  800. Default value is -50 dB.
  801. @item nt
  802. Set the noise type.
  803. It accepts the following values:
  804. @table @option
  805. @item w
  806. Select white noise.
  807. @item v
  808. Select vinyl noise.
  809. @item s
  810. Select shellac noise.
  811. @item c
  812. Select custom noise, defined in @code{bn} option.
  813. Default value is white noise.
  814. @end table
  815. @item bn
  816. Set custom band noise for every one of 15 bands.
  817. Bands are separated by ' ' or '|'.
  818. @item rf
  819. Set the residual floor in dB, allowed range is -80 to -20.
  820. Default value is -38 dB.
  821. @item tn
  822. Enable noise tracking. By default is disabled.
  823. With this enabled, noise floor is automatically adjusted.
  824. @item tr
  825. Enable residual tracking. By default is disabled.
  826. @item om
  827. Set the output mode.
  828. It accepts the following values:
  829. @table @option
  830. @item i
  831. Pass input unchanged.
  832. @item o
  833. Pass noise filtered out.
  834. @item n
  835. Pass only noise.
  836. Default value is @var{o}.
  837. @end table
  838. @end table
  839. @subsection Commands
  840. This filter supports the following commands:
  841. @table @option
  842. @item sample_noise, sn
  843. Start or stop measuring noise profile.
  844. Syntax for the command is : "start" or "stop" string.
  845. After measuring noise profile is stopped it will be
  846. automatically applied in filtering.
  847. @item noise_reduction, nr
  848. Change noise reduction. Argument is single float number.
  849. Syntax for the command is : "@var{noise_reduction}"
  850. @item noise_floor, nf
  851. Change noise floor. Argument is single float number.
  852. Syntax for the command is : "@var{noise_floor}"
  853. @item output_mode, om
  854. Change output mode operation.
  855. Syntax for the command is : "i", "o" or "n" string.
  856. @end table
  857. @section afftfilt
  858. Apply arbitrary expressions to samples in frequency domain.
  859. @table @option
  860. @item real
  861. Set frequency domain real expression for each separate channel separated
  862. by '|'. Default is "re".
  863. If the number of input channels is greater than the number of
  864. expressions, the last specified expression is used for the remaining
  865. output channels.
  866. @item imag
  867. Set frequency domain imaginary expression for each separate channel
  868. separated by '|'. Default is "im".
  869. Each expression in @var{real} and @var{imag} can contain the following
  870. constants and functions:
  871. @table @option
  872. @item sr
  873. sample rate
  874. @item b
  875. current frequency bin number
  876. @item nb
  877. number of available bins
  878. @item ch
  879. channel number of the current expression
  880. @item chs
  881. number of channels
  882. @item pts
  883. current frame pts
  884. @item re
  885. current real part of frequency bin of current channel
  886. @item im
  887. current imaginary part of frequency bin of current channel
  888. @item real(b, ch)
  889. Return the value of real part of frequency bin at location (@var{bin},@var{channel})
  890. @item imag(b, ch)
  891. Return the value of imaginary part of frequency bin at location (@var{bin},@var{channel})
  892. @end table
  893. @item win_size
  894. Set window size. Allowed range is from 16 to 131072.
  895. Default is @code{4096}
  896. @item win_func
  897. Set window function. Default is @code{hann}.
  898. @item overlap
  899. Set window overlap. If set to 1, the recommended overlap for selected
  900. window function will be picked. Default is @code{0.75}.
  901. @end table
  902. @subsection Examples
  903. @itemize
  904. @item
  905. Leave almost only low frequencies in audio:
  906. @example
  907. afftfilt="'real=re * (1-clip((b/nb)*b,0,1))':imag='im * (1-clip((b/nb)*b,0,1))'"
  908. @end example
  909. @item
  910. Apply robotize effect:
  911. @example
  912. afftfilt="real='hypot(re,im)*sin(0)':imag='hypot(re,im)*cos(0)':win_size=512:overlap=0.75"
  913. @end example
  914. @item
  915. Apply whisper effect:
  916. @example
  917. afftfilt="real='hypot(re,im)*cos((random(0)*2-1)*2*3.14)':imag='hypot(re,im)*sin((random(1)*2-1)*2*3.14)':win_size=128:overlap=0.8"
  918. @end example
  919. @end itemize
  920. @anchor{afir}
  921. @section afir
  922. Apply an arbitrary Finite Impulse Response filter.
  923. This filter is designed for applying long FIR filters,
  924. up to 60 seconds long.
  925. It can be used as component for digital crossover filters,
  926. room equalization, cross talk cancellation, wavefield synthesis,
  927. auralization, ambiophonics, ambisonics and spatialization.
  928. This filter uses the streams higher than first one as FIR coefficients.
  929. If the non-first stream holds a single channel, it will be used
  930. for all input channels in the first stream, otherwise
  931. the number of channels in the non-first stream must be same as
  932. the number of channels in the first stream.
  933. It accepts the following parameters:
  934. @table @option
  935. @item dry
  936. Set dry gain. This sets input gain.
  937. @item wet
  938. Set wet gain. This sets final output gain.
  939. @item length
  940. Set Impulse Response filter length. Default is 1, which means whole IR is processed.
  941. @item gtype
  942. Enable applying gain measured from power of IR.
  943. Set which approach to use for auto gain measurement.
  944. @table @option
  945. @item none
  946. Do not apply any gain.
  947. @item peak
  948. select peak gain, very conservative approach. This is default value.
  949. @item dc
  950. select DC gain, limited application.
  951. @item gn
  952. select gain to noise approach, this is most popular one.
  953. @end table
  954. @item irgain
  955. Set gain to be applied to IR coefficients before filtering.
  956. Allowed range is 0 to 1. This gain is applied after any gain applied with @var{gtype} option.
  957. @item irfmt
  958. Set format of IR stream. Can be @code{mono} or @code{input}.
  959. Default is @code{input}.
  960. @item maxir
  961. Set max allowed Impulse Response filter duration in seconds. Default is 30 seconds.
  962. Allowed range is 0.1 to 60 seconds.
  963. @item response
  964. Show IR frequency response, magnitude(magenta), phase(green) and group delay(yellow) in additional video stream.
  965. By default it is disabled.
  966. @item channel
  967. Set for which IR channel to display frequency response. By default is first channel
  968. displayed. This option is used only when @var{response} is enabled.
  969. @item size
  970. Set video stream size. This option is used only when @var{response} is enabled.
  971. @item rate
  972. Set video stream frame rate. This option is used only when @var{response} is enabled.
  973. @item minp
  974. Set minimal partition size used for convolution. Default is @var{8192}.
  975. Allowed range is from @var{1} to @var{32768}.
  976. Lower values decreases latency at cost of higher CPU usage.
  977. @item maxp
  978. Set maximal partition size used for convolution. Default is @var{8192}.
  979. Allowed range is from @var{8} to @var{32768}.
  980. Lower values may increase CPU usage.
  981. @item nbirs
  982. Set number of input impulse responses streams which will be switchable at runtime.
  983. Allowed range is from @var{1} to @var{32}. Default is @var{1}.
  984. @item ir
  985. Set IR stream which will be used for convolution, starting from @var{0}, should always be
  986. lower than supplied value by @code{nbirs} option. Default is @var{0}.
  987. This option can be changed at runtime via @ref{commands}.
  988. @end table
  989. @subsection Examples
  990. @itemize
  991. @item
  992. Apply reverb to stream using mono IR file as second input, complete command using ffmpeg:
  993. @example
  994. ffmpeg -i input.wav -i middle_tunnel_1way_mono.wav -lavfi afir output.wav
  995. @end example
  996. @end itemize
  997. @anchor{aformat}
  998. @section aformat
  999. Set output format constraints for the input audio. The framework will
  1000. negotiate the most appropriate format to minimize conversions.
  1001. It accepts the following parameters:
  1002. @table @option
  1003. @item sample_fmts, f
  1004. A '|'-separated list of requested sample formats.
  1005. @item sample_rates, r
  1006. A '|'-separated list of requested sample rates.
  1007. @item channel_layouts, cl
  1008. A '|'-separated list of requested channel layouts.
  1009. See @ref{channel layout syntax,,the Channel Layout section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  1010. for the required syntax.
  1011. @end table
  1012. If a parameter is omitted, all values are allowed.
  1013. Force the output to either unsigned 8-bit or signed 16-bit stereo
  1014. @example
  1015. aformat=sample_fmts=u8|s16:channel_layouts=stereo
  1016. @end example
  1017. @section agate
  1018. A gate is mainly used to reduce lower parts of a signal. This kind of signal
  1019. processing reduces disturbing noise between useful signals.
  1020. Gating is done by detecting the volume below a chosen level @var{threshold}
  1021. and dividing it by the factor set with @var{ratio}. The bottom of the noise
  1022. floor is set via @var{range}. Because an exact manipulation of the signal
  1023. would cause distortion of the waveform the reduction can be levelled over
  1024. time. This is done by setting @var{attack} and @var{release}.
  1025. @var{attack} determines how long the signal has to fall below the threshold
  1026. before any reduction will occur and @var{release} sets the time the signal
  1027. has to rise above the threshold to reduce the reduction again.
  1028. Shorter signals than the chosen attack time will be left untouched.
  1029. @table @option
  1030. @item level_in
  1031. Set input level before filtering.
  1032. Default is 1. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  1033. @item mode
  1034. Set the mode of operation. Can be @code{upward} or @code{downward}.
  1035. Default is @code{downward}. If set to @code{upward} mode, higher parts of signal
  1036. will be amplified, expanding dynamic range in upward direction.
  1037. Otherwise, in case of @code{downward} lower parts of signal will be reduced.
  1038. @item range
  1039. Set the level of gain reduction when the signal is below the threshold.
  1040. Default is 0.06125. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  1041. Setting this to 0 disables reduction and then filter behaves like expander.
  1042. @item threshold
  1043. If a signal rises above this level the gain reduction is released.
  1044. Default is 0.125. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  1045. @item ratio
  1046. Set a ratio by which the signal is reduced.
  1047. Default is 2. Allowed range is from 1 to 9000.
  1048. @item attack
  1049. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to rise above the threshold before gain
  1050. reduction stops.
  1051. Default is 20 milliseconds. Allowed range is from 0.01 to 9000.
  1052. @item release
  1053. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to fall below the threshold before the
  1054. reduction is increased again. Default is 250 milliseconds.
  1055. Allowed range is from 0.01 to 9000.
  1056. @item makeup
  1057. Set amount of amplification of signal after processing.
  1058. Default is 1. Allowed range is from 1 to 64.
  1059. @item knee
  1060. Curve the sharp knee around the threshold to enter gain reduction more softly.
  1061. Default is 2.828427125. Allowed range is from 1 to 8.
  1062. @item detection
  1063. Choose if exact signal should be taken for detection or an RMS like one.
  1064. Default is @code{rms}. Can be @code{peak} or @code{rms}.
  1065. @item link
  1066. Choose if the average level between all channels or the louder channel affects
  1067. the reduction.
  1068. Default is @code{average}. Can be @code{average} or @code{maximum}.
  1069. @end table
  1070. @section aiir
  1071. Apply an arbitrary Infinite Impulse Response filter.
  1072. It accepts the following parameters:
  1073. @table @option
  1074. @item z
  1075. Set numerator/zeros coefficients.
  1076. @item p
  1077. Set denominator/poles coefficients.
  1078. @item k
  1079. Set channels gains.
  1080. @item dry_gain
  1081. Set input gain.
  1082. @item wet_gain
  1083. Set output gain.
  1084. @item f
  1085. Set coefficients format.
  1086. @table @samp
  1087. @item tf
  1088. transfer function
  1089. @item zp
  1090. Z-plane zeros/poles, cartesian (default)
  1091. @item pr
  1092. Z-plane zeros/poles, polar radians
  1093. @item pd
  1094. Z-plane zeros/poles, polar degrees
  1095. @end table
  1096. @item r
  1097. Set kind of processing.
  1098. Can be @code{d} - direct or @code{s} - serial cascading. Default is @code{s}.
  1099. @item e
  1100. Set filtering precision.
  1101. @table @samp
  1102. @item dbl
  1103. double-precision floating-point (default)
  1104. @item flt
  1105. single-precision floating-point
  1106. @item i32
  1107. 32-bit integers
  1108. @item i16
  1109. 16-bit integers
  1110. @end table
  1111. @item mix
  1112. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  1113. Range is between 0 and 1.
  1114. @item response
  1115. Show IR frequency response, magnitude(magenta), phase(green) and group delay(yellow) in additional video stream.
  1116. By default it is disabled.
  1117. @item channel
  1118. Set for which IR channel to display frequency response. By default is first channel
  1119. displayed. This option is used only when @var{response} is enabled.
  1120. @item size
  1121. Set video stream size. This option is used only when @var{response} is enabled.
  1122. @end table
  1123. Coefficients in @code{tf} format are separated by spaces and are in ascending
  1124. order.
  1125. Coefficients in @code{zp} format are separated by spaces and order of coefficients
  1126. doesn't matter. Coefficients in @code{zp} format are complex numbers with @var{i}
  1127. imaginary unit.
  1128. Different coefficients and gains can be provided for every channel, in such case
  1129. use '|' to separate coefficients or gains. Last provided coefficients will be
  1130. used for all remaining channels.
  1131. @subsection Examples
  1132. @itemize
  1133. @item
  1134. Apply 2 pole elliptic notch at around 5000Hz for 48000 Hz sample rate:
  1135. @example
  1136. aiir=k=1:z=7.957584807809675810E-1 -2.575128568908332300 3.674839853930788710 -2.57512875289799137 7.957586296317130880E-1:p=1 -2.86950072432325953 3.63022088054647218 -2.28075678147272232 6.361362326477423500E-1:f=tf:r=d
  1137. @end example
  1138. @item
  1139. Same as above but in @code{zp} format:
  1140. @example
  1141. aiir=k=0.79575848078096756:z=0.80918701+0.58773007i 0.80918701-0.58773007i 0.80884700+0.58784055i 0.80884700-0.58784055i:p=0.63892345+0.59951235i 0.63892345-0.59951235i 0.79582691+0.44198673i 0.79582691-0.44198673i:f=zp:r=s
  1142. @end example
  1143. @end itemize
  1144. @section alimiter
  1145. The limiter prevents an input signal from rising over a desired threshold.
  1146. This limiter uses lookahead technology to prevent your signal from distorting.
  1147. It means that there is a small delay after the signal is processed. Keep in mind
  1148. that the delay it produces is the attack time you set.
  1149. The filter accepts the following options:
  1150. @table @option
  1151. @item level_in
  1152. Set input gain. Default is 1.
  1153. @item level_out
  1154. Set output gain. Default is 1.
  1155. @item limit
  1156. Don't let signals above this level pass the limiter. Default is 1.
  1157. @item attack
  1158. The limiter will reach its attenuation level in this amount of time in
  1159. milliseconds. Default is 5 milliseconds.
  1160. @item release
  1161. Come back from limiting to attenuation 1.0 in this amount of milliseconds.
  1162. Default is 50 milliseconds.
  1163. @item asc
  1164. When gain reduction is always needed ASC takes care of releasing to an
  1165. average reduction level rather than reaching a reduction of 0 in the release
  1166. time.
  1167. @item asc_level
  1168. Select how much the release time is affected by ASC, 0 means nearly no changes
  1169. in release time while 1 produces higher release times.
  1170. @item level
  1171. Auto level output signal. Default is enabled.
  1172. This normalizes audio back to 0dB if enabled.
  1173. @end table
  1174. Depending on picked setting it is recommended to upsample input 2x or 4x times
  1175. with @ref{aresample} before applying this filter.
  1176. @section allpass
  1177. Apply a two-pole all-pass filter with central frequency (in Hz)
  1178. @var{frequency}, and filter-width @var{width}.
  1179. An all-pass filter changes the audio's frequency to phase relationship
  1180. without changing its frequency to amplitude relationship.
  1181. The filter accepts the following options:
  1182. @table @option
  1183. @item frequency, f
  1184. Set frequency in Hz.
  1185. @item width_type, t
  1186. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  1187. @table @option
  1188. @item h
  1189. Hz
  1190. @item q
  1191. Q-Factor
  1192. @item o
  1193. octave
  1194. @item s
  1195. slope
  1196. @item k
  1197. kHz
  1198. @end table
  1199. @item width, w
  1200. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  1201. @item mix, m
  1202. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  1203. Range is between 0 and 1.
  1204. @item channels, c
  1205. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  1206. @item normalize, n
  1207. Normalize biquad coefficients, by default is disabled.
  1208. Enabling it will normalize magnitude response at DC to 0dB.
  1209. @end table
  1210. @subsection Commands
  1211. This filter supports the following commands:
  1212. @table @option
  1213. @item frequency, f
  1214. Change allpass frequency.
  1215. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  1216. @item width_type, t
  1217. Change allpass width_type.
  1218. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  1219. @item width, w
  1220. Change allpass width.
  1221. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  1222. @item mix, m
  1223. Change allpass mix.
  1224. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  1225. @end table
  1226. @section aloop
  1227. Loop audio samples.
  1228. The filter accepts the following options:
  1229. @table @option
  1230. @item loop
  1231. Set the number of loops. Setting this value to -1 will result in infinite loops.
  1232. Default is 0.
  1233. @item size
  1234. Set maximal number of samples. Default is 0.
  1235. @item start
  1236. Set first sample of loop. Default is 0.
  1237. @end table
  1238. @anchor{amerge}
  1239. @section amerge
  1240. Merge two or more audio streams into a single multi-channel stream.
  1241. The filter accepts the following options:
  1242. @table @option
  1243. @item inputs
  1244. Set the number of inputs. Default is 2.
  1245. @end table
  1246. If the channel layouts of the inputs are disjoint, and therefore compatible,
  1247. the channel layout of the output will be set accordingly and the channels
  1248. will be reordered as necessary. If the channel layouts of the inputs are not
  1249. disjoint, the output will have all the channels of the first input then all
  1250. the channels of the second input, in that order, and the channel layout of
  1251. the output will be the default value corresponding to the total number of
  1252. channels.
  1253. For example, if the first input is in 2.1 (FL+FR+LF) and the second input
  1254. is FC+BL+BR, then the output will be in 5.1, with the channels in the
  1255. following order: a1, a2, b1, a3, b2, b3 (a1 is the first channel of the
  1256. first input, b1 is the first channel of the second input).
  1257. On the other hand, if both input are in stereo, the output channels will be
  1258. in the default order: a1, a2, b1, b2, and the channel layout will be
  1259. arbitrarily set to 4.0, which may or may not be the expected value.
  1260. All inputs must have the same sample rate, and format.
  1261. If inputs do not have the same duration, the output will stop with the
  1262. shortest.
  1263. @subsection Examples
  1264. @itemize
  1265. @item
  1266. Merge two mono files into a stereo stream:
  1267. @example
  1268. amovie=left.wav [l] ; amovie=right.mp3 [r] ; [l] [r] amerge
  1269. @end example
  1270. @item
  1271. Multiple merges assuming 1 video stream and 6 audio streams in @file{input.mkv}:
  1272. @example
  1273. ffmpeg -i input.mkv -filter_complex "[0:1][0:2][0:3][0:4][0:5][0:6] amerge=inputs=6" -c:a pcm_s16le output.mkv
  1274. @end example
  1275. @end itemize
  1276. @section amix
  1277. Mixes multiple audio inputs into a single output.
  1278. Note that this filter only supports float samples (the @var{amerge}
  1279. and @var{pan} audio filters support many formats). If the @var{amix}
  1280. input has integer samples then @ref{aresample} will be automatically
  1281. inserted to perform the conversion to float samples.
  1282. For example
  1283. @example
  1284. ffmpeg -i INPUT1 -i INPUT2 -i INPUT3 -filter_complex amix=inputs=3:duration=first:dropout_transition=3 OUTPUT
  1285. @end example
  1286. will mix 3 input audio streams to a single output with the same duration as the
  1287. first input and a dropout transition time of 3 seconds.
  1288. It accepts the following parameters:
  1289. @table @option
  1290. @item inputs
  1291. The number of inputs. If unspecified, it defaults to 2.
  1292. @item duration
  1293. How to determine the end-of-stream.
  1294. @table @option
  1295. @item longest
  1296. The duration of the longest input. (default)
  1297. @item shortest
  1298. The duration of the shortest input.
  1299. @item first
  1300. The duration of the first input.
  1301. @end table
  1302. @item dropout_transition
  1303. The transition time, in seconds, for volume renormalization when an input
  1304. stream ends. The default value is 2 seconds.
  1305. @item weights
  1306. Specify weight of each input audio stream as sequence.
  1307. Each weight is separated by space. By default all inputs have same weight.
  1308. @end table
  1309. @section amultiply
  1310. Multiply first audio stream with second audio stream and store result
  1311. in output audio stream. Multiplication is done by multiplying each
  1312. sample from first stream with sample at same position from second stream.
  1313. With this element-wise multiplication one can create amplitude fades and
  1314. amplitude modulations.
  1315. @section anequalizer
  1316. High-order parametric multiband equalizer for each channel.
  1317. It accepts the following parameters:
  1318. @table @option
  1319. @item params
  1320. This option string is in format:
  1321. "c@var{chn} f=@var{cf} w=@var{w} g=@var{g} t=@var{f} | ..."
  1322. Each equalizer band is separated by '|'.
  1323. @table @option
  1324. @item chn
  1325. Set channel number to which equalization will be applied.
  1326. If input doesn't have that channel the entry is ignored.
  1327. @item f
  1328. Set central frequency for band.
  1329. If input doesn't have that frequency the entry is ignored.
  1330. @item w
  1331. Set band width in hertz.
  1332. @item g
  1333. Set band gain in dB.
  1334. @item t
  1335. Set filter type for band, optional, can be:
  1336. @table @samp
  1337. @item 0
  1338. Butterworth, this is default.
  1339. @item 1
  1340. Chebyshev type 1.
  1341. @item 2
  1342. Chebyshev type 2.
  1343. @end table
  1344. @end table
  1345. @item curves
  1346. With this option activated frequency response of anequalizer is displayed
  1347. in video stream.
  1348. @item size
  1349. Set video stream size. Only useful if curves option is activated.
  1350. @item mgain
  1351. Set max gain that will be displayed. Only useful if curves option is activated.
  1352. Setting this to a reasonable value makes it possible to display gain which is derived from
  1353. neighbour bands which are too close to each other and thus produce higher gain
  1354. when both are activated.
  1355. @item fscale
  1356. Set frequency scale used to draw frequency response in video output.
  1357. Can be linear or logarithmic. Default is logarithmic.
  1358. @item colors
  1359. Set color for each channel curve which is going to be displayed in video stream.
  1360. This is list of color names separated by space or by '|'.
  1361. Unrecognised or missing colors will be replaced by white color.
  1362. @end table
  1363. @subsection Examples
  1364. @itemize
  1365. @item
  1366. Lower gain by 10 of central frequency 200Hz and width 100 Hz
  1367. for first 2 channels using Chebyshev type 1 filter:
  1368. @example
  1369. anequalizer=c0 f=200 w=100 g=-10 t=1|c1 f=200 w=100 g=-10 t=1
  1370. @end example
  1371. @end itemize
  1372. @subsection Commands
  1373. This filter supports the following commands:
  1374. @table @option
  1375. @item change
  1376. Alter existing filter parameters.
  1377. Syntax for the commands is : "@var{fN}|f=@var{freq}|w=@var{width}|g=@var{gain}"
  1378. @var{fN} is existing filter number, starting from 0, if no such filter is available
  1379. error is returned.
  1380. @var{freq} set new frequency parameter.
  1381. @var{width} set new width parameter in herz.
  1382. @var{gain} set new gain parameter in dB.
  1383. Full filter invocation with asendcmd may look like this:
  1384. asendcmd=c='4.0 anequalizer change 0|f=200|w=50|g=1',anequalizer=...
  1385. @end table
  1386. @section anlmdn
  1387. Reduce broadband noise in audio samples using Non-Local Means algorithm.
  1388. Each sample is adjusted by looking for other samples with similar contexts. This
  1389. context similarity is defined by comparing their surrounding patches of size
  1390. @option{p}. Patches are searched in an area of @option{r} around the sample.
  1391. The filter accepts the following options:
  1392. @table @option
  1393. @item s
  1394. Set denoising strength. Allowed range is from 0.00001 to 10. Default value is 0.00001.
  1395. @item p
  1396. Set patch radius duration. Allowed range is from 1 to 100 milliseconds.
  1397. Default value is 2 milliseconds.
  1398. @item r
  1399. Set research radius duration. Allowed range is from 2 to 300 milliseconds.
  1400. Default value is 6 milliseconds.
  1401. @item o
  1402. Set the output mode.
  1403. It accepts the following values:
  1404. @table @option
  1405. @item i
  1406. Pass input unchanged.
  1407. @item o
  1408. Pass noise filtered out.
  1409. @item n
  1410. Pass only noise.
  1411. Default value is @var{o}.
  1412. @end table
  1413. @item m
  1414. Set smooth factor. Default value is @var{11}. Allowed range is from @var{1} to @var{15}.
  1415. @end table
  1416. @subsection Commands
  1417. This filter supports the following commands:
  1418. @table @option
  1419. @item s
  1420. Change denoise strength. Argument is single float number.
  1421. Syntax for the command is : "@var{s}"
  1422. @item o
  1423. Change output mode.
  1424. Syntax for the command is : "i", "o" or "n" string.
  1425. @end table
  1426. @section anlms
  1427. Apply Normalized Least-Mean-Squares algorithm to the first audio stream using the second audio stream.
  1428. This adaptive filter is used to mimic a desired filter by finding the filter coefficients that
  1429. relate to producing the least mean square of the error signal (difference between the desired,
  1430. 2nd input audio stream and the actual signal, the 1st input audio stream).
  1431. A description of the accepted options follows.
  1432. @table @option
  1433. @item order
  1434. Set filter order.
  1435. @item mu
  1436. Set filter mu.
  1437. @item eps
  1438. Set the filter eps.
  1439. @item leakage
  1440. Set the filter leakage.
  1441. @item out_mode
  1442. It accepts the following values:
  1443. @table @option
  1444. @item i
  1445. Pass the 1st input.
  1446. @item d
  1447. Pass the 2nd input.
  1448. @item o
  1449. Pass filtered samples.
  1450. @item n
  1451. Pass difference between desired and filtered samples.
  1452. Default value is @var{o}.
  1453. @end table
  1454. @end table
  1455. @subsection Examples
  1456. @itemize
  1457. @item
  1458. One of many usages of this filter is noise reduction, input audio is filtered
  1459. with same samples that are delayed by fixed amount, one such example for stereo audio is:
  1460. @example
  1461. asplit[a][b],[a]adelay=32S|32S[a],[b][a]anlms=order=128:leakage=0.0005:mu=.5:out_mode=o
  1462. @end example
  1463. @end itemize
  1464. @subsection Commands
  1465. This filter supports the same commands as options, excluding option @code{order}.
  1466. @section anull
  1467. Pass the audio source unchanged to the output.
  1468. @section apad
  1469. Pad the end of an audio stream with silence.
  1470. This can be used together with @command{ffmpeg} @option{-shortest} to
  1471. extend audio streams to the same length as the video stream.
  1472. A description of the accepted options follows.
  1473. @table @option
  1474. @item packet_size
  1475. Set silence packet size. Default value is 4096.
  1476. @item pad_len
  1477. Set the number of samples of silence to add to the end. After the
  1478. value is reached, the stream is terminated. This option is mutually
  1479. exclusive with @option{whole_len}.
  1480. @item whole_len
  1481. Set the minimum total number of samples in the output audio stream. If
  1482. the value is longer than the input audio length, silence is added to
  1483. the end, until the value is reached. This option is mutually exclusive
  1484. with @option{pad_len}.
  1485. @item pad_dur
  1486. Specify the duration of samples of silence to add. See
  1487. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  1488. for the accepted syntax. Used only if set to non-zero value.
  1489. @item whole_dur
  1490. Specify the minimum total duration in the output audio stream. See
  1491. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  1492. for the accepted syntax. Used only if set to non-zero value. If the value is longer than
  1493. the input audio length, silence is added to the end, until the value is reached.
  1494. This option is mutually exclusive with @option{pad_dur}
  1495. @end table
  1496. If neither the @option{pad_len} nor the @option{whole_len} nor @option{pad_dur}
  1497. nor @option{whole_dur} option is set, the filter will add silence to the end of
  1498. the input stream indefinitely.
  1499. @subsection Examples
  1500. @itemize
  1501. @item
  1502. Add 1024 samples of silence to the end of the input:
  1503. @example
  1504. apad=pad_len=1024
  1505. @end example
  1506. @item
  1507. Make sure the audio output will contain at least 10000 samples, pad
  1508. the input with silence if required:
  1509. @example
  1510. apad=whole_len=10000
  1511. @end example
  1512. @item
  1513. Use @command{ffmpeg} to pad the audio input with silence, so that the
  1514. video stream will always result the shortest and will be converted
  1515. until the end in the output file when using the @option{shortest}
  1516. option:
  1517. @example
  1518. ffmpeg -i VIDEO -i AUDIO -filter_complex "[1:0]apad" -shortest OUTPUT
  1519. @end example
  1520. @end itemize
  1521. @section aphaser
  1522. Add a phasing effect to the input audio.
  1523. A phaser filter creates series of peaks and troughs in the frequency spectrum.
  1524. The position of the peaks and troughs are modulated so that they vary over time, creating a sweeping effect.
  1525. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  1526. @table @option
  1527. @item in_gain
  1528. Set input gain. Default is 0.4.
  1529. @item out_gain
  1530. Set output gain. Default is 0.74
  1531. @item delay
  1532. Set delay in milliseconds. Default is 3.0.
  1533. @item decay
  1534. Set decay. Default is 0.4.
  1535. @item speed
  1536. Set modulation speed in Hz. Default is 0.5.
  1537. @item type
  1538. Set modulation type. Default is triangular.
  1539. It accepts the following values:
  1540. @table @samp
  1541. @item triangular, t
  1542. @item sinusoidal, s
  1543. @end table
  1544. @end table
  1545. @section apulsator
  1546. Audio pulsator is something between an autopanner and a tremolo.
  1547. But it can produce funny stereo effects as well. Pulsator changes the volume
  1548. of the left and right channel based on a LFO (low frequency oscillator) with
  1549. different waveforms and shifted phases.
  1550. This filter have the ability to define an offset between left and right
  1551. channel. An offset of 0 means that both LFO shapes match each other.
  1552. The left and right channel are altered equally - a conventional tremolo.
  1553. An offset of 50% means that the shape of the right channel is exactly shifted
  1554. in phase (or moved backwards about half of the frequency) - pulsator acts as
  1555. an autopanner. At 1 both curves match again. Every setting in between moves the
  1556. phase shift gapless between all stages and produces some "bypassing" sounds with
  1557. sine and triangle waveforms. The more you set the offset near 1 (starting from
  1558. the 0.5) the faster the signal passes from the left to the right speaker.
  1559. The filter accepts the following options:
  1560. @table @option
  1561. @item level_in
  1562. Set input gain. By default it is 1. Range is [0.015625 - 64].
  1563. @item level_out
  1564. Set output gain. By default it is 1. Range is [0.015625 - 64].
  1565. @item mode
  1566. Set waveform shape the LFO will use. Can be one of: sine, triangle, square,
  1567. sawup or sawdown. Default is sine.
  1568. @item amount
  1569. Set modulation. Define how much of original signal is affected by the LFO.
  1570. @item offset_l
  1571. Set left channel offset. Default is 0. Allowed range is [0 - 1].
  1572. @item offset_r
  1573. Set right channel offset. Default is 0.5. Allowed range is [0 - 1].
  1574. @item width
  1575. Set pulse width. Default is 1. Allowed range is [0 - 2].
  1576. @item timing
  1577. Set possible timing mode. Can be one of: bpm, ms or hz. Default is hz.
  1578. @item bpm
  1579. Set bpm. Default is 120. Allowed range is [30 - 300]. Only used if timing
  1580. is set to bpm.
  1581. @item ms
  1582. Set ms. Default is 500. Allowed range is [10 - 2000]. Only used if timing
  1583. is set to ms.
  1584. @item hz
  1585. Set frequency in Hz. Default is 2. Allowed range is [0.01 - 100]. Only used
  1586. if timing is set to hz.
  1587. @end table
  1588. @anchor{aresample}
  1589. @section aresample
  1590. Resample the input audio to the specified parameters, using the
  1591. libswresample library. If none are specified then the filter will
  1592. automatically convert between its input and output.
  1593. This filter is also able to stretch/squeeze the audio data to make it match
  1594. the timestamps or to inject silence / cut out audio to make it match the
  1595. timestamps, do a combination of both or do neither.
  1596. The filter accepts the syntax
  1597. [@var{sample_rate}:]@var{resampler_options}, where @var{sample_rate}
  1598. expresses a sample rate and @var{resampler_options} is a list of
  1599. @var{key}=@var{value} pairs, separated by ":". See the
  1600. @ref{Resampler Options,,"Resampler Options" section in the
  1601. ffmpeg-resampler(1) manual,ffmpeg-resampler}
  1602. for the complete list of supported options.
  1603. @subsection Examples
  1604. @itemize
  1605. @item
  1606. Resample the input audio to 44100Hz:
  1607. @example
  1608. aresample=44100
  1609. @end example
  1610. @item
  1611. Stretch/squeeze samples to the given timestamps, with a maximum of 1000
  1612. samples per second compensation:
  1613. @example
  1614. aresample=async=1000
  1615. @end example
  1616. @end itemize
  1617. @section areverse
  1618. Reverse an audio clip.
  1619. Warning: This filter requires memory to buffer the entire clip, so trimming
  1620. is suggested.
  1621. @subsection Examples
  1622. @itemize
  1623. @item
  1624. Take the first 5 seconds of a clip, and reverse it.
  1625. @example
  1626. atrim=end=5,areverse
  1627. @end example
  1628. @end itemize
  1629. @section arnndn
  1630. Reduce noise from speech using Recurrent Neural Networks.
  1631. This filter accepts the following options:
  1632. @table @option
  1633. @item model, m
  1634. Set train model file to load. This option is always required.
  1635. @end table
  1636. @section asetnsamples
  1637. Set the number of samples per each output audio frame.
  1638. The last output packet may contain a different number of samples, as
  1639. the filter will flush all the remaining samples when the input audio
  1640. signals its end.
  1641. The filter accepts the following options:
  1642. @table @option
  1643. @item nb_out_samples, n
  1644. Set the number of frames per each output audio frame. The number is
  1645. intended as the number of samples @emph{per each channel}.
  1646. Default value is 1024.
  1647. @item pad, p
  1648. If set to 1, the filter will pad the last audio frame with zeroes, so
  1649. that the last frame will contain the same number of samples as the
  1650. previous ones. Default value is 1.
  1651. @end table
  1652. For example, to set the number of per-frame samples to 1234 and
  1653. disable padding for the last frame, use:
  1654. @example
  1655. asetnsamples=n=1234:p=0
  1656. @end example
  1657. @section asetrate
  1658. Set the sample rate without altering the PCM data.
  1659. This will result in a change of speed and pitch.
  1660. The filter accepts the following options:
  1661. @table @option
  1662. @item sample_rate, r
  1663. Set the output sample rate. Default is 44100 Hz.
  1664. @end table
  1665. @section ashowinfo
  1666. Show a line containing various information for each input audio frame.
  1667. The input audio is not modified.
  1668. The shown line contains a sequence of key/value pairs of the form
  1669. @var{key}:@var{value}.
  1670. The following values are shown in the output:
  1671. @table @option
  1672. @item n
  1673. The (sequential) number of the input frame, starting from 0.
  1674. @item pts
  1675. The presentation timestamp of the input frame, in time base units; the time base
  1676. depends on the filter input pad, and is usually 1/@var{sample_rate}.
  1677. @item pts_time
  1678. The presentation timestamp of the input frame in seconds.
  1679. @item pos
  1680. position of the frame in the input stream, -1 if this information in
  1681. unavailable and/or meaningless (for example in case of synthetic audio)
  1682. @item fmt
  1683. The sample format.
  1684. @item chlayout
  1685. The channel layout.
  1686. @item rate
  1687. The sample rate for the audio frame.
  1688. @item nb_samples
  1689. The number of samples (per channel) in the frame.
  1690. @item checksum
  1691. The Adler-32 checksum (printed in hexadecimal) of the audio data. For planar
  1692. audio, the data is treated as if all the planes were concatenated.
  1693. @item plane_checksums
  1694. A list of Adler-32 checksums for each data plane.
  1695. @end table
  1696. @section asoftclip
  1697. Apply audio soft clipping.
  1698. Soft clipping is a type of distortion effect where the amplitude of a signal is saturated
  1699. along a smooth curve, rather than the abrupt shape of hard-clipping.
  1700. This filter accepts the following options:
  1701. @table @option
  1702. @item type
  1703. Set type of soft-clipping.
  1704. It accepts the following values:
  1705. @table @option
  1706. @item tanh
  1707. @item atan
  1708. @item cubic
  1709. @item exp
  1710. @item alg
  1711. @item quintic
  1712. @item sin
  1713. @end table
  1714. @item param
  1715. Set additional parameter which controls sigmoid function.
  1716. @end table
  1717. @subsection Commands
  1718. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  1719. @section asr
  1720. Automatic Speech Recognition
  1721. This filter uses PocketSphinx for speech recognition. To enable
  1722. compilation of this filter, you need to configure FFmpeg with
  1723. @code{--enable-pocketsphinx}.
  1724. It accepts the following options:
  1725. @table @option
  1726. @item rate
  1727. Set sampling rate of input audio. Defaults is @code{16000}.
  1728. This need to match speech models, otherwise one will get poor results.
  1729. @item hmm
  1730. Set dictionary containing acoustic model files.
  1731. @item dict
  1732. Set pronunciation dictionary.
  1733. @item lm
  1734. Set language model file.
  1735. @item lmctl
  1736. Set language model set.
  1737. @item lmname
  1738. Set which language model to use.
  1739. @item logfn
  1740. Set output for log messages.
  1741. @end table
  1742. The filter exports recognized speech as the frame metadata @code{lavfi.asr.text}.
  1743. @anchor{astats}
  1744. @section astats
  1745. Display time domain statistical information about the audio channels.
  1746. Statistics are calculated and displayed for each audio channel and,
  1747. where applicable, an overall figure is also given.
  1748. It accepts the following option:
  1749. @table @option
  1750. @item length
  1751. Short window length in seconds, used for peak and trough RMS measurement.
  1752. Default is @code{0.05} (50 milliseconds). Allowed range is @code{[0.01 - 10]}.
  1753. @item metadata
  1754. Set metadata injection. All the metadata keys are prefixed with @code{lavfi.astats.X},
  1755. where @code{X} is channel number starting from 1 or string @code{Overall}. Default is
  1756. disabled.
  1757. Available keys for each channel are:
  1758. DC_offset
  1759. Min_level
  1760. Max_level
  1761. Min_difference
  1762. Max_difference
  1763. Mean_difference
  1764. RMS_difference
  1765. Peak_level
  1766. RMS_peak
  1767. RMS_trough
  1768. Crest_factor
  1769. Flat_factor
  1770. Peak_count
  1771. Bit_depth
  1772. Dynamic_range
  1773. Zero_crossings
  1774. Zero_crossings_rate
  1775. Number_of_NaNs
  1776. Number_of_Infs
  1777. Number_of_denormals
  1778. and for Overall:
  1779. DC_offset
  1780. Min_level
  1781. Max_level
  1782. Min_difference
  1783. Max_difference
  1784. Mean_difference
  1785. RMS_difference
  1786. Peak_level
  1787. RMS_level
  1788. RMS_peak
  1789. RMS_trough
  1790. Flat_factor
  1791. Peak_count
  1792. Bit_depth
  1793. Number_of_samples
  1794. Number_of_NaNs
  1795. Number_of_Infs
  1796. Number_of_denormals
  1797. For example full key look like this @code{lavfi.astats.1.DC_offset} or
  1798. this @code{lavfi.astats.Overall.Peak_count}.
  1799. For description what each key means read below.
  1800. @item reset
  1801. Set number of frame after which stats are going to be recalculated.
  1802. Default is disabled.
  1803. @item measure_perchannel
  1804. Select the entries which need to be measured per channel. The metadata keys can
  1805. be used as flags, default is @option{all} which measures everything.
  1806. @option{none} disables all per channel measurement.
  1807. @item measure_overall
  1808. Select the entries which need to be measured overall. The metadata keys can
  1809. be used as flags, default is @option{all} which measures everything.
  1810. @option{none} disables all overall measurement.
  1811. @end table
  1812. A description of each shown parameter follows:
  1813. @table @option
  1814. @item DC offset
  1815. Mean amplitude displacement from zero.
  1816. @item Min level
  1817. Minimal sample level.
  1818. @item Max level
  1819. Maximal sample level.
  1820. @item Min difference
  1821. Minimal difference between two consecutive samples.
  1822. @item Max difference
  1823. Maximal difference between two consecutive samples.
  1824. @item Mean difference
  1825. Mean difference between two consecutive samples.
  1826. The average of each difference between two consecutive samples.
  1827. @item RMS difference
  1828. Root Mean Square difference between two consecutive samples.
  1829. @item Peak level dB
  1830. @item RMS level dB
  1831. Standard peak and RMS level measured in dBFS.
  1832. @item RMS peak dB
  1833. @item RMS trough dB
  1834. Peak and trough values for RMS level measured over a short window.
  1835. @item Crest factor
  1836. Standard ratio of peak to RMS level (note: not in dB).
  1837. @item Flat factor
  1838. Flatness (i.e. consecutive samples with the same value) of the signal at its peak levels
  1839. (i.e. either @var{Min level} or @var{Max level}).
  1840. @item Peak count
  1841. Number of occasions (not the number of samples) that the signal attained either
  1842. @var{Min level} or @var{Max level}.
  1843. @item Bit depth
  1844. Overall bit depth of audio. Number of bits used for each sample.
  1845. @item Dynamic range
  1846. Measured dynamic range of audio in dB.
  1847. @item Zero crossings
  1848. Number of points where the waveform crosses the zero level axis.
  1849. @item Zero crossings rate
  1850. Rate of Zero crossings and number of audio samples.
  1851. @end table
  1852. @section atempo
  1853. Adjust audio tempo.
  1854. The filter accepts exactly one parameter, the audio tempo. If not
  1855. specified then the filter will assume nominal 1.0 tempo. Tempo must
  1856. be in the [0.5, 100.0] range.
  1857. Note that tempo greater than 2 will skip some samples rather than
  1858. blend them in. If for any reason this is a concern it is always
  1859. possible to daisy-chain several instances of atempo to achieve the
  1860. desired product tempo.
  1861. @subsection Examples
  1862. @itemize
  1863. @item
  1864. Slow down audio to 80% tempo:
  1865. @example
  1866. atempo=0.8
  1867. @end example
  1868. @item
  1869. To speed up audio to 300% tempo:
  1870. @example
  1871. atempo=3
  1872. @end example
  1873. @item
  1874. To speed up audio to 300% tempo by daisy-chaining two atempo instances:
  1875. @example
  1876. atempo=sqrt(3),atempo=sqrt(3)
  1877. @end example
  1878. @end itemize
  1879. @subsection Commands
  1880. This filter supports the following commands:
  1881. @table @option
  1882. @item tempo
  1883. Change filter tempo scale factor.
  1884. Syntax for the command is : "@var{tempo}"
  1885. @end table
  1886. @section atrim
  1887. Trim the input so that the output contains one continuous subpart of the input.
  1888. It accepts the following parameters:
  1889. @table @option
  1890. @item start
  1891. Timestamp (in seconds) of the start of the section to keep. I.e. the audio
  1892. sample with the timestamp @var{start} will be the first sample in the output.
  1893. @item end
  1894. Specify time of the first audio sample that will be dropped, i.e. the
  1895. audio sample immediately preceding the one with the timestamp @var{end} will be
  1896. the last sample in the output.
  1897. @item start_pts
  1898. Same as @var{start}, except this option sets the start timestamp in samples
  1899. instead of seconds.
  1900. @item end_pts
  1901. Same as @var{end}, except this option sets the end timestamp in samples instead
  1902. of seconds.
  1903. @item duration
  1904. The maximum duration of the output in seconds.
  1905. @item start_sample
  1906. The number of the first sample that should be output.
  1907. @item end_sample
  1908. The number of the first sample that should be dropped.
  1909. @end table
  1910. @option{start}, @option{end}, and @option{duration} are expressed as time
  1911. duration specifications; see
  1912. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  1913. Note that the first two sets of the start/end options and the @option{duration}
  1914. option look at the frame timestamp, while the _sample options simply count the
  1915. samples that pass through the filter. So start/end_pts and start/end_sample will
  1916. give different results when the timestamps are wrong, inexact or do not start at
  1917. zero. Also note that this filter does not modify the timestamps. If you wish
  1918. to have the output timestamps start at zero, insert the asetpts filter after the
  1919. atrim filter.
  1920. If multiple start or end options are set, this filter tries to be greedy and
  1921. keep all samples that match at least one of the specified constraints. To keep
  1922. only the part that matches all the constraints at once, chain multiple atrim
  1923. filters.
  1924. The defaults are such that all the input is kept. So it is possible to set e.g.
  1925. just the end values to keep everything before the specified time.
  1926. Examples:
  1927. @itemize
  1928. @item
  1929. Drop everything except the second minute of input:
  1930. @example
  1931. ffmpeg -i INPUT -af atrim=60:120
  1932. @end example
  1933. @item
  1934. Keep only the first 1000 samples:
  1935. @example
  1936. ffmpeg -i INPUT -af atrim=end_sample=1000
  1937. @end example
  1938. @end itemize
  1939. @section axcorrelate
  1940. Calculate normalized cross-correlation between two input audio streams.
  1941. Resulted samples are always between -1 and 1 inclusive.
  1942. If result is 1 it means two input samples are highly correlated in that selected segment.
  1943. Result 0 means they are not correlated at all.
  1944. If result is -1 it means two input samples are out of phase, which means they cancel each
  1945. other.
  1946. The filter accepts the following options:
  1947. @table @option
  1948. @item size
  1949. Set size of segment over which cross-correlation is calculated.
  1950. Default is 256. Allowed range is from 2 to 131072.
  1951. @item algo
  1952. Set algorithm for cross-correlation. Can be @code{slow} or @code{fast}.
  1953. Default is @code{slow}. Fast algorithm assumes mean values over any given segment
  1954. are always zero and thus need much less calculations to make.
  1955. This is generally not true, but is valid for typical audio streams.
  1956. @end table
  1957. @subsection Examples
  1958. @itemize
  1959. @item
  1960. Calculate correlation between channels in stereo audio stream:
  1961. @example
  1962. ffmpeg -i stereo.wav -af channelsplit,axcorrelate=size=1024:algo=fast correlation.wav
  1963. @end example
  1964. @end itemize
  1965. @section bandpass
  1966. Apply a two-pole Butterworth band-pass filter with central
  1967. frequency @var{frequency}, and (3dB-point) band-width width.
  1968. The @var{csg} option selects a constant skirt gain (peak gain = Q)
  1969. instead of the default: constant 0dB peak gain.
  1970. The filter roll off at 6dB per octave (20dB per decade).
  1971. The filter accepts the following options:
  1972. @table @option
  1973. @item frequency, f
  1974. Set the filter's central frequency. Default is @code{3000}.
  1975. @item csg
  1976. Constant skirt gain if set to 1. Defaults to 0.
  1977. @item width_type, t
  1978. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  1979. @table @option
  1980. @item h
  1981. Hz
  1982. @item q
  1983. Q-Factor
  1984. @item o
  1985. octave
  1986. @item s
  1987. slope
  1988. @item k
  1989. kHz
  1990. @end table
  1991. @item width, w
  1992. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  1993. @item mix, m
  1994. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  1995. Range is between 0 and 1.
  1996. @item channels, c
  1997. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  1998. @item normalize, n
  1999. Normalize biquad coefficients, by default is disabled.
  2000. Enabling it will normalize magnitude response at DC to 0dB.
  2001. @end table
  2002. @subsection Commands
  2003. This filter supports the following commands:
  2004. @table @option
  2005. @item frequency, f
  2006. Change bandpass frequency.
  2007. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  2008. @item width_type, t
  2009. Change bandpass width_type.
  2010. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  2011. @item width, w
  2012. Change bandpass width.
  2013. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  2014. @item mix, m
  2015. Change bandpass mix.
  2016. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  2017. @end table
  2018. @section bandreject
  2019. Apply a two-pole Butterworth band-reject filter with central
  2020. frequency @var{frequency}, and (3dB-point) band-width @var{width}.
  2021. The filter roll off at 6dB per octave (20dB per decade).
  2022. The filter accepts the following options:
  2023. @table @option
  2024. @item frequency, f
  2025. Set the filter's central frequency. Default is @code{3000}.
  2026. @item width_type, t
  2027. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  2028. @table @option
  2029. @item h
  2030. Hz
  2031. @item q
  2032. Q-Factor
  2033. @item o
  2034. octave
  2035. @item s
  2036. slope
  2037. @item k
  2038. kHz
  2039. @end table
  2040. @item width, w
  2041. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  2042. @item mix, m
  2043. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  2044. Range is between 0 and 1.
  2045. @item channels, c
  2046. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  2047. @item normalize, n
  2048. Normalize biquad coefficients, by default is disabled.
  2049. Enabling it will normalize magnitude response at DC to 0dB.
  2050. @end table
  2051. @subsection Commands
  2052. This filter supports the following commands:
  2053. @table @option
  2054. @item frequency, f
  2055. Change bandreject frequency.
  2056. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  2057. @item width_type, t
  2058. Change bandreject width_type.
  2059. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  2060. @item width, w
  2061. Change bandreject width.
  2062. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  2063. @item mix, m
  2064. Change bandreject mix.
  2065. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  2066. @end table
  2067. @section bass, lowshelf
  2068. Boost or cut the bass (lower) frequencies of the audio using a two-pole
  2069. shelving filter with a response similar to that of a standard
  2070. hi-fi's tone-controls. This is also known as shelving equalisation (EQ).
  2071. The filter accepts the following options:
  2072. @table @option
  2073. @item gain, g
  2074. Give the gain at 0 Hz. Its useful range is about -20
  2075. (for a large cut) to +20 (for a large boost).
  2076. Beware of clipping when using a positive gain.
  2077. @item frequency, f
  2078. Set the filter's central frequency and so can be used
  2079. to extend or reduce the frequency range to be boosted or cut.
  2080. The default value is @code{100} Hz.
  2081. @item width_type, t
  2082. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  2083. @table @option
  2084. @item h
  2085. Hz
  2086. @item q
  2087. Q-Factor
  2088. @item o
  2089. octave
  2090. @item s
  2091. slope
  2092. @item k
  2093. kHz
  2094. @end table
  2095. @item width, w
  2096. Determine how steep is the filter's shelf transition.
  2097. @item mix, m
  2098. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  2099. Range is between 0 and 1.
  2100. @item channels, c
  2101. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  2102. @item normalize, n
  2103. Normalize biquad coefficients, by default is disabled.
  2104. Enabling it will normalize magnitude response at DC to 0dB.
  2105. @end table
  2106. @subsection Commands
  2107. This filter supports the following commands:
  2108. @table @option
  2109. @item frequency, f
  2110. Change bass frequency.
  2111. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  2112. @item width_type, t
  2113. Change bass width_type.
  2114. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  2115. @item width, w
  2116. Change bass width.
  2117. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  2118. @item gain, g
  2119. Change bass gain.
  2120. Syntax for the command is : "@var{gain}"
  2121. @item mix, m
  2122. Change bass mix.
  2123. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  2124. @end table
  2125. @section biquad
  2126. Apply a biquad IIR filter with the given coefficients.
  2127. Where @var{b0}, @var{b1}, @var{b2} and @var{a0}, @var{a1}, @var{a2}
  2128. are the numerator and denominator coefficients respectively.
  2129. and @var{channels}, @var{c} specify which channels to filter, by default all
  2130. available are filtered.
  2131. @subsection Commands
  2132. This filter supports the following commands:
  2133. @table @option
  2134. @item a0
  2135. @item a1
  2136. @item a2
  2137. @item b0
  2138. @item b1
  2139. @item b2
  2140. Change biquad parameter.
  2141. Syntax for the command is : "@var{value}"
  2142. @item mix, m
  2143. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  2144. Range is between 0 and 1.
  2145. @item channels, c
  2146. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  2147. @item normalize, n
  2148. Normalize biquad coefficients, by default is disabled.
  2149. Enabling it will normalize magnitude response at DC to 0dB.
  2150. @end table
  2151. @section bs2b
  2152. Bauer stereo to binaural transformation, which improves headphone listening of
  2153. stereo audio records.
  2154. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  2155. @code{--enable-libbs2b}.
  2156. It accepts the following parameters:
  2157. @table @option
  2158. @item profile
  2159. Pre-defined crossfeed level.
  2160. @table @option
  2161. @item default
  2162. Default level (fcut=700, feed=50).
  2163. @item cmoy
  2164. Chu Moy circuit (fcut=700, feed=60).
  2165. @item jmeier
  2166. Jan Meier circuit (fcut=650, feed=95).
  2167. @end table
  2168. @item fcut
  2169. Cut frequency (in Hz).
  2170. @item feed
  2171. Feed level (in Hz).
  2172. @end table
  2173. @section channelmap
  2174. Remap input channels to new locations.
  2175. It accepts the following parameters:
  2176. @table @option
  2177. @item map
  2178. Map channels from input to output. The argument is a '|'-separated list of
  2179. mappings, each in the @code{@var{in_channel}-@var{out_channel}} or
  2180. @var{in_channel} form. @var{in_channel} can be either the name of the input
  2181. channel (e.g. FL for front left) or its index in the input channel layout.
  2182. @var{out_channel} is the name of the output channel or its index in the output
  2183. channel layout. If @var{out_channel} is not given then it is implicitly an
  2184. index, starting with zero and increasing by one for each mapping.
  2185. @item channel_layout
  2186. The channel layout of the output stream.
  2187. @end table
  2188. If no mapping is present, the filter will implicitly map input channels to
  2189. output channels, preserving indices.
  2190. @subsection Examples
  2191. @itemize
  2192. @item
  2193. For example, assuming a 5.1+downmix input MOV file,
  2194. @example
  2195. ffmpeg -i in.mov -filter 'channelmap=map=DL-FL|DR-FR' out.wav
  2196. @end example
  2197. will create an output WAV file tagged as stereo from the downmix channels of
  2198. the input.
  2199. @item
  2200. To fix a 5.1 WAV improperly encoded in AAC's native channel order
  2201. @example
  2202. ffmpeg -i in.wav -filter 'channelmap=1|2|0|5|3|4:5.1' out.wav
  2203. @end example
  2204. @end itemize
  2205. @section channelsplit
  2206. Split each channel from an input audio stream into a separate output stream.
  2207. It accepts the following parameters:
  2208. @table @option
  2209. @item channel_layout
  2210. The channel layout of the input stream. The default is "stereo".
  2211. @item channels
  2212. A channel layout describing the channels to be extracted as separate output streams
  2213. or "all" to extract each input channel as a separate stream. The default is "all".
  2214. Choosing channels not present in channel layout in the input will result in an error.
  2215. @end table
  2216. @subsection Examples
  2217. @itemize
  2218. @item
  2219. For example, assuming a stereo input MP3 file,
  2220. @example
  2221. ffmpeg -i in.mp3 -filter_complex channelsplit out.mkv
  2222. @end example
  2223. will create an output Matroska file with two audio streams, one containing only
  2224. the left channel and the other the right channel.
  2225. @item
  2226. Split a 5.1 WAV file into per-channel files:
  2227. @example
  2228. ffmpeg -i in.wav -filter_complex
  2229. 'channelsplit=channel_layout=5.1[FL][FR][FC][LFE][SL][SR]'
  2230. -map '[FL]' front_left.wav -map '[FR]' front_right.wav -map '[FC]'
  2231. front_center.wav -map '[LFE]' lfe.wav -map '[SL]' side_left.wav -map '[SR]'
  2232. side_right.wav
  2233. @end example
  2234. @item
  2235. Extract only LFE from a 5.1 WAV file:
  2236. @example
  2237. ffmpeg -i in.wav -filter_complex 'channelsplit=channel_layout=5.1:channels=LFE[LFE]'
  2238. -map '[LFE]' lfe.wav
  2239. @end example
  2240. @end itemize
  2241. @section chorus
  2242. Add a chorus effect to the audio.
  2243. Can make a single vocal sound like a chorus, but can also be applied to instrumentation.
  2244. Chorus resembles an echo effect with a short delay, but whereas with echo the delay is
  2245. constant, with chorus, it is varied using using sinusoidal or triangular modulation.
  2246. The modulation depth defines the range the modulated delay is played before or after
  2247. the delay. Hence the delayed sound will sound slower or faster, that is the delayed
  2248. sound tuned around the original one, like in a chorus where some vocals are slightly
  2249. off key.
  2250. It accepts the following parameters:
  2251. @table @option
  2252. @item in_gain
  2253. Set input gain. Default is 0.4.
  2254. @item out_gain
  2255. Set output gain. Default is 0.4.
  2256. @item delays
  2257. Set delays. A typical delay is around 40ms to 60ms.
  2258. @item decays
  2259. Set decays.
  2260. @item speeds
  2261. Set speeds.
  2262. @item depths
  2263. Set depths.
  2264. @end table
  2265. @subsection Examples
  2266. @itemize
  2267. @item
  2268. A single delay:
  2269. @example
  2270. chorus=0.7:0.9:55:0.4:0.25:2
  2271. @end example
  2272. @item
  2273. Two delays:
  2274. @example
  2275. chorus=0.6:0.9:50|60:0.4|0.32:0.25|0.4:2|1.3
  2276. @end example
  2277. @item
  2278. Fuller sounding chorus with three delays:
  2279. @example
  2280. chorus=0.5:0.9:50|60|40:0.4|0.32|0.3:0.25|0.4|0.3:2|2.3|1.3
  2281. @end example
  2282. @end itemize
  2283. @section compand
  2284. Compress or expand the audio's dynamic range.
  2285. It accepts the following parameters:
  2286. @table @option
  2287. @item attacks
  2288. @item decays
  2289. A list of times in seconds for each channel over which the instantaneous level
  2290. of the input signal is averaged to determine its volume. @var{attacks} refers to
  2291. increase of volume and @var{decays} refers to decrease of volume. For most
  2292. situations, the attack time (response to the audio getting louder) should be
  2293. shorter than the decay time, because the human ear is more sensitive to sudden
  2294. loud audio than sudden soft audio. A typical value for attack is 0.3 seconds and
  2295. a typical value for decay is 0.8 seconds.
  2296. If specified number of attacks & decays is lower than number of channels, the last
  2297. set attack/decay will be used for all remaining channels.
  2298. @item points
  2299. A list of points for the transfer function, specified in dB relative to the
  2300. maximum possible signal amplitude. Each key points list must be defined using
  2301. the following syntax: @code{x0/y0|x1/y1|x2/y2|....} or
  2302. @code{x0/y0 x1/y1 x2/y2 ....}
  2303. The input values must be in strictly increasing order but the transfer function
  2304. does not have to be monotonically rising. The point @code{0/0} is assumed but
  2305. may be overridden (by @code{0/out-dBn}). Typical values for the transfer
  2306. function are @code{-70/-70|-60/-20|1/0}.
  2307. @item soft-knee
  2308. Set the curve radius in dB for all joints. It defaults to 0.01.
  2309. @item gain
  2310. Set the additional gain in dB to be applied at all points on the transfer
  2311. function. This allows for easy adjustment of the overall gain.
  2312. It defaults to 0.
  2313. @item volume
  2314. Set an initial volume, in dB, to be assumed for each channel when filtering
  2315. starts. This permits the user to supply a nominal level initially, so that, for
  2316. example, a very large gain is not applied to initial signal levels before the
  2317. companding has begun to operate. A typical value for audio which is initially
  2318. quiet is -90 dB. It defaults to 0.
  2319. @item delay
  2320. Set a delay, in seconds. The input audio is analyzed immediately, but audio is
  2321. delayed before being fed to the volume adjuster. Specifying a delay
  2322. approximately equal to the attack/decay times allows the filter to effectively
  2323. operate in predictive rather than reactive mode. It defaults to 0.
  2324. @end table
  2325. @subsection Examples
  2326. @itemize
  2327. @item
  2328. Make music with both quiet and loud passages suitable for listening to in a
  2329. noisy environment:
  2330. @example
  2331. compand=.3|.3:1|1:-90/-60|-60/-40|-40/-30|-20/-20:6:0:-90:0.2
  2332. @end example
  2333. Another example for audio with whisper and explosion parts:
  2334. @example
  2335. compand=0|0:1|1:-90/-900|-70/-70|-30/-9|0/-3:6:0:0:0
  2336. @end example
  2337. @item
  2338. A noise gate for when the noise is at a lower level than the signal:
  2339. @example
  2340. compand=.1|.1:.2|.2:-900/-900|-50.1/-900|-50/-50:.01:0:-90:.1
  2341. @end example
  2342. @item
  2343. Here is another noise gate, this time for when the noise is at a higher level
  2344. than the signal (making it, in some ways, similar to squelch):
  2345. @example
  2346. compand=.1|.1:.1|.1:-45.1/-45.1|-45/-900|0/-900:.01:45:-90:.1
  2347. @end example
  2348. @item
  2349. 2:1 compression starting at -6dB:
  2350. @example
  2351. compand=points=-80/-80|-6/-6|0/-3.8|20/3.5
  2352. @end example
  2353. @item
  2354. 2:1 compression starting at -9dB:
  2355. @example
  2356. compand=points=-80/-80|-9/-9|0/-5.3|20/2.9
  2357. @end example
  2358. @item
  2359. 2:1 compression starting at -12dB:
  2360. @example
  2361. compand=points=-80/-80|-12/-12|0/-6.8|20/1.9
  2362. @end example
  2363. @item
  2364. 2:1 compression starting at -18dB:
  2365. @example
  2366. compand=points=-80/-80|-18/-18|0/-9.8|20/0.7
  2367. @end example
  2368. @item
  2369. 3:1 compression starting at -15dB:
  2370. @example
  2371. compand=points=-80/-80|-15/-15|0/-10.8|20/-5.2
  2372. @end example
  2373. @item
  2374. Compressor/Gate:
  2375. @example
  2376. compand=points=-80/-105|-62/-80|-15.4/-15.4|0/-12|20/-7.6
  2377. @end example
  2378. @item
  2379. Expander:
  2380. @example
  2381. compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-169|-54/-80|-49.5/-64.6|-41.1/-41.1|-25.8/-15|-10.8/-4.5|0/0|20/8.3
  2382. @end example
  2383. @item
  2384. Hard limiter at -6dB:
  2385. @example
  2386. compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-80|-6/-6|20/-6
  2387. @end example
  2388. @item
  2389. Hard limiter at -12dB:
  2390. @example
  2391. compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-80|-12/-12|20/-12
  2392. @end example
  2393. @item
  2394. Hard noise gate at -35 dB:
  2395. @example
  2396. compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-115|-35.1/-80|-35/-35|20/20
  2397. @end example
  2398. @item
  2399. Soft limiter:
  2400. @example
  2401. compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-80|-12.4/-12.4|-6/-8|0/-6.8|20/-2.8
  2402. @end example
  2403. @end itemize
  2404. @section compensationdelay
  2405. Compensation Delay Line is a metric based delay to compensate differing
  2406. positions of microphones or speakers.
  2407. For example, you have recorded guitar with two microphones placed in
  2408. different locations. Because the front of sound wave has fixed speed in
  2409. normal conditions, the phasing of microphones can vary and depends on
  2410. their location and interposition. The best sound mix can be achieved when
  2411. these microphones are in phase (synchronized). Note that a distance of
  2412. ~30 cm between microphones makes one microphone capture the signal in
  2413. antiphase to the other microphone. That makes the final mix sound moody.
  2414. This filter helps to solve phasing problems by adding different delays
  2415. to each microphone track and make them synchronized.
  2416. The best result can be reached when you take one track as base and
  2417. synchronize other tracks one by one with it.
  2418. Remember that synchronization/delay tolerance depends on sample rate, too.
  2419. Higher sample rates will give more tolerance.
  2420. The filter accepts the following parameters:
  2421. @table @option
  2422. @item mm
  2423. Set millimeters distance. This is compensation distance for fine tuning.
  2424. Default is 0.
  2425. @item cm
  2426. Set cm distance. This is compensation distance for tightening distance setup.
  2427. Default is 0.
  2428. @item m
  2429. Set meters distance. This is compensation distance for hard distance setup.
  2430. Default is 0.
  2431. @item dry
  2432. Set dry amount. Amount of unprocessed (dry) signal.
  2433. Default is 0.
  2434. @item wet
  2435. Set wet amount. Amount of processed (wet) signal.
  2436. Default is 1.
  2437. @item temp
  2438. Set temperature in degrees Celsius. This is the temperature of the environment.
  2439. Default is 20.
  2440. @end table
  2441. @section crossfeed
  2442. Apply headphone crossfeed filter.
  2443. Crossfeed is the process of blending the left and right channels of stereo
  2444. audio recording.
  2445. It is mainly used to reduce extreme stereo separation of low frequencies.
  2446. The intent is to produce more speaker like sound to the listener.
  2447. The filter accepts the following options:
  2448. @table @option
  2449. @item strength
  2450. Set strength of crossfeed. Default is 0.2. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  2451. This sets gain of low shelf filter for side part of stereo image.
  2452. Default is -6dB. Max allowed is -30db when strength is set to 1.
  2453. @item range
  2454. Set soundstage wideness. Default is 0.5. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  2455. This sets cut off frequency of low shelf filter. Default is cut off near
  2456. 1550 Hz. With range set to 1 cut off frequency is set to 2100 Hz.
  2457. @item level_in
  2458. Set input gain. Default is 0.9.
  2459. @item level_out
  2460. Set output gain. Default is 1.
  2461. @end table
  2462. @section crystalizer
  2463. Simple algorithm to expand audio dynamic range.
  2464. The filter accepts the following options:
  2465. @table @option
  2466. @item i
  2467. Sets the intensity of effect (default: 2.0). Must be in range between 0.0
  2468. (unchanged sound) to 10.0 (maximum effect).
  2469. @item c
  2470. Enable clipping. By default is enabled.
  2471. @end table
  2472. @subsection Commands
  2473. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  2474. @section dcshift
  2475. Apply a DC shift to the audio.
  2476. This can be useful to remove a DC offset (caused perhaps by a hardware problem
  2477. in the recording chain) from the audio. The effect of a DC offset is reduced
  2478. headroom and hence volume. The @ref{astats} filter can be used to determine if
  2479. a signal has a DC offset.
  2480. @table @option
  2481. @item shift
  2482. Set the DC shift, allowed range is [-1, 1]. It indicates the amount to shift
  2483. the audio.
  2484. @item limitergain
  2485. Optional. It should have a value much less than 1 (e.g. 0.05 or 0.02) and is
  2486. used to prevent clipping.
  2487. @end table
  2488. @section deesser
  2489. Apply de-essing to the audio samples.
  2490. @table @option
  2491. @item i
  2492. Set intensity for triggering de-essing. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  2493. Default is 0.
  2494. @item m
  2495. Set amount of ducking on treble part of sound. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  2496. Default is 0.5.
  2497. @item f
  2498. How much of original frequency content to keep when de-essing. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  2499. Default is 0.5.
  2500. @item s
  2501. Set the output mode.
  2502. It accepts the following values:
  2503. @table @option
  2504. @item i
  2505. Pass input unchanged.
  2506. @item o
  2507. Pass ess filtered out.
  2508. @item e
  2509. Pass only ess.
  2510. Default value is @var{o}.
  2511. @end table
  2512. @end table
  2513. @section drmeter
  2514. Measure audio dynamic range.
  2515. DR values of 14 and higher is found in very dynamic material. DR of 8 to 13
  2516. is found in transition material. And anything less that 8 have very poor dynamics
  2517. and is very compressed.
  2518. The filter accepts the following options:
  2519. @table @option
  2520. @item length
  2521. Set window length in seconds used to split audio into segments of equal length.
  2522. Default is 3 seconds.
  2523. @end table
  2524. @section dynaudnorm
  2525. Dynamic Audio Normalizer.
  2526. This filter applies a certain amount of gain to the input audio in order
  2527. to bring its peak magnitude to a target level (e.g. 0 dBFS). However, in
  2528. contrast to more "simple" normalization algorithms, the Dynamic Audio
  2529. Normalizer *dynamically* re-adjusts the gain factor to the input audio.
  2530. This allows for applying extra gain to the "quiet" sections of the audio
  2531. while avoiding distortions or clipping the "loud" sections. In other words:
  2532. The Dynamic Audio Normalizer will "even out" the volume of quiet and loud
  2533. sections, in the sense that the volume of each section is brought to the
  2534. same target level. Note, however, that the Dynamic Audio Normalizer achieves
  2535. this goal *without* applying "dynamic range compressing". It will retain 100%
  2536. of the dynamic range *within* each section of the audio file.
  2537. @table @option
  2538. @item framelen, f
  2539. Set the frame length in milliseconds. In range from 10 to 8000 milliseconds.
  2540. Default is 500 milliseconds.
  2541. The Dynamic Audio Normalizer processes the input audio in small chunks,
  2542. referred to as frames. This is required, because a peak magnitude has no
  2543. meaning for just a single sample value. Instead, we need to determine the
  2544. peak magnitude for a contiguous sequence of sample values. While a "standard"
  2545. normalizer would simply use the peak magnitude of the complete file, the
  2546. Dynamic Audio Normalizer determines the peak magnitude individually for each
  2547. frame. The length of a frame is specified in milliseconds. By default, the
  2548. Dynamic Audio Normalizer uses a frame length of 500 milliseconds, which has
  2549. been found to give good results with most files.
  2550. Note that the exact frame length, in number of samples, will be determined
  2551. automatically, based on the sampling rate of the individual input audio file.
  2552. @item gausssize, g
  2553. Set the Gaussian filter window size. In range from 3 to 301, must be odd
  2554. number. Default is 31.
  2555. Probably the most important parameter of the Dynamic Audio Normalizer is the
  2556. @code{window size} of the Gaussian smoothing filter. The filter's window size
  2557. is specified in frames, centered around the current frame. For the sake of
  2558. simplicity, this must be an odd number. Consequently, the default value of 31
  2559. takes into account the current frame, as well as the 15 preceding frames and
  2560. the 15 subsequent frames. Using a larger window results in a stronger
  2561. smoothing effect and thus in less gain variation, i.e. slower gain
  2562. adaptation. Conversely, using a smaller window results in a weaker smoothing
  2563. effect and thus in more gain variation, i.e. faster gain adaptation.
  2564. In other words, the more you increase this value, the more the Dynamic Audio
  2565. Normalizer will behave like a "traditional" normalization filter. On the
  2566. contrary, the more you decrease this value, the more the Dynamic Audio
  2567. Normalizer will behave like a dynamic range compressor.
  2568. @item peak, p
  2569. Set the target peak value. This specifies the highest permissible magnitude
  2570. level for the normalized audio input. This filter will try to approach the
  2571. target peak magnitude as closely as possible, but at the same time it also
  2572. makes sure that the normalized signal will never exceed the peak magnitude.
  2573. A frame's maximum local gain factor is imposed directly by the target peak
  2574. magnitude. The default value is 0.95 and thus leaves a headroom of 5%*.
  2575. It is not recommended to go above this value.
  2576. @item maxgain, m
  2577. Set the maximum gain factor. In range from 1.0 to 100.0. Default is 10.0.
  2578. The Dynamic Audio Normalizer determines the maximum possible (local) gain
  2579. factor for each input frame, i.e. the maximum gain factor that does not
  2580. result in clipping or distortion. The maximum gain factor is determined by
  2581. the frame's highest magnitude sample. However, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer
  2582. additionally bounds the frame's maximum gain factor by a predetermined
  2583. (global) maximum gain factor. This is done in order to avoid excessive gain
  2584. factors in "silent" or almost silent frames. By default, the maximum gain
  2585. factor is 10.0, For most inputs the default value should be sufficient and
  2586. it usually is not recommended to increase this value. Though, for input
  2587. with an extremely low overall volume level, it may be necessary to allow even
  2588. higher gain factors. Note, however, that the Dynamic Audio Normalizer does
  2589. not simply apply a "hard" threshold (i.e. cut off values above the threshold).
  2590. Instead, a "sigmoid" threshold function will be applied. This way, the
  2591. gain factors will smoothly approach the threshold value, but never exceed that
  2592. value.
  2593. @item targetrms, r
  2594. Set the target RMS. In range from 0.0 to 1.0. Default is 0.0 - disabled.
  2595. By default, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer performs "peak" normalization.
  2596. This means that the maximum local gain factor for each frame is defined
  2597. (only) by the frame's highest magnitude sample. This way, the samples can
  2598. be amplified as much as possible without exceeding the maximum signal
  2599. level, i.e. without clipping. Optionally, however, the Dynamic Audio
  2600. Normalizer can also take into account the frame's root mean square,
  2601. abbreviated RMS. In electrical engineering, the RMS is commonly used to
  2602. determine the power of a time-varying signal. It is therefore considered
  2603. that the RMS is a better approximation of the "perceived loudness" than
  2604. just looking at the signal's peak magnitude. Consequently, by adjusting all
  2605. frames to a constant RMS value, a uniform "perceived loudness" can be
  2606. established. If a target RMS value has been specified, a frame's local gain
  2607. factor is defined as the factor that would result in exactly that RMS value.
  2608. Note, however, that the maximum local gain factor is still restricted by the
  2609. frame's highest magnitude sample, in order to prevent clipping.
  2610. @item coupling, n
  2611. Enable channels coupling. By default is enabled.
  2612. By default, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer will amplify all channels by the same
  2613. amount. This means the same gain factor will be applied to all channels, i.e.
  2614. the maximum possible gain factor is determined by the "loudest" channel.
  2615. However, in some recordings, it may happen that the volume of the different
  2616. channels is uneven, e.g. one channel may be "quieter" than the other one(s).
  2617. In this case, this option can be used to disable the channel coupling. This way,
  2618. the gain factor will be determined independently for each channel, depending
  2619. only on the individual channel's highest magnitude sample. This allows for
  2620. harmonizing the volume of the different channels.
  2621. @item correctdc, c
  2622. Enable DC bias correction. By default is disabled.
  2623. An audio signal (in the time domain) is a sequence of sample values.
  2624. In the Dynamic Audio Normalizer these sample values are represented in the
  2625. -1.0 to 1.0 range, regardless of the original input format. Normally, the
  2626. audio signal, or "waveform", should be centered around the zero point.
  2627. That means if we calculate the mean value of all samples in a file, or in a
  2628. single frame, then the result should be 0.0 or at least very close to that
  2629. value. If, however, there is a significant deviation of the mean value from
  2630. 0.0, in either positive or negative direction, this is referred to as a
  2631. DC bias or DC offset. Since a DC bias is clearly undesirable, the Dynamic
  2632. Audio Normalizer provides optional DC bias correction.
  2633. With DC bias correction enabled, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer will determine
  2634. the mean value, or "DC correction" offset, of each input frame and subtract
  2635. that value from all of the frame's sample values which ensures those samples
  2636. are centered around 0.0 again. Also, in order to avoid "gaps" at the frame
  2637. boundaries, the DC correction offset values will be interpolated smoothly
  2638. between neighbouring frames.
  2639. @item altboundary, b
  2640. Enable alternative boundary mode. By default is disabled.
  2641. The Dynamic Audio Normalizer takes into account a certain neighbourhood
  2642. around each frame. This includes the preceding frames as well as the
  2643. subsequent frames. However, for the "boundary" frames, located at the very
  2644. beginning and at the very end of the audio file, not all neighbouring
  2645. frames are available. In particular, for the first few frames in the audio
  2646. file, the preceding frames are not known. And, similarly, for the last few
  2647. frames in the audio file, the subsequent frames are not known. Thus, the
  2648. question arises which gain factors should be assumed for the missing frames
  2649. in the "boundary" region. The Dynamic Audio Normalizer implements two modes
  2650. to deal with this situation. The default boundary mode assumes a gain factor
  2651. of exactly 1.0 for the missing frames, resulting in a smooth "fade in" and
  2652. "fade out" at the beginning and at the end of the input, respectively.
  2653. @item compress, s
  2654. Set the compress factor. In range from 0.0 to 30.0. Default is 0.0.
  2655. By default, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer does not apply "traditional"
  2656. compression. This means that signal peaks will not be pruned and thus the
  2657. full dynamic range will be retained within each local neighbourhood. However,
  2658. in some cases it may be desirable to combine the Dynamic Audio Normalizer's
  2659. normalization algorithm with a more "traditional" compression.
  2660. For this purpose, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer provides an optional compression
  2661. (thresholding) function. If (and only if) the compression feature is enabled,
  2662. all input frames will be processed by a soft knee thresholding function prior
  2663. to the actual normalization process. Put simply, the thresholding function is
  2664. going to prune all samples whose magnitude exceeds a certain threshold value.
  2665. However, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer does not simply apply a fixed threshold
  2666. value. Instead, the threshold value will be adjusted for each individual
  2667. frame.
  2668. In general, smaller parameters result in stronger compression, and vice versa.
  2669. Values below 3.0 are not recommended, because audible distortion may appear.
  2670. @item threshold, t
  2671. Set the target threshold value. This specifies the lowest permissible
  2672. magnitude level for the audio input which will be normalized.
  2673. If input frame volume is above this value frame will be normalized.
  2674. Otherwise frame may not be normalized at all. The default value is set
  2675. to 0, which means all input frames will be normalized.
  2676. This option is mostly useful if digital noise is not wanted to be amplified.
  2677. @end table
  2678. @subsection Commands
  2679. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  2680. @section earwax
  2681. Make audio easier to listen to on headphones.
  2682. This filter adds `cues' to 44.1kHz stereo (i.e. audio CD format) audio
  2683. so that when listened to on headphones the stereo image is moved from
  2684. inside your head (standard for headphones) to outside and in front of
  2685. the listener (standard for speakers).
  2686. Ported from SoX.
  2687. @section equalizer
  2688. Apply a two-pole peaking equalisation (EQ) filter. With this
  2689. filter, the signal-level at and around a selected frequency can
  2690. be increased or decreased, whilst (unlike bandpass and bandreject
  2691. filters) that at all other frequencies is unchanged.
  2692. In order to produce complex equalisation curves, this filter can
  2693. be given several times, each with a different central frequency.
  2694. The filter accepts the following options:
  2695. @table @option
  2696. @item frequency, f
  2697. Set the filter's central frequency in Hz.
  2698. @item width_type, t
  2699. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  2700. @table @option
  2701. @item h
  2702. Hz
  2703. @item q
  2704. Q-Factor
  2705. @item o
  2706. octave
  2707. @item s
  2708. slope
  2709. @item k
  2710. kHz
  2711. @end table
  2712. @item width, w
  2713. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  2714. @item gain, g
  2715. Set the required gain or attenuation in dB.
  2716. Beware of clipping when using a positive gain.
  2717. @item mix, m
  2718. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  2719. Range is between 0 and 1.
  2720. @item channels, c
  2721. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  2722. @item normalize, n
  2723. Normalize biquad coefficients, by default is disabled.
  2724. Enabling it will normalize magnitude response at DC to 0dB.
  2725. @end table
  2726. @subsection Examples
  2727. @itemize
  2728. @item
  2729. Attenuate 10 dB at 1000 Hz, with a bandwidth of 200 Hz:
  2730. @example
  2731. equalizer=f=1000:t=h:width=200:g=-10
  2732. @end example
  2733. @item
  2734. Apply 2 dB gain at 1000 Hz with Q 1 and attenuate 5 dB at 100 Hz with Q 2:
  2735. @example
  2736. equalizer=f=1000:t=q:w=1:g=2,equalizer=f=100:t=q:w=2:g=-5
  2737. @end example
  2738. @end itemize
  2739. @subsection Commands
  2740. This filter supports the following commands:
  2741. @table @option
  2742. @item frequency, f
  2743. Change equalizer frequency.
  2744. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  2745. @item width_type, t
  2746. Change equalizer width_type.
  2747. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  2748. @item width, w
  2749. Change equalizer width.
  2750. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  2751. @item gain, g
  2752. Change equalizer gain.
  2753. Syntax for the command is : "@var{gain}"
  2754. @item mix, m
  2755. Change equalizer mix.
  2756. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  2757. @end table
  2758. @section extrastereo
  2759. Linearly increases the difference between left and right channels which
  2760. adds some sort of "live" effect to playback.
  2761. The filter accepts the following options:
  2762. @table @option
  2763. @item m
  2764. Sets the difference coefficient (default: 2.5). 0.0 means mono sound
  2765. (average of both channels), with 1.0 sound will be unchanged, with
  2766. -1.0 left and right channels will be swapped.
  2767. @item c
  2768. Enable clipping. By default is enabled.
  2769. @end table
  2770. @subsection Commands
  2771. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  2772. @section firequalizer
  2773. Apply FIR Equalization using arbitrary frequency response.
  2774. The filter accepts the following option:
  2775. @table @option
  2776. @item gain
  2777. Set gain curve equation (in dB). The expression can contain variables:
  2778. @table @option
  2779. @item f
  2780. the evaluated frequency
  2781. @item sr
  2782. sample rate
  2783. @item ch
  2784. channel number, set to 0 when multichannels evaluation is disabled
  2785. @item chid
  2786. channel id, see libavutil/channel_layout.h, set to the first channel id when
  2787. multichannels evaluation is disabled
  2788. @item chs
  2789. number of channels
  2790. @item chlayout
  2791. channel_layout, see libavutil/channel_layout.h
  2792. @end table
  2793. and functions:
  2794. @table @option
  2795. @item gain_interpolate(f)
  2796. interpolate gain on frequency f based on gain_entry
  2797. @item cubic_interpolate(f)
  2798. same as gain_interpolate, but smoother
  2799. @end table
  2800. This option is also available as command. Default is @code{gain_interpolate(f)}.
  2801. @item gain_entry
  2802. Set gain entry for gain_interpolate function. The expression can
  2803. contain functions:
  2804. @table @option
  2805. @item entry(f, g)
  2806. store gain entry at frequency f with value g
  2807. @end table
  2808. This option is also available as command.
  2809. @item delay
  2810. Set filter delay in seconds. Higher value means more accurate.
  2811. Default is @code{0.01}.
  2812. @item accuracy
  2813. Set filter accuracy in Hz. Lower value means more accurate.
  2814. Default is @code{5}.
  2815. @item wfunc
  2816. Set window function. Acceptable values are:
  2817. @table @option
  2818. @item rectangular
  2819. rectangular window, useful when gain curve is already smooth
  2820. @item hann
  2821. hann window (default)
  2822. @item hamming
  2823. hamming window
  2824. @item blackman
  2825. blackman window
  2826. @item nuttall3
  2827. 3-terms continuous 1st derivative nuttall window
  2828. @item mnuttall3
  2829. minimum 3-terms discontinuous nuttall window
  2830. @item nuttall
  2831. 4-terms continuous 1st derivative nuttall window
  2832. @item bnuttall
  2833. minimum 4-terms discontinuous nuttall (blackman-nuttall) window
  2834. @item bharris
  2835. blackman-harris window
  2836. @item tukey
  2837. tukey window
  2838. @end table
  2839. @item fixed
  2840. If enabled, use fixed number of audio samples. This improves speed when
  2841. filtering with large delay. Default is disabled.
  2842. @item multi
  2843. Enable multichannels evaluation on gain. Default is disabled.
  2844. @item zero_phase
  2845. Enable zero phase mode by subtracting timestamp to compensate delay.
  2846. Default is disabled.
  2847. @item scale
  2848. Set scale used by gain. Acceptable values are:
  2849. @table @option
  2850. @item linlin
  2851. linear frequency, linear gain
  2852. @item linlog
  2853. linear frequency, logarithmic (in dB) gain (default)
  2854. @item loglin
  2855. logarithmic (in octave scale where 20 Hz is 0) frequency, linear gain
  2856. @item loglog
  2857. logarithmic frequency, logarithmic gain
  2858. @end table
  2859. @item dumpfile
  2860. Set file for dumping, suitable for gnuplot.
  2861. @item dumpscale
  2862. Set scale for dumpfile. Acceptable values are same with scale option.
  2863. Default is linlog.
  2864. @item fft2
  2865. Enable 2-channel convolution using complex FFT. This improves speed significantly.
  2866. Default is disabled.
  2867. @item min_phase
  2868. Enable minimum phase impulse response. Default is disabled.
  2869. @end table
  2870. @subsection Examples
  2871. @itemize
  2872. @item
  2873. lowpass at 1000 Hz:
  2874. @example
  2875. firequalizer=gain='if(lt(f,1000), 0, -INF)'
  2876. @end example
  2877. @item
  2878. lowpass at 1000 Hz with gain_entry:
  2879. @example
  2880. firequalizer=gain_entry='entry(1000,0); entry(1001, -INF)'
  2881. @end example
  2882. @item
  2883. custom equalization:
  2884. @example
  2885. firequalizer=gain_entry='entry(100,0); entry(400, -4); entry(1000, -6); entry(2000, 0)'
  2886. @end example
  2887. @item
  2888. higher delay with zero phase to compensate delay:
  2889. @example
  2890. firequalizer=delay=0.1:fixed=on:zero_phase=on
  2891. @end example
  2892. @item
  2893. lowpass on left channel, highpass on right channel:
  2894. @example
  2895. firequalizer=gain='if(eq(chid,1), gain_interpolate(f), if(eq(chid,2), gain_interpolate(1e6+f), 0))'
  2896. :gain_entry='entry(1000, 0); entry(1001,-INF); entry(1e6+1000,0)':multi=on
  2897. @end example
  2898. @end itemize
  2899. @section flanger
  2900. Apply a flanging effect to the audio.
  2901. The filter accepts the following options:
  2902. @table @option
  2903. @item delay
  2904. Set base delay in milliseconds. Range from 0 to 30. Default value is 0.
  2905. @item depth
  2906. Set added sweep delay in milliseconds. Range from 0 to 10. Default value is 2.
  2907. @item regen
  2908. Set percentage regeneration (delayed signal feedback). Range from -95 to 95.
  2909. Default value is 0.
  2910. @item width
  2911. Set percentage of delayed signal mixed with original. Range from 0 to 100.
  2912. Default value is 71.
  2913. @item speed
  2914. Set sweeps per second (Hz). Range from 0.1 to 10. Default value is 0.5.
  2915. @item shape
  2916. Set swept wave shape, can be @var{triangular} or @var{sinusoidal}.
  2917. Default value is @var{sinusoidal}.
  2918. @item phase
  2919. Set swept wave percentage-shift for multi channel. Range from 0 to 100.
  2920. Default value is 25.
  2921. @item interp
  2922. Set delay-line interpolation, @var{linear} or @var{quadratic}.
  2923. Default is @var{linear}.
  2924. @end table
  2925. @section haas
  2926. Apply Haas effect to audio.
  2927. Note that this makes most sense to apply on mono signals.
  2928. With this filter applied to mono signals it give some directionality and
  2929. stretches its stereo image.
  2930. The filter accepts the following options:
  2931. @table @option
  2932. @item level_in
  2933. Set input level. By default is @var{1}, or 0dB
  2934. @item level_out
  2935. Set output level. By default is @var{1}, or 0dB.
  2936. @item side_gain
  2937. Set gain applied to side part of signal. By default is @var{1}.
  2938. @item middle_source
  2939. Set kind of middle source. Can be one of the following:
  2940. @table @samp
  2941. @item left
  2942. Pick left channel.
  2943. @item right
  2944. Pick right channel.
  2945. @item mid
  2946. Pick middle part signal of stereo image.
  2947. @item side
  2948. Pick side part signal of stereo image.
  2949. @end table
  2950. @item middle_phase
  2951. Change middle phase. By default is disabled.
  2952. @item left_delay
  2953. Set left channel delay. By default is @var{2.05} milliseconds.
  2954. @item left_balance
  2955. Set left channel balance. By default is @var{-1}.
  2956. @item left_gain
  2957. Set left channel gain. By default is @var{1}.
  2958. @item left_phase
  2959. Change left phase. By default is disabled.
  2960. @item right_delay
  2961. Set right channel delay. By defaults is @var{2.12} milliseconds.
  2962. @item right_balance
  2963. Set right channel balance. By default is @var{1}.
  2964. @item right_gain
  2965. Set right channel gain. By default is @var{1}.
  2966. @item right_phase
  2967. Change right phase. By default is enabled.
  2968. @end table
  2969. @section hdcd
  2970. Decodes High Definition Compatible Digital (HDCD) data. A 16-bit PCM stream with
  2971. embedded HDCD codes is expanded into a 20-bit PCM stream.
  2972. The filter supports the Peak Extend and Low-level Gain Adjustment features
  2973. of HDCD, and detects the Transient Filter flag.
  2974. @example
  2975. ffmpeg -i HDCD16.flac -af hdcd OUT24.flac
  2976. @end example
  2977. When using the filter with wav, note the default encoding for wav is 16-bit,
  2978. so the resulting 20-bit stream will be truncated back to 16-bit. Use something
  2979. like @command{-acodec pcm_s24le} after the filter to get 24-bit PCM output.
  2980. @example
  2981. ffmpeg -i HDCD16.wav -af hdcd OUT16.wav
  2982. ffmpeg -i HDCD16.wav -af hdcd -c:a pcm_s24le OUT24.wav
  2983. @end example
  2984. The filter accepts the following options:
  2985. @table @option
  2986. @item disable_autoconvert
  2987. Disable any automatic format conversion or resampling in the filter graph.
  2988. @item process_stereo
  2989. Process the stereo channels together. If target_gain does not match between
  2990. channels, consider it invalid and use the last valid target_gain.
  2991. @item cdt_ms
  2992. Set the code detect timer period in ms.
  2993. @item force_pe
  2994. Always extend peaks above -3dBFS even if PE isn't signaled.
  2995. @item analyze_mode
  2996. Replace audio with a solid tone and adjust the amplitude to signal some
  2997. specific aspect of the decoding process. The output file can be loaded in
  2998. an audio editor alongside the original to aid analysis.
  2999. @code{analyze_mode=pe:force_pe=true} can be used to see all samples above the PE level.
  3000. Modes are:
  3001. @table @samp
  3002. @item 0, off
  3003. Disabled
  3004. @item 1, lle
  3005. Gain adjustment level at each sample
  3006. @item 2, pe
  3007. Samples where peak extend occurs
  3008. @item 3, cdt
  3009. Samples where the code detect timer is active
  3010. @item 4, tgm
  3011. Samples where the target gain does not match between channels
  3012. @end table
  3013. @end table
  3014. @section headphone
  3015. Apply head-related transfer functions (HRTFs) to create virtual
  3016. loudspeakers around the user for binaural listening via headphones.
  3017. The HRIRs are provided via additional streams, for each channel
  3018. one stereo input stream is needed.
  3019. The filter accepts the following options:
  3020. @table @option
  3021. @item map
  3022. Set mapping of input streams for convolution.
  3023. The argument is a '|'-separated list of channel names in order as they
  3024. are given as additional stream inputs for filter.
  3025. This also specify number of input streams. Number of input streams
  3026. must be not less than number of channels in first stream plus one.
  3027. @item gain
  3028. Set gain applied to audio. Value is in dB. Default is 0.
  3029. @item type
  3030. Set processing type. Can be @var{time} or @var{freq}. @var{time} is
  3031. processing audio in time domain which is slow.
  3032. @var{freq} is processing audio in frequency domain which is fast.
  3033. Default is @var{freq}.
  3034. @item lfe
  3035. Set custom gain for LFE channels. Value is in dB. Default is 0.
  3036. @item size
  3037. Set size of frame in number of samples which will be processed at once.
  3038. Default value is @var{1024}. Allowed range is from 1024 to 96000.
  3039. @item hrir
  3040. Set format of hrir stream.
  3041. Default value is @var{stereo}. Alternative value is @var{multich}.
  3042. If value is set to @var{stereo}, number of additional streams should
  3043. be greater or equal to number of input channels in first input stream.
  3044. Also each additional stream should have stereo number of channels.
  3045. If value is set to @var{multich}, number of additional streams should
  3046. be exactly one. Also number of input channels of additional stream
  3047. should be equal or greater than twice number of channels of first input
  3048. stream.
  3049. @end table
  3050. @subsection Examples
  3051. @itemize
  3052. @item
  3053. Full example using wav files as coefficients with amovie filters for 7.1 downmix,
  3054. each amovie filter use stereo file with IR coefficients as input.
  3055. The files give coefficients for each position of virtual loudspeaker:
  3056. @example
  3057. ffmpeg -i input.wav
  3058. -filter_complex "amovie=azi_270_ele_0_DFC.wav[sr];amovie=azi_90_ele_0_DFC.wav[sl];amovie=azi_225_ele_0_DFC.wav[br];amovie=azi_135_ele_0_DFC.wav[bl];amovie=azi_0_ele_0_DFC.wav,asplit[fc][lfe];amovie=azi_35_ele_0_DFC.wav[fl];amovie=azi_325_ele_0_DFC.wav[fr];[0:a][fl][fr][fc][lfe][bl][br][sl][sr]headphone=FL|FR|FC|LFE|BL|BR|SL|SR"
  3059. output.wav
  3060. @end example
  3061. @item
  3062. Full example using wav files as coefficients with amovie filters for 7.1 downmix,
  3063. but now in @var{multich} @var{hrir} format.
  3064. @example
  3065. ffmpeg -i input.wav -filter_complex "amovie=minp.wav[hrirs];[0:a][hrirs]headphone=map=FL|FR|FC|LFE|BL|BR|SL|SR:hrir=multich"
  3066. output.wav
  3067. @end example
  3068. @end itemize
  3069. @section highpass
  3070. Apply a high-pass filter with 3dB point frequency.
  3071. The filter can be either single-pole, or double-pole (the default).
  3072. The filter roll off at 6dB per pole per octave (20dB per pole per decade).
  3073. The filter accepts the following options:
  3074. @table @option
  3075. @item frequency, f
  3076. Set frequency in Hz. Default is 3000.
  3077. @item poles, p
  3078. Set number of poles. Default is 2.
  3079. @item width_type, t
  3080. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  3081. @table @option
  3082. @item h
  3083. Hz
  3084. @item q
  3085. Q-Factor
  3086. @item o
  3087. octave
  3088. @item s
  3089. slope
  3090. @item k
  3091. kHz
  3092. @end table
  3093. @item width, w
  3094. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  3095. Applies only to double-pole filter.
  3096. The default is 0.707q and gives a Butterworth response.
  3097. @item mix, m
  3098. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  3099. Range is between 0 and 1.
  3100. @item channels, c
  3101. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  3102. @item normalize, n
  3103. Normalize biquad coefficients, by default is disabled.
  3104. Enabling it will normalize magnitude response at DC to 0dB.
  3105. @end table
  3106. @subsection Commands
  3107. This filter supports the following commands:
  3108. @table @option
  3109. @item frequency, f
  3110. Change highpass frequency.
  3111. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  3112. @item width_type, t
  3113. Change highpass width_type.
  3114. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  3115. @item width, w
  3116. Change highpass width.
  3117. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  3118. @item mix, m
  3119. Change highpass mix.
  3120. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  3121. @end table
  3122. @section join
  3123. Join multiple input streams into one multi-channel stream.
  3124. It accepts the following parameters:
  3125. @table @option
  3126. @item inputs
  3127. The number of input streams. It defaults to 2.
  3128. @item channel_layout
  3129. The desired output channel layout. It defaults to stereo.
  3130. @item map
  3131. Map channels from inputs to output. The argument is a '|'-separated list of
  3132. mappings, each in the @code{@var{input_idx}.@var{in_channel}-@var{out_channel}}
  3133. form. @var{input_idx} is the 0-based index of the input stream. @var{in_channel}
  3134. can be either the name of the input channel (e.g. FL for front left) or its
  3135. index in the specified input stream. @var{out_channel} is the name of the output
  3136. channel.
  3137. @end table
  3138. The filter will attempt to guess the mappings when they are not specified
  3139. explicitly. It does so by first trying to find an unused matching input channel
  3140. and if that fails it picks the first unused input channel.
  3141. Join 3 inputs (with properly set channel layouts):
  3142. @example
  3143. ffmpeg -i INPUT1 -i INPUT2 -i INPUT3 -filter_complex join=inputs=3 OUTPUT
  3144. @end example
  3145. Build a 5.1 output from 6 single-channel streams:
  3146. @example
  3147. ffmpeg -i fl -i fr -i fc -i sl -i sr -i lfe -filter_complex
  3148. 'join=inputs=6:channel_layout=5.1:map=0.0-FL|1.0-FR|2.0-FC|3.0-SL|4.0-SR|5.0-LFE'
  3149. out
  3150. @end example
  3151. @section ladspa
  3152. Load a LADSPA (Linux Audio Developer's Simple Plugin API) plugin.
  3153. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  3154. @code{--enable-ladspa}.
  3155. @table @option
  3156. @item file, f
  3157. Specifies the name of LADSPA plugin library to load. If the environment
  3158. variable @env{LADSPA_PATH} is defined, the LADSPA plugin is searched in
  3159. each one of the directories specified by the colon separated list in
  3160. @env{LADSPA_PATH}, otherwise in the standard LADSPA paths, which are in
  3161. this order: @file{HOME/.ladspa/lib/}, @file{/usr/local/lib/ladspa/},
  3162. @file{/usr/lib/ladspa/}.
  3163. @item plugin, p
  3164. Specifies the plugin within the library. Some libraries contain only
  3165. one plugin, but others contain many of them. If this is not set filter
  3166. will list all available plugins within the specified library.
  3167. @item controls, c
  3168. Set the '|' separated list of controls which are zero or more floating point
  3169. values that determine the behavior of the loaded plugin (for example delay,
  3170. threshold or gain).
  3171. Controls need to be defined using the following syntax:
  3172. c0=@var{value0}|c1=@var{value1}|c2=@var{value2}|..., where
  3173. @var{valuei} is the value set on the @var{i}-th control.
  3174. Alternatively they can be also defined using the following syntax:
  3175. @var{value0}|@var{value1}|@var{value2}|..., where
  3176. @var{valuei} is the value set on the @var{i}-th control.
  3177. If @option{controls} is set to @code{help}, all available controls and
  3178. their valid ranges are printed.
  3179. @item sample_rate, s
  3180. Specify the sample rate, default to 44100. Only used if plugin have
  3181. zero inputs.
  3182. @item nb_samples, n
  3183. Set the number of samples per channel per each output frame, default
  3184. is 1024. Only used if plugin have zero inputs.
  3185. @item duration, d
  3186. Set the minimum duration of the sourced audio. See
  3187. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  3188. for the accepted syntax.
  3189. Note that the resulting duration may be greater than the specified duration,
  3190. as the generated audio is always cut at the end of a complete frame.
  3191. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the audio is
  3192. supposed to be generated forever.
  3193. Only used if plugin have zero inputs.
  3194. @end table
  3195. @subsection Examples
  3196. @itemize
  3197. @item
  3198. List all available plugins within amp (LADSPA example plugin) library:
  3199. @example
  3200. ladspa=file=amp
  3201. @end example
  3202. @item
  3203. List all available controls and their valid ranges for @code{vcf_notch}
  3204. plugin from @code{VCF} library:
  3205. @example
  3206. ladspa=f=vcf:p=vcf_notch:c=help
  3207. @end example
  3208. @item
  3209. Simulate low quality audio equipment using @code{Computer Music Toolkit} (CMT)
  3210. plugin library:
  3211. @example
  3212. ladspa=file=cmt:plugin=lofi:controls=c0=22|c1=12|c2=12
  3213. @end example
  3214. @item
  3215. Add reverberation to the audio using TAP-plugins
  3216. (Tom's Audio Processing plugins):
  3217. @example
  3218. ladspa=file=tap_reverb:tap_reverb
  3219. @end example
  3220. @item
  3221. Generate white noise, with 0.2 amplitude:
  3222. @example
  3223. ladspa=file=cmt:noise_source_white:c=c0=.2
  3224. @end example
  3225. @item
  3226. Generate 20 bpm clicks using plugin @code{C* Click - Metronome} from the
  3227. @code{C* Audio Plugin Suite} (CAPS) library:
  3228. @example
  3229. ladspa=file=caps:Click:c=c1=20'
  3230. @end example
  3231. @item
  3232. Apply @code{C* Eq10X2 - Stereo 10-band equaliser} effect:
  3233. @example
  3234. ladspa=caps:Eq10X2:c=c0=-48|c9=-24|c3=12|c4=2
  3235. @end example
  3236. @item
  3237. Increase volume by 20dB using fast lookahead limiter from Steve Harris
  3238. @code{SWH Plugins} collection:
  3239. @example
  3240. ladspa=fast_lookahead_limiter_1913:fastLookaheadLimiter:20|0|2
  3241. @end example
  3242. @item
  3243. Attenuate low frequencies using Multiband EQ from Steve Harris
  3244. @code{SWH Plugins} collection:
  3245. @example
  3246. ladspa=mbeq_1197:mbeq:-24|-24|-24|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0
  3247. @end example
  3248. @item
  3249. Reduce stereo image using @code{Narrower} from the @code{C* Audio Plugin Suite}
  3250. (CAPS) library:
  3251. @example
  3252. ladspa=caps:Narrower
  3253. @end example
  3254. @item
  3255. Another white noise, now using @code{C* Audio Plugin Suite} (CAPS) library:
  3256. @example
  3257. ladspa=caps:White:.2
  3258. @end example
  3259. @item
  3260. Some fractal noise, using @code{C* Audio Plugin Suite} (CAPS) library:
  3261. @example
  3262. ladspa=caps:Fractal:c=c1=1
  3263. @end example
  3264. @item
  3265. Dynamic volume normalization using @code{VLevel} plugin:
  3266. @example
  3267. ladspa=vlevel-ladspa:vlevel_mono
  3268. @end example
  3269. @end itemize
  3270. @subsection Commands
  3271. This filter supports the following commands:
  3272. @table @option
  3273. @item cN
  3274. Modify the @var{N}-th control value.
  3275. If the specified value is not valid, it is ignored and prior one is kept.
  3276. @end table
  3277. @section loudnorm
  3278. EBU R128 loudness normalization. Includes both dynamic and linear normalization modes.
  3279. Support for both single pass (livestreams, files) and double pass (files) modes.
  3280. This algorithm can target IL, LRA, and maximum true peak. In dynamic mode, to accurately
  3281. detect true peaks, the audio stream will be upsampled to 192 kHz.
  3282. Use the @code{-ar} option or @code{aresample} filter to explicitly set an output sample rate.
  3283. The filter accepts the following options:
  3284. @table @option
  3285. @item I, i
  3286. Set integrated loudness target.
  3287. Range is -70.0 - -5.0. Default value is -24.0.
  3288. @item LRA, lra
  3289. Set loudness range target.
  3290. Range is 1.0 - 20.0. Default value is 7.0.
  3291. @item TP, tp
  3292. Set maximum true peak.
  3293. Range is -9.0 - +0.0. Default value is -2.0.
  3294. @item measured_I, measured_i
  3295. Measured IL of input file.
  3296. Range is -99.0 - +0.0.
  3297. @item measured_LRA, measured_lra
  3298. Measured LRA of input file.
  3299. Range is 0.0 - 99.0.
  3300. @item measured_TP, measured_tp
  3301. Measured true peak of input file.
  3302. Range is -99.0 - +99.0.
  3303. @item measured_thresh
  3304. Measured threshold of input file.
  3305. Range is -99.0 - +0.0.
  3306. @item offset
  3307. Set offset gain. Gain is applied before the true-peak limiter.
  3308. Range is -99.0 - +99.0. Default is +0.0.
  3309. @item linear
  3310. Normalize by linearly scaling the source audio.
  3311. @code{measured_I}, @code{measured_LRA}, @code{measured_TP},
  3312. and @code{measured_thresh} must all be specified. Target LRA shouldn't
  3313. be lower than source LRA and the change in integrated loudness shouldn't
  3314. result in a true peak which exceeds the target TP. If any of these
  3315. conditions aren't met, normalization mode will revert to @var{dynamic}.
  3316. Options are @code{true} or @code{false}. Default is @code{true}.
  3317. @item dual_mono
  3318. Treat mono input files as "dual-mono". If a mono file is intended for playback
  3319. on a stereo system, its EBU R128 measurement will be perceptually incorrect.
  3320. If set to @code{true}, this option will compensate for this effect.
  3321. Multi-channel input files are not affected by this option.
  3322. Options are true or false. Default is false.
  3323. @item print_format
  3324. Set print format for stats. Options are summary, json, or none.
  3325. Default value is none.
  3326. @end table
  3327. @section lowpass
  3328. Apply a low-pass filter with 3dB point frequency.
  3329. The filter can be either single-pole or double-pole (the default).
  3330. The filter roll off at 6dB per pole per octave (20dB per pole per decade).
  3331. The filter accepts the following options:
  3332. @table @option
  3333. @item frequency, f
  3334. Set frequency in Hz. Default is 500.
  3335. @item poles, p
  3336. Set number of poles. Default is 2.
  3337. @item width_type, t
  3338. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  3339. @table @option
  3340. @item h
  3341. Hz
  3342. @item q
  3343. Q-Factor
  3344. @item o
  3345. octave
  3346. @item s
  3347. slope
  3348. @item k
  3349. kHz
  3350. @end table
  3351. @item width, w
  3352. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  3353. Applies only to double-pole filter.
  3354. The default is 0.707q and gives a Butterworth response.
  3355. @item mix, m
  3356. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  3357. Range is between 0 and 1.
  3358. @item channels, c
  3359. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  3360. @item normalize, n
  3361. Normalize biquad coefficients, by default is disabled.
  3362. Enabling it will normalize magnitude response at DC to 0dB.
  3363. @end table
  3364. @subsection Examples
  3365. @itemize
  3366. @item
  3367. Lowpass only LFE channel, it LFE is not present it does nothing:
  3368. @example
  3369. lowpass=c=LFE
  3370. @end example
  3371. @end itemize
  3372. @subsection Commands
  3373. This filter supports the following commands:
  3374. @table @option
  3375. @item frequency, f
  3376. Change lowpass frequency.
  3377. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  3378. @item width_type, t
  3379. Change lowpass width_type.
  3380. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  3381. @item width, w
  3382. Change lowpass width.
  3383. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  3384. @item mix, m
  3385. Change lowpass mix.
  3386. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  3387. @end table
  3388. @section lv2
  3389. Load a LV2 (LADSPA Version 2) plugin.
  3390. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  3391. @code{--enable-lv2}.
  3392. @table @option
  3393. @item plugin, p
  3394. Specifies the plugin URI. You may need to escape ':'.
  3395. @item controls, c
  3396. Set the '|' separated list of controls which are zero or more floating point
  3397. values that determine the behavior of the loaded plugin (for example delay,
  3398. threshold or gain).
  3399. If @option{controls} is set to @code{help}, all available controls and
  3400. their valid ranges are printed.
  3401. @item sample_rate, s
  3402. Specify the sample rate, default to 44100. Only used if plugin have
  3403. zero inputs.
  3404. @item nb_samples, n
  3405. Set the number of samples per channel per each output frame, default
  3406. is 1024. Only used if plugin have zero inputs.
  3407. @item duration, d
  3408. Set the minimum duration of the sourced audio. See
  3409. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  3410. for the accepted syntax.
  3411. Note that the resulting duration may be greater than the specified duration,
  3412. as the generated audio is always cut at the end of a complete frame.
  3413. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the audio is
  3414. supposed to be generated forever.
  3415. Only used if plugin have zero inputs.
  3416. @end table
  3417. @subsection Examples
  3418. @itemize
  3419. @item
  3420. Apply bass enhancer plugin from Calf:
  3421. @example
  3422. lv2=p=http\\\\://calf.sourceforge.net/plugins/BassEnhancer:c=amount=2
  3423. @end example
  3424. @item
  3425. Apply vinyl plugin from Calf:
  3426. @example
  3427. lv2=p=http\\\\://calf.sourceforge.net/plugins/Vinyl:c=drone=0.2|aging=0.5
  3428. @end example
  3429. @item
  3430. Apply bit crusher plugin from ArtyFX:
  3431. @example
  3432. lv2=p=http\\\\://www.openavproductions.com/artyfx#bitta:c=crush=0.3
  3433. @end example
  3434. @end itemize
  3435. @section mcompand
  3436. Multiband Compress or expand the audio's dynamic range.
  3437. The input audio is divided into bands using 4th order Linkwitz-Riley IIRs.
  3438. This is akin to the crossover of a loudspeaker, and results in flat frequency
  3439. response when absent compander action.
  3440. It accepts the following parameters:
  3441. @table @option
  3442. @item args
  3443. This option syntax is:
  3444. attack,decay,[attack,decay..] soft-knee points crossover_frequency [delay [initial_volume [gain]]] | attack,decay ...
  3445. For explanation of each item refer to compand filter documentation.
  3446. @end table
  3447. @anchor{pan}
  3448. @section pan
  3449. Mix channels with specific gain levels. The filter accepts the output
  3450. channel layout followed by a set of channels definitions.
  3451. This filter is also designed to efficiently remap the channels of an audio
  3452. stream.
  3453. The filter accepts parameters of the form:
  3454. "@var{l}|@var{outdef}|@var{outdef}|..."
  3455. @table @option
  3456. @item l
  3457. output channel layout or number of channels
  3458. @item outdef
  3459. output channel specification, of the form:
  3460. "@var{out_name}=[@var{gain}*]@var{in_name}[(+-)[@var{gain}*]@var{in_name}...]"
  3461. @item out_name
  3462. output channel to define, either a channel name (FL, FR, etc.) or a channel
  3463. number (c0, c1, etc.)
  3464. @item gain
  3465. multiplicative coefficient for the channel, 1 leaving the volume unchanged
  3466. @item in_name
  3467. input channel to use, see out_name for details; it is not possible to mix
  3468. named and numbered input channels
  3469. @end table
  3470. If the `=' in a channel specification is replaced by `<', then the gains for
  3471. that specification will be renormalized so that the total is 1, thus
  3472. avoiding clipping noise.
  3473. @subsection Mixing examples
  3474. For example, if you want to down-mix from stereo to mono, but with a bigger
  3475. factor for the left channel:
  3476. @example
  3477. pan=1c|c0=0.9*c0+0.1*c1
  3478. @end example
  3479. A customized down-mix to stereo that works automatically for 3-, 4-, 5- and
  3480. 7-channels surround:
  3481. @example
  3482. pan=stereo| FL < FL + 0.5*FC + 0.6*BL + 0.6*SL | FR < FR + 0.5*FC + 0.6*BR + 0.6*SR
  3483. @end example
  3484. Note that @command{ffmpeg} integrates a default down-mix (and up-mix) system
  3485. that should be preferred (see "-ac" option) unless you have very specific
  3486. needs.
  3487. @subsection Remapping examples
  3488. The channel remapping will be effective if, and only if:
  3489. @itemize
  3490. @item gain coefficients are zeroes or ones,
  3491. @item only one input per channel output,
  3492. @end itemize
  3493. If all these conditions are satisfied, the filter will notify the user ("Pure
  3494. channel mapping detected"), and use an optimized and lossless method to do the
  3495. remapping.
  3496. For example, if you have a 5.1 source and want a stereo audio stream by
  3497. dropping the extra channels:
  3498. @example
  3499. pan="stereo| c0=FL | c1=FR"
  3500. @end example
  3501. Given the same source, you can also switch front left and front right channels
  3502. and keep the input channel layout:
  3503. @example
  3504. pan="5.1| c0=c1 | c1=c0 | c2=c2 | c3=c3 | c4=c4 | c5=c5"
  3505. @end example
  3506. If the input is a stereo audio stream, you can mute the front left channel (and
  3507. still keep the stereo channel layout) with:
  3508. @example
  3509. pan="stereo|c1=c1"
  3510. @end example
  3511. Still with a stereo audio stream input, you can copy the right channel in both
  3512. front left and right:
  3513. @example
  3514. pan="stereo| c0=FR | c1=FR"
  3515. @end example
  3516. @section replaygain
  3517. ReplayGain scanner filter. This filter takes an audio stream as an input and
  3518. outputs it unchanged.
  3519. At end of filtering it displays @code{track_gain} and @code{track_peak}.
  3520. @section resample
  3521. Convert the audio sample format, sample rate and channel layout. It is
  3522. not meant to be used directly.
  3523. @section rubberband
  3524. Apply time-stretching and pitch-shifting with librubberband.
  3525. To enable compilation of this filter, you need to configure FFmpeg with
  3526. @code{--enable-librubberband}.
  3527. The filter accepts the following options:
  3528. @table @option
  3529. @item tempo
  3530. Set tempo scale factor.
  3531. @item pitch
  3532. Set pitch scale factor.
  3533. @item transients
  3534. Set transients detector.
  3535. Possible values are:
  3536. @table @var
  3537. @item crisp
  3538. @item mixed
  3539. @item smooth
  3540. @end table
  3541. @item detector
  3542. Set detector.
  3543. Possible values are:
  3544. @table @var
  3545. @item compound
  3546. @item percussive
  3547. @item soft
  3548. @end table
  3549. @item phase
  3550. Set phase.
  3551. Possible values are:
  3552. @table @var
  3553. @item laminar
  3554. @item independent
  3555. @end table
  3556. @item window
  3557. Set processing window size.
  3558. Possible values are:
  3559. @table @var
  3560. @item standard
  3561. @item short
  3562. @item long
  3563. @end table
  3564. @item smoothing
  3565. Set smoothing.
  3566. Possible values are:
  3567. @table @var
  3568. @item off
  3569. @item on
  3570. @end table
  3571. @item formant
  3572. Enable formant preservation when shift pitching.
  3573. Possible values are:
  3574. @table @var
  3575. @item shifted
  3576. @item preserved
  3577. @end table
  3578. @item pitchq
  3579. Set pitch quality.
  3580. Possible values are:
  3581. @table @var
  3582. @item quality
  3583. @item speed
  3584. @item consistency
  3585. @end table
  3586. @item channels
  3587. Set channels.
  3588. Possible values are:
  3589. @table @var
  3590. @item apart
  3591. @item together
  3592. @end table
  3593. @end table
  3594. @subsection Commands
  3595. This filter supports the following commands:
  3596. @table @option
  3597. @item tempo
  3598. Change filter tempo scale factor.
  3599. Syntax for the command is : "@var{tempo}"
  3600. @item pitch
  3601. Change filter pitch scale factor.
  3602. Syntax for the command is : "@var{pitch}"
  3603. @end table
  3604. @section sidechaincompress
  3605. This filter acts like normal compressor but has the ability to compress
  3606. detected signal using second input signal.
  3607. It needs two input streams and returns one output stream.
  3608. First input stream will be processed depending on second stream signal.
  3609. The filtered signal then can be filtered with other filters in later stages of
  3610. processing. See @ref{pan} and @ref{amerge} filter.
  3611. The filter accepts the following options:
  3612. @table @option
  3613. @item level_in
  3614. Set input gain. Default is 1. Range is between 0.015625 and 64.
  3615. @item mode
  3616. Set mode of compressor operation. Can be @code{upward} or @code{downward}.
  3617. Default is @code{downward}.
  3618. @item threshold
  3619. If a signal of second stream raises above this level it will affect the gain
  3620. reduction of first stream.
  3621. By default is 0.125. Range is between 0.00097563 and 1.
  3622. @item ratio
  3623. Set a ratio about which the signal is reduced. 1:2 means that if the level
  3624. raised 4dB above the threshold, it will be only 2dB above after the reduction.
  3625. Default is 2. Range is between 1 and 20.
  3626. @item attack
  3627. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to rise above the threshold before gain
  3628. reduction starts. Default is 20. Range is between 0.01 and 2000.
  3629. @item release
  3630. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to fall below the threshold before
  3631. reduction is decreased again. Default is 250. Range is between 0.01 and 9000.
  3632. @item makeup
  3633. Set the amount by how much signal will be amplified after processing.
  3634. Default is 1. Range is from 1 to 64.
  3635. @item knee
  3636. Curve the sharp knee around the threshold to enter gain reduction more softly.
  3637. Default is 2.82843. Range is between 1 and 8.
  3638. @item link
  3639. Choose if the @code{average} level between all channels of side-chain stream
  3640. or the louder(@code{maximum}) channel of side-chain stream affects the
  3641. reduction. Default is @code{average}.
  3642. @item detection
  3643. Should the exact signal be taken in case of @code{peak} or an RMS one in case
  3644. of @code{rms}. Default is @code{rms} which is mainly smoother.
  3645. @item level_sc
  3646. Set sidechain gain. Default is 1. Range is between 0.015625 and 64.
  3647. @item mix
  3648. How much to use compressed signal in output. Default is 1.
  3649. Range is between 0 and 1.
  3650. @end table
  3651. @subsection Commands
  3652. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  3653. @subsection Examples
  3654. @itemize
  3655. @item
  3656. Full ffmpeg example taking 2 audio inputs, 1st input to be compressed
  3657. depending on the signal of 2nd input and later compressed signal to be
  3658. merged with 2nd input:
  3659. @example
  3660. ffmpeg -i main.flac -i sidechain.flac -filter_complex "[1:a]asplit=2[sc][mix];[0:a][sc]sidechaincompress[compr];[compr][mix]amerge"
  3661. @end example
  3662. @end itemize
  3663. @section sidechaingate
  3664. A sidechain gate acts like a normal (wideband) gate but has the ability to
  3665. filter the detected signal before sending it to the gain reduction stage.
  3666. Normally a gate uses the full range signal to detect a level above the
  3667. threshold.
  3668. For example: If you cut all lower frequencies from your sidechain signal
  3669. the gate will decrease the volume of your track only if not enough highs
  3670. appear. With this technique you are able to reduce the resonation of a
  3671. natural drum or remove "rumbling" of muted strokes from a heavily distorted
  3672. guitar.
  3673. It needs two input streams and returns one output stream.
  3674. First input stream will be processed depending on second stream signal.
  3675. The filter accepts the following options:
  3676. @table @option
  3677. @item level_in
  3678. Set input level before filtering.
  3679. Default is 1. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  3680. @item mode
  3681. Set the mode of operation. Can be @code{upward} or @code{downward}.
  3682. Default is @code{downward}. If set to @code{upward} mode, higher parts of signal
  3683. will be amplified, expanding dynamic range in upward direction.
  3684. Otherwise, in case of @code{downward} lower parts of signal will be reduced.
  3685. @item range
  3686. Set the level of gain reduction when the signal is below the threshold.
  3687. Default is 0.06125. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  3688. Setting this to 0 disables reduction and then filter behaves like expander.
  3689. @item threshold
  3690. If a signal rises above this level the gain reduction is released.
  3691. Default is 0.125. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  3692. @item ratio
  3693. Set a ratio about which the signal is reduced.
  3694. Default is 2. Allowed range is from 1 to 9000.
  3695. @item attack
  3696. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to rise above the threshold before gain
  3697. reduction stops.
  3698. Default is 20 milliseconds. Allowed range is from 0.01 to 9000.
  3699. @item release
  3700. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to fall below the threshold before the
  3701. reduction is increased again. Default is 250 milliseconds.
  3702. Allowed range is from 0.01 to 9000.
  3703. @item makeup
  3704. Set amount of amplification of signal after processing.
  3705. Default is 1. Allowed range is from 1 to 64.
  3706. @item knee
  3707. Curve the sharp knee around the threshold to enter gain reduction more softly.
  3708. Default is 2.828427125. Allowed range is from 1 to 8.
  3709. @item detection
  3710. Choose if exact signal should be taken for detection or an RMS like one.
  3711. Default is rms. Can be peak or rms.
  3712. @item link
  3713. Choose if the average level between all channels or the louder channel affects
  3714. the reduction.
  3715. Default is average. Can be average or maximum.
  3716. @item level_sc
  3717. Set sidechain gain. Default is 1. Range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  3718. @end table
  3719. @section silencedetect
  3720. Detect silence in an audio stream.
  3721. This filter logs a message when it detects that the input audio volume is less
  3722. or equal to a noise tolerance value for a duration greater or equal to the
  3723. minimum detected noise duration.
  3724. The printed times and duration are expressed in seconds. The
  3725. @code{lavfi.silence_start} or @code{lavfi.silence_start.X} metadata key
  3726. is set on the first frame whose timestamp equals or exceeds the detection
  3727. duration and it contains the timestamp of the first frame of the silence.
  3728. The @code{lavfi.silence_duration} or @code{lavfi.silence_duration.X}
  3729. and @code{lavfi.silence_end} or @code{lavfi.silence_end.X} metadata
  3730. keys are set on the first frame after the silence. If @option{mono} is
  3731. enabled, and each channel is evaluated separately, the @code{.X}
  3732. suffixed keys are used, and @code{X} corresponds to the channel number.
  3733. The filter accepts the following options:
  3734. @table @option
  3735. @item noise, n
  3736. Set noise tolerance. Can be specified in dB (in case "dB" is appended to the
  3737. specified value) or amplitude ratio. Default is -60dB, or 0.001.
  3738. @item duration, d
  3739. Set silence duration until notification (default is 2 seconds). See
  3740. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  3741. for the accepted syntax.
  3742. @item mono, m
  3743. Process each channel separately, instead of combined. By default is disabled.
  3744. @end table
  3745. @subsection Examples
  3746. @itemize
  3747. @item
  3748. Detect 5 seconds of silence with -50dB noise tolerance:
  3749. @example
  3750. silencedetect=n=-50dB:d=5
  3751. @end example
  3752. @item
  3753. Complete example with @command{ffmpeg} to detect silence with 0.0001 noise
  3754. tolerance in @file{silence.mp3}:
  3755. @example
  3756. ffmpeg -i silence.mp3 -af silencedetect=noise=0.0001 -f null -
  3757. @end example
  3758. @end itemize
  3759. @section silenceremove
  3760. Remove silence from the beginning, middle or end of the audio.
  3761. The filter accepts the following options:
  3762. @table @option
  3763. @item start_periods
  3764. This value is used to indicate if audio should be trimmed at beginning of
  3765. the audio. A value of zero indicates no silence should be trimmed from the
  3766. beginning. When specifying a non-zero value, it trims audio up until it
  3767. finds non-silence. Normally, when trimming silence from beginning of audio
  3768. the @var{start_periods} will be @code{1} but it can be increased to higher
  3769. values to trim all audio up to specific count of non-silence periods.
  3770. Default value is @code{0}.
  3771. @item start_duration
  3772. Specify the amount of time that non-silence must be detected before it stops
  3773. trimming audio. By increasing the duration, bursts of noises can be treated
  3774. as silence and trimmed off. Default value is @code{0}.
  3775. @item start_threshold
  3776. This indicates what sample value should be treated as silence. For digital
  3777. audio, a value of @code{0} may be fine but for audio recorded from analog,
  3778. you may wish to increase the value to account for background noise.
  3779. Can be specified in dB (in case "dB" is appended to the specified value)
  3780. or amplitude ratio. Default value is @code{0}.
  3781. @item start_silence
  3782. Specify max duration of silence at beginning that will be kept after
  3783. trimming. Default is 0, which is equal to trimming all samples detected
  3784. as silence.
  3785. @item start_mode
  3786. Specify mode of detection of silence end in start of multi-channel audio.
  3787. Can be @var{any} or @var{all}. Default is @var{any}.
  3788. With @var{any}, any sample that is detected as non-silence will cause
  3789. stopped trimming of silence.
  3790. With @var{all}, only if all channels are detected as non-silence will cause
  3791. stopped trimming of silence.
  3792. @item stop_periods
  3793. Set the count for trimming silence from the end of audio.
  3794. To remove silence from the middle of a file, specify a @var{stop_periods}
  3795. that is negative. This value is then treated as a positive value and is
  3796. used to indicate the effect should restart processing as specified by
  3797. @var{start_periods}, making it suitable for removing periods of silence
  3798. in the middle of the audio.
  3799. Default value is @code{0}.
  3800. @item stop_duration
  3801. Specify a duration of silence that must exist before audio is not copied any
  3802. more. By specifying a higher duration, silence that is wanted can be left in
  3803. the audio.
  3804. Default value is @code{0}.
  3805. @item stop_threshold
  3806. This is the same as @option{start_threshold} but for trimming silence from
  3807. the end of audio.
  3808. Can be specified in dB (in case "dB" is appended to the specified value)
  3809. or amplitude ratio. Default value is @code{0}.
  3810. @item stop_silence
  3811. Specify max duration of silence at end that will be kept after
  3812. trimming. Default is 0, which is equal to trimming all samples detected
  3813. as silence.
  3814. @item stop_mode
  3815. Specify mode of detection of silence start in end of multi-channel audio.
  3816. Can be @var{any} or @var{all}. Default is @var{any}.
  3817. With @var{any}, any sample that is detected as non-silence will cause
  3818. stopped trimming of silence.
  3819. With @var{all}, only if all channels are detected as non-silence will cause
  3820. stopped trimming of silence.
  3821. @item detection
  3822. Set how is silence detected. Can be @code{rms} or @code{peak}. Second is faster
  3823. and works better with digital silence which is exactly 0.
  3824. Default value is @code{rms}.
  3825. @item window
  3826. Set duration in number of seconds used to calculate size of window in number
  3827. of samples for detecting silence.
  3828. Default value is @code{0.02}. Allowed range is from @code{0} to @code{10}.
  3829. @end table
  3830. @subsection Examples
  3831. @itemize
  3832. @item
  3833. The following example shows how this filter can be used to start a recording
  3834. that does not contain the delay at the start which usually occurs between
  3835. pressing the record button and the start of the performance:
  3836. @example
  3837. silenceremove=start_periods=1:start_duration=5:start_threshold=0.02
  3838. @end example
  3839. @item
  3840. Trim all silence encountered from beginning to end where there is more than 1
  3841. second of silence in audio:
  3842. @example
  3843. silenceremove=stop_periods=-1:stop_duration=1:stop_threshold=-90dB
  3844. @end example
  3845. @item
  3846. Trim all digital silence samples, using peak detection, from beginning to end
  3847. where there is more than 0 samples of digital silence in audio and digital
  3848. silence is detected in all channels at same positions in stream:
  3849. @example
  3850. silenceremove=window=0:detection=peak:stop_mode=all:start_mode=all:stop_periods=-1:stop_threshold=0
  3851. @end example
  3852. @end itemize
  3853. @section sofalizer
  3854. SOFAlizer uses head-related transfer functions (HRTFs) to create virtual
  3855. loudspeakers around the user for binaural listening via headphones (audio
  3856. formats up to 9 channels supported).
  3857. The HRTFs are stored in SOFA files (see @url{http://www.sofacoustics.org/} for a database).
  3858. SOFAlizer is developed at the Acoustics Research Institute (ARI) of the
  3859. Austrian Academy of Sciences.
  3860. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  3861. @code{--enable-libmysofa}.
  3862. The filter accepts the following options:
  3863. @table @option
  3864. @item sofa
  3865. Set the SOFA file used for rendering.
  3866. @item gain
  3867. Set gain applied to audio. Value is in dB. Default is 0.
  3868. @item rotation
  3869. Set rotation of virtual loudspeakers in deg. Default is 0.
  3870. @item elevation
  3871. Set elevation of virtual speakers in deg. Default is 0.
  3872. @item radius
  3873. Set distance in meters between loudspeakers and the listener with near-field
  3874. HRTFs. Default is 1.
  3875. @item type
  3876. Set processing type. Can be @var{time} or @var{freq}. @var{time} is
  3877. processing audio in time domain which is slow.
  3878. @var{freq} is processing audio in frequency domain which is fast.
  3879. Default is @var{freq}.
  3880. @item speakers
  3881. Set custom positions of virtual loudspeakers. Syntax for this option is:
  3882. <CH> <AZIM> <ELEV>[|<CH> <AZIM> <ELEV>|...].
  3883. Each virtual loudspeaker is described with short channel name following with
  3884. azimuth and elevation in degrees.
  3885. Each virtual loudspeaker description is separated by '|'.
  3886. For example to override front left and front right channel positions use:
  3887. 'speakers=FL 45 15|FR 345 15'.
  3888. Descriptions with unrecognised channel names are ignored.
  3889. @item lfegain
  3890. Set custom gain for LFE channels. Value is in dB. Default is 0.
  3891. @item framesize
  3892. Set custom frame size in number of samples. Default is 1024.
  3893. Allowed range is from 1024 to 96000. Only used if option @samp{type}
  3894. is set to @var{freq}.
  3895. @item normalize
  3896. Should all IRs be normalized upon importing SOFA file.
  3897. By default is enabled.
  3898. @item interpolate
  3899. Should nearest IRs be interpolated with neighbor IRs if exact position
  3900. does not match. By default is disabled.
  3901. @item minphase
  3902. Minphase all IRs upon loading of SOFA file. By default is disabled.
  3903. @item anglestep
  3904. Set neighbor search angle step. Only used if option @var{interpolate} is enabled.
  3905. @item radstep
  3906. Set neighbor search radius step. Only used if option @var{interpolate} is enabled.
  3907. @end table
  3908. @subsection Examples
  3909. @itemize
  3910. @item
  3911. Using ClubFritz6 sofa file:
  3912. @example
  3913. sofalizer=sofa=/path/to/ClubFritz6.sofa:type=freq:radius=1
  3914. @end example
  3915. @item
  3916. Using ClubFritz12 sofa file and bigger radius with small rotation:
  3917. @example
  3918. sofalizer=sofa=/path/to/ClubFritz12.sofa:type=freq:radius=2:rotation=5
  3919. @end example
  3920. @item
  3921. Similar as above but with custom speaker positions for front left, front right, back left and back right
  3922. and also with custom gain:
  3923. @example
  3924. "sofalizer=sofa=/path/to/ClubFritz6.sofa:type=freq:radius=2:speakers=FL 45|FR 315|BL 135|BR 225:gain=28"
  3925. @end example
  3926. @end itemize
  3927. @section stereotools
  3928. This filter has some handy utilities to manage stereo signals, for converting
  3929. M/S stereo recordings to L/R signal while having control over the parameters
  3930. or spreading the stereo image of master track.
  3931. The filter accepts the following options:
  3932. @table @option
  3933. @item level_in
  3934. Set input level before filtering for both channels. Defaults is 1.
  3935. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  3936. @item level_out
  3937. Set output level after filtering for both channels. Defaults is 1.
  3938. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  3939. @item balance_in
  3940. Set input balance between both channels. Default is 0.
  3941. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  3942. @item balance_out
  3943. Set output balance between both channels. Default is 0.
  3944. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  3945. @item softclip
  3946. Enable softclipping. Results in analog distortion instead of harsh digital 0dB
  3947. clipping. Disabled by default.
  3948. @item mutel
  3949. Mute the left channel. Disabled by default.
  3950. @item muter
  3951. Mute the right channel. Disabled by default.
  3952. @item phasel
  3953. Change the phase of the left channel. Disabled by default.
  3954. @item phaser
  3955. Change the phase of the right channel. Disabled by default.
  3956. @item mode
  3957. Set stereo mode. Available values are:
  3958. @table @samp
  3959. @item lr>lr
  3960. Left/Right to Left/Right, this is default.
  3961. @item lr>ms
  3962. Left/Right to Mid/Side.
  3963. @item ms>lr
  3964. Mid/Side to Left/Right.
  3965. @item lr>ll
  3966. Left/Right to Left/Left.
  3967. @item lr>rr
  3968. Left/Right to Right/Right.
  3969. @item lr>l+r
  3970. Left/Right to Left + Right.
  3971. @item lr>rl
  3972. Left/Right to Right/Left.
  3973. @item ms>ll
  3974. Mid/Side to Left/Left.
  3975. @item ms>rr
  3976. Mid/Side to Right/Right.
  3977. @end table
  3978. @item slev
  3979. Set level of side signal. Default is 1.
  3980. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  3981. @item sbal
  3982. Set balance of side signal. Default is 0.
  3983. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  3984. @item mlev
  3985. Set level of the middle signal. Default is 1.
  3986. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  3987. @item mpan
  3988. Set middle signal pan. Default is 0. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  3989. @item base
  3990. Set stereo base between mono and inversed channels. Default is 0.
  3991. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  3992. @item delay
  3993. Set delay in milliseconds how much to delay left from right channel and
  3994. vice versa. Default is 0. Allowed range is from -20 to 20.
  3995. @item sclevel
  3996. Set S/C level. Default is 1. Allowed range is from 1 to 100.
  3997. @item phase
  3998. Set the stereo phase in degrees. Default is 0. Allowed range is from 0 to 360.
  3999. @item bmode_in, bmode_out
  4000. Set balance mode for balance_in/balance_out option.
  4001. Can be one of the following:
  4002. @table @samp
  4003. @item balance
  4004. Classic balance mode. Attenuate one channel at time.
  4005. Gain is raised up to 1.
  4006. @item amplitude
  4007. Similar as classic mode above but gain is raised up to 2.
  4008. @item power
  4009. Equal power distribution, from -6dB to +6dB range.
  4010. @end table
  4011. @end table
  4012. @subsection Examples
  4013. @itemize
  4014. @item
  4015. Apply karaoke like effect:
  4016. @example
  4017. stereotools=mlev=0.015625
  4018. @end example
  4019. @item
  4020. Convert M/S signal to L/R:
  4021. @example
  4022. "stereotools=mode=ms>lr"
  4023. @end example
  4024. @end itemize
  4025. @section stereowiden
  4026. This filter enhance the stereo effect by suppressing signal common to both
  4027. channels and by delaying the signal of left into right and vice versa,
  4028. thereby widening the stereo effect.
  4029. The filter accepts the following options:
  4030. @table @option
  4031. @item delay
  4032. Time in milliseconds of the delay of left signal into right and vice versa.
  4033. Default is 20 milliseconds.
  4034. @item feedback
  4035. Amount of gain in delayed signal into right and vice versa. Gives a delay
  4036. effect of left signal in right output and vice versa which gives widening
  4037. effect. Default is 0.3.
  4038. @item crossfeed
  4039. Cross feed of left into right with inverted phase. This helps in suppressing
  4040. the mono. If the value is 1 it will cancel all the signal common to both
  4041. channels. Default is 0.3.
  4042. @item drymix
  4043. Set level of input signal of original channel. Default is 0.8.
  4044. @end table
  4045. @subsection Commands
  4046. This filter supports the all above options except @code{delay} as @ref{commands}.
  4047. @section superequalizer
  4048. Apply 18 band equalizer.
  4049. The filter accepts the following options:
  4050. @table @option
  4051. @item 1b
  4052. Set 65Hz band gain.
  4053. @item 2b
  4054. Set 92Hz band gain.
  4055. @item 3b
  4056. Set 131Hz band gain.
  4057. @item 4b
  4058. Set 185Hz band gain.
  4059. @item 5b
  4060. Set 262Hz band gain.
  4061. @item 6b
  4062. Set 370Hz band gain.
  4063. @item 7b
  4064. Set 523Hz band gain.
  4065. @item 8b
  4066. Set 740Hz band gain.
  4067. @item 9b
  4068. Set 1047Hz band gain.
  4069. @item 10b
  4070. Set 1480Hz band gain.
  4071. @item 11b
  4072. Set 2093Hz band gain.
  4073. @item 12b
  4074. Set 2960Hz band gain.
  4075. @item 13b
  4076. Set 4186Hz band gain.
  4077. @item 14b
  4078. Set 5920Hz band gain.
  4079. @item 15b
  4080. Set 8372Hz band gain.
  4081. @item 16b
  4082. Set 11840Hz band gain.
  4083. @item 17b
  4084. Set 16744Hz band gain.
  4085. @item 18b
  4086. Set 20000Hz band gain.
  4087. @end table
  4088. @section surround
  4089. Apply audio surround upmix filter.
  4090. This filter allows to produce multichannel output from audio stream.
  4091. The filter accepts the following options:
  4092. @table @option
  4093. @item chl_out
  4094. Set output channel layout. By default, this is @var{5.1}.
  4095. See @ref{channel layout syntax,,the Channel Layout section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  4096. for the required syntax.
  4097. @item chl_in
  4098. Set input channel layout. By default, this is @var{stereo}.
  4099. See @ref{channel layout syntax,,the Channel Layout section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  4100. for the required syntax.
  4101. @item level_in
  4102. Set input volume level. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4103. @item level_out
  4104. Set output volume level. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4105. @item lfe
  4106. Enable LFE channel output if output channel layout has it. By default, this is enabled.
  4107. @item lfe_low
  4108. Set LFE low cut off frequency. By default, this is @var{128} Hz.
  4109. @item lfe_high
  4110. Set LFE high cut off frequency. By default, this is @var{256} Hz.
  4111. @item lfe_mode
  4112. Set LFE mode, can be @var{add} or @var{sub}. Default is @var{add}.
  4113. In @var{add} mode, LFE channel is created from input audio and added to output.
  4114. In @var{sub} mode, LFE channel is created from input audio and added to output but
  4115. also all non-LFE output channels are subtracted with output LFE channel.
  4116. @item angle
  4117. Set angle of stereo surround transform, Allowed range is from @var{0} to @var{360}.
  4118. Default is @var{90}.
  4119. @item fc_in
  4120. Set front center input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4121. @item fc_out
  4122. Set front center output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4123. @item fl_in
  4124. Set front left input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4125. @item fl_out
  4126. Set front left output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4127. @item fr_in
  4128. Set front right input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4129. @item fr_out
  4130. Set front right output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4131. @item sl_in
  4132. Set side left input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4133. @item sl_out
  4134. Set side left output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4135. @item sr_in
  4136. Set side right input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4137. @item sr_out
  4138. Set side right output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4139. @item bl_in
  4140. Set back left input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4141. @item bl_out
  4142. Set back left output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4143. @item br_in
  4144. Set back right input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4145. @item br_out
  4146. Set back right output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4147. @item bc_in
  4148. Set back center input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4149. @item bc_out
  4150. Set back center output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4151. @item lfe_in
  4152. Set LFE input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4153. @item lfe_out
  4154. Set LFE output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4155. @item allx
  4156. Set spread usage of stereo image across X axis for all channels.
  4157. @item ally
  4158. Set spread usage of stereo image across Y axis for all channels.
  4159. @item fcx, flx, frx, blx, brx, slx, srx, bcx
  4160. Set spread usage of stereo image across X axis for each channel.
  4161. @item fcy, fly, fry, bly, bry, sly, sry, bcy
  4162. Set spread usage of stereo image across Y axis for each channel.
  4163. @item win_size
  4164. Set window size. Allowed range is from @var{1024} to @var{65536}. Default size is @var{4096}.
  4165. @item win_func
  4166. Set window function.
  4167. It accepts the following values:
  4168. @table @samp
  4169. @item rect
  4170. @item bartlett
  4171. @item hann, hanning
  4172. @item hamming
  4173. @item blackman
  4174. @item welch
  4175. @item flattop
  4176. @item bharris
  4177. @item bnuttall
  4178. @item bhann
  4179. @item sine
  4180. @item nuttall
  4181. @item lanczos
  4182. @item gauss
  4183. @item tukey
  4184. @item dolph
  4185. @item cauchy
  4186. @item parzen
  4187. @item poisson
  4188. @item bohman
  4189. @end table
  4190. Default is @code{hann}.
  4191. @item overlap
  4192. Set window overlap. If set to 1, the recommended overlap for selected
  4193. window function will be picked. Default is @code{0.5}.
  4194. @end table
  4195. @section treble, highshelf
  4196. Boost or cut treble (upper) frequencies of the audio using a two-pole
  4197. shelving filter with a response similar to that of a standard
  4198. hi-fi's tone-controls. This is also known as shelving equalisation (EQ).
  4199. The filter accepts the following options:
  4200. @table @option
  4201. @item gain, g
  4202. Give the gain at whichever is the lower of ~22 kHz and the
  4203. Nyquist frequency. Its useful range is about -20 (for a large cut)
  4204. to +20 (for a large boost). Beware of clipping when using a positive gain.
  4205. @item frequency, f
  4206. Set the filter's central frequency and so can be used
  4207. to extend or reduce the frequency range to be boosted or cut.
  4208. The default value is @code{3000} Hz.
  4209. @item width_type, t
  4210. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  4211. @table @option
  4212. @item h
  4213. Hz
  4214. @item q
  4215. Q-Factor
  4216. @item o
  4217. octave
  4218. @item s
  4219. slope
  4220. @item k
  4221. kHz
  4222. @end table
  4223. @item width, w
  4224. Determine how steep is the filter's shelf transition.
  4225. @item mix, m
  4226. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  4227. Range is between 0 and 1.
  4228. @item channels, c
  4229. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  4230. @item normalize, n
  4231. Normalize biquad coefficients, by default is disabled.
  4232. Enabling it will normalize magnitude response at DC to 0dB.
  4233. @end table
  4234. @subsection Commands
  4235. This filter supports the following commands:
  4236. @table @option
  4237. @item frequency, f
  4238. Change treble frequency.
  4239. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  4240. @item width_type, t
  4241. Change treble width_type.
  4242. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  4243. @item width, w
  4244. Change treble width.
  4245. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  4246. @item gain, g
  4247. Change treble gain.
  4248. Syntax for the command is : "@var{gain}"
  4249. @item mix, m
  4250. Change treble mix.
  4251. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  4252. @end table
  4253. @section tremolo
  4254. Sinusoidal amplitude modulation.
  4255. The filter accepts the following options:
  4256. @table @option
  4257. @item f
  4258. Modulation frequency in Hertz. Modulation frequencies in the subharmonic range
  4259. (20 Hz or lower) will result in a tremolo effect.
  4260. This filter may also be used as a ring modulator by specifying
  4261. a modulation frequency higher than 20 Hz.
  4262. Range is 0.1 - 20000.0. Default value is 5.0 Hz.
  4263. @item d
  4264. Depth of modulation as a percentage. Range is 0.0 - 1.0.
  4265. Default value is 0.5.
  4266. @end table
  4267. @section vibrato
  4268. Sinusoidal phase modulation.
  4269. The filter accepts the following options:
  4270. @table @option
  4271. @item f
  4272. Modulation frequency in Hertz.
  4273. Range is 0.1 - 20000.0. Default value is 5.0 Hz.
  4274. @item d
  4275. Depth of modulation as a percentage. Range is 0.0 - 1.0.
  4276. Default value is 0.5.
  4277. @end table
  4278. @section volume
  4279. Adjust the input audio volume.
  4280. It accepts the following parameters:
  4281. @table @option
  4282. @item volume
  4283. Set audio volume expression.
  4284. Output values are clipped to the maximum value.
  4285. The output audio volume is given by the relation:
  4286. @example
  4287. @var{output_volume} = @var{volume} * @var{input_volume}
  4288. @end example
  4289. The default value for @var{volume} is "1.0".
  4290. @item precision
  4291. This parameter represents the mathematical precision.
  4292. It determines which input sample formats will be allowed, which affects the
  4293. precision of the volume scaling.
  4294. @table @option
  4295. @item fixed
  4296. 8-bit fixed-point; this limits input sample format to U8, S16, and S32.
  4297. @item float
  4298. 32-bit floating-point; this limits input sample format to FLT. (default)
  4299. @item double
  4300. 64-bit floating-point; this limits input sample format to DBL.
  4301. @end table
  4302. @item replaygain
  4303. Choose the behaviour on encountering ReplayGain side data in input frames.
  4304. @table @option
  4305. @item drop
  4306. Remove ReplayGain side data, ignoring its contents (the default).
  4307. @item ignore
  4308. Ignore ReplayGain side data, but leave it in the frame.
  4309. @item track
  4310. Prefer the track gain, if present.
  4311. @item album
  4312. Prefer the album gain, if present.
  4313. @end table
  4314. @item replaygain_preamp
  4315. Pre-amplification gain in dB to apply to the selected replaygain gain.
  4316. Default value for @var{replaygain_preamp} is 0.0.
  4317. @item replaygain_noclip
  4318. Prevent clipping by limiting the gain applied.
  4319. Default value for @var{replaygain_noclip} is 1.
  4320. @item eval
  4321. Set when the volume expression is evaluated.
  4322. It accepts the following values:
  4323. @table @samp
  4324. @item once
  4325. only evaluate expression once during the filter initialization, or
  4326. when the @samp{volume} command is sent
  4327. @item frame
  4328. evaluate expression for each incoming frame
  4329. @end table
  4330. Default value is @samp{once}.
  4331. @end table
  4332. The volume expression can contain the following parameters.
  4333. @table @option
  4334. @item n
  4335. frame number (starting at zero)
  4336. @item nb_channels
  4337. number of channels
  4338. @item nb_consumed_samples
  4339. number of samples consumed by the filter
  4340. @item nb_samples
  4341. number of samples in the current frame
  4342. @item pos
  4343. original frame position in the file
  4344. @item pts
  4345. frame PTS
  4346. @item sample_rate
  4347. sample rate
  4348. @item startpts
  4349. PTS at start of stream
  4350. @item startt
  4351. time at start of stream
  4352. @item t
  4353. frame time
  4354. @item tb
  4355. timestamp timebase
  4356. @item volume
  4357. last set volume value
  4358. @end table
  4359. Note that when @option{eval} is set to @samp{once} only the
  4360. @var{sample_rate} and @var{tb} variables are available, all other
  4361. variables will evaluate to NAN.
  4362. @subsection Commands
  4363. This filter supports the following commands:
  4364. @table @option
  4365. @item volume
  4366. Modify the volume expression.
  4367. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  4368. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  4369. value.
  4370. @end table
  4371. @subsection Examples
  4372. @itemize
  4373. @item
  4374. Halve the input audio volume:
  4375. @example
  4376. volume=volume=0.5
  4377. volume=volume=1/2
  4378. volume=volume=-6.0206dB
  4379. @end example
  4380. In all the above example the named key for @option{volume} can be
  4381. omitted, for example like in:
  4382. @example
  4383. volume=0.5
  4384. @end example
  4385. @item
  4386. Increase input audio power by 6 decibels using fixed-point precision:
  4387. @example
  4388. volume=volume=6dB:precision=fixed
  4389. @end example
  4390. @item
  4391. Fade volume after time 10 with an annihilation period of 5 seconds:
  4392. @example
  4393. volume='if(lt(t,10),1,max(1-(t-10)/5,0))':eval=frame
  4394. @end example
  4395. @end itemize
  4396. @section volumedetect
  4397. Detect the volume of the input video.
  4398. The filter has no parameters. The input is not modified. Statistics about
  4399. the volume will be printed in the log when the input stream end is reached.
  4400. In particular it will show the mean volume (root mean square), maximum
  4401. volume (on a per-sample basis), and the beginning of a histogram of the
  4402. registered volume values (from the maximum value to a cumulated 1/1000 of
  4403. the samples).
  4404. All volumes are in decibels relative to the maximum PCM value.
  4405. @subsection Examples
  4406. Here is an excerpt of the output:
  4407. @example
  4408. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] mean_volume: -27 dB
  4409. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] max_volume: -4 dB
  4410. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_4db: 6
  4411. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_5db: 62
  4412. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_6db: 286
  4413. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_7db: 1042
  4414. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_8db: 2551
  4415. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_9db: 4609
  4416. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_10db: 8409
  4417. @end example
  4418. It means that:
  4419. @itemize
  4420. @item
  4421. The mean square energy is approximately -27 dB, or 10^-2.7.
  4422. @item
  4423. The largest sample is at -4 dB, or more precisely between -4 dB and -5 dB.
  4424. @item
  4425. There are 6 samples at -4 dB, 62 at -5 dB, 286 at -6 dB, etc.
  4426. @end itemize
  4427. In other words, raising the volume by +4 dB does not cause any clipping,
  4428. raising it by +5 dB causes clipping for 6 samples, etc.
  4429. @c man end AUDIO FILTERS
  4430. @chapter Audio Sources
  4431. @c man begin AUDIO SOURCES
  4432. Below is a description of the currently available audio sources.
  4433. @section abuffer
  4434. Buffer audio frames, and make them available to the filter chain.
  4435. This source is mainly intended for a programmatic use, in particular
  4436. through the interface defined in @file{libavfilter/asrc_abuffer.h}.
  4437. It accepts the following parameters:
  4438. @table @option
  4439. @item time_base
  4440. The timebase which will be used for timestamps of submitted frames. It must be
  4441. either a floating-point number or in @var{numerator}/@var{denominator} form.
  4442. @item sample_rate
  4443. The sample rate of the incoming audio buffers.
  4444. @item sample_fmt
  4445. The sample format of the incoming audio buffers.
  4446. Either a sample format name or its corresponding integer representation from
  4447. the enum AVSampleFormat in @file{libavutil/samplefmt.h}
  4448. @item channel_layout
  4449. The channel layout of the incoming audio buffers.
  4450. Either a channel layout name from channel_layout_map in
  4451. @file{libavutil/channel_layout.c} or its corresponding integer representation
  4452. from the AV_CH_LAYOUT_* macros in @file{libavutil/channel_layout.h}
  4453. @item channels
  4454. The number of channels of the incoming audio buffers.
  4455. If both @var{channels} and @var{channel_layout} are specified, then they
  4456. must be consistent.
  4457. @end table
  4458. @subsection Examples
  4459. @example
  4460. abuffer=sample_rate=44100:sample_fmt=s16p:channel_layout=stereo
  4461. @end example
  4462. will instruct the source to accept planar 16bit signed stereo at 44100Hz.
  4463. Since the sample format with name "s16p" corresponds to the number
  4464. 6 and the "stereo" channel layout corresponds to the value 0x3, this is
  4465. equivalent to:
  4466. @example
  4467. abuffer=sample_rate=44100:sample_fmt=6:channel_layout=0x3
  4468. @end example
  4469. @section aevalsrc
  4470. Generate an audio signal specified by an expression.
  4471. This source accepts in input one or more expressions (one for each
  4472. channel), which are evaluated and used to generate a corresponding
  4473. audio signal.
  4474. This source accepts the following options:
  4475. @table @option
  4476. @item exprs
  4477. Set the '|'-separated expressions list for each separate channel. In case the
  4478. @option{channel_layout} option is not specified, the selected channel layout
  4479. depends on the number of provided expressions. Otherwise the last
  4480. specified expression is applied to the remaining output channels.
  4481. @item channel_layout, c
  4482. Set the channel layout. The number of channels in the specified layout
  4483. must be equal to the number of specified expressions.
  4484. @item duration, d
  4485. Set the minimum duration of the sourced audio. See
  4486. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  4487. for the accepted syntax.
  4488. Note that the resulting duration may be greater than the specified
  4489. duration, as the generated audio is always cut at the end of a
  4490. complete frame.
  4491. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the audio is
  4492. supposed to be generated forever.
  4493. @item nb_samples, n
  4494. Set the number of samples per channel per each output frame,
  4495. default to 1024.
  4496. @item sample_rate, s
  4497. Specify the sample rate, default to 44100.
  4498. @end table
  4499. Each expression in @var{exprs} can contain the following constants:
  4500. @table @option
  4501. @item n
  4502. number of the evaluated sample, starting from 0
  4503. @item t
  4504. time of the evaluated sample expressed in seconds, starting from 0
  4505. @item s
  4506. sample rate
  4507. @end table
  4508. @subsection Examples
  4509. @itemize
  4510. @item
  4511. Generate silence:
  4512. @example
  4513. aevalsrc=0
  4514. @end example
  4515. @item
  4516. Generate a sin signal with frequency of 440 Hz, set sample rate to
  4517. 8000 Hz:
  4518. @example
  4519. aevalsrc="sin(440*2*PI*t):s=8000"
  4520. @end example
  4521. @item
  4522. Generate a two channels signal, specify the channel layout (Front
  4523. Center + Back Center) explicitly:
  4524. @example
  4525. aevalsrc="sin(420*2*PI*t)|cos(430*2*PI*t):c=FC|BC"
  4526. @end example
  4527. @item
  4528. Generate white noise:
  4529. @example
  4530. aevalsrc="-2+random(0)"
  4531. @end example
  4532. @item
  4533. Generate an amplitude modulated signal:
  4534. @example
  4535. aevalsrc="sin(10*2*PI*t)*sin(880*2*PI*t)"
  4536. @end example
  4537. @item
  4538. Generate 2.5 Hz binaural beats on a 360 Hz carrier:
  4539. @example
  4540. aevalsrc="0.1*sin(2*PI*(360-2.5/2)*t) | 0.1*sin(2*PI*(360+2.5/2)*t)"
  4541. @end example
  4542. @end itemize
  4543. @section afirsrc
  4544. Generate a FIR coefficients using frequency sampling method.
  4545. The resulting stream can be used with @ref{afir} filter for filtering the audio signal.
  4546. The filter accepts the following options:
  4547. @table @option
  4548. @item taps, t
  4549. Set number of filter coefficents in output audio stream.
  4550. Default value is 1025.
  4551. @item frequency, f
  4552. Set frequency points from where magnitude and phase are set.
  4553. This must be in non decreasing order, and first element must be 0, while last element
  4554. must be 1. Elements are separated by white spaces.
  4555. @item magnitude, m
  4556. Set magnitude value for every frequency point set by @option{frequency}.
  4557. Number of values must be same as number of frequency points.
  4558. Values are separated by white spaces.
  4559. @item phase, p
  4560. Set phase value for every frequency point set by @option{frequency}.
  4561. Number of values must be same as number of frequency points.
  4562. Values are separated by white spaces.
  4563. @item sample_rate, r
  4564. Set sample rate, default is 44100.
  4565. @item nb_samples, n
  4566. Set number of samples per each frame. Default is 1024.
  4567. @item win_func, w
  4568. Set window function. Default is blackman.
  4569. @end table
  4570. @section anullsrc
  4571. The null audio source, return unprocessed audio frames. It is mainly useful
  4572. as a template and to be employed in analysis / debugging tools, or as
  4573. the source for filters which ignore the input data (for example the sox
  4574. synth filter).
  4575. This source accepts the following options:
  4576. @table @option
  4577. @item channel_layout, cl
  4578. Specifies the channel layout, and can be either an integer or a string
  4579. representing a channel layout. The default value of @var{channel_layout}
  4580. is "stereo".
  4581. Check the channel_layout_map definition in
  4582. @file{libavutil/channel_layout.c} for the mapping between strings and
  4583. channel layout values.
  4584. @item sample_rate, r
  4585. Specifies the sample rate, and defaults to 44100.
  4586. @item nb_samples, n
  4587. Set the number of samples per requested frames.
  4588. @end table
  4589. @subsection Examples
  4590. @itemize
  4591. @item
  4592. Set the sample rate to 48000 Hz and the channel layout to AV_CH_LAYOUT_MONO.
  4593. @example
  4594. anullsrc=r=48000:cl=4
  4595. @end example
  4596. @item
  4597. Do the same operation with a more obvious syntax:
  4598. @example
  4599. anullsrc=r=48000:cl=mono
  4600. @end example
  4601. @end itemize
  4602. All the parameters need to be explicitly defined.
  4603. @section flite
  4604. Synthesize a voice utterance using the libflite library.
  4605. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  4606. @code{--enable-libflite}.
  4607. Note that versions of the flite library prior to 2.0 are not thread-safe.
  4608. The filter accepts the following options:
  4609. @table @option
  4610. @item list_voices
  4611. If set to 1, list the names of the available voices and exit
  4612. immediately. Default value is 0.
  4613. @item nb_samples, n
  4614. Set the maximum number of samples per frame. Default value is 512.
  4615. @item textfile
  4616. Set the filename containing the text to speak.
  4617. @item text
  4618. Set the text to speak.
  4619. @item voice, v
  4620. Set the voice to use for the speech synthesis. Default value is
  4621. @code{kal}. See also the @var{list_voices} option.
  4622. @end table
  4623. @subsection Examples
  4624. @itemize
  4625. @item
  4626. Read from file @file{speech.txt}, and synthesize the text using the
  4627. standard flite voice:
  4628. @example
  4629. flite=textfile=speech.txt
  4630. @end example
  4631. @item
  4632. Read the specified text selecting the @code{slt} voice:
  4633. @example
  4634. flite=text='So fare thee well, poor devil of a Sub-Sub, whose commentator I am':voice=slt
  4635. @end example
  4636. @item
  4637. Input text to ffmpeg:
  4638. @example
  4639. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i flite=text='So fare thee well, poor devil of a Sub-Sub, whose commentator I am':voice=slt
  4640. @end example
  4641. @item
  4642. Make @file{ffplay} speak the specified text, using @code{flite} and
  4643. the @code{lavfi} device:
  4644. @example
  4645. ffplay -f lavfi flite=text='No more be grieved for which that thou hast done.'
  4646. @end example
  4647. @end itemize
  4648. For more information about libflite, check:
  4649. @url{http://www.festvox.org/flite/}
  4650. @section anoisesrc
  4651. Generate a noise audio signal.
  4652. The filter accepts the following options:
  4653. @table @option
  4654. @item sample_rate, r
  4655. Specify the sample rate. Default value is 48000 Hz.
  4656. @item amplitude, a
  4657. Specify the amplitude (0.0 - 1.0) of the generated audio stream. Default value
  4658. is 1.0.
  4659. @item duration, d
  4660. Specify the duration of the generated audio stream. Not specifying this option
  4661. results in noise with an infinite length.
  4662. @item color, colour, c
  4663. Specify the color of noise. Available noise colors are white, pink, brown,
  4664. blue, violet and velvet. Default color is white.
  4665. @item seed, s
  4666. Specify a value used to seed the PRNG.
  4667. @item nb_samples, n
  4668. Set the number of samples per each output frame, default is 1024.
  4669. @end table
  4670. @subsection Examples
  4671. @itemize
  4672. @item
  4673. Generate 60 seconds of pink noise, with a 44.1 kHz sampling rate and an amplitude of 0.5:
  4674. @example
  4675. anoisesrc=d=60:c=pink:r=44100:a=0.5
  4676. @end example
  4677. @end itemize
  4678. @section hilbert
  4679. Generate odd-tap Hilbert transform FIR coefficients.
  4680. The resulting stream can be used with @ref{afir} filter for phase-shifting
  4681. the signal by 90 degrees.
  4682. This is used in many matrix coding schemes and for analytic signal generation.
  4683. The process is often written as a multiplication by i (or j), the imaginary unit.
  4684. The filter accepts the following options:
  4685. @table @option
  4686. @item sample_rate, s
  4687. Set sample rate, default is 44100.
  4688. @item taps, t
  4689. Set length of FIR filter, default is 22051.
  4690. @item nb_samples, n
  4691. Set number of samples per each frame.
  4692. @item win_func, w
  4693. Set window function to be used when generating FIR coefficients.
  4694. @end table
  4695. @section sinc
  4696. Generate a sinc kaiser-windowed low-pass, high-pass, band-pass, or band-reject FIR coefficients.
  4697. The resulting stream can be used with @ref{afir} filter for filtering the audio signal.
  4698. The filter accepts the following options:
  4699. @table @option
  4700. @item sample_rate, r
  4701. Set sample rate, default is 44100.
  4702. @item nb_samples, n
  4703. Set number of samples per each frame. Default is 1024.
  4704. @item hp
  4705. Set high-pass frequency. Default is 0.
  4706. @item lp
  4707. Set low-pass frequency. Default is 0.
  4708. If high-pass frequency is lower than low-pass frequency and low-pass frequency
  4709. is higher than 0 then filter will create band-pass filter coefficients,
  4710. otherwise band-reject filter coefficients.
  4711. @item phase
  4712. Set filter phase response. Default is 50. Allowed range is from 0 to 100.
  4713. @item beta
  4714. Set Kaiser window beta.
  4715. @item att
  4716. Set stop-band attenuation. Default is 120dB, allowed range is from 40 to 180 dB.
  4717. @item round
  4718. Enable rounding, by default is disabled.
  4719. @item hptaps
  4720. Set number of taps for high-pass filter.
  4721. @item lptaps
  4722. Set number of taps for low-pass filter.
  4723. @end table
  4724. @section sine
  4725. Generate an audio signal made of a sine wave with amplitude 1/8.
  4726. The audio signal is bit-exact.
  4727. The filter accepts the following options:
  4728. @table @option
  4729. @item frequency, f
  4730. Set the carrier frequency. Default is 440 Hz.
  4731. @item beep_factor, b
  4732. Enable a periodic beep every second with frequency @var{beep_factor} times
  4733. the carrier frequency. Default is 0, meaning the beep is disabled.
  4734. @item sample_rate, r
  4735. Specify the sample rate, default is 44100.
  4736. @item duration, d
  4737. Specify the duration of the generated audio stream.
  4738. @item samples_per_frame
  4739. Set the number of samples per output frame.
  4740. The expression can contain the following constants:
  4741. @table @option
  4742. @item n
  4743. The (sequential) number of the output audio frame, starting from 0.
  4744. @item pts
  4745. The PTS (Presentation TimeStamp) of the output audio frame,
  4746. expressed in @var{TB} units.
  4747. @item t
  4748. The PTS of the output audio frame, expressed in seconds.
  4749. @item TB
  4750. The timebase of the output audio frames.
  4751. @end table
  4752. Default is @code{1024}.
  4753. @end table
  4754. @subsection Examples
  4755. @itemize
  4756. @item
  4757. Generate a simple 440 Hz sine wave:
  4758. @example
  4759. sine
  4760. @end example
  4761. @item
  4762. Generate a 220 Hz sine wave with a 880 Hz beep each second, for 5 seconds:
  4763. @example
  4764. sine=220:4:d=5
  4765. sine=f=220:b=4:d=5
  4766. sine=frequency=220:beep_factor=4:duration=5
  4767. @end example
  4768. @item
  4769. Generate a 1 kHz sine wave following @code{1602,1601,1602,1601,1602} NTSC
  4770. pattern:
  4771. @example
  4772. sine=1000:samples_per_frame='st(0,mod(n,5)); 1602-not(not(eq(ld(0),1)+eq(ld(0),3)))'
  4773. @end example
  4774. @end itemize
  4775. @c man end AUDIO SOURCES
  4776. @chapter Audio Sinks
  4777. @c man begin AUDIO SINKS
  4778. Below is a description of the currently available audio sinks.
  4779. @section abuffersink
  4780. Buffer audio frames, and make them available to the end of filter chain.
  4781. This sink is mainly intended for programmatic use, in particular
  4782. through the interface defined in @file{libavfilter/buffersink.h}
  4783. or the options system.
  4784. It accepts a pointer to an AVABufferSinkContext structure, which
  4785. defines the incoming buffers' formats, to be passed as the opaque
  4786. parameter to @code{avfilter_init_filter} for initialization.
  4787. @section anullsink
  4788. Null audio sink; do absolutely nothing with the input audio. It is
  4789. mainly useful as a template and for use in analysis / debugging
  4790. tools.
  4791. @c man end AUDIO SINKS
  4792. @chapter Video Filters
  4793. @c man begin VIDEO FILTERS
  4794. When you configure your FFmpeg build, you can disable any of the
  4795. existing filters using @code{--disable-filters}.
  4796. The configure output will show the video filters included in your
  4797. build.
  4798. Below is a description of the currently available video filters.
  4799. @section addroi
  4800. Mark a region of interest in a video frame.
  4801. The frame data is passed through unchanged, but metadata is attached
  4802. to the frame indicating regions of interest which can affect the
  4803. behaviour of later encoding. Multiple regions can be marked by
  4804. applying the filter multiple times.
  4805. @table @option
  4806. @item x
  4807. Region distance in pixels from the left edge of the frame.
  4808. @item y
  4809. Region distance in pixels from the top edge of the frame.
  4810. @item w
  4811. Region width in pixels.
  4812. @item h
  4813. Region height in pixels.
  4814. The parameters @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w} and @var{h} are expressions,
  4815. and may contain the following variables:
  4816. @table @option
  4817. @item iw
  4818. Width of the input frame.
  4819. @item ih
  4820. Height of the input frame.
  4821. @end table
  4822. @item qoffset
  4823. Quantisation offset to apply within the region.
  4824. This must be a real value in the range -1 to +1. A value of zero
  4825. indicates no quality change. A negative value asks for better quality
  4826. (less quantisation), while a positive value asks for worse quality
  4827. (greater quantisation).
  4828. The range is calibrated so that the extreme values indicate the
  4829. largest possible offset - if the rest of the frame is encoded with the
  4830. worst possible quality, an offset of -1 indicates that this region
  4831. should be encoded with the best possible quality anyway. Intermediate
  4832. values are then interpolated in some codec-dependent way.
  4833. For example, in 10-bit H.264 the quantisation parameter varies between
  4834. -12 and 51. A typical qoffset value of -1/10 therefore indicates that
  4835. this region should be encoded with a QP around one-tenth of the full
  4836. range better than the rest of the frame. So, if most of the frame
  4837. were to be encoded with a QP of around 30, this region would get a QP
  4838. of around 24 (an offset of approximately -1/10 * (51 - -12) = -6.3).
  4839. An extreme value of -1 would indicate that this region should be
  4840. encoded with the best possible quality regardless of the treatment of
  4841. the rest of the frame - that is, should be encoded at a QP of -12.
  4842. @item clear
  4843. If set to true, remove any existing regions of interest marked on the
  4844. frame before adding the new one.
  4845. @end table
  4846. @subsection Examples
  4847. @itemize
  4848. @item
  4849. Mark the centre quarter of the frame as interesting.
  4850. @example
  4851. addroi=iw/4:ih/4:iw/2:ih/2:-1/10
  4852. @end example
  4853. @item
  4854. Mark the 100-pixel-wide region on the left edge of the frame as very
  4855. uninteresting (to be encoded at much lower quality than the rest of
  4856. the frame).
  4857. @example
  4858. addroi=0:0:100:ih:+1/5
  4859. @end example
  4860. @end itemize
  4861. @section alphaextract
  4862. Extract the alpha component from the input as a grayscale video. This
  4863. is especially useful with the @var{alphamerge} filter.
  4864. @section alphamerge
  4865. Add or replace the alpha component of the primary input with the
  4866. grayscale value of a second input. This is intended for use with
  4867. @var{alphaextract} to allow the transmission or storage of frame
  4868. sequences that have alpha in a format that doesn't support an alpha
  4869. channel.
  4870. For example, to reconstruct full frames from a normal YUV-encoded video
  4871. and a separate video created with @var{alphaextract}, you might use:
  4872. @example
  4873. movie=in_alpha.mkv [alpha]; [in][alpha] alphamerge [out]
  4874. @end example
  4875. Since this filter is designed for reconstruction, it operates on frame
  4876. sequences without considering timestamps, and terminates when either
  4877. input reaches end of stream. This will cause problems if your encoding
  4878. pipeline drops frames. If you're trying to apply an image as an
  4879. overlay to a video stream, consider the @var{overlay} filter instead.
  4880. @section amplify
  4881. Amplify differences between current pixel and pixels of adjacent frames in
  4882. same pixel location.
  4883. This filter accepts the following options:
  4884. @table @option
  4885. @item radius
  4886. Set frame radius. Default is 2. Allowed range is from 1 to 63.
  4887. For example radius of 3 will instruct filter to calculate average of 7 frames.
  4888. @item factor
  4889. Set factor to amplify difference. Default is 2. Allowed range is from 0 to 65535.
  4890. @item threshold
  4891. Set threshold for difference amplification. Any difference greater or equal to
  4892. this value will not alter source pixel. Default is 10.
  4893. Allowed range is from 0 to 65535.
  4894. @item tolerance
  4895. Set tolerance for difference amplification. Any difference lower to
  4896. this value will not alter source pixel. Default is 0.
  4897. Allowed range is from 0 to 65535.
  4898. @item low
  4899. Set lower limit for changing source pixel. Default is 65535. Allowed range is from 0 to 65535.
  4900. This option controls maximum possible value that will decrease source pixel value.
  4901. @item high
  4902. Set high limit for changing source pixel. Default is 65535. Allowed range is from 0 to 65535.
  4903. This option controls maximum possible value that will increase source pixel value.
  4904. @item planes
  4905. Set which planes to filter. Default is all. Allowed range is from 0 to 15.
  4906. @end table
  4907. @subsection Commands
  4908. This filter supports the following @ref{commands} that corresponds to option of same name:
  4909. @table @option
  4910. @item factor
  4911. @item threshold
  4912. @item tolerance
  4913. @item low
  4914. @item high
  4915. @item planes
  4916. @end table
  4917. @section ass
  4918. Same as the @ref{subtitles} filter, except that it doesn't require libavcodec
  4919. and libavformat to work. On the other hand, it is limited to ASS (Advanced
  4920. Substation Alpha) subtitles files.
  4921. This filter accepts the following option in addition to the common options from
  4922. the @ref{subtitles} filter:
  4923. @table @option
  4924. @item shaping
  4925. Set the shaping engine
  4926. Available values are:
  4927. @table @samp
  4928. @item auto
  4929. The default libass shaping engine, which is the best available.
  4930. @item simple
  4931. Fast, font-agnostic shaper that can do only substitutions
  4932. @item complex
  4933. Slower shaper using OpenType for substitutions and positioning
  4934. @end table
  4935. The default is @code{auto}.
  4936. @end table
  4937. @section atadenoise
  4938. Apply an Adaptive Temporal Averaging Denoiser to the video input.
  4939. The filter accepts the following options:
  4940. @table @option
  4941. @item 0a
  4942. Set threshold A for 1st plane. Default is 0.02.
  4943. Valid range is 0 to 0.3.
  4944. @item 0b
  4945. Set threshold B for 1st plane. Default is 0.04.
  4946. Valid range is 0 to 5.
  4947. @item 1a
  4948. Set threshold A for 2nd plane. Default is 0.02.
  4949. Valid range is 0 to 0.3.
  4950. @item 1b
  4951. Set threshold B for 2nd plane. Default is 0.04.
  4952. Valid range is 0 to 5.
  4953. @item 2a
  4954. Set threshold A for 3rd plane. Default is 0.02.
  4955. Valid range is 0 to 0.3.
  4956. @item 2b
  4957. Set threshold B for 3rd plane. Default is 0.04.
  4958. Valid range is 0 to 5.
  4959. Threshold A is designed to react on abrupt changes in the input signal and
  4960. threshold B is designed to react on continuous changes in the input signal.
  4961. @item s
  4962. Set number of frames filter will use for averaging. Default is 9. Must be odd
  4963. number in range [5, 129].
  4964. @item p
  4965. Set what planes of frame filter will use for averaging. Default is all.
  4966. @item a
  4967. Set what variant of algorithm filter will use for averaging. Default is @code{p} parallel.
  4968. Alternatively can be set to @code{s} serial.
  4969. Parallel can be faster then serial, while other way around is never true.
  4970. Parallel will abort early on first change being greater then thresholds, while serial
  4971. will continue processing other side of frames if they are equal or bellow thresholds.
  4972. @end table
  4973. @subsection Commands
  4974. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options except option @code{s}.
  4975. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  4976. @section avgblur
  4977. Apply average blur filter.
  4978. The filter accepts the following options:
  4979. @table @option
  4980. @item sizeX
  4981. Set horizontal radius size.
  4982. @item planes
  4983. Set which planes to filter. By default all planes are filtered.
  4984. @item sizeY
  4985. Set vertical radius size, if zero it will be same as @code{sizeX}.
  4986. Default is @code{0}.
  4987. @end table
  4988. @subsection Commands
  4989. This filter supports same commands as options.
  4990. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  4991. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  4992. value.
  4993. @section bbox
  4994. Compute the bounding box for the non-black pixels in the input frame
  4995. luminance plane.
  4996. This filter computes the bounding box containing all the pixels with a
  4997. luminance value greater than the minimum allowed value.
  4998. The parameters describing the bounding box are printed on the filter
  4999. log.
  5000. The filter accepts the following option:
  5001. @table @option
  5002. @item min_val
  5003. Set the minimal luminance value. Default is @code{16}.
  5004. @end table
  5005. @section bilateral
  5006. Apply bilateral filter, spatial smoothing while preserving edges.
  5007. The filter accepts the following options:
  5008. @table @option
  5009. @item sigmaS
  5010. Set sigma of gaussian function to calculate spatial weight.
  5011. Allowed range is 0 to 10. Default is 0.1.
  5012. @item sigmaR
  5013. Set sigma of gaussian function to calculate range weight.
  5014. Allowed range is 0 to 1. Default is 0.1.
  5015. @item planes
  5016. Set planes to filter. Default is first only.
  5017. @end table
  5018. @section bitplanenoise
  5019. Show and measure bit plane noise.
  5020. The filter accepts the following options:
  5021. @table @option
  5022. @item bitplane
  5023. Set which plane to analyze. Default is @code{1}.
  5024. @item filter
  5025. Filter out noisy pixels from @code{bitplane} set above.
  5026. Default is disabled.
  5027. @end table
  5028. @section blackdetect
  5029. Detect video intervals that are (almost) completely black. Can be
  5030. useful to detect chapter transitions, commercials, or invalid
  5031. recordings. Output lines contains the time for the start, end and
  5032. duration of the detected black interval expressed in seconds.
  5033. In order to display the output lines, you need to set the loglevel at
  5034. least to the AV_LOG_INFO value.
  5035. The filter accepts the following options:
  5036. @table @option
  5037. @item black_min_duration, d
  5038. Set the minimum detected black duration expressed in seconds. It must
  5039. be a non-negative floating point number.
  5040. Default value is 2.0.
  5041. @item picture_black_ratio_th, pic_th
  5042. Set the threshold for considering a picture "black".
  5043. Express the minimum value for the ratio:
  5044. @example
  5045. @var{nb_black_pixels} / @var{nb_pixels}
  5046. @end example
  5047. for which a picture is considered black.
  5048. Default value is 0.98.
  5049. @item pixel_black_th, pix_th
  5050. Set the threshold for considering a pixel "black".
  5051. The threshold expresses the maximum pixel luminance value for which a
  5052. pixel is considered "black". The provided value is scaled according to
  5053. the following equation:
  5054. @example
  5055. @var{absolute_threshold} = @var{luminance_minimum_value} + @var{pixel_black_th} * @var{luminance_range_size}
  5056. @end example
  5057. @var{luminance_range_size} and @var{luminance_minimum_value} depend on
  5058. the input video format, the range is [0-255] for YUV full-range
  5059. formats and [16-235] for YUV non full-range formats.
  5060. Default value is 0.10.
  5061. @end table
  5062. The following example sets the maximum pixel threshold to the minimum
  5063. value, and detects only black intervals of 2 or more seconds:
  5064. @example
  5065. blackdetect=d=2:pix_th=0.00
  5066. @end example
  5067. @section blackframe
  5068. Detect frames that are (almost) completely black. Can be useful to
  5069. detect chapter transitions or commercials. Output lines consist of
  5070. the frame number of the detected frame, the percentage of blackness,
  5071. the position in the file if known or -1 and the timestamp in seconds.
  5072. In order to display the output lines, you need to set the loglevel at
  5073. least to the AV_LOG_INFO value.
  5074. This filter exports frame metadata @code{lavfi.blackframe.pblack}.
  5075. The value represents the percentage of pixels in the picture that
  5076. are below the threshold value.
  5077. It accepts the following parameters:
  5078. @table @option
  5079. @item amount
  5080. The percentage of the pixels that have to be below the threshold; it defaults to
  5081. @code{98}.
  5082. @item threshold, thresh
  5083. The threshold below which a pixel value is considered black; it defaults to
  5084. @code{32}.
  5085. @end table
  5086. @anchor{blend}
  5087. @section blend
  5088. Blend two video frames into each other.
  5089. The @code{blend} filter takes two input streams and outputs one
  5090. stream, the first input is the "top" layer and second input is
  5091. "bottom" layer. By default, the output terminates when the longest input terminates.
  5092. The @code{tblend} (time blend) filter takes two consecutive frames
  5093. from one single stream, and outputs the result obtained by blending
  5094. the new frame on top of the old frame.
  5095. A description of the accepted options follows.
  5096. @table @option
  5097. @item c0_mode
  5098. @item c1_mode
  5099. @item c2_mode
  5100. @item c3_mode
  5101. @item all_mode
  5102. Set blend mode for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
  5103. of @var{all_mode}. Default value is @code{normal}.
  5104. Available values for component modes are:
  5105. @table @samp
  5106. @item addition
  5107. @item grainmerge
  5108. @item and
  5109. @item average
  5110. @item burn
  5111. @item darken
  5112. @item difference
  5113. @item grainextract
  5114. @item divide
  5115. @item dodge
  5116. @item freeze
  5117. @item exclusion
  5118. @item extremity
  5119. @item glow
  5120. @item hardlight
  5121. @item hardmix
  5122. @item heat
  5123. @item lighten
  5124. @item linearlight
  5125. @item multiply
  5126. @item multiply128
  5127. @item negation
  5128. @item normal
  5129. @item or
  5130. @item overlay
  5131. @item phoenix
  5132. @item pinlight
  5133. @item reflect
  5134. @item screen
  5135. @item softlight
  5136. @item subtract
  5137. @item vividlight
  5138. @item xor
  5139. @end table
  5140. @item c0_opacity
  5141. @item c1_opacity
  5142. @item c2_opacity
  5143. @item c3_opacity
  5144. @item all_opacity
  5145. Set blend opacity for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
  5146. of @var{all_opacity}. Only used in combination with pixel component blend modes.
  5147. @item c0_expr
  5148. @item c1_expr
  5149. @item c2_expr
  5150. @item c3_expr
  5151. @item all_expr
  5152. Set blend expression for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
  5153. of @var{all_expr}. Note that related mode options will be ignored if those are set.
  5154. The expressions can use the following variables:
  5155. @table @option
  5156. @item N
  5157. The sequential number of the filtered frame, starting from @code{0}.
  5158. @item X
  5159. @item Y
  5160. the coordinates of the current sample
  5161. @item W
  5162. @item H
  5163. the width and height of currently filtered plane
  5164. @item SW
  5165. @item SH
  5166. Width and height scale for the plane being filtered. It is the
  5167. ratio between the dimensions of the current plane to the luma plane,
  5168. e.g. for a @code{yuv420p} frame, the values are @code{1,1} for
  5169. the luma plane and @code{0.5,0.5} for the chroma planes.
  5170. @item T
  5171. Time of the current frame, expressed in seconds.
  5172. @item TOP, A
  5173. Value of pixel component at current location for first video frame (top layer).
  5174. @item BOTTOM, B
  5175. Value of pixel component at current location for second video frame (bottom layer).
  5176. @end table
  5177. @end table
  5178. The @code{blend} filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  5179. @subsection Examples
  5180. @itemize
  5181. @item
  5182. Apply transition from bottom layer to top layer in first 10 seconds:
  5183. @example
  5184. blend=all_expr='A*(if(gte(T,10),1,T/10))+B*(1-(if(gte(T,10),1,T/10)))'
  5185. @end example
  5186. @item
  5187. Apply linear horizontal transition from top layer to bottom layer:
  5188. @example
  5189. blend=all_expr='A*(X/W)+B*(1-X/W)'
  5190. @end example
  5191. @item
  5192. Apply 1x1 checkerboard effect:
  5193. @example
  5194. blend=all_expr='if(eq(mod(X,2),mod(Y,2)),A,B)'
  5195. @end example
  5196. @item
  5197. Apply uncover left effect:
  5198. @example
  5199. blend=all_expr='if(gte(N*SW+X,W),A,B)'
  5200. @end example
  5201. @item
  5202. Apply uncover down effect:
  5203. @example
  5204. blend=all_expr='if(gte(Y-N*SH,0),A,B)'
  5205. @end example
  5206. @item
  5207. Apply uncover up-left effect:
  5208. @example
  5209. blend=all_expr='if(gte(T*SH*40+Y,H)*gte((T*40*SW+X)*W/H,W),A,B)'
  5210. @end example
  5211. @item
  5212. Split diagonally video and shows top and bottom layer on each side:
  5213. @example
  5214. blend=all_expr='if(gt(X,Y*(W/H)),A,B)'
  5215. @end example
  5216. @item
  5217. Display differences between the current and the previous frame:
  5218. @example
  5219. tblend=all_mode=grainextract
  5220. @end example
  5221. @end itemize
  5222. @section bm3d
  5223. Denoise frames using Block-Matching 3D algorithm.
  5224. The filter accepts the following options.
  5225. @table @option
  5226. @item sigma
  5227. Set denoising strength. Default value is 1.
  5228. Allowed range is from 0 to 999.9.
  5229. The denoising algorithm is very sensitive to sigma, so adjust it
  5230. according to the source.
  5231. @item block
  5232. Set local patch size. This sets dimensions in 2D.
  5233. @item bstep
  5234. Set sliding step for processing blocks. Default value is 4.
  5235. Allowed range is from 1 to 64.
  5236. Smaller values allows processing more reference blocks and is slower.
  5237. @item group
  5238. Set maximal number of similar blocks for 3rd dimension. Default value is 1.
  5239. When set to 1, no block matching is done. Larger values allows more blocks
  5240. in single group.
  5241. Allowed range is from 1 to 256.
  5242. @item range
  5243. Set radius for search block matching. Default is 9.
  5244. Allowed range is from 1 to INT32_MAX.
  5245. @item mstep
  5246. Set step between two search locations for block matching. Default is 1.
  5247. Allowed range is from 1 to 64. Smaller is slower.
  5248. @item thmse
  5249. Set threshold of mean square error for block matching. Valid range is 0 to
  5250. INT32_MAX.
  5251. @item hdthr
  5252. Set thresholding parameter for hard thresholding in 3D transformed domain.
  5253. Larger values results in stronger hard-thresholding filtering in frequency
  5254. domain.
  5255. @item estim
  5256. Set filtering estimation mode. Can be @code{basic} or @code{final}.
  5257. Default is @code{basic}.
  5258. @item ref
  5259. If enabled, filter will use 2nd stream for block matching.
  5260. Default is disabled for @code{basic} value of @var{estim} option,
  5261. and always enabled if value of @var{estim} is @code{final}.
  5262. @item planes
  5263. Set planes to filter. Default is all available except alpha.
  5264. @end table
  5265. @subsection Examples
  5266. @itemize
  5267. @item
  5268. Basic filtering with bm3d:
  5269. @example
  5270. bm3d=sigma=3:block=4:bstep=2:group=1:estim=basic
  5271. @end example
  5272. @item
  5273. Same as above, but filtering only luma:
  5274. @example
  5275. bm3d=sigma=3:block=4:bstep=2:group=1:estim=basic:planes=1
  5276. @end example
  5277. @item
  5278. Same as above, but with both estimation modes:
  5279. @example
  5280. split[a][b],[a]bm3d=sigma=3:block=4:bstep=2:group=1:estim=basic[a],[b][a]bm3d=sigma=3:block=4:bstep=2:group=16:estim=final:ref=1
  5281. @end example
  5282. @item
  5283. Same as above, but prefilter with @ref{nlmeans} filter instead:
  5284. @example
  5285. split[a][b],[a]nlmeans=s=3:r=7:p=3[a],[b][a]bm3d=sigma=3:block=4:bstep=2:group=16:estim=final:ref=1
  5286. @end example
  5287. @end itemize
  5288. @section boxblur
  5289. Apply a boxblur algorithm to the input video.
  5290. It accepts the following parameters:
  5291. @table @option
  5292. @item luma_radius, lr
  5293. @item luma_power, lp
  5294. @item chroma_radius, cr
  5295. @item chroma_power, cp
  5296. @item alpha_radius, ar
  5297. @item alpha_power, ap
  5298. @end table
  5299. A description of the accepted options follows.
  5300. @table @option
  5301. @item luma_radius, lr
  5302. @item chroma_radius, cr
  5303. @item alpha_radius, ar
  5304. Set an expression for the box radius in pixels used for blurring the
  5305. corresponding input plane.
  5306. The radius value must be a non-negative number, and must not be
  5307. greater than the value of the expression @code{min(w,h)/2} for the
  5308. luma and alpha planes, and of @code{min(cw,ch)/2} for the chroma
  5309. planes.
  5310. Default value for @option{luma_radius} is "2". If not specified,
  5311. @option{chroma_radius} and @option{alpha_radius} default to the
  5312. corresponding value set for @option{luma_radius}.
  5313. The expressions can contain the following constants:
  5314. @table @option
  5315. @item w
  5316. @item h
  5317. The input width and height in pixels.
  5318. @item cw
  5319. @item ch
  5320. The input chroma image width and height in pixels.
  5321. @item hsub
  5322. @item vsub
  5323. The horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example, for the
  5324. pixel format "yuv422p", @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  5325. @end table
  5326. @item luma_power, lp
  5327. @item chroma_power, cp
  5328. @item alpha_power, ap
  5329. Specify how many times the boxblur filter is applied to the
  5330. corresponding plane.
  5331. Default value for @option{luma_power} is 2. If not specified,
  5332. @option{chroma_power} and @option{alpha_power} default to the
  5333. corresponding value set for @option{luma_power}.
  5334. A value of 0 will disable the effect.
  5335. @end table
  5336. @subsection Examples
  5337. @itemize
  5338. @item
  5339. Apply a boxblur filter with the luma, chroma, and alpha radii
  5340. set to 2:
  5341. @example
  5342. boxblur=luma_radius=2:luma_power=1
  5343. boxblur=2:1
  5344. @end example
  5345. @item
  5346. Set the luma radius to 2, and alpha and chroma radius to 0:
  5347. @example
  5348. boxblur=2:1:cr=0:ar=0
  5349. @end example
  5350. @item
  5351. Set the luma and chroma radii to a fraction of the video dimension:
  5352. @example
  5353. boxblur=luma_radius=min(h\,w)/10:luma_power=1:chroma_radius=min(cw\,ch)/10:chroma_power=1
  5354. @end example
  5355. @end itemize
  5356. @section bwdif
  5357. Deinterlace the input video ("bwdif" stands for "Bob Weaver
  5358. Deinterlacing Filter").
  5359. Motion adaptive deinterlacing based on yadif with the use of w3fdif and cubic
  5360. interpolation algorithms.
  5361. It accepts the following parameters:
  5362. @table @option
  5363. @item mode
  5364. The interlacing mode to adopt. It accepts one of the following values:
  5365. @table @option
  5366. @item 0, send_frame
  5367. Output one frame for each frame.
  5368. @item 1, send_field
  5369. Output one frame for each field.
  5370. @end table
  5371. The default value is @code{send_field}.
  5372. @item parity
  5373. The picture field parity assumed for the input interlaced video. It accepts one
  5374. of the following values:
  5375. @table @option
  5376. @item 0, tff
  5377. Assume the top field is first.
  5378. @item 1, bff
  5379. Assume the bottom field is first.
  5380. @item -1, auto
  5381. Enable automatic detection of field parity.
  5382. @end table
  5383. The default value is @code{auto}.
  5384. If the interlacing is unknown or the decoder does not export this information,
  5385. top field first will be assumed.
  5386. @item deint
  5387. Specify which frames to deinterlace. Accepts one of the following
  5388. values:
  5389. @table @option
  5390. @item 0, all
  5391. Deinterlace all frames.
  5392. @item 1, interlaced
  5393. Only deinterlace frames marked as interlaced.
  5394. @end table
  5395. The default value is @code{all}.
  5396. @end table
  5397. @section cas
  5398. Apply Contrast Adaptive Sharpen filter to video stream.
  5399. The filter accepts the following options:
  5400. @table @option
  5401. @item strength
  5402. Set the sharpening strength. Default value is 0.
  5403. @item planes
  5404. Set planes to filter. Default value is to filter all
  5405. planes except alpha plane.
  5406. @end table
  5407. @section chromahold
  5408. Remove all color information for all colors except for certain one.
  5409. The filter accepts the following options:
  5410. @table @option
  5411. @item color
  5412. The color which will not be replaced with neutral chroma.
  5413. @item similarity
  5414. Similarity percentage with the above color.
  5415. 0.01 matches only the exact key color, while 1.0 matches everything.
  5416. @item blend
  5417. Blend percentage.
  5418. 0.0 makes pixels either fully gray, or not gray at all.
  5419. Higher values result in more preserved color.
  5420. @item yuv
  5421. Signals that the color passed is already in YUV instead of RGB.
  5422. Literal colors like "green" or "red" don't make sense with this enabled anymore.
  5423. This can be used to pass exact YUV values as hexadecimal numbers.
  5424. @end table
  5425. @subsection Commands
  5426. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options.
  5427. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  5428. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  5429. value.
  5430. @section chromakey
  5431. YUV colorspace color/chroma keying.
  5432. The filter accepts the following options:
  5433. @table @option
  5434. @item color
  5435. The color which will be replaced with transparency.
  5436. @item similarity
  5437. Similarity percentage with the key color.
  5438. 0.01 matches only the exact key color, while 1.0 matches everything.
  5439. @item blend
  5440. Blend percentage.
  5441. 0.0 makes pixels either fully transparent, or not transparent at all.
  5442. Higher values result in semi-transparent pixels, with a higher transparency
  5443. the more similar the pixels color is to the key color.
  5444. @item yuv
  5445. Signals that the color passed is already in YUV instead of RGB.
  5446. Literal colors like "green" or "red" don't make sense with this enabled anymore.
  5447. This can be used to pass exact YUV values as hexadecimal numbers.
  5448. @end table
  5449. @subsection Commands
  5450. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options.
  5451. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  5452. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  5453. value.
  5454. @subsection Examples
  5455. @itemize
  5456. @item
  5457. Make every green pixel in the input image transparent:
  5458. @example
  5459. ffmpeg -i input.png -vf chromakey=green out.png
  5460. @end example
  5461. @item
  5462. Overlay a greenscreen-video on top of a static black background.
  5463. @example
  5464. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i color=c=black:s=1280x720 -i video.mp4 -shortest -filter_complex "[1:v]chromakey=0x70de77:0.1:0.2[ckout];[0:v][ckout]overlay[out]" -map "[out]" output.mkv
  5465. @end example
  5466. @end itemize
  5467. @section chromashift
  5468. Shift chroma pixels horizontally and/or vertically.
  5469. The filter accepts the following options:
  5470. @table @option
  5471. @item cbh
  5472. Set amount to shift chroma-blue horizontally.
  5473. @item cbv
  5474. Set amount to shift chroma-blue vertically.
  5475. @item crh
  5476. Set amount to shift chroma-red horizontally.
  5477. @item crv
  5478. Set amount to shift chroma-red vertically.
  5479. @item edge
  5480. Set edge mode, can be @var{smear}, default, or @var{warp}.
  5481. @end table
  5482. @subsection Commands
  5483. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  5484. @section ciescope
  5485. Display CIE color diagram with pixels overlaid onto it.
  5486. The filter accepts the following options:
  5487. @table @option
  5488. @item system
  5489. Set color system.
  5490. @table @samp
  5491. @item ntsc, 470m
  5492. @item ebu, 470bg
  5493. @item smpte
  5494. @item 240m
  5495. @item apple
  5496. @item widergb
  5497. @item cie1931
  5498. @item rec709, hdtv
  5499. @item uhdtv, rec2020
  5500. @item dcip3
  5501. @end table
  5502. @item cie
  5503. Set CIE system.
  5504. @table @samp
  5505. @item xyy
  5506. @item ucs
  5507. @item luv
  5508. @end table
  5509. @item gamuts
  5510. Set what gamuts to draw.
  5511. See @code{system} option for available values.
  5512. @item size, s
  5513. Set ciescope size, by default set to 512.
  5514. @item intensity, i
  5515. Set intensity used to map input pixel values to CIE diagram.
  5516. @item contrast
  5517. Set contrast used to draw tongue colors that are out of active color system gamut.
  5518. @item corrgamma
  5519. Correct gamma displayed on scope, by default enabled.
  5520. @item showwhite
  5521. Show white point on CIE diagram, by default disabled.
  5522. @item gamma
  5523. Set input gamma. Used only with XYZ input color space.
  5524. @end table
  5525. @section codecview
  5526. Visualize information exported by some codecs.
  5527. Some codecs can export information through frames using side-data or other
  5528. means. For example, some MPEG based codecs export motion vectors through the
  5529. @var{export_mvs} flag in the codec @option{flags2} option.
  5530. The filter accepts the following option:
  5531. @table @option
  5532. @item mv
  5533. Set motion vectors to visualize.
  5534. Available flags for @var{mv} are:
  5535. @table @samp
  5536. @item pf
  5537. forward predicted MVs of P-frames
  5538. @item bf
  5539. forward predicted MVs of B-frames
  5540. @item bb
  5541. backward predicted MVs of B-frames
  5542. @end table
  5543. @item qp
  5544. Display quantization parameters using the chroma planes.
  5545. @item mv_type, mvt
  5546. Set motion vectors type to visualize. Includes MVs from all frames unless specified by @var{frame_type} option.
  5547. Available flags for @var{mv_type} are:
  5548. @table @samp
  5549. @item fp
  5550. forward predicted MVs
  5551. @item bp
  5552. backward predicted MVs
  5553. @end table
  5554. @item frame_type, ft
  5555. Set frame type to visualize motion vectors of.
  5556. Available flags for @var{frame_type} are:
  5557. @table @samp
  5558. @item if
  5559. intra-coded frames (I-frames)
  5560. @item pf
  5561. predicted frames (P-frames)
  5562. @item bf
  5563. bi-directionally predicted frames (B-frames)
  5564. @end table
  5565. @end table
  5566. @subsection Examples
  5567. @itemize
  5568. @item
  5569. Visualize forward predicted MVs of all frames using @command{ffplay}:
  5570. @example
  5571. ffplay -flags2 +export_mvs input.mp4 -vf codecview=mv_type=fp
  5572. @end example
  5573. @item
  5574. Visualize multi-directionals MVs of P and B-Frames using @command{ffplay}:
  5575. @example
  5576. ffplay -flags2 +export_mvs input.mp4 -vf codecview=mv=pf+bf+bb
  5577. @end example
  5578. @end itemize
  5579. @section colorbalance
  5580. Modify intensity of primary colors (red, green and blue) of input frames.
  5581. The filter allows an input frame to be adjusted in the shadows, midtones or highlights
  5582. regions for the red-cyan, green-magenta or blue-yellow balance.
  5583. A positive adjustment value shifts the balance towards the primary color, a negative
  5584. value towards the complementary color.
  5585. The filter accepts the following options:
  5586. @table @option
  5587. @item rs
  5588. @item gs
  5589. @item bs
  5590. Adjust red, green and blue shadows (darkest pixels).
  5591. @item rm
  5592. @item gm
  5593. @item bm
  5594. Adjust red, green and blue midtones (medium pixels).
  5595. @item rh
  5596. @item gh
  5597. @item bh
  5598. Adjust red, green and blue highlights (brightest pixels).
  5599. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[-1.0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{0}.
  5600. @item pl
  5601. Preserve lightness when changing color balance. Default is disabled.
  5602. @end table
  5603. @subsection Examples
  5604. @itemize
  5605. @item
  5606. Add red color cast to shadows:
  5607. @example
  5608. colorbalance=rs=.3
  5609. @end example
  5610. @end itemize
  5611. @subsection Commands
  5612. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  5613. @section colorchannelmixer
  5614. Adjust video input frames by re-mixing color channels.
  5615. This filter modifies a color channel by adding the values associated to
  5616. the other channels of the same pixels. For example if the value to
  5617. modify is red, the output value will be:
  5618. @example
  5619. @var{red}=@var{red}*@var{rr} + @var{blue}*@var{rb} + @var{green}*@var{rg} + @var{alpha}*@var{ra}
  5620. @end example
  5621. The filter accepts the following options:
  5622. @table @option
  5623. @item rr
  5624. @item rg
  5625. @item rb
  5626. @item ra
  5627. Adjust contribution of input red, green, blue and alpha channels for output red channel.
  5628. Default is @code{1} for @var{rr}, and @code{0} for @var{rg}, @var{rb} and @var{ra}.
  5629. @item gr
  5630. @item gg
  5631. @item gb
  5632. @item ga
  5633. Adjust contribution of input red, green, blue and alpha channels for output green channel.
  5634. Default is @code{1} for @var{gg}, and @code{0} for @var{gr}, @var{gb} and @var{ga}.
  5635. @item br
  5636. @item bg
  5637. @item bb
  5638. @item ba
  5639. Adjust contribution of input red, green, blue and alpha channels for output blue channel.
  5640. Default is @code{1} for @var{bb}, and @code{0} for @var{br}, @var{bg} and @var{ba}.
  5641. @item ar
  5642. @item ag
  5643. @item ab
  5644. @item aa
  5645. Adjust contribution of input red, green, blue and alpha channels for output alpha channel.
  5646. Default is @code{1} for @var{aa}, and @code{0} for @var{ar}, @var{ag} and @var{ab}.
  5647. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[-2.0, 2.0]}.
  5648. @end table
  5649. @subsection Examples
  5650. @itemize
  5651. @item
  5652. Convert source to grayscale:
  5653. @example
  5654. colorchannelmixer=.3:.4:.3:0:.3:.4:.3:0:.3:.4:.3
  5655. @end example
  5656. @item
  5657. Simulate sepia tones:
  5658. @example
  5659. colorchannelmixer=.393:.769:.189:0:.349:.686:.168:0:.272:.534:.131
  5660. @end example
  5661. @end itemize
  5662. @subsection Commands
  5663. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  5664. @section colorkey
  5665. RGB colorspace color keying.
  5666. The filter accepts the following options:
  5667. @table @option
  5668. @item color
  5669. The color which will be replaced with transparency.
  5670. @item similarity
  5671. Similarity percentage with the key color.
  5672. 0.01 matches only the exact key color, while 1.0 matches everything.
  5673. @item blend
  5674. Blend percentage.
  5675. 0.0 makes pixels either fully transparent, or not transparent at all.
  5676. Higher values result in semi-transparent pixels, with a higher transparency
  5677. the more similar the pixels color is to the key color.
  5678. @end table
  5679. @subsection Examples
  5680. @itemize
  5681. @item
  5682. Make every green pixel in the input image transparent:
  5683. @example
  5684. ffmpeg -i input.png -vf colorkey=green out.png
  5685. @end example
  5686. @item
  5687. Overlay a greenscreen-video on top of a static background image.
  5688. @example
  5689. ffmpeg -i background.png -i video.mp4 -filter_complex "[1:v]colorkey=0x3BBD1E:0.3:0.2[ckout];[0:v][ckout]overlay[out]" -map "[out]" output.flv
  5690. @end example
  5691. @end itemize
  5692. @subsection Commands
  5693. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options.
  5694. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  5695. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  5696. value.
  5697. @section colorhold
  5698. Remove all color information for all RGB colors except for certain one.
  5699. The filter accepts the following options:
  5700. @table @option
  5701. @item color
  5702. The color which will not be replaced with neutral gray.
  5703. @item similarity
  5704. Similarity percentage with the above color.
  5705. 0.01 matches only the exact key color, while 1.0 matches everything.
  5706. @item blend
  5707. Blend percentage. 0.0 makes pixels fully gray.
  5708. Higher values result in more preserved color.
  5709. @end table
  5710. @subsection Commands
  5711. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options.
  5712. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  5713. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  5714. value.
  5715. @section colorlevels
  5716. Adjust video input frames using levels.
  5717. The filter accepts the following options:
  5718. @table @option
  5719. @item rimin
  5720. @item gimin
  5721. @item bimin
  5722. @item aimin
  5723. Adjust red, green, blue and alpha input black point.
  5724. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[-1.0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{0}.
  5725. @item rimax
  5726. @item gimax
  5727. @item bimax
  5728. @item aimax
  5729. Adjust red, green, blue and alpha input white point.
  5730. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[-1.0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{1}.
  5731. Input levels are used to lighten highlights (bright tones), darken shadows
  5732. (dark tones), change the balance of bright and dark tones.
  5733. @item romin
  5734. @item gomin
  5735. @item bomin
  5736. @item aomin
  5737. Adjust red, green, blue and alpha output black point.
  5738. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{0}.
  5739. @item romax
  5740. @item gomax
  5741. @item bomax
  5742. @item aomax
  5743. Adjust red, green, blue and alpha output white point.
  5744. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{1}.
  5745. Output levels allows manual selection of a constrained output level range.
  5746. @end table
  5747. @subsection Examples
  5748. @itemize
  5749. @item
  5750. Make video output darker:
  5751. @example
  5752. colorlevels=rimin=0.058:gimin=0.058:bimin=0.058
  5753. @end example
  5754. @item
  5755. Increase contrast:
  5756. @example
  5757. colorlevels=rimin=0.039:gimin=0.039:bimin=0.039:rimax=0.96:gimax=0.96:bimax=0.96
  5758. @end example
  5759. @item
  5760. Make video output lighter:
  5761. @example
  5762. colorlevels=rimax=0.902:gimax=0.902:bimax=0.902
  5763. @end example
  5764. @item
  5765. Increase brightness:
  5766. @example
  5767. colorlevels=romin=0.5:gomin=0.5:bomin=0.5
  5768. @end example
  5769. @end itemize
  5770. @subsection Commands
  5771. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  5772. @section colormatrix
  5773. Convert color matrix.
  5774. The filter accepts the following options:
  5775. @table @option
  5776. @item src
  5777. @item dst
  5778. Specify the source and destination color matrix. Both values must be
  5779. specified.
  5780. The accepted values are:
  5781. @table @samp
  5782. @item bt709
  5783. BT.709
  5784. @item fcc
  5785. FCC
  5786. @item bt601
  5787. BT.601
  5788. @item bt470
  5789. BT.470
  5790. @item bt470bg
  5791. BT.470BG
  5792. @item smpte170m
  5793. SMPTE-170M
  5794. @item smpte240m
  5795. SMPTE-240M
  5796. @item bt2020
  5797. BT.2020
  5798. @end table
  5799. @end table
  5800. For example to convert from BT.601 to SMPTE-240M, use the command:
  5801. @example
  5802. colormatrix=bt601:smpte240m
  5803. @end example
  5804. @section colorspace
  5805. Convert colorspace, transfer characteristics or color primaries.
  5806. Input video needs to have an even size.
  5807. The filter accepts the following options:
  5808. @table @option
  5809. @anchor{all}
  5810. @item all
  5811. Specify all color properties at once.
  5812. The accepted values are:
  5813. @table @samp
  5814. @item bt470m
  5815. BT.470M
  5816. @item bt470bg
  5817. BT.470BG
  5818. @item bt601-6-525
  5819. BT.601-6 525
  5820. @item bt601-6-625
  5821. BT.601-6 625
  5822. @item bt709
  5823. BT.709
  5824. @item smpte170m
  5825. SMPTE-170M
  5826. @item smpte240m
  5827. SMPTE-240M
  5828. @item bt2020
  5829. BT.2020
  5830. @end table
  5831. @anchor{space}
  5832. @item space
  5833. Specify output colorspace.
  5834. The accepted values are:
  5835. @table @samp
  5836. @item bt709
  5837. BT.709
  5838. @item fcc
  5839. FCC
  5840. @item bt470bg
  5841. BT.470BG or BT.601-6 625
  5842. @item smpte170m
  5843. SMPTE-170M or BT.601-6 525
  5844. @item smpte240m
  5845. SMPTE-240M
  5846. @item ycgco
  5847. YCgCo
  5848. @item bt2020ncl
  5849. BT.2020 with non-constant luminance
  5850. @end table
  5851. @anchor{trc}
  5852. @item trc
  5853. Specify output transfer characteristics.
  5854. The accepted values are:
  5855. @table @samp
  5856. @item bt709
  5857. BT.709
  5858. @item bt470m
  5859. BT.470M
  5860. @item bt470bg
  5861. BT.470BG
  5862. @item gamma22
  5863. Constant gamma of 2.2
  5864. @item gamma28
  5865. Constant gamma of 2.8
  5866. @item smpte170m
  5867. SMPTE-170M, BT.601-6 625 or BT.601-6 525
  5868. @item smpte240m
  5869. SMPTE-240M
  5870. @item srgb
  5871. SRGB
  5872. @item iec61966-2-1
  5873. iec61966-2-1
  5874. @item iec61966-2-4
  5875. iec61966-2-4
  5876. @item xvycc
  5877. xvycc
  5878. @item bt2020-10
  5879. BT.2020 for 10-bits content
  5880. @item bt2020-12
  5881. BT.2020 for 12-bits content
  5882. @end table
  5883. @anchor{primaries}
  5884. @item primaries
  5885. Specify output color primaries.
  5886. The accepted values are:
  5887. @table @samp
  5888. @item bt709
  5889. BT.709
  5890. @item bt470m
  5891. BT.470M
  5892. @item bt470bg
  5893. BT.470BG or BT.601-6 625
  5894. @item smpte170m
  5895. SMPTE-170M or BT.601-6 525
  5896. @item smpte240m
  5897. SMPTE-240M
  5898. @item film
  5899. film
  5900. @item smpte431
  5901. SMPTE-431
  5902. @item smpte432
  5903. SMPTE-432
  5904. @item bt2020
  5905. BT.2020
  5906. @item jedec-p22
  5907. JEDEC P22 phosphors
  5908. @end table
  5909. @anchor{range}
  5910. @item range
  5911. Specify output color range.
  5912. The accepted values are:
  5913. @table @samp
  5914. @item tv
  5915. TV (restricted) range
  5916. @item mpeg
  5917. MPEG (restricted) range
  5918. @item pc
  5919. PC (full) range
  5920. @item jpeg
  5921. JPEG (full) range
  5922. @end table
  5923. @item format
  5924. Specify output color format.
  5925. The accepted values are:
  5926. @table @samp
  5927. @item yuv420p
  5928. YUV 4:2:0 planar 8-bits
  5929. @item yuv420p10
  5930. YUV 4:2:0 planar 10-bits
  5931. @item yuv420p12
  5932. YUV 4:2:0 planar 12-bits
  5933. @item yuv422p
  5934. YUV 4:2:2 planar 8-bits
  5935. @item yuv422p10
  5936. YUV 4:2:2 planar 10-bits
  5937. @item yuv422p12
  5938. YUV 4:2:2 planar 12-bits
  5939. @item yuv444p
  5940. YUV 4:4:4 planar 8-bits
  5941. @item yuv444p10
  5942. YUV 4:4:4 planar 10-bits
  5943. @item yuv444p12
  5944. YUV 4:4:4 planar 12-bits
  5945. @end table
  5946. @item fast
  5947. Do a fast conversion, which skips gamma/primary correction. This will take
  5948. significantly less CPU, but will be mathematically incorrect. To get output
  5949. compatible with that produced by the colormatrix filter, use fast=1.
  5950. @item dither
  5951. Specify dithering mode.
  5952. The accepted values are:
  5953. @table @samp
  5954. @item none
  5955. No dithering
  5956. @item fsb
  5957. Floyd-Steinberg dithering
  5958. @end table
  5959. @item wpadapt
  5960. Whitepoint adaptation mode.
  5961. The accepted values are:
  5962. @table @samp
  5963. @item bradford
  5964. Bradford whitepoint adaptation
  5965. @item vonkries
  5966. von Kries whitepoint adaptation
  5967. @item identity
  5968. identity whitepoint adaptation (i.e. no whitepoint adaptation)
  5969. @end table
  5970. @item iall
  5971. Override all input properties at once. Same accepted values as @ref{all}.
  5972. @item ispace
  5973. Override input colorspace. Same accepted values as @ref{space}.
  5974. @item iprimaries
  5975. Override input color primaries. Same accepted values as @ref{primaries}.
  5976. @item itrc
  5977. Override input transfer characteristics. Same accepted values as @ref{trc}.
  5978. @item irange
  5979. Override input color range. Same accepted values as @ref{range}.
  5980. @end table
  5981. The filter converts the transfer characteristics, color space and color
  5982. primaries to the specified user values. The output value, if not specified,
  5983. is set to a default value based on the "all" property. If that property is
  5984. also not specified, the filter will log an error. The output color range and
  5985. format default to the same value as the input color range and format. The
  5986. input transfer characteristics, color space, color primaries and color range
  5987. should be set on the input data. If any of these are missing, the filter will
  5988. log an error and no conversion will take place.
  5989. For example to convert the input to SMPTE-240M, use the command:
  5990. @example
  5991. colorspace=smpte240m
  5992. @end example
  5993. @section convolution
  5994. Apply convolution of 3x3, 5x5, 7x7 or horizontal/vertical up to 49 elements.
  5995. The filter accepts the following options:
  5996. @table @option
  5997. @item 0m
  5998. @item 1m
  5999. @item 2m
  6000. @item 3m
  6001. Set matrix for each plane.
  6002. Matrix is sequence of 9, 25 or 49 signed integers in @var{square} mode,
  6003. and from 1 to 49 odd number of signed integers in @var{row} mode.
  6004. @item 0rdiv
  6005. @item 1rdiv
  6006. @item 2rdiv
  6007. @item 3rdiv
  6008. Set multiplier for calculated value for each plane.
  6009. If unset or 0, it will be sum of all matrix elements.
  6010. @item 0bias
  6011. @item 1bias
  6012. @item 2bias
  6013. @item 3bias
  6014. Set bias for each plane. This value is added to the result of the multiplication.
  6015. Useful for making the overall image brighter or darker. Default is 0.0.
  6016. @item 0mode
  6017. @item 1mode
  6018. @item 2mode
  6019. @item 3mode
  6020. Set matrix mode for each plane. Can be @var{square}, @var{row} or @var{column}.
  6021. Default is @var{square}.
  6022. @end table
  6023. @subsection Examples
  6024. @itemize
  6025. @item
  6026. Apply sharpen:
  6027. @example
  6028. convolution="0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0"
  6029. @end example
  6030. @item
  6031. Apply blur:
  6032. @example
  6033. convolution="1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1/9:1/9:1/9:1/9"
  6034. @end example
  6035. @item
  6036. Apply edge enhance:
  6037. @example
  6038. convolution="0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:5:1:1:1:0:128:128:128"
  6039. @end example
  6040. @item
  6041. Apply edge detect:
  6042. @example
  6043. convolution="0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:5:5:5:1:0:128:128:128"
  6044. @end example
  6045. @item
  6046. Apply laplacian edge detector which includes diagonals:
  6047. @example
  6048. convolution="1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:5:5:5:1:0:128:128:0"
  6049. @end example
  6050. @item
  6051. Apply emboss:
  6052. @example
  6053. convolution="-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2"
  6054. @end example
  6055. @end itemize
  6056. @section convolve
  6057. Apply 2D convolution of video stream in frequency domain using second stream
  6058. as impulse.
  6059. The filter accepts the following options:
  6060. @table @option
  6061. @item planes
  6062. Set which planes to process.
  6063. @item impulse
  6064. Set which impulse video frames will be processed, can be @var{first}
  6065. or @var{all}. Default is @var{all}.
  6066. @end table
  6067. The @code{convolve} filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  6068. @section copy
  6069. Copy the input video source unchanged to the output. This is mainly useful for
  6070. testing purposes.
  6071. @anchor{coreimage}
  6072. @section coreimage
  6073. Video filtering on GPU using Apple's CoreImage API on OSX.
  6074. Hardware acceleration is based on an OpenGL context. Usually, this means it is
  6075. processed by video hardware. However, software-based OpenGL implementations
  6076. exist which means there is no guarantee for hardware processing. It depends on
  6077. the respective OSX.
  6078. There are many filters and image generators provided by Apple that come with a
  6079. large variety of options. The filter has to be referenced by its name along
  6080. with its options.
  6081. The coreimage filter accepts the following options:
  6082. @table @option
  6083. @item list_filters
  6084. List all available filters and generators along with all their respective
  6085. options as well as possible minimum and maximum values along with the default
  6086. values.
  6087. @example
  6088. list_filters=true
  6089. @end example
  6090. @item filter
  6091. Specify all filters by their respective name and options.
  6092. Use @var{list_filters} to determine all valid filter names and options.
  6093. Numerical options are specified by a float value and are automatically clamped
  6094. to their respective value range. Vector and color options have to be specified
  6095. by a list of space separated float values. Character escaping has to be done.
  6096. A special option name @code{default} is available to use default options for a
  6097. filter.
  6098. It is required to specify either @code{default} or at least one of the filter options.
  6099. All omitted options are used with their default values.
  6100. The syntax of the filter string is as follows:
  6101. @example
  6102. filter=<NAME>@@<OPTION>=<VALUE>[@@<OPTION>=<VALUE>][@@...][#<NAME>@@<OPTION>=<VALUE>[@@<OPTION>=<VALUE>][@@...]][#...]
  6103. @end example
  6104. @item output_rect
  6105. Specify a rectangle where the output of the filter chain is copied into the
  6106. input image. It is given by a list of space separated float values:
  6107. @example
  6108. output_rect=x\ y\ width\ height
  6109. @end example
  6110. If not given, the output rectangle equals the dimensions of the input image.
  6111. The output rectangle is automatically cropped at the borders of the input
  6112. image. Negative values are valid for each component.
  6113. @example
  6114. output_rect=25\ 25\ 100\ 100
  6115. @end example
  6116. @end table
  6117. Several filters can be chained for successive processing without GPU-HOST
  6118. transfers allowing for fast processing of complex filter chains.
  6119. Currently, only filters with zero (generators) or exactly one (filters) input
  6120. image and one output image are supported. Also, transition filters are not yet
  6121. usable as intended.
  6122. Some filters generate output images with additional padding depending on the
  6123. respective filter kernel. The padding is automatically removed to ensure the
  6124. filter output has the same size as the input image.
  6125. For image generators, the size of the output image is determined by the
  6126. previous output image of the filter chain or the input image of the whole
  6127. filterchain, respectively. The generators do not use the pixel information of
  6128. this image to generate their output. However, the generated output is
  6129. blended onto this image, resulting in partial or complete coverage of the
  6130. output image.
  6131. The @ref{coreimagesrc} video source can be used for generating input images
  6132. which are directly fed into the filter chain. By using it, providing input
  6133. images by another video source or an input video is not required.
  6134. @subsection Examples
  6135. @itemize
  6136. @item
  6137. List all filters available:
  6138. @example
  6139. coreimage=list_filters=true
  6140. @end example
  6141. @item
  6142. Use the CIBoxBlur filter with default options to blur an image:
  6143. @example
  6144. coreimage=filter=CIBoxBlur@@default
  6145. @end example
  6146. @item
  6147. Use a filter chain with CISepiaTone at default values and CIVignetteEffect with
  6148. its center at 100x100 and a radius of 50 pixels:
  6149. @example
  6150. coreimage=filter=CIBoxBlur@@default#CIVignetteEffect@@inputCenter=100\ 100@@inputRadius=50
  6151. @end example
  6152. @item
  6153. Use nullsrc and CIQRCodeGenerator to create a QR code for the FFmpeg homepage,
  6154. given as complete and escaped command-line for Apple's standard bash shell:
  6155. @example
  6156. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i nullsrc=s=100x100,coreimage=filter=CIQRCodeGenerator@@inputMessage=https\\\\\://FFmpeg.org/@@inputCorrectionLevel=H -frames:v 1 QRCode.png
  6157. @end example
  6158. @end itemize
  6159. @section cover_rect
  6160. Cover a rectangular object
  6161. It accepts the following options:
  6162. @table @option
  6163. @item cover
  6164. Filepath of the optional cover image, needs to be in yuv420.
  6165. @item mode
  6166. Set covering mode.
  6167. It accepts the following values:
  6168. @table @samp
  6169. @item cover
  6170. cover it by the supplied image
  6171. @item blur
  6172. cover it by interpolating the surrounding pixels
  6173. @end table
  6174. Default value is @var{blur}.
  6175. @end table
  6176. @subsection Examples
  6177. @itemize
  6178. @item
  6179. Cover a rectangular object by the supplied image of a given video using @command{ffmpeg}:
  6180. @example
  6181. ffmpeg -i file.ts -vf find_rect=newref.pgm,cover_rect=cover.jpg:mode=cover new.mkv
  6182. @end example
  6183. @end itemize
  6184. @section crop
  6185. Crop the input video to given dimensions.
  6186. It accepts the following parameters:
  6187. @table @option
  6188. @item w, out_w
  6189. The width of the output video. It defaults to @code{iw}.
  6190. This expression is evaluated only once during the filter
  6191. configuration, or when the @samp{w} or @samp{out_w} command is sent.
  6192. @item h, out_h
  6193. The height of the output video. It defaults to @code{ih}.
  6194. This expression is evaluated only once during the filter
  6195. configuration, or when the @samp{h} or @samp{out_h} command is sent.
  6196. @item x
  6197. The horizontal position, in the input video, of the left edge of the output
  6198. video. It defaults to @code{(in_w-out_w)/2}.
  6199. This expression is evaluated per-frame.
  6200. @item y
  6201. The vertical position, in the input video, of the top edge of the output video.
  6202. It defaults to @code{(in_h-out_h)/2}.
  6203. This expression is evaluated per-frame.
  6204. @item keep_aspect
  6205. If set to 1 will force the output display aspect ratio
  6206. to be the same of the input, by changing the output sample aspect
  6207. ratio. It defaults to 0.
  6208. @item exact
  6209. Enable exact cropping. If enabled, subsampled videos will be cropped at exact
  6210. width/height/x/y as specified and will not be rounded to nearest smaller value.
  6211. It defaults to 0.
  6212. @end table
  6213. The @var{out_w}, @var{out_h}, @var{x}, @var{y} parameters are
  6214. expressions containing the following constants:
  6215. @table @option
  6216. @item x
  6217. @item y
  6218. The computed values for @var{x} and @var{y}. They are evaluated for
  6219. each new frame.
  6220. @item in_w
  6221. @item in_h
  6222. The input width and height.
  6223. @item iw
  6224. @item ih
  6225. These are the same as @var{in_w} and @var{in_h}.
  6226. @item out_w
  6227. @item out_h
  6228. The output (cropped) width and height.
  6229. @item ow
  6230. @item oh
  6231. These are the same as @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}.
  6232. @item a
  6233. same as @var{iw} / @var{ih}
  6234. @item sar
  6235. input sample aspect ratio
  6236. @item dar
  6237. input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{iw} / @var{ih}) * @var{sar}
  6238. @item hsub
  6239. @item vsub
  6240. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  6241. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  6242. @item n
  6243. The number of the input frame, starting from 0.
  6244. @item pos
  6245. the position in the file of the input frame, NAN if unknown
  6246. @item t
  6247. The timestamp expressed in seconds. It's NAN if the input timestamp is unknown.
  6248. @end table
  6249. The expression for @var{out_w} may depend on the value of @var{out_h},
  6250. and the expression for @var{out_h} may depend on @var{out_w}, but they
  6251. cannot depend on @var{x} and @var{y}, as @var{x} and @var{y} are
  6252. evaluated after @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}.
  6253. The @var{x} and @var{y} parameters specify the expressions for the
  6254. position of the top-left corner of the output (non-cropped) area. They
  6255. are evaluated for each frame. If the evaluated value is not valid, it
  6256. is approximated to the nearest valid value.
  6257. The expression for @var{x} may depend on @var{y}, and the expression
  6258. for @var{y} may depend on @var{x}.
  6259. @subsection Examples
  6260. @itemize
  6261. @item
  6262. Crop area with size 100x100 at position (12,34).
  6263. @example
  6264. crop=100:100:12:34
  6265. @end example
  6266. Using named options, the example above becomes:
  6267. @example
  6268. crop=w=100:h=100:x=12:y=34
  6269. @end example
  6270. @item
  6271. Crop the central input area with size 100x100:
  6272. @example
  6273. crop=100:100
  6274. @end example
  6275. @item
  6276. Crop the central input area with size 2/3 of the input video:
  6277. @example
  6278. crop=2/3*in_w:2/3*in_h
  6279. @end example
  6280. @item
  6281. Crop the input video central square:
  6282. @example
  6283. crop=out_w=in_h
  6284. crop=in_h
  6285. @end example
  6286. @item
  6287. Delimit the rectangle with the top-left corner placed at position
  6288. 100:100 and the right-bottom corner corresponding to the right-bottom
  6289. corner of the input image.
  6290. @example
  6291. crop=in_w-100:in_h-100:100:100
  6292. @end example
  6293. @item
  6294. Crop 10 pixels from the left and right borders, and 20 pixels from
  6295. the top and bottom borders
  6296. @example
  6297. crop=in_w-2*10:in_h-2*20
  6298. @end example
  6299. @item
  6300. Keep only the bottom right quarter of the input image:
  6301. @example
  6302. crop=in_w/2:in_h/2:in_w/2:in_h/2
  6303. @end example
  6304. @item
  6305. Crop height for getting Greek harmony:
  6306. @example
  6307. crop=in_w:1/PHI*in_w
  6308. @end example
  6309. @item
  6310. Apply trembling effect:
  6311. @example
  6312. crop=in_w/2:in_h/2:(in_w-out_w)/2+((in_w-out_w)/2)*sin(n/10):(in_h-out_h)/2 +((in_h-out_h)/2)*sin(n/7)
  6313. @end example
  6314. @item
  6315. Apply erratic camera effect depending on timestamp:
  6316. @example
  6317. crop=in_w/2:in_h/2:(in_w-out_w)/2+((in_w-out_w)/2)*sin(t*10):(in_h-out_h)/2 +((in_h-out_h)/2)*sin(t*13)"
  6318. @end example
  6319. @item
  6320. Set x depending on the value of y:
  6321. @example
  6322. crop=in_w/2:in_h/2:y:10+10*sin(n/10)
  6323. @end example
  6324. @end itemize
  6325. @subsection Commands
  6326. This filter supports the following commands:
  6327. @table @option
  6328. @item w, out_w
  6329. @item h, out_h
  6330. @item x
  6331. @item y
  6332. Set width/height of the output video and the horizontal/vertical position
  6333. in the input video.
  6334. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  6335. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  6336. value.
  6337. @end table
  6338. @section cropdetect
  6339. Auto-detect the crop size.
  6340. It calculates the necessary cropping parameters and prints the
  6341. recommended parameters via the logging system. The detected dimensions
  6342. correspond to the non-black area of the input video.
  6343. It accepts the following parameters:
  6344. @table @option
  6345. @item limit
  6346. Set higher black value threshold, which can be optionally specified
  6347. from nothing (0) to everything (255 for 8-bit based formats). An intensity
  6348. value greater to the set value is considered non-black. It defaults to 24.
  6349. You can also specify a value between 0.0 and 1.0 which will be scaled depending
  6350. on the bitdepth of the pixel format.
  6351. @item round
  6352. The value which the width/height should be divisible by. It defaults to
  6353. 16. The offset is automatically adjusted to center the video. Use 2 to
  6354. get only even dimensions (needed for 4:2:2 video). 16 is best when
  6355. encoding to most video codecs.
  6356. @item reset_count, reset
  6357. Set the counter that determines after how many frames cropdetect will
  6358. reset the previously detected largest video area and start over to
  6359. detect the current optimal crop area. Default value is 0.
  6360. This can be useful when channel logos distort the video area. 0
  6361. indicates 'never reset', and returns the largest area encountered during
  6362. playback.
  6363. @end table
  6364. @anchor{cue}
  6365. @section cue
  6366. Delay video filtering until a given wallclock timestamp. The filter first
  6367. passes on @option{preroll} amount of frames, then it buffers at most
  6368. @option{buffer} amount of frames and waits for the cue. After reaching the cue
  6369. it forwards the buffered frames and also any subsequent frames coming in its
  6370. input.
  6371. The filter can be used synchronize the output of multiple ffmpeg processes for
  6372. realtime output devices like decklink. By putting the delay in the filtering
  6373. chain and pre-buffering frames the process can pass on data to output almost
  6374. immediately after the target wallclock timestamp is reached.
  6375. Perfect frame accuracy cannot be guaranteed, but the result is good enough for
  6376. some use cases.
  6377. @table @option
  6378. @item cue
  6379. The cue timestamp expressed in a UNIX timestamp in microseconds. Default is 0.
  6380. @item preroll
  6381. The duration of content to pass on as preroll expressed in seconds. Default is 0.
  6382. @item buffer
  6383. The maximum duration of content to buffer before waiting for the cue expressed
  6384. in seconds. Default is 0.
  6385. @end table
  6386. @anchor{curves}
  6387. @section curves
  6388. Apply color adjustments using curves.
  6389. This filter is similar to the Adobe Photoshop and GIMP curves tools. Each
  6390. component (red, green and blue) has its values defined by @var{N} key points
  6391. tied from each other using a smooth curve. The x-axis represents the pixel
  6392. values from the input frame, and the y-axis the new pixel values to be set for
  6393. the output frame.
  6394. By default, a component curve is defined by the two points @var{(0;0)} and
  6395. @var{(1;1)}. This creates a straight line where each original pixel value is
  6396. "adjusted" to its own value, which means no change to the image.
  6397. The filter allows you to redefine these two points and add some more. A new
  6398. curve (using a natural cubic spline interpolation) will be define to pass
  6399. smoothly through all these new coordinates. The new defined points needs to be
  6400. strictly increasing over the x-axis, and their @var{x} and @var{y} values must
  6401. be in the @var{[0;1]} interval. If the computed curves happened to go outside
  6402. the vector spaces, the values will be clipped accordingly.
  6403. The filter accepts the following options:
  6404. @table @option
  6405. @item preset
  6406. Select one of the available color presets. This option can be used in addition
  6407. to the @option{r}, @option{g}, @option{b} parameters; in this case, the later
  6408. options takes priority on the preset values.
  6409. Available presets are:
  6410. @table @samp
  6411. @item none
  6412. @item color_negative
  6413. @item cross_process
  6414. @item darker
  6415. @item increase_contrast
  6416. @item lighter
  6417. @item linear_contrast
  6418. @item medium_contrast
  6419. @item negative
  6420. @item strong_contrast
  6421. @item vintage
  6422. @end table
  6423. Default is @code{none}.
  6424. @item master, m
  6425. Set the master key points. These points will define a second pass mapping. It
  6426. is sometimes called a "luminance" or "value" mapping. It can be used with
  6427. @option{r}, @option{g}, @option{b} or @option{all} since it acts like a
  6428. post-processing LUT.
  6429. @item red, r
  6430. Set the key points for the red component.
  6431. @item green, g
  6432. Set the key points for the green component.
  6433. @item blue, b
  6434. Set the key points for the blue component.
  6435. @item all
  6436. Set the key points for all components (not including master).
  6437. Can be used in addition to the other key points component
  6438. options. In this case, the unset component(s) will fallback on this
  6439. @option{all} setting.
  6440. @item psfile
  6441. Specify a Photoshop curves file (@code{.acv}) to import the settings from.
  6442. @item plot
  6443. Save Gnuplot script of the curves in specified file.
  6444. @end table
  6445. To avoid some filtergraph syntax conflicts, each key points list need to be
  6446. defined using the following syntax: @code{x0/y0 x1/y1 x2/y2 ...}.
  6447. @subsection Examples
  6448. @itemize
  6449. @item
  6450. Increase slightly the middle level of blue:
  6451. @example
  6452. curves=blue='0/0 0.5/0.58 1/1'
  6453. @end example
  6454. @item
  6455. Vintage effect:
  6456. @example
  6457. curves=r='0/0.11 .42/.51 1/0.95':g='0/0 0.50/0.48 1/1':b='0/0.22 .49/.44 1/0.8'
  6458. @end example
  6459. Here we obtain the following coordinates for each components:
  6460. @table @var
  6461. @item red
  6462. @code{(0;0.11) (0.42;0.51) (1;0.95)}
  6463. @item green
  6464. @code{(0;0) (0.50;0.48) (1;1)}
  6465. @item blue
  6466. @code{(0;0.22) (0.49;0.44) (1;0.80)}
  6467. @end table
  6468. @item
  6469. The previous example can also be achieved with the associated built-in preset:
  6470. @example
  6471. curves=preset=vintage
  6472. @end example
  6473. @item
  6474. Or simply:
  6475. @example
  6476. curves=vintage
  6477. @end example
  6478. @item
  6479. Use a Photoshop preset and redefine the points of the green component:
  6480. @example
  6481. curves=psfile='MyCurvesPresets/purple.acv':green='0/0 0.45/0.53 1/1'
  6482. @end example
  6483. @item
  6484. Check out the curves of the @code{cross_process} profile using @command{ffmpeg}
  6485. and @command{gnuplot}:
  6486. @example
  6487. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i color -vf curves=cross_process:plot=/tmp/curves.plt -frames:v 1 -f null -
  6488. gnuplot -p /tmp/curves.plt
  6489. @end example
  6490. @end itemize
  6491. @section datascope
  6492. Video data analysis filter.
  6493. This filter shows hexadecimal pixel values of part of video.
  6494. The filter accepts the following options:
  6495. @table @option
  6496. @item size, s
  6497. Set output video size.
  6498. @item x
  6499. Set x offset from where to pick pixels.
  6500. @item y
  6501. Set y offset from where to pick pixels.
  6502. @item mode
  6503. Set scope mode, can be one of the following:
  6504. @table @samp
  6505. @item mono
  6506. Draw hexadecimal pixel values with white color on black background.
  6507. @item color
  6508. Draw hexadecimal pixel values with input video pixel color on black
  6509. background.
  6510. @item color2
  6511. Draw hexadecimal pixel values on color background picked from input video,
  6512. the text color is picked in such way so its always visible.
  6513. @end table
  6514. @item axis
  6515. Draw rows and columns numbers on left and top of video.
  6516. @item opacity
  6517. Set background opacity.
  6518. @item format
  6519. Set display number format. Can be @code{hex}, or @code{dec}. Default is @code{hex}.
  6520. @end table
  6521. @section dctdnoiz
  6522. Denoise frames using 2D DCT (frequency domain filtering).
  6523. This filter is not designed for real time.
  6524. The filter accepts the following options:
  6525. @table @option
  6526. @item sigma, s
  6527. Set the noise sigma constant.
  6528. This @var{sigma} defines a hard threshold of @code{3 * sigma}; every DCT
  6529. coefficient (absolute value) below this threshold with be dropped.
  6530. If you need a more advanced filtering, see @option{expr}.
  6531. Default is @code{0}.
  6532. @item overlap
  6533. Set number overlapping pixels for each block. Since the filter can be slow, you
  6534. may want to reduce this value, at the cost of a less effective filter and the
  6535. risk of various artefacts.
  6536. If the overlapping value doesn't permit processing the whole input width or
  6537. height, a warning will be displayed and according borders won't be denoised.
  6538. Default value is @var{blocksize}-1, which is the best possible setting.
  6539. @item expr, e
  6540. Set the coefficient factor expression.
  6541. For each coefficient of a DCT block, this expression will be evaluated as a
  6542. multiplier value for the coefficient.
  6543. If this is option is set, the @option{sigma} option will be ignored.
  6544. The absolute value of the coefficient can be accessed through the @var{c}
  6545. variable.
  6546. @item n
  6547. Set the @var{blocksize} using the number of bits. @code{1<<@var{n}} defines the
  6548. @var{blocksize}, which is the width and height of the processed blocks.
  6549. The default value is @var{3} (8x8) and can be raised to @var{4} for a
  6550. @var{blocksize} of 16x16. Note that changing this setting has huge consequences
  6551. on the speed processing. Also, a larger block size does not necessarily means a
  6552. better de-noising.
  6553. @end table
  6554. @subsection Examples
  6555. Apply a denoise with a @option{sigma} of @code{4.5}:
  6556. @example
  6557. dctdnoiz=4.5
  6558. @end example
  6559. The same operation can be achieved using the expression system:
  6560. @example
  6561. dctdnoiz=e='gte(c, 4.5*3)'
  6562. @end example
  6563. Violent denoise using a block size of @code{16x16}:
  6564. @example
  6565. dctdnoiz=15:n=4
  6566. @end example
  6567. @section deband
  6568. Remove banding artifacts from input video.
  6569. It works by replacing banded pixels with average value of referenced pixels.
  6570. The filter accepts the following options:
  6571. @table @option
  6572. @item 1thr
  6573. @item 2thr
  6574. @item 3thr
  6575. @item 4thr
  6576. Set banding detection threshold for each plane. Default is 0.02.
  6577. Valid range is 0.00003 to 0.5.
  6578. If difference between current pixel and reference pixel is less than threshold,
  6579. it will be considered as banded.
  6580. @item range, r
  6581. Banding detection range in pixels. Default is 16. If positive, random number
  6582. in range 0 to set value will be used. If negative, exact absolute value
  6583. will be used.
  6584. The range defines square of four pixels around current pixel.
  6585. @item direction, d
  6586. Set direction in radians from which four pixel will be compared. If positive,
  6587. random direction from 0 to set direction will be picked. If negative, exact of
  6588. absolute value will be picked. For example direction 0, -PI or -2*PI radians
  6589. will pick only pixels on same row and -PI/2 will pick only pixels on same
  6590. column.
  6591. @item blur, b
  6592. If enabled, current pixel is compared with average value of all four
  6593. surrounding pixels. The default is enabled. If disabled current pixel is
  6594. compared with all four surrounding pixels. The pixel is considered banded
  6595. if only all four differences with surrounding pixels are less than threshold.
  6596. @item coupling, c
  6597. If enabled, current pixel is changed if and only if all pixel components are banded,
  6598. e.g. banding detection threshold is triggered for all color components.
  6599. The default is disabled.
  6600. @end table
  6601. @section deblock
  6602. Remove blocking artifacts from input video.
  6603. The filter accepts the following options:
  6604. @table @option
  6605. @item filter
  6606. Set filter type, can be @var{weak} or @var{strong}. Default is @var{strong}.
  6607. This controls what kind of deblocking is applied.
  6608. @item block
  6609. Set size of block, allowed range is from 4 to 512. Default is @var{8}.
  6610. @item alpha
  6611. @item beta
  6612. @item gamma
  6613. @item delta
  6614. Set blocking detection thresholds. Allowed range is 0 to 1.
  6615. Defaults are: @var{0.098} for @var{alpha} and @var{0.05} for the rest.
  6616. Using higher threshold gives more deblocking strength.
  6617. Setting @var{alpha} controls threshold detection at exact edge of block.
  6618. Remaining options controls threshold detection near the edge. Each one for
  6619. below/above or left/right. Setting any of those to @var{0} disables
  6620. deblocking.
  6621. @item planes
  6622. Set planes to filter. Default is to filter all available planes.
  6623. @end table
  6624. @subsection Examples
  6625. @itemize
  6626. @item
  6627. Deblock using weak filter and block size of 4 pixels.
  6628. @example
  6629. deblock=filter=weak:block=4
  6630. @end example
  6631. @item
  6632. Deblock using strong filter, block size of 4 pixels and custom thresholds for
  6633. deblocking more edges.
  6634. @example
  6635. deblock=filter=strong:block=4:alpha=0.12:beta=0.07:gamma=0.06:delta=0.05
  6636. @end example
  6637. @item
  6638. Similar as above, but filter only first plane.
  6639. @example
  6640. deblock=filter=strong:block=4:alpha=0.12:beta=0.07:gamma=0.06:delta=0.05:planes=1
  6641. @end example
  6642. @item
  6643. Similar as above, but filter only second and third plane.
  6644. @example
  6645. deblock=filter=strong:block=4:alpha=0.12:beta=0.07:gamma=0.06:delta=0.05:planes=6
  6646. @end example
  6647. @end itemize
  6648. @anchor{decimate}
  6649. @section decimate
  6650. Drop duplicated frames at regular intervals.
  6651. The filter accepts the following options:
  6652. @table @option
  6653. @item cycle
  6654. Set the number of frames from which one will be dropped. Setting this to
  6655. @var{N} means one frame in every batch of @var{N} frames will be dropped.
  6656. Default is @code{5}.
  6657. @item dupthresh
  6658. Set the threshold for duplicate detection. If the difference metric for a frame
  6659. is less than or equal to this value, then it is declared as duplicate. Default
  6660. is @code{1.1}
  6661. @item scthresh
  6662. Set scene change threshold. Default is @code{15}.
  6663. @item blockx
  6664. @item blocky
  6665. Set the size of the x and y-axis blocks used during metric calculations.
  6666. Larger blocks give better noise suppression, but also give worse detection of
  6667. small movements. Must be a power of two. Default is @code{32}.
  6668. @item ppsrc
  6669. Mark main input as a pre-processed input and activate clean source input
  6670. stream. This allows the input to be pre-processed with various filters to help
  6671. the metrics calculation while keeping the frame selection lossless. When set to
  6672. @code{1}, the first stream is for the pre-processed input, and the second
  6673. stream is the clean source from where the kept frames are chosen. Default is
  6674. @code{0}.
  6675. @item chroma
  6676. Set whether or not chroma is considered in the metric calculations. Default is
  6677. @code{1}.
  6678. @end table
  6679. @section deconvolve
  6680. Apply 2D deconvolution of video stream in frequency domain using second stream
  6681. as impulse.
  6682. The filter accepts the following options:
  6683. @table @option
  6684. @item planes
  6685. Set which planes to process.
  6686. @item impulse
  6687. Set which impulse video frames will be processed, can be @var{first}
  6688. or @var{all}. Default is @var{all}.
  6689. @item noise
  6690. Set noise when doing divisions. Default is @var{0.0000001}. Useful when width
  6691. and height are not same and not power of 2 or if stream prior to convolving
  6692. had noise.
  6693. @end table
  6694. The @code{deconvolve} filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  6695. @section dedot
  6696. Reduce cross-luminance (dot-crawl) and cross-color (rainbows) from video.
  6697. It accepts the following options:
  6698. @table @option
  6699. @item m
  6700. Set mode of operation. Can be combination of @var{dotcrawl} for cross-luminance reduction and/or
  6701. @var{rainbows} for cross-color reduction.
  6702. @item lt
  6703. Set spatial luma threshold. Lower values increases reduction of cross-luminance.
  6704. @item tl
  6705. Set tolerance for temporal luma. Higher values increases reduction of cross-luminance.
  6706. @item tc
  6707. Set tolerance for chroma temporal variation. Higher values increases reduction of cross-color.
  6708. @item ct
  6709. Set temporal chroma threshold. Lower values increases reduction of cross-color.
  6710. @end table
  6711. @section deflate
  6712. Apply deflate effect to the video.
  6713. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) average by taking into account
  6714. only values lower than the pixel.
  6715. It accepts the following options:
  6716. @table @option
  6717. @item threshold0
  6718. @item threshold1
  6719. @item threshold2
  6720. @item threshold3
  6721. Limit the maximum change for each plane, default is 65535.
  6722. If 0, plane will remain unchanged.
  6723. @end table
  6724. @subsection Commands
  6725. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  6726. @section deflicker
  6727. Remove temporal frame luminance variations.
  6728. It accepts the following options:
  6729. @table @option
  6730. @item size, s
  6731. Set moving-average filter size in frames. Default is 5. Allowed range is 2 - 129.
  6732. @item mode, m
  6733. Set averaging mode to smooth temporal luminance variations.
  6734. Available values are:
  6735. @table @samp
  6736. @item am
  6737. Arithmetic mean
  6738. @item gm
  6739. Geometric mean
  6740. @item hm
  6741. Harmonic mean
  6742. @item qm
  6743. Quadratic mean
  6744. @item cm
  6745. Cubic mean
  6746. @item pm
  6747. Power mean
  6748. @item median
  6749. Median
  6750. @end table
  6751. @item bypass
  6752. Do not actually modify frame. Useful when one only wants metadata.
  6753. @end table
  6754. @section dejudder
  6755. Remove judder produced by partially interlaced telecined content.
  6756. Judder can be introduced, for instance, by @ref{pullup} filter. If the original
  6757. source was partially telecined content then the output of @code{pullup,dejudder}
  6758. will have a variable frame rate. May change the recorded frame rate of the
  6759. container. Aside from that change, this filter will not affect constant frame
  6760. rate video.
  6761. The option available in this filter is:
  6762. @table @option
  6763. @item cycle
  6764. Specify the length of the window over which the judder repeats.
  6765. Accepts any integer greater than 1. Useful values are:
  6766. @table @samp
  6767. @item 4
  6768. If the original was telecined from 24 to 30 fps (Film to NTSC).
  6769. @item 5
  6770. If the original was telecined from 25 to 30 fps (PAL to NTSC).
  6771. @item 20
  6772. If a mixture of the two.
  6773. @end table
  6774. The default is @samp{4}.
  6775. @end table
  6776. @section delogo
  6777. Suppress a TV station logo by a simple interpolation of the surrounding
  6778. pixels. Just set a rectangle covering the logo and watch it disappear
  6779. (and sometimes something even uglier appear - your mileage may vary).
  6780. It accepts the following parameters:
  6781. @table @option
  6782. @item x
  6783. @item y
  6784. Specify the top left corner coordinates of the logo. They must be
  6785. specified.
  6786. @item w
  6787. @item h
  6788. Specify the width and height of the logo to clear. They must be
  6789. specified.
  6790. @item band, t
  6791. Specify the thickness of the fuzzy edge of the rectangle (added to
  6792. @var{w} and @var{h}). The default value is 1. This option is
  6793. deprecated, setting higher values should no longer be necessary and
  6794. is not recommended.
  6795. @item show
  6796. When set to 1, a green rectangle is drawn on the screen to simplify
  6797. finding the right @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w}, and @var{h} parameters.
  6798. The default value is 0.
  6799. The rectangle is drawn on the outermost pixels which will be (partly)
  6800. replaced with interpolated values. The values of the next pixels
  6801. immediately outside this rectangle in each direction will be used to
  6802. compute the interpolated pixel values inside the rectangle.
  6803. @end table
  6804. @subsection Examples
  6805. @itemize
  6806. @item
  6807. Set a rectangle covering the area with top left corner coordinates 0,0
  6808. and size 100x77, and a band of size 10:
  6809. @example
  6810. delogo=x=0:y=0:w=100:h=77:band=10
  6811. @end example
  6812. @end itemize
  6813. @section derain
  6814. Remove the rain in the input image/video by applying the derain methods based on
  6815. convolutional neural networks. Supported models:
  6816. @itemize
  6817. @item
  6818. Recurrent Squeeze-and-Excitation Context Aggregation Net (RESCAN).
  6819. See @url{http://openaccess.thecvf.com/content_ECCV_2018/papers/Xia_Li_Recurrent_Squeeze-and-Excitation_Context_ECCV_2018_paper.pdf}.
  6820. @end itemize
  6821. Training as well as model generation scripts are provided in
  6822. the repository at @url{https://github.com/XueweiMeng/derain_filter.git}.
  6823. Native model files (.model) can be generated from TensorFlow model
  6824. files (.pb) by using tools/python/convert.py
  6825. The filter accepts the following options:
  6826. @table @option
  6827. @item filter_type
  6828. Specify which filter to use. This option accepts the following values:
  6829. @table @samp
  6830. @item derain
  6831. Derain filter. To conduct derain filter, you need to use a derain model.
  6832. @item dehaze
  6833. Dehaze filter. To conduct dehaze filter, you need to use a dehaze model.
  6834. @end table
  6835. Default value is @samp{derain}.
  6836. @item dnn_backend
  6837. Specify which DNN backend to use for model loading and execution. This option accepts
  6838. the following values:
  6839. @table @samp
  6840. @item native
  6841. Native implementation of DNN loading and execution.
  6842. @item tensorflow
  6843. TensorFlow backend. To enable this backend you
  6844. need to install the TensorFlow for C library (see
  6845. @url{https://www.tensorflow.org/install/install_c}) and configure FFmpeg with
  6846. @code{--enable-libtensorflow}
  6847. @end table
  6848. Default value is @samp{native}.
  6849. @item model
  6850. Set path to model file specifying network architecture and its parameters.
  6851. Note that different backends use different file formats. TensorFlow and native
  6852. backend can load files for only its format.
  6853. @end table
  6854. @section deshake
  6855. Attempt to fix small changes in horizontal and/or vertical shift. This
  6856. filter helps remove camera shake from hand-holding a camera, bumping a
  6857. tripod, moving on a vehicle, etc.
  6858. The filter accepts the following options:
  6859. @table @option
  6860. @item x
  6861. @item y
  6862. @item w
  6863. @item h
  6864. Specify a rectangular area where to limit the search for motion
  6865. vectors.
  6866. If desired the search for motion vectors can be limited to a
  6867. rectangular area of the frame defined by its top left corner, width
  6868. and height. These parameters have the same meaning as the drawbox
  6869. filter which can be used to visualise the position of the bounding
  6870. box.
  6871. This is useful when simultaneous movement of subjects within the frame
  6872. might be confused for camera motion by the motion vector search.
  6873. If any or all of @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w} and @var{h} are set to -1
  6874. then the full frame is used. This allows later options to be set
  6875. without specifying the bounding box for the motion vector search.
  6876. Default - search the whole frame.
  6877. @item rx
  6878. @item ry
  6879. Specify the maximum extent of movement in x and y directions in the
  6880. range 0-64 pixels. Default 16.
  6881. @item edge
  6882. Specify how to generate pixels to fill blanks at the edge of the
  6883. frame. Available values are:
  6884. @table @samp
  6885. @item blank, 0
  6886. Fill zeroes at blank locations
  6887. @item original, 1
  6888. Original image at blank locations
  6889. @item clamp, 2
  6890. Extruded edge value at blank locations
  6891. @item mirror, 3
  6892. Mirrored edge at blank locations
  6893. @end table
  6894. Default value is @samp{mirror}.
  6895. @item blocksize
  6896. Specify the blocksize to use for motion search. Range 4-128 pixels,
  6897. default 8.
  6898. @item contrast
  6899. Specify the contrast threshold for blocks. Only blocks with more than
  6900. the specified contrast (difference between darkest and lightest
  6901. pixels) will be considered. Range 1-255, default 125.
  6902. @item search
  6903. Specify the search strategy. Available values are:
  6904. @table @samp
  6905. @item exhaustive, 0
  6906. Set exhaustive search
  6907. @item less, 1
  6908. Set less exhaustive search.
  6909. @end table
  6910. Default value is @samp{exhaustive}.
  6911. @item filename
  6912. If set then a detailed log of the motion search is written to the
  6913. specified file.
  6914. @end table
  6915. @section despill
  6916. Remove unwanted contamination of foreground colors, caused by reflected color of
  6917. greenscreen or bluescreen.
  6918. This filter accepts the following options:
  6919. @table @option
  6920. @item type
  6921. Set what type of despill to use.
  6922. @item mix
  6923. Set how spillmap will be generated.
  6924. @item expand
  6925. Set how much to get rid of still remaining spill.
  6926. @item red
  6927. Controls amount of red in spill area.
  6928. @item green
  6929. Controls amount of green in spill area.
  6930. Should be -1 for greenscreen.
  6931. @item blue
  6932. Controls amount of blue in spill area.
  6933. Should be -1 for bluescreen.
  6934. @item brightness
  6935. Controls brightness of spill area, preserving colors.
  6936. @item alpha
  6937. Modify alpha from generated spillmap.
  6938. @end table
  6939. @section detelecine
  6940. Apply an exact inverse of the telecine operation. It requires a predefined
  6941. pattern specified using the pattern option which must be the same as that passed
  6942. to the telecine filter.
  6943. This filter accepts the following options:
  6944. @table @option
  6945. @item first_field
  6946. @table @samp
  6947. @item top, t
  6948. top field first
  6949. @item bottom, b
  6950. bottom field first
  6951. The default value is @code{top}.
  6952. @end table
  6953. @item pattern
  6954. A string of numbers representing the pulldown pattern you wish to apply.
  6955. The default value is @code{23}.
  6956. @item start_frame
  6957. A number representing position of the first frame with respect to the telecine
  6958. pattern. This is to be used if the stream is cut. The default value is @code{0}.
  6959. @end table
  6960. @section dilation
  6961. Apply dilation effect to the video.
  6962. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) maximum.
  6963. It accepts the following options:
  6964. @table @option
  6965. @item threshold0
  6966. @item threshold1
  6967. @item threshold2
  6968. @item threshold3
  6969. Limit the maximum change for each plane, default is 65535.
  6970. If 0, plane will remain unchanged.
  6971. @item coordinates
  6972. Flag which specifies the pixel to refer to. Default is 255 i.e. all eight
  6973. pixels are used.
  6974. Flags to local 3x3 coordinates maps like this:
  6975. 1 2 3
  6976. 4 5
  6977. 6 7 8
  6978. @end table
  6979. @subsection Commands
  6980. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  6981. @section displace
  6982. Displace pixels as indicated by second and third input stream.
  6983. It takes three input streams and outputs one stream, the first input is the
  6984. source, and second and third input are displacement maps.
  6985. The second input specifies how much to displace pixels along the
  6986. x-axis, while the third input specifies how much to displace pixels
  6987. along the y-axis.
  6988. If one of displacement map streams terminates, last frame from that
  6989. displacement map will be used.
  6990. Note that once generated, displacements maps can be reused over and over again.
  6991. A description of the accepted options follows.
  6992. @table @option
  6993. @item edge
  6994. Set displace behavior for pixels that are out of range.
  6995. Available values are:
  6996. @table @samp
  6997. @item blank
  6998. Missing pixels are replaced by black pixels.
  6999. @item smear
  7000. Adjacent pixels will spread out to replace missing pixels.
  7001. @item wrap
  7002. Out of range pixels are wrapped so they point to pixels of other side.
  7003. @item mirror
  7004. Out of range pixels will be replaced with mirrored pixels.
  7005. @end table
  7006. Default is @samp{smear}.
  7007. @end table
  7008. @subsection Examples
  7009. @itemize
  7010. @item
  7011. Add ripple effect to rgb input of video size hd720:
  7012. @example
  7013. ffmpeg -i INPUT -f lavfi -i nullsrc=s=hd720,lutrgb=128:128:128 -f lavfi -i nullsrc=s=hd720,geq='r=128+30*sin(2*PI*X/400+T):g=128+30*sin(2*PI*X/400+T):b=128+30*sin(2*PI*X/400+T)' -lavfi '[0][1][2]displace' OUTPUT
  7014. @end example
  7015. @item
  7016. Add wave effect to rgb input of video size hd720:
  7017. @example
  7018. ffmpeg -i INPUT -f lavfi -i nullsrc=hd720,geq='r=128+80*(sin(sqrt((X-W/2)*(X-W/2)+(Y-H/2)*(Y-H/2))/220*2*PI+T)):g=128+80*(sin(sqrt((X-W/2)*(X-W/2)+(Y-H/2)*(Y-H/2))/220*2*PI+T)):b=128+80*(sin(sqrt((X-W/2)*(X-W/2)+(Y-H/2)*(Y-H/2))/220*2*PI+T))' -lavfi '[1]split[x][y],[0][x][y]displace' OUTPUT
  7019. @end example
  7020. @end itemize
  7021. @anchor{dnn_processing}
  7022. @section dnn_processing
  7023. Do image processing with deep neural networks. It works together with another filter
  7024. which converts the pixel format of the Frame to what the dnn network requires.
  7025. The filter accepts the following options:
  7026. @table @option
  7027. @item dnn_backend
  7028. Specify which DNN backend to use for model loading and execution. This option accepts
  7029. the following values:
  7030. @table @samp
  7031. @item native
  7032. Native implementation of DNN loading and execution.
  7033. @item tensorflow
  7034. TensorFlow backend. To enable this backend you
  7035. need to install the TensorFlow for C library (see
  7036. @url{https://www.tensorflow.org/install/install_c}) and configure FFmpeg with
  7037. @code{--enable-libtensorflow}
  7038. @end table
  7039. Default value is @samp{native}.
  7040. @item model
  7041. Set path to model file specifying network architecture and its parameters.
  7042. Note that different backends use different file formats. TensorFlow and native
  7043. backend can load files for only its format.
  7044. Native model file (.model) can be generated from TensorFlow model file (.pb) by using tools/python/convert.py
  7045. @item input
  7046. Set the input name of the dnn network.
  7047. @item output
  7048. Set the output name of the dnn network.
  7049. @end table
  7050. @subsection Examples
  7051. @itemize
  7052. @item
  7053. Halve the red channle of the frame with format rgb24:
  7054. @example
  7055. ffmpeg -i input.jpg -vf format=rgb24,dnn_processing=model=halve_first_channel.model:input=dnn_in:output=dnn_out:dnn_backend=native out.native.png
  7056. @end example
  7057. @item
  7058. Halve the pixel value of the frame with format gray32f:
  7059. @example
  7060. ffmpeg -i input.jpg -vf format=grayf32,dnn_processing=model=halve_gray_float.model:input=dnn_in:output=dnn_out:dnn_backend=native -y out.native.png
  7061. @end example
  7062. @item
  7063. Handle the Y channel with srcnn.pb (see @ref{sr} filter) for frame with yuv420p (planar YUV formats supported):
  7064. @example
  7065. ./ffmpeg -i 480p.jpg -vf format=yuv420p,scale=w=iw*2:h=ih*2,dnn_processing=dnn_backend=tensorflow:model=srcnn.pb:input=x:output=y -y srcnn.jpg
  7066. @end example
  7067. @item
  7068. Handle the Y channel with espcn.pb (see @ref{sr} filter), which changes frame size, for format yuv420p (planar YUV formats supported):
  7069. @example
  7070. ./ffmpeg -i 480p.jpg -vf format=yuv420p,dnn_processing=dnn_backend=tensorflow:model=espcn.pb:input=x:output=y -y tmp.espcn.jpg
  7071. @end example
  7072. @end itemize
  7073. @section drawbox
  7074. Draw a colored box on the input image.
  7075. It accepts the following parameters:
  7076. @table @option
  7077. @item x
  7078. @item y
  7079. The expressions which specify the top left corner coordinates of the box. It defaults to 0.
  7080. @item width, w
  7081. @item height, h
  7082. The expressions which specify the width and height of the box; if 0 they are interpreted as
  7083. the input width and height. It defaults to 0.
  7084. @item color, c
  7085. Specify the color of the box to write. For the general syntax of this option,
  7086. check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}. If the special
  7087. value @code{invert} is used, the box edge color is the same as the
  7088. video with inverted luma.
  7089. @item thickness, t
  7090. The expression which sets the thickness of the box edge.
  7091. A value of @code{fill} will create a filled box. Default value is @code{3}.
  7092. See below for the list of accepted constants.
  7093. @item replace
  7094. Applicable if the input has alpha. With value @code{1}, the pixels of the painted box
  7095. will overwrite the video's color and alpha pixels.
  7096. Default is @code{0}, which composites the box onto the input, leaving the video's alpha intact.
  7097. @end table
  7098. The parameters for @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w} and @var{h} and @var{t} are expressions containing the
  7099. following constants:
  7100. @table @option
  7101. @item dar
  7102. The input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}.
  7103. @item hsub
  7104. @item vsub
  7105. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  7106. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  7107. @item in_h, ih
  7108. @item in_w, iw
  7109. The input width and height.
  7110. @item sar
  7111. The input sample aspect ratio.
  7112. @item x
  7113. @item y
  7114. The x and y offset coordinates where the box is drawn.
  7115. @item w
  7116. @item h
  7117. The width and height of the drawn box.
  7118. @item t
  7119. The thickness of the drawn box.
  7120. These constants allow the @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w}, @var{h} and @var{t} expressions to refer to
  7121. each other, so you may for example specify @code{y=x/dar} or @code{h=w/dar}.
  7122. @end table
  7123. @subsection Examples
  7124. @itemize
  7125. @item
  7126. Draw a black box around the edge of the input image:
  7127. @example
  7128. drawbox
  7129. @end example
  7130. @item
  7131. Draw a box with color red and an opacity of 50%:
  7132. @example
  7133. drawbox=10:20:200:60:red@@0.5
  7134. @end example
  7135. The previous example can be specified as:
  7136. @example
  7137. drawbox=x=10:y=20:w=200:h=60:color=red@@0.5
  7138. @end example
  7139. @item
  7140. Fill the box with pink color:
  7141. @example
  7142. drawbox=x=10:y=10:w=100:h=100:color=pink@@0.5:t=fill
  7143. @end example
  7144. @item
  7145. Draw a 2-pixel red 2.40:1 mask:
  7146. @example
  7147. drawbox=x=-t:y=0.5*(ih-iw/2.4)-t:w=iw+t*2:h=iw/2.4+t*2:t=2:c=red
  7148. @end example
  7149. @end itemize
  7150. @subsection Commands
  7151. This filter supports same commands as options.
  7152. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  7153. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  7154. value.
  7155. @anchor{drawgraph}
  7156. @section drawgraph
  7157. Draw a graph using input video metadata.
  7158. It accepts the following parameters:
  7159. @table @option
  7160. @item m1
  7161. Set 1st frame metadata key from which metadata values will be used to draw a graph.
  7162. @item fg1
  7163. Set 1st foreground color expression.
  7164. @item m2
  7165. Set 2nd frame metadata key from which metadata values will be used to draw a graph.
  7166. @item fg2
  7167. Set 2nd foreground color expression.
  7168. @item m3
  7169. Set 3rd frame metadata key from which metadata values will be used to draw a graph.
  7170. @item fg3
  7171. Set 3rd foreground color expression.
  7172. @item m4
  7173. Set 4th frame metadata key from which metadata values will be used to draw a graph.
  7174. @item fg4
  7175. Set 4th foreground color expression.
  7176. @item min
  7177. Set minimal value of metadata value.
  7178. @item max
  7179. Set maximal value of metadata value.
  7180. @item bg
  7181. Set graph background color. Default is white.
  7182. @item mode
  7183. Set graph mode.
  7184. Available values for mode is:
  7185. @table @samp
  7186. @item bar
  7187. @item dot
  7188. @item line
  7189. @end table
  7190. Default is @code{line}.
  7191. @item slide
  7192. Set slide mode.
  7193. Available values for slide is:
  7194. @table @samp
  7195. @item frame
  7196. Draw new frame when right border is reached.
  7197. @item replace
  7198. Replace old columns with new ones.
  7199. @item scroll
  7200. Scroll from right to left.
  7201. @item rscroll
  7202. Scroll from left to right.
  7203. @item picture
  7204. Draw single picture.
  7205. @end table
  7206. Default is @code{frame}.
  7207. @item size
  7208. Set size of graph video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  7209. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  7210. The default value is @code{900x256}.
  7211. @item rate, r
  7212. Set the output frame rate. Default value is @code{25}.
  7213. The foreground color expressions can use the following variables:
  7214. @table @option
  7215. @item MIN
  7216. Minimal value of metadata value.
  7217. @item MAX
  7218. Maximal value of metadata value.
  7219. @item VAL
  7220. Current metadata key value.
  7221. @end table
  7222. The color is defined as 0xAABBGGRR.
  7223. @end table
  7224. Example using metadata from @ref{signalstats} filter:
  7225. @example
  7226. signalstats,drawgraph=lavfi.signalstats.YAVG:min=0:max=255
  7227. @end example
  7228. Example using metadata from @ref{ebur128} filter:
  7229. @example
  7230. ebur128=metadata=1,adrawgraph=lavfi.r128.M:min=-120:max=5
  7231. @end example
  7232. @section drawgrid
  7233. Draw a grid on the input image.
  7234. It accepts the following parameters:
  7235. @table @option
  7236. @item x
  7237. @item y
  7238. The expressions which specify the coordinates of some point of grid intersection (meant to configure offset). Both default to 0.
  7239. @item width, w
  7240. @item height, h
  7241. The expressions which specify the width and height of the grid cell, if 0 they are interpreted as the
  7242. input width and height, respectively, minus @code{thickness}, so image gets
  7243. framed. Default to 0.
  7244. @item color, c
  7245. Specify the color of the grid. For the general syntax of this option,
  7246. check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}. If the special
  7247. value @code{invert} is used, the grid color is the same as the
  7248. video with inverted luma.
  7249. @item thickness, t
  7250. The expression which sets the thickness of the grid line. Default value is @code{1}.
  7251. See below for the list of accepted constants.
  7252. @item replace
  7253. Applicable if the input has alpha. With @code{1} the pixels of the painted grid
  7254. will overwrite the video's color and alpha pixels.
  7255. Default is @code{0}, which composites the grid onto the input, leaving the video's alpha intact.
  7256. @end table
  7257. The parameters for @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w} and @var{h} and @var{t} are expressions containing the
  7258. following constants:
  7259. @table @option
  7260. @item dar
  7261. The input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}.
  7262. @item hsub
  7263. @item vsub
  7264. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  7265. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  7266. @item in_h, ih
  7267. @item in_w, iw
  7268. The input grid cell width and height.
  7269. @item sar
  7270. The input sample aspect ratio.
  7271. @item x
  7272. @item y
  7273. The x and y coordinates of some point of grid intersection (meant to configure offset).
  7274. @item w
  7275. @item h
  7276. The width and height of the drawn cell.
  7277. @item t
  7278. The thickness of the drawn cell.
  7279. These constants allow the @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w}, @var{h} and @var{t} expressions to refer to
  7280. each other, so you may for example specify @code{y=x/dar} or @code{h=w/dar}.
  7281. @end table
  7282. @subsection Examples
  7283. @itemize
  7284. @item
  7285. Draw a grid with cell 100x100 pixels, thickness 2 pixels, with color red and an opacity of 50%:
  7286. @example
  7287. drawgrid=width=100:height=100:thickness=2:color=red@@0.5
  7288. @end example
  7289. @item
  7290. Draw a white 3x3 grid with an opacity of 50%:
  7291. @example
  7292. drawgrid=w=iw/3:h=ih/3:t=2:c=white@@0.5
  7293. @end example
  7294. @end itemize
  7295. @subsection Commands
  7296. This filter supports same commands as options.
  7297. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  7298. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  7299. value.
  7300. @anchor{drawtext}
  7301. @section drawtext
  7302. Draw a text string or text from a specified file on top of a video, using the
  7303. libfreetype library.
  7304. To enable compilation of this filter, you need to configure FFmpeg with
  7305. @code{--enable-libfreetype}.
  7306. To enable default font fallback and the @var{font} option you need to
  7307. configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-libfontconfig}.
  7308. To enable the @var{text_shaping} option, you need to configure FFmpeg with
  7309. @code{--enable-libfribidi}.
  7310. @subsection Syntax
  7311. It accepts the following parameters:
  7312. @table @option
  7313. @item box
  7314. Used to draw a box around text using the background color.
  7315. The value must be either 1 (enable) or 0 (disable).
  7316. The default value of @var{box} is 0.
  7317. @item boxborderw
  7318. Set the width of the border to be drawn around the box using @var{boxcolor}.
  7319. The default value of @var{boxborderw} is 0.
  7320. @item boxcolor
  7321. The color to be used for drawing box around text. For the syntax of this
  7322. option, check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  7323. The default value of @var{boxcolor} is "white".
  7324. @item line_spacing
  7325. Set the line spacing in pixels of the border to be drawn around the box using @var{box}.
  7326. The default value of @var{line_spacing} is 0.
  7327. @item borderw
  7328. Set the width of the border to be drawn around the text using @var{bordercolor}.
  7329. The default value of @var{borderw} is 0.
  7330. @item bordercolor
  7331. Set the color to be used for drawing border around text. For the syntax of this
  7332. option, check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  7333. The default value of @var{bordercolor} is "black".
  7334. @item expansion
  7335. Select how the @var{text} is expanded. Can be either @code{none},
  7336. @code{strftime} (deprecated) or
  7337. @code{normal} (default). See the @ref{drawtext_expansion, Text expansion} section
  7338. below for details.
  7339. @item basetime
  7340. Set a start time for the count. Value is in microseconds. Only applied
  7341. in the deprecated strftime expansion mode. To emulate in normal expansion
  7342. mode use the @code{pts} function, supplying the start time (in seconds)
  7343. as the second argument.
  7344. @item fix_bounds
  7345. If true, check and fix text coords to avoid clipping.
  7346. @item fontcolor
  7347. The color to be used for drawing fonts. For the syntax of this option, check
  7348. the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  7349. The default value of @var{fontcolor} is "black".
  7350. @item fontcolor_expr
  7351. String which is expanded the same way as @var{text} to obtain dynamic
  7352. @var{fontcolor} value. By default this option has empty value and is not
  7353. processed. When this option is set, it overrides @var{fontcolor} option.
  7354. @item font
  7355. The font family to be used for drawing text. By default Sans.
  7356. @item fontfile
  7357. The font file to be used for drawing text. The path must be included.
  7358. This parameter is mandatory if the fontconfig support is disabled.
  7359. @item alpha
  7360. Draw the text applying alpha blending. The value can
  7361. be a number between 0.0 and 1.0.
  7362. The expression accepts the same variables @var{x, y} as well.
  7363. The default value is 1.
  7364. Please see @var{fontcolor_expr}.
  7365. @item fontsize
  7366. The font size to be used for drawing text.
  7367. The default value of @var{fontsize} is 16.
  7368. @item text_shaping
  7369. If set to 1, attempt to shape the text (for example, reverse the order of
  7370. right-to-left text and join Arabic characters) before drawing it.
  7371. Otherwise, just draw the text exactly as given.
  7372. By default 1 (if supported).
  7373. @item ft_load_flags
  7374. The flags to be used for loading the fonts.
  7375. The flags map the corresponding flags supported by libfreetype, and are
  7376. a combination of the following values:
  7377. @table @var
  7378. @item default
  7379. @item no_scale
  7380. @item no_hinting
  7381. @item render
  7382. @item no_bitmap
  7383. @item vertical_layout
  7384. @item force_autohint
  7385. @item crop_bitmap
  7386. @item pedantic
  7387. @item ignore_global_advance_width
  7388. @item no_recurse
  7389. @item ignore_transform
  7390. @item monochrome
  7391. @item linear_design
  7392. @item no_autohint
  7393. @end table
  7394. Default value is "default".
  7395. For more information consult the documentation for the FT_LOAD_*
  7396. libfreetype flags.
  7397. @item shadowcolor
  7398. The color to be used for drawing a shadow behind the drawn text. For the
  7399. syntax of this option, check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the
  7400. ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  7401. The default value of @var{shadowcolor} is "black".
  7402. @item shadowx
  7403. @item shadowy
  7404. The x and y offsets for the text shadow position with respect to the
  7405. position of the text. They can be either positive or negative
  7406. values. The default value for both is "0".
  7407. @item start_number
  7408. The starting frame number for the n/frame_num variable. The default value
  7409. is "0".
  7410. @item tabsize
  7411. The size in number of spaces to use for rendering the tab.
  7412. Default value is 4.
  7413. @item timecode
  7414. Set the initial timecode representation in "hh:mm:ss[:;.]ff"
  7415. format. It can be used with or without text parameter. @var{timecode_rate}
  7416. option must be specified.
  7417. @item timecode_rate, rate, r
  7418. Set the timecode frame rate (timecode only). Value will be rounded to nearest
  7419. integer. Minimum value is "1".
  7420. Drop-frame timecode is supported for frame rates 30 & 60.
  7421. @item tc24hmax
  7422. If set to 1, the output of the timecode option will wrap around at 24 hours.
  7423. Default is 0 (disabled).
  7424. @item text
  7425. The text string to be drawn. The text must be a sequence of UTF-8
  7426. encoded characters.
  7427. This parameter is mandatory if no file is specified with the parameter
  7428. @var{textfile}.
  7429. @item textfile
  7430. A text file containing text to be drawn. The text must be a sequence
  7431. of UTF-8 encoded characters.
  7432. This parameter is mandatory if no text string is specified with the
  7433. parameter @var{text}.
  7434. If both @var{text} and @var{textfile} are specified, an error is thrown.
  7435. @item reload
  7436. If set to 1, the @var{textfile} will be reloaded before each frame.
  7437. Be sure to update it atomically, or it may be read partially, or even fail.
  7438. @item x
  7439. @item y
  7440. The expressions which specify the offsets where text will be drawn
  7441. within the video frame. They are relative to the top/left border of the
  7442. output image.
  7443. The default value of @var{x} and @var{y} is "0".
  7444. See below for the list of accepted constants and functions.
  7445. @end table
  7446. The parameters for @var{x} and @var{y} are expressions containing the
  7447. following constants and functions:
  7448. @table @option
  7449. @item dar
  7450. input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}
  7451. @item hsub
  7452. @item vsub
  7453. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  7454. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  7455. @item line_h, lh
  7456. the height of each text line
  7457. @item main_h, h, H
  7458. the input height
  7459. @item main_w, w, W
  7460. the input width
  7461. @item max_glyph_a, ascent
  7462. the maximum distance from the baseline to the highest/upper grid
  7463. coordinate used to place a glyph outline point, for all the rendered
  7464. glyphs.
  7465. It is a positive value, due to the grid's orientation with the Y axis
  7466. upwards.
  7467. @item max_glyph_d, descent
  7468. the maximum distance from the baseline to the lowest grid coordinate
  7469. used to place a glyph outline point, for all the rendered glyphs.
  7470. This is a negative value, due to the grid's orientation, with the Y axis
  7471. upwards.
  7472. @item max_glyph_h
  7473. maximum glyph height, that is the maximum height for all the glyphs
  7474. contained in the rendered text, it is equivalent to @var{ascent} -
  7475. @var{descent}.
  7476. @item max_glyph_w
  7477. maximum glyph width, that is the maximum width for all the glyphs
  7478. contained in the rendered text
  7479. @item n
  7480. the number of input frame, starting from 0
  7481. @item rand(min, max)
  7482. return a random number included between @var{min} and @var{max}
  7483. @item sar
  7484. The input sample aspect ratio.
  7485. @item t
  7486. timestamp expressed in seconds, NAN if the input timestamp is unknown
  7487. @item text_h, th
  7488. the height of the rendered text
  7489. @item text_w, tw
  7490. the width of the rendered text
  7491. @item x
  7492. @item y
  7493. the x and y offset coordinates where the text is drawn.
  7494. These parameters allow the @var{x} and @var{y} expressions to refer
  7495. to each other, so you can for example specify @code{y=x/dar}.
  7496. @item pict_type
  7497. A one character description of the current frame's picture type.
  7498. @item pkt_pos
  7499. The current packet's position in the input file or stream
  7500. (in bytes, from the start of the input). A value of -1 indicates
  7501. this info is not available.
  7502. @item pkt_duration
  7503. The current packet's duration, in seconds.
  7504. @item pkt_size
  7505. The current packet's size (in bytes).
  7506. @end table
  7507. @anchor{drawtext_expansion}
  7508. @subsection Text expansion
  7509. If @option{expansion} is set to @code{strftime},
  7510. the filter recognizes strftime() sequences in the provided text and
  7511. expands them accordingly. Check the documentation of strftime(). This
  7512. feature is deprecated.
  7513. If @option{expansion} is set to @code{none}, the text is printed verbatim.
  7514. If @option{expansion} is set to @code{normal} (which is the default),
  7515. the following expansion mechanism is used.
  7516. The backslash character @samp{\}, followed by any character, always expands to
  7517. the second character.
  7518. Sequences of the form @code{%@{...@}} are expanded. The text between the
  7519. braces is a function name, possibly followed by arguments separated by ':'.
  7520. If the arguments contain special characters or delimiters (':' or '@}'),
  7521. they should be escaped.
  7522. Note that they probably must also be escaped as the value for the
  7523. @option{text} option in the filter argument string and as the filter
  7524. argument in the filtergraph description, and possibly also for the shell,
  7525. that makes up to four levels of escaping; using a text file avoids these
  7526. problems.
  7527. The following functions are available:
  7528. @table @command
  7529. @item expr, e
  7530. The expression evaluation result.
  7531. It must take one argument specifying the expression to be evaluated,
  7532. which accepts the same constants and functions as the @var{x} and
  7533. @var{y} values. Note that not all constants should be used, for
  7534. example the text size is not known when evaluating the expression, so
  7535. the constants @var{text_w} and @var{text_h} will have an undefined
  7536. value.
  7537. @item expr_int_format, eif
  7538. Evaluate the expression's value and output as formatted integer.
  7539. The first argument is the expression to be evaluated, just as for the @var{expr} function.
  7540. The second argument specifies the output format. Allowed values are @samp{x},
  7541. @samp{X}, @samp{d} and @samp{u}. They are treated exactly as in the
  7542. @code{printf} function.
  7543. The third parameter is optional and sets the number of positions taken by the output.
  7544. It can be used to add padding with zeros from the left.
  7545. @item gmtime
  7546. The time at which the filter is running, expressed in UTC.
  7547. It can accept an argument: a strftime() format string.
  7548. @item localtime
  7549. The time at which the filter is running, expressed in the local time zone.
  7550. It can accept an argument: a strftime() format string.
  7551. @item metadata
  7552. Frame metadata. Takes one or two arguments.
  7553. The first argument is mandatory and specifies the metadata key.
  7554. The second argument is optional and specifies a default value, used when the
  7555. metadata key is not found or empty.
  7556. Available metadata can be identified by inspecting entries
  7557. starting with TAG included within each frame section
  7558. printed by running @code{ffprobe -show_frames}.
  7559. String metadata generated in filters leading to
  7560. the drawtext filter are also available.
  7561. @item n, frame_num
  7562. The frame number, starting from 0.
  7563. @item pict_type
  7564. A one character description of the current picture type.
  7565. @item pts
  7566. The timestamp of the current frame.
  7567. It can take up to three arguments.
  7568. The first argument is the format of the timestamp; it defaults to @code{flt}
  7569. for seconds as a decimal number with microsecond accuracy; @code{hms} stands
  7570. for a formatted @var{[-]HH:MM:SS.mmm} timestamp with millisecond accuracy.
  7571. @code{gmtime} stands for the timestamp of the frame formatted as UTC time;
  7572. @code{localtime} stands for the timestamp of the frame formatted as
  7573. local time zone time.
  7574. The second argument is an offset added to the timestamp.
  7575. If the format is set to @code{hms}, a third argument @code{24HH} may be
  7576. supplied to present the hour part of the formatted timestamp in 24h format
  7577. (00-23).
  7578. If the format is set to @code{localtime} or @code{gmtime},
  7579. a third argument may be supplied: a strftime() format string.
  7580. By default, @var{YYYY-MM-DD HH:MM:SS} format will be used.
  7581. @end table
  7582. @subsection Commands
  7583. This filter supports altering parameters via commands:
  7584. @table @option
  7585. @item reinit
  7586. Alter existing filter parameters.
  7587. Syntax for the argument is the same as for filter invocation, e.g.
  7588. @example
  7589. fontsize=56:fontcolor=green:text='Hello World'
  7590. @end example
  7591. Full filter invocation with sendcmd would look like this:
  7592. @example
  7593. sendcmd=c='56.0 drawtext reinit fontsize=56\:fontcolor=green\:text=Hello\\ World'
  7594. @end example
  7595. @end table
  7596. If the entire argument can't be parsed or applied as valid values then the filter will
  7597. continue with its existing parameters.
  7598. @subsection Examples
  7599. @itemize
  7600. @item
  7601. Draw "Test Text" with font FreeSerif, using the default values for the
  7602. optional parameters.
  7603. @example
  7604. drawtext="fontfile=/usr/share/fonts/truetype/freefont/FreeSerif.ttf: text='Test Text'"
  7605. @end example
  7606. @item
  7607. Draw 'Test Text' with font FreeSerif of size 24 at position x=100
  7608. and y=50 (counting from the top-left corner of the screen), text is
  7609. yellow with a red box around it. Both the text and the box have an
  7610. opacity of 20%.
  7611. @example
  7612. drawtext="fontfile=/usr/share/fonts/truetype/freefont/FreeSerif.ttf: text='Test Text':\
  7613. x=100: y=50: fontsize=24: fontcolor=yellow@@0.2: box=1: boxcolor=red@@0.2"
  7614. @end example
  7615. Note that the double quotes are not necessary if spaces are not used
  7616. within the parameter list.
  7617. @item
  7618. Show the text at the center of the video frame:
  7619. @example
  7620. drawtext="fontsize=30:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text='hello world':x=(w-text_w)/2:y=(h-text_h)/2"
  7621. @end example
  7622. @item
  7623. Show the text at a random position, switching to a new position every 30 seconds:
  7624. @example
  7625. drawtext="fontsize=30:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text='hello world':x=if(eq(mod(t\,30)\,0)\,rand(0\,(w-text_w))\,x):y=if(eq(mod(t\,30)\,0)\,rand(0\,(h-text_h))\,y)"
  7626. @end example
  7627. @item
  7628. Show a text line sliding from right to left in the last row of the video
  7629. frame. The file @file{LONG_LINE} is assumed to contain a single line
  7630. with no newlines.
  7631. @example
  7632. drawtext="fontsize=15:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=LONG_LINE:y=h-line_h:x=-50*t"
  7633. @end example
  7634. @item
  7635. Show the content of file @file{CREDITS} off the bottom of the frame and scroll up.
  7636. @example
  7637. drawtext="fontsize=20:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:textfile=CREDITS:y=h-20*t"
  7638. @end example
  7639. @item
  7640. Draw a single green letter "g", at the center of the input video.
  7641. The glyph baseline is placed at half screen height.
  7642. @example
  7643. drawtext="fontsize=60:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:fontcolor=green:text=g:x=(w-max_glyph_w)/2:y=h/2-ascent"
  7644. @end example
  7645. @item
  7646. Show text for 1 second every 3 seconds:
  7647. @example
  7648. drawtext="fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:fontcolor=white:x=100:y=x/dar:enable=lt(mod(t\,3)\,1):text='blink'"
  7649. @end example
  7650. @item
  7651. Use fontconfig to set the font. Note that the colons need to be escaped.
  7652. @example
  7653. drawtext='fontfile=Linux Libertine O-40\:style=Semibold:text=FFmpeg'
  7654. @end example
  7655. @item
  7656. Print the date of a real-time encoding (see strftime(3)):
  7657. @example
  7658. drawtext='fontfile=FreeSans.ttf:text=%@{localtime\:%a %b %d %Y@}'
  7659. @end example
  7660. @item
  7661. Show text fading in and out (appearing/disappearing):
  7662. @example
  7663. #!/bin/sh
  7664. DS=1.0 # display start
  7665. DE=10.0 # display end
  7666. FID=1.5 # fade in duration
  7667. FOD=5 # fade out duration
  7668. ffplay -f lavfi "color,drawtext=text=TEST:fontsize=50:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:fontcolor_expr=ff0000%@{eif\\\\: clip(255*(1*between(t\\, $DS + $FID\\, $DE - $FOD) + ((t - $DS)/$FID)*between(t\\, $DS\\, $DS + $FID) + (-(t - $DE)/$FOD)*between(t\\, $DE - $FOD\\, $DE) )\\, 0\\, 255) \\\\: x\\\\: 2 @}"
  7669. @end example
  7670. @item
  7671. Horizontally align multiple separate texts. Note that @option{max_glyph_a}
  7672. and the @option{fontsize} value are included in the @option{y} offset.
  7673. @example
  7674. drawtext=fontfile=FreeSans.ttf:text=DOG:fontsize=24:x=10:y=20+24-max_glyph_a,
  7675. drawtext=fontfile=FreeSans.ttf:text=cow:fontsize=24:x=80:y=20+24-max_glyph_a
  7676. @end example
  7677. @item
  7678. Plot special @var{lavf.image2dec.source_basename} metadata onto each frame if
  7679. such metadata exists. Otherwise, plot the string "NA". Note that image2 demuxer
  7680. must have option @option{-export_path_metadata 1} for the special metadata fields
  7681. to be available for filters.
  7682. @example
  7683. drawtext="fontsize=20:fontcolor=white:fontfile=FreeSans.ttf:text='%@{metadata\:lavf.image2dec.source_basename\:NA@}':x=10:y=10"
  7684. @end example
  7685. @end itemize
  7686. For more information about libfreetype, check:
  7687. @url{http://www.freetype.org/}.
  7688. For more information about fontconfig, check:
  7689. @url{http://freedesktop.org/software/fontconfig/fontconfig-user.html}.
  7690. For more information about libfribidi, check:
  7691. @url{http://fribidi.org/}.
  7692. @section edgedetect
  7693. Detect and draw edges. The filter uses the Canny Edge Detection algorithm.
  7694. The filter accepts the following options:
  7695. @table @option
  7696. @item low
  7697. @item high
  7698. Set low and high threshold values used by the Canny thresholding
  7699. algorithm.
  7700. The high threshold selects the "strong" edge pixels, which are then
  7701. connected through 8-connectivity with the "weak" edge pixels selected
  7702. by the low threshold.
  7703. @var{low} and @var{high} threshold values must be chosen in the range
  7704. [0,1], and @var{low} should be lesser or equal to @var{high}.
  7705. Default value for @var{low} is @code{20/255}, and default value for @var{high}
  7706. is @code{50/255}.
  7707. @item mode
  7708. Define the drawing mode.
  7709. @table @samp
  7710. @item wires
  7711. Draw white/gray wires on black background.
  7712. @item colormix
  7713. Mix the colors to create a paint/cartoon effect.
  7714. @item canny
  7715. Apply Canny edge detector on all selected planes.
  7716. @end table
  7717. Default value is @var{wires}.
  7718. @item planes
  7719. Select planes for filtering. By default all available planes are filtered.
  7720. @end table
  7721. @subsection Examples
  7722. @itemize
  7723. @item
  7724. Standard edge detection with custom values for the hysteresis thresholding:
  7725. @example
  7726. edgedetect=low=0.1:high=0.4
  7727. @end example
  7728. @item
  7729. Painting effect without thresholding:
  7730. @example
  7731. edgedetect=mode=colormix:high=0
  7732. @end example
  7733. @end itemize
  7734. @section elbg
  7735. Apply a posterize effect using the ELBG (Enhanced LBG) algorithm.
  7736. For each input image, the filter will compute the optimal mapping from
  7737. the input to the output given the codebook length, that is the number
  7738. of distinct output colors.
  7739. This filter accepts the following options.
  7740. @table @option
  7741. @item codebook_length, l
  7742. Set codebook length. The value must be a positive integer, and
  7743. represents the number of distinct output colors. Default value is 256.
  7744. @item nb_steps, n
  7745. Set the maximum number of iterations to apply for computing the optimal
  7746. mapping. The higher the value the better the result and the higher the
  7747. computation time. Default value is 1.
  7748. @item seed, s
  7749. Set a random seed, must be an integer included between 0 and
  7750. UINT32_MAX. If not specified, or if explicitly set to -1, the filter
  7751. will try to use a good random seed on a best effort basis.
  7752. @item pal8
  7753. Set pal8 output pixel format. This option does not work with codebook
  7754. length greater than 256.
  7755. @end table
  7756. @section entropy
  7757. Measure graylevel entropy in histogram of color channels of video frames.
  7758. It accepts the following parameters:
  7759. @table @option
  7760. @item mode
  7761. Can be either @var{normal} or @var{diff}. Default is @var{normal}.
  7762. @var{diff} mode measures entropy of histogram delta values, absolute differences
  7763. between neighbour histogram values.
  7764. @end table
  7765. @section eq
  7766. Set brightness, contrast, saturation and approximate gamma adjustment.
  7767. The filter accepts the following options:
  7768. @table @option
  7769. @item contrast
  7770. Set the contrast expression. The value must be a float value in range
  7771. @code{-1000.0} to @code{1000.0}. The default value is "1".
  7772. @item brightness
  7773. Set the brightness expression. The value must be a float value in
  7774. range @code{-1.0} to @code{1.0}. The default value is "0".
  7775. @item saturation
  7776. Set the saturation expression. The value must be a float in
  7777. range @code{0.0} to @code{3.0}. The default value is "1".
  7778. @item gamma
  7779. Set the gamma expression. The value must be a float in range
  7780. @code{0.1} to @code{10.0}. The default value is "1".
  7781. @item gamma_r
  7782. Set the gamma expression for red. The value must be a float in
  7783. range @code{0.1} to @code{10.0}. The default value is "1".
  7784. @item gamma_g
  7785. Set the gamma expression for green. The value must be a float in range
  7786. @code{0.1} to @code{10.0}. The default value is "1".
  7787. @item gamma_b
  7788. Set the gamma expression for blue. The value must be a float in range
  7789. @code{0.1} to @code{10.0}. The default value is "1".
  7790. @item gamma_weight
  7791. Set the gamma weight expression. It can be used to reduce the effect
  7792. of a high gamma value on bright image areas, e.g. keep them from
  7793. getting overamplified and just plain white. The value must be a float
  7794. in range @code{0.0} to @code{1.0}. A value of @code{0.0} turns the
  7795. gamma correction all the way down while @code{1.0} leaves it at its
  7796. full strength. Default is "1".
  7797. @item eval
  7798. Set when the expressions for brightness, contrast, saturation and
  7799. gamma expressions are evaluated.
  7800. It accepts the following values:
  7801. @table @samp
  7802. @item init
  7803. only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or
  7804. when a command is processed
  7805. @item frame
  7806. evaluate expressions for each incoming frame
  7807. @end table
  7808. Default value is @samp{init}.
  7809. @end table
  7810. The expressions accept the following parameters:
  7811. @table @option
  7812. @item n
  7813. frame count of the input frame starting from 0
  7814. @item pos
  7815. byte position of the corresponding packet in the input file, NAN if
  7816. unspecified
  7817. @item r
  7818. frame rate of the input video, NAN if the input frame rate is unknown
  7819. @item t
  7820. timestamp expressed in seconds, NAN if the input timestamp is unknown
  7821. @end table
  7822. @subsection Commands
  7823. The filter supports the following commands:
  7824. @table @option
  7825. @item contrast
  7826. Set the contrast expression.
  7827. @item brightness
  7828. Set the brightness expression.
  7829. @item saturation
  7830. Set the saturation expression.
  7831. @item gamma
  7832. Set the gamma expression.
  7833. @item gamma_r
  7834. Set the gamma_r expression.
  7835. @item gamma_g
  7836. Set gamma_g expression.
  7837. @item gamma_b
  7838. Set gamma_b expression.
  7839. @item gamma_weight
  7840. Set gamma_weight expression.
  7841. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  7842. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  7843. value.
  7844. @end table
  7845. @section erosion
  7846. Apply erosion effect to the video.
  7847. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) minimum.
  7848. It accepts the following options:
  7849. @table @option
  7850. @item threshold0
  7851. @item threshold1
  7852. @item threshold2
  7853. @item threshold3
  7854. Limit the maximum change for each plane, default is 65535.
  7855. If 0, plane will remain unchanged.
  7856. @item coordinates
  7857. Flag which specifies the pixel to refer to. Default is 255 i.e. all eight
  7858. pixels are used.
  7859. Flags to local 3x3 coordinates maps like this:
  7860. 1 2 3
  7861. 4 5
  7862. 6 7 8
  7863. @end table
  7864. @subsection Commands
  7865. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  7866. @section extractplanes
  7867. Extract color channel components from input video stream into
  7868. separate grayscale video streams.
  7869. The filter accepts the following option:
  7870. @table @option
  7871. @item planes
  7872. Set plane(s) to extract.
  7873. Available values for planes are:
  7874. @table @samp
  7875. @item y
  7876. @item u
  7877. @item v
  7878. @item a
  7879. @item r
  7880. @item g
  7881. @item b
  7882. @end table
  7883. Choosing planes not available in the input will result in an error.
  7884. That means you cannot select @code{r}, @code{g}, @code{b} planes
  7885. with @code{y}, @code{u}, @code{v} planes at same time.
  7886. @end table
  7887. @subsection Examples
  7888. @itemize
  7889. @item
  7890. Extract luma, u and v color channel component from input video frame
  7891. into 3 grayscale outputs:
  7892. @example
  7893. ffmpeg -i video.avi -filter_complex 'extractplanes=y+u+v[y][u][v]' -map '[y]' y.avi -map '[u]' u.avi -map '[v]' v.avi
  7894. @end example
  7895. @end itemize
  7896. @section fade
  7897. Apply a fade-in/out effect to the input video.
  7898. It accepts the following parameters:
  7899. @table @option
  7900. @item type, t
  7901. The effect type can be either "in" for a fade-in, or "out" for a fade-out
  7902. effect.
  7903. Default is @code{in}.
  7904. @item start_frame, s
  7905. Specify the number of the frame to start applying the fade
  7906. effect at. Default is 0.
  7907. @item nb_frames, n
  7908. The number of frames that the fade effect lasts. At the end of the
  7909. fade-in effect, the output video will have the same intensity as the input video.
  7910. At the end of the fade-out transition, the output video will be filled with the
  7911. selected @option{color}.
  7912. Default is 25.
  7913. @item alpha
  7914. If set to 1, fade only alpha channel, if one exists on the input.
  7915. Default value is 0.
  7916. @item start_time, st
  7917. Specify the timestamp (in seconds) of the frame to start to apply the fade
  7918. effect. If both start_frame and start_time are specified, the fade will start at
  7919. whichever comes last. Default is 0.
  7920. @item duration, d
  7921. The number of seconds for which the fade effect has to last. At the end of the
  7922. fade-in effect the output video will have the same intensity as the input video,
  7923. at the end of the fade-out transition the output video will be filled with the
  7924. selected @option{color}.
  7925. If both duration and nb_frames are specified, duration is used. Default is 0
  7926. (nb_frames is used by default).
  7927. @item color, c
  7928. Specify the color of the fade. Default is "black".
  7929. @end table
  7930. @subsection Examples
  7931. @itemize
  7932. @item
  7933. Fade in the first 30 frames of video:
  7934. @example
  7935. fade=in:0:30
  7936. @end example
  7937. The command above is equivalent to:
  7938. @example
  7939. fade=t=in:s=0:n=30
  7940. @end example
  7941. @item
  7942. Fade out the last 45 frames of a 200-frame video:
  7943. @example
  7944. fade=out:155:45
  7945. fade=type=out:start_frame=155:nb_frames=45
  7946. @end example
  7947. @item
  7948. Fade in the first 25 frames and fade out the last 25 frames of a 1000-frame video:
  7949. @example
  7950. fade=in:0:25, fade=out:975:25
  7951. @end example
  7952. @item
  7953. Make the first 5 frames yellow, then fade in from frame 5-24:
  7954. @example
  7955. fade=in:5:20:color=yellow
  7956. @end example
  7957. @item
  7958. Fade in alpha over first 25 frames of video:
  7959. @example
  7960. fade=in:0:25:alpha=1
  7961. @end example
  7962. @item
  7963. Make the first 5.5 seconds black, then fade in for 0.5 seconds:
  7964. @example
  7965. fade=t=in:st=5.5:d=0.5
  7966. @end example
  7967. @end itemize
  7968. @section fftdnoiz
  7969. Denoise frames using 3D FFT (frequency domain filtering).
  7970. The filter accepts the following options:
  7971. @table @option
  7972. @item sigma
  7973. Set the noise sigma constant. This sets denoising strength.
  7974. Default value is 1. Allowed range is from 0 to 30.
  7975. Using very high sigma with low overlap may give blocking artifacts.
  7976. @item amount
  7977. Set amount of denoising. By default all detected noise is reduced.
  7978. Default value is 1. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  7979. @item block
  7980. Set size of block, Default is 4, can be 3, 4, 5 or 6.
  7981. Actual size of block in pixels is 2 to power of @var{block}, so by default
  7982. block size in pixels is 2^4 which is 16.
  7983. @item overlap
  7984. Set block overlap. Default is 0.5. Allowed range is from 0.2 to 0.8.
  7985. @item prev
  7986. Set number of previous frames to use for denoising. By default is set to 0.
  7987. @item next
  7988. Set number of next frames to to use for denoising. By default is set to 0.
  7989. @item planes
  7990. Set planes which will be filtered, by default are all available filtered
  7991. except alpha.
  7992. @end table
  7993. @section fftfilt
  7994. Apply arbitrary expressions to samples in frequency domain
  7995. @table @option
  7996. @item dc_Y
  7997. Adjust the dc value (gain) of the luma plane of the image. The filter
  7998. accepts an integer value in range @code{0} to @code{1000}. The default
  7999. value is set to @code{0}.
  8000. @item dc_U
  8001. Adjust the dc value (gain) of the 1st chroma plane of the image. The
  8002. filter accepts an integer value in range @code{0} to @code{1000}. The
  8003. default value is set to @code{0}.
  8004. @item dc_V
  8005. Adjust the dc value (gain) of the 2nd chroma plane of the image. The
  8006. filter accepts an integer value in range @code{0} to @code{1000}. The
  8007. default value is set to @code{0}.
  8008. @item weight_Y
  8009. Set the frequency domain weight expression for the luma plane.
  8010. @item weight_U
  8011. Set the frequency domain weight expression for the 1st chroma plane.
  8012. @item weight_V
  8013. Set the frequency domain weight expression for the 2nd chroma plane.
  8014. @item eval
  8015. Set when the expressions are evaluated.
  8016. It accepts the following values:
  8017. @table @samp
  8018. @item init
  8019. Only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization.
  8020. @item frame
  8021. Evaluate expressions for each incoming frame.
  8022. @end table
  8023. Default value is @samp{init}.
  8024. The filter accepts the following variables:
  8025. @item X
  8026. @item Y
  8027. The coordinates of the current sample.
  8028. @item W
  8029. @item H
  8030. The width and height of the image.
  8031. @item N
  8032. The number of input frame, starting from 0.
  8033. @end table
  8034. @subsection Examples
  8035. @itemize
  8036. @item
  8037. High-pass:
  8038. @example
  8039. fftfilt=dc_Y=128:weight_Y='squish(1-(Y+X)/100)'
  8040. @end example
  8041. @item
  8042. Low-pass:
  8043. @example
  8044. fftfilt=dc_Y=0:weight_Y='squish((Y+X)/100-1)'
  8045. @end example
  8046. @item
  8047. Sharpen:
  8048. @example
  8049. fftfilt=dc_Y=0:weight_Y='1+squish(1-(Y+X)/100)'
  8050. @end example
  8051. @item
  8052. Blur:
  8053. @example
  8054. fftfilt=dc_Y=0:weight_Y='exp(-4 * ((Y+X)/(W+H)))'
  8055. @end example
  8056. @end itemize
  8057. @section field
  8058. Extract a single field from an interlaced image using stride
  8059. arithmetic to avoid wasting CPU time. The output frames are marked as
  8060. non-interlaced.
  8061. The filter accepts the following options:
  8062. @table @option
  8063. @item type
  8064. Specify whether to extract the top (if the value is @code{0} or
  8065. @code{top}) or the bottom field (if the value is @code{1} or
  8066. @code{bottom}).
  8067. @end table
  8068. @section fieldhint
  8069. Create new frames by copying the top and bottom fields from surrounding frames
  8070. supplied as numbers by the hint file.
  8071. @table @option
  8072. @item hint
  8073. Set file containing hints: absolute/relative frame numbers.
  8074. There must be one line for each frame in a clip. Each line must contain two
  8075. numbers separated by the comma, optionally followed by @code{-} or @code{+}.
  8076. Numbers supplied on each line of file can not be out of [N-1,N+1] where N
  8077. is current frame number for @code{absolute} mode or out of [-1, 1] range
  8078. for @code{relative} mode. First number tells from which frame to pick up top
  8079. field and second number tells from which frame to pick up bottom field.
  8080. If optionally followed by @code{+} output frame will be marked as interlaced,
  8081. else if followed by @code{-} output frame will be marked as progressive, else
  8082. it will be marked same as input frame.
  8083. If optionally followed by @code{t} output frame will use only top field, or in
  8084. case of @code{b} it will use only bottom field.
  8085. If line starts with @code{#} or @code{;} that line is skipped.
  8086. @item mode
  8087. Can be item @code{absolute} or @code{relative}. Default is @code{absolute}.
  8088. @end table
  8089. Example of first several lines of @code{hint} file for @code{relative} mode:
  8090. @example
  8091. 0,0 - # first frame
  8092. 1,0 - # second frame, use third's frame top field and second's frame bottom field
  8093. 1,0 - # third frame, use fourth's frame top field and third's frame bottom field
  8094. 1,0 -
  8095. 0,0 -
  8096. 0,0 -
  8097. 1,0 -
  8098. 1,0 -
  8099. 1,0 -
  8100. 0,0 -
  8101. 0,0 -
  8102. 1,0 -
  8103. 1,0 -
  8104. 1,0 -
  8105. 0,0 -
  8106. @end example
  8107. @section fieldmatch
  8108. Field matching filter for inverse telecine. It is meant to reconstruct the
  8109. progressive frames from a telecined stream. The filter does not drop duplicated
  8110. frames, so to achieve a complete inverse telecine @code{fieldmatch} needs to be
  8111. followed by a decimation filter such as @ref{decimate} in the filtergraph.
  8112. The separation of the field matching and the decimation is notably motivated by
  8113. the possibility of inserting a de-interlacing filter fallback between the two.
  8114. If the source has mixed telecined and real interlaced content,
  8115. @code{fieldmatch} will not be able to match fields for the interlaced parts.
  8116. But these remaining combed frames will be marked as interlaced, and thus can be
  8117. de-interlaced by a later filter such as @ref{yadif} before decimation.
  8118. In addition to the various configuration options, @code{fieldmatch} can take an
  8119. optional second stream, activated through the @option{ppsrc} option. If
  8120. enabled, the frames reconstruction will be based on the fields and frames from
  8121. this second stream. This allows the first input to be pre-processed in order to
  8122. help the various algorithms of the filter, while keeping the output lossless
  8123. (assuming the fields are matched properly). Typically, a field-aware denoiser,
  8124. or brightness/contrast adjustments can help.
  8125. Note that this filter uses the same algorithms as TIVTC/TFM (AviSynth project)
  8126. and VIVTC/VFM (VapourSynth project). The later is a light clone of TFM from
  8127. which @code{fieldmatch} is based on. While the semantic and usage are very
  8128. close, some behaviour and options names can differ.
  8129. The @ref{decimate} filter currently only works for constant frame rate input.
  8130. If your input has mixed telecined (30fps) and progressive content with a lower
  8131. framerate like 24fps use the following filterchain to produce the necessary cfr
  8132. stream: @code{dejudder,fps=30000/1001,fieldmatch,decimate}.
  8133. The filter accepts the following options:
  8134. @table @option
  8135. @item order
  8136. Specify the assumed field order of the input stream. Available values are:
  8137. @table @samp
  8138. @item auto
  8139. Auto detect parity (use FFmpeg's internal parity value).
  8140. @item bff
  8141. Assume bottom field first.
  8142. @item tff
  8143. Assume top field first.
  8144. @end table
  8145. Note that it is sometimes recommended not to trust the parity announced by the
  8146. stream.
  8147. Default value is @var{auto}.
  8148. @item mode
  8149. Set the matching mode or strategy to use. @option{pc} mode is the safest in the
  8150. sense that it won't risk creating jerkiness due to duplicate frames when
  8151. possible, but if there are bad edits or blended fields it will end up
  8152. outputting combed frames when a good match might actually exist. On the other
  8153. hand, @option{pcn_ub} mode is the most risky in terms of creating jerkiness,
  8154. but will almost always find a good frame if there is one. The other values are
  8155. all somewhere in between @option{pc} and @option{pcn_ub} in terms of risking
  8156. jerkiness and creating duplicate frames versus finding good matches in sections
  8157. with bad edits, orphaned fields, blended fields, etc.
  8158. More details about p/c/n/u/b are available in @ref{p/c/n/u/b meaning} section.
  8159. Available values are:
  8160. @table @samp
  8161. @item pc
  8162. 2-way matching (p/c)
  8163. @item pc_n
  8164. 2-way matching, and trying 3rd match if still combed (p/c + n)
  8165. @item pc_u
  8166. 2-way matching, and trying 3rd match (same order) if still combed (p/c + u)
  8167. @item pc_n_ub
  8168. 2-way matching, trying 3rd match if still combed, and trying 4th/5th matches if
  8169. still combed (p/c + n + u/b)
  8170. @item pcn
  8171. 3-way matching (p/c/n)
  8172. @item pcn_ub
  8173. 3-way matching, and trying 4th/5th matches if all 3 of the original matches are
  8174. detected as combed (p/c/n + u/b)
  8175. @end table
  8176. The parenthesis at the end indicate the matches that would be used for that
  8177. mode assuming @option{order}=@var{tff} (and @option{field} on @var{auto} or
  8178. @var{top}).
  8179. In terms of speed @option{pc} mode is by far the fastest and @option{pcn_ub} is
  8180. the slowest.
  8181. Default value is @var{pc_n}.
  8182. @item ppsrc
  8183. Mark the main input stream as a pre-processed input, and enable the secondary
  8184. input stream as the clean source to pick the fields from. See the filter
  8185. introduction for more details. It is similar to the @option{clip2} feature from
  8186. VFM/TFM.
  8187. Default value is @code{0} (disabled).
  8188. @item field
  8189. Set the field to match from. It is recommended to set this to the same value as
  8190. @option{order} unless you experience matching failures with that setting. In
  8191. certain circumstances changing the field that is used to match from can have a
  8192. large impact on matching performance. Available values are:
  8193. @table @samp
  8194. @item auto
  8195. Automatic (same value as @option{order}).
  8196. @item bottom
  8197. Match from the bottom field.
  8198. @item top
  8199. Match from the top field.
  8200. @end table
  8201. Default value is @var{auto}.
  8202. @item mchroma
  8203. Set whether or not chroma is included during the match comparisons. In most
  8204. cases it is recommended to leave this enabled. You should set this to @code{0}
  8205. only if your clip has bad chroma problems such as heavy rainbowing or other
  8206. artifacts. Setting this to @code{0} could also be used to speed things up at
  8207. the cost of some accuracy.
  8208. Default value is @code{1}.
  8209. @item y0
  8210. @item y1
  8211. These define an exclusion band which excludes the lines between @option{y0} and
  8212. @option{y1} from being included in the field matching decision. An exclusion
  8213. band can be used to ignore subtitles, a logo, or other things that may
  8214. interfere with the matching. @option{y0} sets the starting scan line and
  8215. @option{y1} sets the ending line; all lines in between @option{y0} and
  8216. @option{y1} (including @option{y0} and @option{y1}) will be ignored. Setting
  8217. @option{y0} and @option{y1} to the same value will disable the feature.
  8218. @option{y0} and @option{y1} defaults to @code{0}.
  8219. @item scthresh
  8220. Set the scene change detection threshold as a percentage of maximum change on
  8221. the luma plane. Good values are in the @code{[8.0, 14.0]} range. Scene change
  8222. detection is only relevant in case @option{combmatch}=@var{sc}. The range for
  8223. @option{scthresh} is @code{[0.0, 100.0]}.
  8224. Default value is @code{12.0}.
  8225. @item combmatch
  8226. When @option{combatch} is not @var{none}, @code{fieldmatch} will take into
  8227. account the combed scores of matches when deciding what match to use as the
  8228. final match. Available values are:
  8229. @table @samp
  8230. @item none
  8231. No final matching based on combed scores.
  8232. @item sc
  8233. Combed scores are only used when a scene change is detected.
  8234. @item full
  8235. Use combed scores all the time.
  8236. @end table
  8237. Default is @var{sc}.
  8238. @item combdbg
  8239. Force @code{fieldmatch} to calculate the combed metrics for certain matches and
  8240. print them. This setting is known as @option{micout} in TFM/VFM vocabulary.
  8241. Available values are:
  8242. @table @samp
  8243. @item none
  8244. No forced calculation.
  8245. @item pcn
  8246. Force p/c/n calculations.
  8247. @item pcnub
  8248. Force p/c/n/u/b calculations.
  8249. @end table
  8250. Default value is @var{none}.
  8251. @item cthresh
  8252. This is the area combing threshold used for combed frame detection. This
  8253. essentially controls how "strong" or "visible" combing must be to be detected.
  8254. Larger values mean combing must be more visible and smaller values mean combing
  8255. can be less visible or strong and still be detected. Valid settings are from
  8256. @code{-1} (every pixel will be detected as combed) to @code{255} (no pixel will
  8257. be detected as combed). This is basically a pixel difference value. A good
  8258. range is @code{[8, 12]}.
  8259. Default value is @code{9}.
  8260. @item chroma
  8261. Sets whether or not chroma is considered in the combed frame decision. Only
  8262. disable this if your source has chroma problems (rainbowing, etc.) that are
  8263. causing problems for the combed frame detection with chroma enabled. Actually,
  8264. using @option{chroma}=@var{0} is usually more reliable, except for the case
  8265. where there is chroma only combing in the source.
  8266. Default value is @code{0}.
  8267. @item blockx
  8268. @item blocky
  8269. Respectively set the x-axis and y-axis size of the window used during combed
  8270. frame detection. This has to do with the size of the area in which
  8271. @option{combpel} pixels are required to be detected as combed for a frame to be
  8272. declared combed. See the @option{combpel} parameter description for more info.
  8273. Possible values are any number that is a power of 2 starting at 4 and going up
  8274. to 512.
  8275. Default value is @code{16}.
  8276. @item combpel
  8277. The number of combed pixels inside any of the @option{blocky} by
  8278. @option{blockx} size blocks on the frame for the frame to be detected as
  8279. combed. While @option{cthresh} controls how "visible" the combing must be, this
  8280. setting controls "how much" combing there must be in any localized area (a
  8281. window defined by the @option{blockx} and @option{blocky} settings) on the
  8282. frame. Minimum value is @code{0} and maximum is @code{blocky x blockx} (at
  8283. which point no frames will ever be detected as combed). This setting is known
  8284. as @option{MI} in TFM/VFM vocabulary.
  8285. Default value is @code{80}.
  8286. @end table
  8287. @anchor{p/c/n/u/b meaning}
  8288. @subsection p/c/n/u/b meaning
  8289. @subsubsection p/c/n
  8290. We assume the following telecined stream:
  8291. @example
  8292. Top fields: 1 2 2 3 4
  8293. Bottom fields: 1 2 3 4 4
  8294. @end example
  8295. The numbers correspond to the progressive frame the fields relate to. Here, the
  8296. first two frames are progressive, the 3rd and 4th are combed, and so on.
  8297. When @code{fieldmatch} is configured to run a matching from bottom
  8298. (@option{field}=@var{bottom}) this is how this input stream get transformed:
  8299. @example
  8300. Input stream:
  8301. T 1 2 2 3 4
  8302. B 1 2 3 4 4 <-- matching reference
  8303. Matches: c c n n c
  8304. Output stream:
  8305. T 1 2 3 4 4
  8306. B 1 2 3 4 4
  8307. @end example
  8308. As a result of the field matching, we can see that some frames get duplicated.
  8309. To perform a complete inverse telecine, you need to rely on a decimation filter
  8310. after this operation. See for instance the @ref{decimate} filter.
  8311. The same operation now matching from top fields (@option{field}=@var{top})
  8312. looks like this:
  8313. @example
  8314. Input stream:
  8315. T 1 2 2 3 4 <-- matching reference
  8316. B 1 2 3 4 4
  8317. Matches: c c p p c
  8318. Output stream:
  8319. T 1 2 2 3 4
  8320. B 1 2 2 3 4
  8321. @end example
  8322. In these examples, we can see what @var{p}, @var{c} and @var{n} mean;
  8323. basically, they refer to the frame and field of the opposite parity:
  8324. @itemize
  8325. @item @var{p} matches the field of the opposite parity in the previous frame
  8326. @item @var{c} matches the field of the opposite parity in the current frame
  8327. @item @var{n} matches the field of the opposite parity in the next frame
  8328. @end itemize
  8329. @subsubsection u/b
  8330. The @var{u} and @var{b} matching are a bit special in the sense that they match
  8331. from the opposite parity flag. In the following examples, we assume that we are
  8332. currently matching the 2nd frame (Top:2, bottom:2). According to the match, a
  8333. 'x' is placed above and below each matched fields.
  8334. With bottom matching (@option{field}=@var{bottom}):
  8335. @example
  8336. Match: c p n b u
  8337. x x x x x
  8338. Top 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2
  8339. Bottom 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3
  8340. x x x x x
  8341. Output frames:
  8342. 2 1 2 2 2
  8343. 2 2 2 1 3
  8344. @end example
  8345. With top matching (@option{field}=@var{top}):
  8346. @example
  8347. Match: c p n b u
  8348. x x x x x
  8349. Top 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2
  8350. Bottom 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3
  8351. x x x x x
  8352. Output frames:
  8353. 2 2 2 1 2
  8354. 2 1 3 2 2
  8355. @end example
  8356. @subsection Examples
  8357. Simple IVTC of a top field first telecined stream:
  8358. @example
  8359. fieldmatch=order=tff:combmatch=none, decimate
  8360. @end example
  8361. Advanced IVTC, with fallback on @ref{yadif} for still combed frames:
  8362. @example
  8363. fieldmatch=order=tff:combmatch=full, yadif=deint=interlaced, decimate
  8364. @end example
  8365. @section fieldorder
  8366. Transform the field order of the input video.
  8367. It accepts the following parameters:
  8368. @table @option
  8369. @item order
  8370. The output field order. Valid values are @var{tff} for top field first or @var{bff}
  8371. for bottom field first.
  8372. @end table
  8373. The default value is @samp{tff}.
  8374. The transformation is done by shifting the picture content up or down
  8375. by one line, and filling the remaining line with appropriate picture content.
  8376. This method is consistent with most broadcast field order converters.
  8377. If the input video is not flagged as being interlaced, or it is already
  8378. flagged as being of the required output field order, then this filter does
  8379. not alter the incoming video.
  8380. It is very useful when converting to or from PAL DV material,
  8381. which is bottom field first.
  8382. For example:
  8383. @example
  8384. ffmpeg -i in.vob -vf "fieldorder=bff" out.dv
  8385. @end example
  8386. @section fifo, afifo
  8387. Buffer input images and send them when they are requested.
  8388. It is mainly useful when auto-inserted by the libavfilter
  8389. framework.
  8390. It does not take parameters.
  8391. @section fillborders
  8392. Fill borders of the input video, without changing video stream dimensions.
  8393. Sometimes video can have garbage at the four edges and you may not want to
  8394. crop video input to keep size multiple of some number.
  8395. This filter accepts the following options:
  8396. @table @option
  8397. @item left
  8398. Number of pixels to fill from left border.
  8399. @item right
  8400. Number of pixels to fill from right border.
  8401. @item top
  8402. Number of pixels to fill from top border.
  8403. @item bottom
  8404. Number of pixels to fill from bottom border.
  8405. @item mode
  8406. Set fill mode.
  8407. It accepts the following values:
  8408. @table @samp
  8409. @item smear
  8410. fill pixels using outermost pixels
  8411. @item mirror
  8412. fill pixels using mirroring
  8413. @item fixed
  8414. fill pixels with constant value
  8415. @end table
  8416. Default is @var{smear}.
  8417. @item color
  8418. Set color for pixels in fixed mode. Default is @var{black}.
  8419. @end table
  8420. @subsection Commands
  8421. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options.
  8422. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  8423. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  8424. value.
  8425. @section find_rect
  8426. Find a rectangular object
  8427. It accepts the following options:
  8428. @table @option
  8429. @item object
  8430. Filepath of the object image, needs to be in gray8.
  8431. @item threshold
  8432. Detection threshold, default is 0.5.
  8433. @item mipmaps
  8434. Number of mipmaps, default is 3.
  8435. @item xmin, ymin, xmax, ymax
  8436. Specifies the rectangle in which to search.
  8437. @end table
  8438. @subsection Examples
  8439. @itemize
  8440. @item
  8441. Cover a rectangular object by the supplied image of a given video using @command{ffmpeg}:
  8442. @example
  8443. ffmpeg -i file.ts -vf find_rect=newref.pgm,cover_rect=cover.jpg:mode=cover new.mkv
  8444. @end example
  8445. @end itemize
  8446. @section floodfill
  8447. Flood area with values of same pixel components with another values.
  8448. It accepts the following options:
  8449. @table @option
  8450. @item x
  8451. Set pixel x coordinate.
  8452. @item y
  8453. Set pixel y coordinate.
  8454. @item s0
  8455. Set source #0 component value.
  8456. @item s1
  8457. Set source #1 component value.
  8458. @item s2
  8459. Set source #2 component value.
  8460. @item s3
  8461. Set source #3 component value.
  8462. @item d0
  8463. Set destination #0 component value.
  8464. @item d1
  8465. Set destination #1 component value.
  8466. @item d2
  8467. Set destination #2 component value.
  8468. @item d3
  8469. Set destination #3 component value.
  8470. @end table
  8471. @anchor{format}
  8472. @section format
  8473. Convert the input video to one of the specified pixel formats.
  8474. Libavfilter will try to pick one that is suitable as input to
  8475. the next filter.
  8476. It accepts the following parameters:
  8477. @table @option
  8478. @item pix_fmts
  8479. A '|'-separated list of pixel format names, such as
  8480. "pix_fmts=yuv420p|monow|rgb24".
  8481. @end table
  8482. @subsection Examples
  8483. @itemize
  8484. @item
  8485. Convert the input video to the @var{yuv420p} format
  8486. @example
  8487. format=pix_fmts=yuv420p
  8488. @end example
  8489. Convert the input video to any of the formats in the list
  8490. @example
  8491. format=pix_fmts=yuv420p|yuv444p|yuv410p
  8492. @end example
  8493. @end itemize
  8494. @anchor{fps}
  8495. @section fps
  8496. Convert the video to specified constant frame rate by duplicating or dropping
  8497. frames as necessary.
  8498. It accepts the following parameters:
  8499. @table @option
  8500. @item fps
  8501. The desired output frame rate. The default is @code{25}.
  8502. @item start_time
  8503. Assume the first PTS should be the given value, in seconds. This allows for
  8504. padding/trimming at the start of stream. By default, no assumption is made
  8505. about the first frame's expected PTS, so no padding or trimming is done.
  8506. For example, this could be set to 0 to pad the beginning with duplicates of
  8507. the first frame if a video stream starts after the audio stream or to trim any
  8508. frames with a negative PTS.
  8509. @item round
  8510. Timestamp (PTS) rounding method.
  8511. Possible values are:
  8512. @table @option
  8513. @item zero
  8514. round towards 0
  8515. @item inf
  8516. round away from 0
  8517. @item down
  8518. round towards -infinity
  8519. @item up
  8520. round towards +infinity
  8521. @item near
  8522. round to nearest
  8523. @end table
  8524. The default is @code{near}.
  8525. @item eof_action
  8526. Action performed when reading the last frame.
  8527. Possible values are:
  8528. @table @option
  8529. @item round
  8530. Use same timestamp rounding method as used for other frames.
  8531. @item pass
  8532. Pass through last frame if input duration has not been reached yet.
  8533. @end table
  8534. The default is @code{round}.
  8535. @end table
  8536. Alternatively, the options can be specified as a flat string:
  8537. @var{fps}[:@var{start_time}[:@var{round}]].
  8538. See also the @ref{setpts} filter.
  8539. @subsection Examples
  8540. @itemize
  8541. @item
  8542. A typical usage in order to set the fps to 25:
  8543. @example
  8544. fps=fps=25
  8545. @end example
  8546. @item
  8547. Sets the fps to 24, using abbreviation and rounding method to round to nearest:
  8548. @example
  8549. fps=fps=film:round=near
  8550. @end example
  8551. @end itemize
  8552. @section framepack
  8553. Pack two different video streams into a stereoscopic video, setting proper
  8554. metadata on supported codecs. The two views should have the same size and
  8555. framerate and processing will stop when the shorter video ends. Please note
  8556. that you may conveniently adjust view properties with the @ref{scale} and
  8557. @ref{fps} filters.
  8558. It accepts the following parameters:
  8559. @table @option
  8560. @item format
  8561. The desired packing format. Supported values are:
  8562. @table @option
  8563. @item sbs
  8564. The views are next to each other (default).
  8565. @item tab
  8566. The views are on top of each other.
  8567. @item lines
  8568. The views are packed by line.
  8569. @item columns
  8570. The views are packed by column.
  8571. @item frameseq
  8572. The views are temporally interleaved.
  8573. @end table
  8574. @end table
  8575. Some examples:
  8576. @example
  8577. # Convert left and right views into a frame-sequential video
  8578. ffmpeg -i LEFT -i RIGHT -filter_complex framepack=frameseq OUTPUT
  8579. # Convert views into a side-by-side video with the same output resolution as the input
  8580. ffmpeg -i LEFT -i RIGHT -filter_complex [0:v]scale=w=iw/2[left],[1:v]scale=w=iw/2[right],[left][right]framepack=sbs OUTPUT
  8581. @end example
  8582. @section framerate
  8583. Change the frame rate by interpolating new video output frames from the source
  8584. frames.
  8585. This filter is not designed to function correctly with interlaced media. If
  8586. you wish to change the frame rate of interlaced media then you are required
  8587. to deinterlace before this filter and re-interlace after this filter.
  8588. A description of the accepted options follows.
  8589. @table @option
  8590. @item fps
  8591. Specify the output frames per second. This option can also be specified
  8592. as a value alone. The default is @code{50}.
  8593. @item interp_start
  8594. Specify the start of a range where the output frame will be created as a
  8595. linear interpolation of two frames. The range is [@code{0}-@code{255}],
  8596. the default is @code{15}.
  8597. @item interp_end
  8598. Specify the end of a range where the output frame will be created as a
  8599. linear interpolation of two frames. The range is [@code{0}-@code{255}],
  8600. the default is @code{240}.
  8601. @item scene
  8602. Specify the level at which a scene change is detected as a value between
  8603. 0 and 100 to indicate a new scene; a low value reflects a low
  8604. probability for the current frame to introduce a new scene, while a higher
  8605. value means the current frame is more likely to be one.
  8606. The default is @code{8.2}.
  8607. @item flags
  8608. Specify flags influencing the filter process.
  8609. Available value for @var{flags} is:
  8610. @table @option
  8611. @item scene_change_detect, scd
  8612. Enable scene change detection using the value of the option @var{scene}.
  8613. This flag is enabled by default.
  8614. @end table
  8615. @end table
  8616. @section framestep
  8617. Select one frame every N-th frame.
  8618. This filter accepts the following option:
  8619. @table @option
  8620. @item step
  8621. Select frame after every @code{step} frames.
  8622. Allowed values are positive integers higher than 0. Default value is @code{1}.
  8623. @end table
  8624. @section freezedetect
  8625. Detect frozen video.
  8626. This filter logs a message and sets frame metadata when it detects that the
  8627. input video has no significant change in content during a specified duration.
  8628. Video freeze detection calculates the mean average absolute difference of all
  8629. the components of video frames and compares it to a noise floor.
  8630. The printed times and duration are expressed in seconds. The
  8631. @code{lavfi.freezedetect.freeze_start} metadata key is set on the first frame
  8632. whose timestamp equals or exceeds the detection duration and it contains the
  8633. timestamp of the first frame of the freeze. The
  8634. @code{lavfi.freezedetect.freeze_duration} and
  8635. @code{lavfi.freezedetect.freeze_end} metadata keys are set on the first frame
  8636. after the freeze.
  8637. The filter accepts the following options:
  8638. @table @option
  8639. @item noise, n
  8640. Set noise tolerance. Can be specified in dB (in case "dB" is appended to the
  8641. specified value) or as a difference ratio between 0 and 1. Default is -60dB, or
  8642. 0.001.
  8643. @item duration, d
  8644. Set freeze duration until notification (default is 2 seconds).
  8645. @end table
  8646. @section freezeframes
  8647. Freeze video frames.
  8648. This filter freezes video frames using frame from 2nd input.
  8649. The filter accepts the following options:
  8650. @table @option
  8651. @item first
  8652. Set number of first frame from which to start freeze.
  8653. @item last
  8654. Set number of last frame from which to end freeze.
  8655. @item replace
  8656. Set number of frame from 2nd input which will be used instead of replaced frames.
  8657. @end table
  8658. @anchor{frei0r}
  8659. @section frei0r
  8660. Apply a frei0r effect to the input video.
  8661. To enable the compilation of this filter, you need to install the frei0r
  8662. header and configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-frei0r}.
  8663. It accepts the following parameters:
  8664. @table @option
  8665. @item filter_name
  8666. The name of the frei0r effect to load. If the environment variable
  8667. @env{FREI0R_PATH} is defined, the frei0r effect is searched for in each of the
  8668. directories specified by the colon-separated list in @env{FREI0R_PATH}.
  8669. Otherwise, the standard frei0r paths are searched, in this order:
  8670. @file{HOME/.frei0r-1/lib/}, @file{/usr/local/lib/frei0r-1/},
  8671. @file{/usr/lib/frei0r-1/}.
  8672. @item filter_params
  8673. A '|'-separated list of parameters to pass to the frei0r effect.
  8674. @end table
  8675. A frei0r effect parameter can be a boolean (its value is either
  8676. "y" or "n"), a double, a color (specified as
  8677. @var{R}/@var{G}/@var{B}, where @var{R}, @var{G}, and @var{B} are floating point
  8678. numbers between 0.0 and 1.0, inclusive) or a color description as specified in the
  8679. @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils},
  8680. a position (specified as @var{X}/@var{Y}, where
  8681. @var{X} and @var{Y} are floating point numbers) and/or a string.
  8682. The number and types of parameters depend on the loaded effect. If an
  8683. effect parameter is not specified, the default value is set.
  8684. @subsection Examples
  8685. @itemize
  8686. @item
  8687. Apply the distort0r effect, setting the first two double parameters:
  8688. @example
  8689. frei0r=filter_name=distort0r:filter_params=0.5|0.01
  8690. @end example
  8691. @item
  8692. Apply the colordistance effect, taking a color as the first parameter:
  8693. @example
  8694. frei0r=colordistance:0.2/0.3/0.4
  8695. frei0r=colordistance:violet
  8696. frei0r=colordistance:0x112233
  8697. @end example
  8698. @item
  8699. Apply the perspective effect, specifying the top left and top right image
  8700. positions:
  8701. @example
  8702. frei0r=perspective:0.2/0.2|0.8/0.2
  8703. @end example
  8704. @end itemize
  8705. For more information, see
  8706. @url{http://frei0r.dyne.org}
  8707. @section fspp
  8708. Apply fast and simple postprocessing. It is a faster version of @ref{spp}.
  8709. It splits (I)DCT into horizontal/vertical passes. Unlike the simple post-
  8710. processing filter, one of them is performed once per block, not per pixel.
  8711. This allows for much higher speed.
  8712. The filter accepts the following options:
  8713. @table @option
  8714. @item quality
  8715. Set quality. This option defines the number of levels for averaging. It accepts
  8716. an integer in the range 4-5. Default value is @code{4}.
  8717. @item qp
  8718. Force a constant quantization parameter. It accepts an integer in range 0-63.
  8719. If not set, the filter will use the QP from the video stream (if available).
  8720. @item strength
  8721. Set filter strength. It accepts an integer in range -15 to 32. Lower values mean
  8722. more details but also more artifacts, while higher values make the image smoother
  8723. but also blurrier. Default value is @code{0} − PSNR optimal.
  8724. @item use_bframe_qp
  8725. Enable the use of the QP from the B-Frames if set to @code{1}. Using this
  8726. option may cause flicker since the B-Frames have often larger QP. Default is
  8727. @code{0} (not enabled).
  8728. @end table
  8729. @section gblur
  8730. Apply Gaussian blur filter.
  8731. The filter accepts the following options:
  8732. @table @option
  8733. @item sigma
  8734. Set horizontal sigma, standard deviation of Gaussian blur. Default is @code{0.5}.
  8735. @item steps
  8736. Set number of steps for Gaussian approximation. Default is @code{1}.
  8737. @item planes
  8738. Set which planes to filter. By default all planes are filtered.
  8739. @item sigmaV
  8740. Set vertical sigma, if negative it will be same as @code{sigma}.
  8741. Default is @code{-1}.
  8742. @end table
  8743. @subsection Commands
  8744. This filter supports same commands as options.
  8745. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  8746. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  8747. value.
  8748. @section geq
  8749. Apply generic equation to each pixel.
  8750. The filter accepts the following options:
  8751. @table @option
  8752. @item lum_expr, lum
  8753. Set the luminance expression.
  8754. @item cb_expr, cb
  8755. Set the chrominance blue expression.
  8756. @item cr_expr, cr
  8757. Set the chrominance red expression.
  8758. @item alpha_expr, a
  8759. Set the alpha expression.
  8760. @item red_expr, r
  8761. Set the red expression.
  8762. @item green_expr, g
  8763. Set the green expression.
  8764. @item blue_expr, b
  8765. Set the blue expression.
  8766. @end table
  8767. The colorspace is selected according to the specified options. If one
  8768. of the @option{lum_expr}, @option{cb_expr}, or @option{cr_expr}
  8769. options is specified, the filter will automatically select a YCbCr
  8770. colorspace. If one of the @option{red_expr}, @option{green_expr}, or
  8771. @option{blue_expr} options is specified, it will select an RGB
  8772. colorspace.
  8773. If one of the chrominance expression is not defined, it falls back on the other
  8774. one. If no alpha expression is specified it will evaluate to opaque value.
  8775. If none of chrominance expressions are specified, they will evaluate
  8776. to the luminance expression.
  8777. The expressions can use the following variables and functions:
  8778. @table @option
  8779. @item N
  8780. The sequential number of the filtered frame, starting from @code{0}.
  8781. @item X
  8782. @item Y
  8783. The coordinates of the current sample.
  8784. @item W
  8785. @item H
  8786. The width and height of the image.
  8787. @item SW
  8788. @item SH
  8789. Width and height scale depending on the currently filtered plane. It is the
  8790. ratio between the corresponding luma plane number of pixels and the current
  8791. plane ones. E.g. for YUV4:2:0 the values are @code{1,1} for the luma plane, and
  8792. @code{0.5,0.5} for chroma planes.
  8793. @item T
  8794. Time of the current frame, expressed in seconds.
  8795. @item p(x, y)
  8796. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the current
  8797. plane.
  8798. @item lum(x, y)
  8799. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the luminance
  8800. plane.
  8801. @item cb(x, y)
  8802. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the
  8803. blue-difference chroma plane. Return 0 if there is no such plane.
  8804. @item cr(x, y)
  8805. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the
  8806. red-difference chroma plane. Return 0 if there is no such plane.
  8807. @item r(x, y)
  8808. @item g(x, y)
  8809. @item b(x, y)
  8810. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the
  8811. red/green/blue component. Return 0 if there is no such component.
  8812. @item alpha(x, y)
  8813. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the alpha
  8814. plane. Return 0 if there is no such plane.
  8815. @item psum(x,y), lumsum(x, y), cbsum(x,y), crsum(x,y), rsum(x,y), gsum(x,y), bsum(x,y), alphasum(x,y)
  8816. Sum of sample values in the rectangle from (0,0) to (x,y), this allows obtaining
  8817. sums of samples within a rectangle. See the functions without the sum postfix.
  8818. @item interpolation
  8819. Set one of interpolation methods:
  8820. @table @option
  8821. @item nearest, n
  8822. @item bilinear, b
  8823. @end table
  8824. Default is bilinear.
  8825. @end table
  8826. For functions, if @var{x} and @var{y} are outside the area, the value will be
  8827. automatically clipped to the closer edge.
  8828. Please note that this filter can use multiple threads in which case each slice
  8829. will have its own expression state. If you want to use only a single expression
  8830. state because your expressions depend on previous state then you should limit
  8831. the number of filter threads to 1.
  8832. @subsection Examples
  8833. @itemize
  8834. @item
  8835. Flip the image horizontally:
  8836. @example
  8837. geq=p(W-X\,Y)
  8838. @end example
  8839. @item
  8840. Generate a bidimensional sine wave, with angle @code{PI/3} and a
  8841. wavelength of 100 pixels:
  8842. @example
  8843. geq=128 + 100*sin(2*(PI/100)*(cos(PI/3)*(X-50*T) + sin(PI/3)*Y)):128:128
  8844. @end example
  8845. @item
  8846. Generate a fancy enigmatic moving light:
  8847. @example
  8848. nullsrc=s=256x256,geq=random(1)/hypot(X-cos(N*0.07)*W/2-W/2\,Y-sin(N*0.09)*H/2-H/2)^2*1000000*sin(N*0.02):128:128
  8849. @end example
  8850. @item
  8851. Generate a quick emboss effect:
  8852. @example
  8853. format=gray,geq=lum_expr='(p(X,Y)+(256-p(X-4,Y-4)))/2'
  8854. @end example
  8855. @item
  8856. Modify RGB components depending on pixel position:
  8857. @example
  8858. geq=r='X/W*r(X,Y)':g='(1-X/W)*g(X,Y)':b='(H-Y)/H*b(X,Y)'
  8859. @end example
  8860. @item
  8861. Create a radial gradient that is the same size as the input (also see
  8862. the @ref{vignette} filter):
  8863. @example
  8864. geq=lum=255*gauss((X/W-0.5)*3)*gauss((Y/H-0.5)*3)/gauss(0)/gauss(0),format=gray
  8865. @end example
  8866. @end itemize
  8867. @section gradfun
  8868. Fix the banding artifacts that are sometimes introduced into nearly flat
  8869. regions by truncation to 8-bit color depth.
  8870. Interpolate the gradients that should go where the bands are, and
  8871. dither them.
  8872. It is designed for playback only. Do not use it prior to
  8873. lossy compression, because compression tends to lose the dither and
  8874. bring back the bands.
  8875. It accepts the following parameters:
  8876. @table @option
  8877. @item strength
  8878. The maximum amount by which the filter will change any one pixel. This is also
  8879. the threshold for detecting nearly flat regions. Acceptable values range from
  8880. .51 to 64; the default value is 1.2. Out-of-range values will be clipped to the
  8881. valid range.
  8882. @item radius
  8883. The neighborhood to fit the gradient to. A larger radius makes for smoother
  8884. gradients, but also prevents the filter from modifying the pixels near detailed
  8885. regions. Acceptable values are 8-32; the default value is 16. Out-of-range
  8886. values will be clipped to the valid range.
  8887. @end table
  8888. Alternatively, the options can be specified as a flat string:
  8889. @var{strength}[:@var{radius}]
  8890. @subsection Examples
  8891. @itemize
  8892. @item
  8893. Apply the filter with a @code{3.5} strength and radius of @code{8}:
  8894. @example
  8895. gradfun=3.5:8
  8896. @end example
  8897. @item
  8898. Specify radius, omitting the strength (which will fall-back to the default
  8899. value):
  8900. @example
  8901. gradfun=radius=8
  8902. @end example
  8903. @end itemize
  8904. @anchor{graphmonitor}
  8905. @section graphmonitor
  8906. Show various filtergraph stats.
  8907. With this filter one can debug complete filtergraph.
  8908. Especially issues with links filling with queued frames.
  8909. The filter accepts the following options:
  8910. @table @option
  8911. @item size, s
  8912. Set video output size. Default is @var{hd720}.
  8913. @item opacity, o
  8914. Set video opacity. Default is @var{0.9}. Allowed range is from @var{0} to @var{1}.
  8915. @item mode, m
  8916. Set output mode, can be @var{fulll} or @var{compact}.
  8917. In @var{compact} mode only filters with some queued frames have displayed stats.
  8918. @item flags, f
  8919. Set flags which enable which stats are shown in video.
  8920. Available values for flags are:
  8921. @table @samp
  8922. @item queue
  8923. Display number of queued frames in each link.
  8924. @item frame_count_in
  8925. Display number of frames taken from filter.
  8926. @item frame_count_out
  8927. Display number of frames given out from filter.
  8928. @item pts
  8929. Display current filtered frame pts.
  8930. @item time
  8931. Display current filtered frame time.
  8932. @item timebase
  8933. Display time base for filter link.
  8934. @item format
  8935. Display used format for filter link.
  8936. @item size
  8937. Display video size or number of audio channels in case of audio used by filter link.
  8938. @item rate
  8939. Display video frame rate or sample rate in case of audio used by filter link.
  8940. @end table
  8941. @item rate, r
  8942. Set upper limit for video rate of output stream, Default value is @var{25}.
  8943. This guarantee that output video frame rate will not be higher than this value.
  8944. @end table
  8945. @section greyedge
  8946. A color constancy variation filter which estimates scene illumination via grey edge algorithm
  8947. and corrects the scene colors accordingly.
  8948. See: @url{https://staff.science.uva.nl/th.gevers/pub/GeversTIP07.pdf}
  8949. The filter accepts the following options:
  8950. @table @option
  8951. @item difford
  8952. The order of differentiation to be applied on the scene. Must be chosen in the range
  8953. [0,2] and default value is 1.
  8954. @item minknorm
  8955. The Minkowski parameter to be used for calculating the Minkowski distance. Must
  8956. be chosen in the range [0,20] and default value is 1. Set to 0 for getting
  8957. max value instead of calculating Minkowski distance.
  8958. @item sigma
  8959. The standard deviation of Gaussian blur to be applied on the scene. Must be
  8960. chosen in the range [0,1024.0] and default value = 1. floor( @var{sigma} * break_off_sigma(3) )
  8961. can't be equal to 0 if @var{difford} is greater than 0.
  8962. @end table
  8963. @subsection Examples
  8964. @itemize
  8965. @item
  8966. Grey Edge:
  8967. @example
  8968. greyedge=difford=1:minknorm=5:sigma=2
  8969. @end example
  8970. @item
  8971. Max Edge:
  8972. @example
  8973. greyedge=difford=1:minknorm=0:sigma=2
  8974. @end example
  8975. @end itemize
  8976. @anchor{haldclut}
  8977. @section haldclut
  8978. Apply a Hald CLUT to a video stream.
  8979. First input is the video stream to process, and second one is the Hald CLUT.
  8980. The Hald CLUT input can be a simple picture or a complete video stream.
  8981. The filter accepts the following options:
  8982. @table @option
  8983. @item shortest
  8984. Force termination when the shortest input terminates. Default is @code{0}.
  8985. @item repeatlast
  8986. Continue applying the last CLUT after the end of the stream. A value of
  8987. @code{0} disable the filter after the last frame of the CLUT is reached.
  8988. Default is @code{1}.
  8989. @end table
  8990. @code{haldclut} also has the same interpolation options as @ref{lut3d} (both
  8991. filters share the same internals).
  8992. This filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  8993. More information about the Hald CLUT can be found on Eskil Steenberg's website
  8994. (Hald CLUT author) at @url{http://www.quelsolaar.com/technology/clut.html}.
  8995. @subsection Workflow examples
  8996. @subsubsection Hald CLUT video stream
  8997. Generate an identity Hald CLUT stream altered with various effects:
  8998. @example
  8999. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i @ref{haldclutsrc}=8 -vf "hue=H=2*PI*t:s=sin(2*PI*t)+1, curves=cross_process" -t 10 -c:v ffv1 clut.nut
  9000. @end example
  9001. Note: make sure you use a lossless codec.
  9002. Then use it with @code{haldclut} to apply it on some random stream:
  9003. @example
  9004. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i mandelbrot -i clut.nut -filter_complex '[0][1] haldclut' -t 20 mandelclut.mkv
  9005. @end example
  9006. The Hald CLUT will be applied to the 10 first seconds (duration of
  9007. @file{clut.nut}), then the latest picture of that CLUT stream will be applied
  9008. to the remaining frames of the @code{mandelbrot} stream.
  9009. @subsubsection Hald CLUT with preview
  9010. A Hald CLUT is supposed to be a squared image of @code{Level*Level*Level} by
  9011. @code{Level*Level*Level} pixels. For a given Hald CLUT, FFmpeg will select the
  9012. biggest possible square starting at the top left of the picture. The remaining
  9013. padding pixels (bottom or right) will be ignored. This area can be used to add
  9014. a preview of the Hald CLUT.
  9015. Typically, the following generated Hald CLUT will be supported by the
  9016. @code{haldclut} filter:
  9017. @example
  9018. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i @ref{haldclutsrc}=8 -vf "
  9019. pad=iw+320 [padded_clut];
  9020. smptebars=s=320x256, split [a][b];
  9021. [padded_clut][a] overlay=W-320:h, curves=color_negative [main];
  9022. [main][b] overlay=W-320" -frames:v 1 clut.png
  9023. @end example
  9024. It contains the original and a preview of the effect of the CLUT: SMPTE color
  9025. bars are displayed on the right-top, and below the same color bars processed by
  9026. the color changes.
  9027. Then, the effect of this Hald CLUT can be visualized with:
  9028. @example
  9029. ffplay input.mkv -vf "movie=clut.png, [in] haldclut"
  9030. @end example
  9031. @section hflip
  9032. Flip the input video horizontally.
  9033. For example, to horizontally flip the input video with @command{ffmpeg}:
  9034. @example
  9035. ffmpeg -i in.avi -vf "hflip" out.avi
  9036. @end example
  9037. @section histeq
  9038. This filter applies a global color histogram equalization on a
  9039. per-frame basis.
  9040. It can be used to correct video that has a compressed range of pixel
  9041. intensities. The filter redistributes the pixel intensities to
  9042. equalize their distribution across the intensity range. It may be
  9043. viewed as an "automatically adjusting contrast filter". This filter is
  9044. useful only for correcting degraded or poorly captured source
  9045. video.
  9046. The filter accepts the following options:
  9047. @table @option
  9048. @item strength
  9049. Determine the amount of equalization to be applied. As the strength
  9050. is reduced, the distribution of pixel intensities more-and-more
  9051. approaches that of the input frame. The value must be a float number
  9052. in the range [0,1] and defaults to 0.200.
  9053. @item intensity
  9054. Set the maximum intensity that can generated and scale the output
  9055. values appropriately. The strength should be set as desired and then
  9056. the intensity can be limited if needed to avoid washing-out. The value
  9057. must be a float number in the range [0,1] and defaults to 0.210.
  9058. @item antibanding
  9059. Set the antibanding level. If enabled the filter will randomly vary
  9060. the luminance of output pixels by a small amount to avoid banding of
  9061. the histogram. Possible values are @code{none}, @code{weak} or
  9062. @code{strong}. It defaults to @code{none}.
  9063. @end table
  9064. @anchor{histogram}
  9065. @section histogram
  9066. Compute and draw a color distribution histogram for the input video.
  9067. The computed histogram is a representation of the color component
  9068. distribution in an image.
  9069. Standard histogram displays the color components distribution in an image.
  9070. Displays color graph for each color component. Shows distribution of
  9071. the Y, U, V, A or R, G, B components, depending on input format, in the
  9072. current frame. Below each graph a color component scale meter is shown.
  9073. The filter accepts the following options:
  9074. @table @option
  9075. @item level_height
  9076. Set height of level. Default value is @code{200}.
  9077. Allowed range is [50, 2048].
  9078. @item scale_height
  9079. Set height of color scale. Default value is @code{12}.
  9080. Allowed range is [0, 40].
  9081. @item display_mode
  9082. Set display mode.
  9083. It accepts the following values:
  9084. @table @samp
  9085. @item stack
  9086. Per color component graphs are placed below each other.
  9087. @item parade
  9088. Per color component graphs are placed side by side.
  9089. @item overlay
  9090. Presents information identical to that in the @code{parade}, except
  9091. that the graphs representing color components are superimposed directly
  9092. over one another.
  9093. @end table
  9094. Default is @code{stack}.
  9095. @item levels_mode
  9096. Set mode. Can be either @code{linear}, or @code{logarithmic}.
  9097. Default is @code{linear}.
  9098. @item components
  9099. Set what color components to display.
  9100. Default is @code{7}.
  9101. @item fgopacity
  9102. Set foreground opacity. Default is @code{0.7}.
  9103. @item bgopacity
  9104. Set background opacity. Default is @code{0.5}.
  9105. @end table
  9106. @subsection Examples
  9107. @itemize
  9108. @item
  9109. Calculate and draw histogram:
  9110. @example
  9111. ffplay -i input -vf histogram
  9112. @end example
  9113. @end itemize
  9114. @anchor{hqdn3d}
  9115. @section hqdn3d
  9116. This is a high precision/quality 3d denoise filter. It aims to reduce
  9117. image noise, producing smooth images and making still images really
  9118. still. It should enhance compressibility.
  9119. It accepts the following optional parameters:
  9120. @table @option
  9121. @item luma_spatial
  9122. A non-negative floating point number which specifies spatial luma strength.
  9123. It defaults to 4.0.
  9124. @item chroma_spatial
  9125. A non-negative floating point number which specifies spatial chroma strength.
  9126. It defaults to 3.0*@var{luma_spatial}/4.0.
  9127. @item luma_tmp
  9128. A floating point number which specifies luma temporal strength. It defaults to
  9129. 6.0*@var{luma_spatial}/4.0.
  9130. @item chroma_tmp
  9131. A floating point number which specifies chroma temporal strength. It defaults to
  9132. @var{luma_tmp}*@var{chroma_spatial}/@var{luma_spatial}.
  9133. @end table
  9134. @subsection Commands
  9135. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options.
  9136. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  9137. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  9138. value.
  9139. @anchor{hwdownload}
  9140. @section hwdownload
  9141. Download hardware frames to system memory.
  9142. The input must be in hardware frames, and the output a non-hardware format.
  9143. Not all formats will be supported on the output - it may be necessary to insert
  9144. an additional @option{format} filter immediately following in the graph to get
  9145. the output in a supported format.
  9146. @section hwmap
  9147. Map hardware frames to system memory or to another device.
  9148. This filter has several different modes of operation; which one is used depends
  9149. on the input and output formats:
  9150. @itemize
  9151. @item
  9152. Hardware frame input, normal frame output
  9153. Map the input frames to system memory and pass them to the output. If the
  9154. original hardware frame is later required (for example, after overlaying
  9155. something else on part of it), the @option{hwmap} filter can be used again
  9156. in the next mode to retrieve it.
  9157. @item
  9158. Normal frame input, hardware frame output
  9159. If the input is actually a software-mapped hardware frame, then unmap it -
  9160. that is, return the original hardware frame.
  9161. Otherwise, a device must be provided. Create new hardware surfaces on that
  9162. device for the output, then map them back to the software format at the input
  9163. and give those frames to the preceding filter. This will then act like the
  9164. @option{hwupload} filter, but may be able to avoid an additional copy when
  9165. the input is already in a compatible format.
  9166. @item
  9167. Hardware frame input and output
  9168. A device must be supplied for the output, either directly or with the
  9169. @option{derive_device} option. The input and output devices must be of
  9170. different types and compatible - the exact meaning of this is
  9171. system-dependent, but typically it means that they must refer to the same
  9172. underlying hardware context (for example, refer to the same graphics card).
  9173. If the input frames were originally created on the output device, then unmap
  9174. to retrieve the original frames.
  9175. Otherwise, map the frames to the output device - create new hardware frames
  9176. on the output corresponding to the frames on the input.
  9177. @end itemize
  9178. The following additional parameters are accepted:
  9179. @table @option
  9180. @item mode
  9181. Set the frame mapping mode. Some combination of:
  9182. @table @var
  9183. @item read
  9184. The mapped frame should be readable.
  9185. @item write
  9186. The mapped frame should be writeable.
  9187. @item overwrite
  9188. The mapping will always overwrite the entire frame.
  9189. This may improve performance in some cases, as the original contents of the
  9190. frame need not be loaded.
  9191. @item direct
  9192. The mapping must not involve any copying.
  9193. Indirect mappings to copies of frames are created in some cases where either
  9194. direct mapping is not possible or it would have unexpected properties.
  9195. Setting this flag ensures that the mapping is direct and will fail if that is
  9196. not possible.
  9197. @end table
  9198. Defaults to @var{read+write} if not specified.
  9199. @item derive_device @var{type}
  9200. Rather than using the device supplied at initialisation, instead derive a new
  9201. device of type @var{type} from the device the input frames exist on.
  9202. @item reverse
  9203. In a hardware to hardware mapping, map in reverse - create frames in the sink
  9204. and map them back to the source. This may be necessary in some cases where
  9205. a mapping in one direction is required but only the opposite direction is
  9206. supported by the devices being used.
  9207. This option is dangerous - it may break the preceding filter in undefined
  9208. ways if there are any additional constraints on that filter's output.
  9209. Do not use it without fully understanding the implications of its use.
  9210. @end table
  9211. @anchor{hwupload}
  9212. @section hwupload
  9213. Upload system memory frames to hardware surfaces.
  9214. The device to upload to must be supplied when the filter is initialised. If
  9215. using ffmpeg, select the appropriate device with the @option{-filter_hw_device}
  9216. option or with the @option{derive_device} option. The input and output devices
  9217. must be of different types and compatible - the exact meaning of this is
  9218. system-dependent, but typically it means that they must refer to the same
  9219. underlying hardware context (for example, refer to the same graphics card).
  9220. The following additional parameters are accepted:
  9221. @table @option
  9222. @item derive_device @var{type}
  9223. Rather than using the device supplied at initialisation, instead derive a new
  9224. device of type @var{type} from the device the input frames exist on.
  9225. @end table
  9226. @anchor{hwupload_cuda}
  9227. @section hwupload_cuda
  9228. Upload system memory frames to a CUDA device.
  9229. It accepts the following optional parameters:
  9230. @table @option
  9231. @item device
  9232. The number of the CUDA device to use
  9233. @end table
  9234. @section hqx
  9235. Apply a high-quality magnification filter designed for pixel art. This filter
  9236. was originally created by Maxim Stepin.
  9237. It accepts the following option:
  9238. @table @option
  9239. @item n
  9240. Set the scaling dimension: @code{2} for @code{hq2x}, @code{3} for
  9241. @code{hq3x} and @code{4} for @code{hq4x}.
  9242. Default is @code{3}.
  9243. @end table
  9244. @section hstack
  9245. Stack input videos horizontally.
  9246. All streams must be of same pixel format and of same height.
  9247. Note that this filter is faster than using @ref{overlay} and @ref{pad} filter
  9248. to create same output.
  9249. The filter accepts the following option:
  9250. @table @option
  9251. @item inputs
  9252. Set number of input streams. Default is 2.
  9253. @item shortest
  9254. If set to 1, force the output to terminate when the shortest input
  9255. terminates. Default value is 0.
  9256. @end table
  9257. @section hue
  9258. Modify the hue and/or the saturation of the input.
  9259. It accepts the following parameters:
  9260. @table @option
  9261. @item h
  9262. Specify the hue angle as a number of degrees. It accepts an expression,
  9263. and defaults to "0".
  9264. @item s
  9265. Specify the saturation in the [-10,10] range. It accepts an expression and
  9266. defaults to "1".
  9267. @item H
  9268. Specify the hue angle as a number of radians. It accepts an
  9269. expression, and defaults to "0".
  9270. @item b
  9271. Specify the brightness in the [-10,10] range. It accepts an expression and
  9272. defaults to "0".
  9273. @end table
  9274. @option{h} and @option{H} are mutually exclusive, and can't be
  9275. specified at the same time.
  9276. The @option{b}, @option{h}, @option{H} and @option{s} option values are
  9277. expressions containing the following constants:
  9278. @table @option
  9279. @item n
  9280. frame count of the input frame starting from 0
  9281. @item pts
  9282. presentation timestamp of the input frame expressed in time base units
  9283. @item r
  9284. frame rate of the input video, NAN if the input frame rate is unknown
  9285. @item t
  9286. timestamp expressed in seconds, NAN if the input timestamp is unknown
  9287. @item tb
  9288. time base of the input video
  9289. @end table
  9290. @subsection Examples
  9291. @itemize
  9292. @item
  9293. Set the hue to 90 degrees and the saturation to 1.0:
  9294. @example
  9295. hue=h=90:s=1
  9296. @end example
  9297. @item
  9298. Same command but expressing the hue in radians:
  9299. @example
  9300. hue=H=PI/2:s=1
  9301. @end example
  9302. @item
  9303. Rotate hue and make the saturation swing between 0
  9304. and 2 over a period of 1 second:
  9305. @example
  9306. hue="H=2*PI*t: s=sin(2*PI*t)+1"
  9307. @end example
  9308. @item
  9309. Apply a 3 seconds saturation fade-in effect starting at 0:
  9310. @example
  9311. hue="s=min(t/3\,1)"
  9312. @end example
  9313. The general fade-in expression can be written as:
  9314. @example
  9315. hue="s=min(0\, max((t-START)/DURATION\, 1))"
  9316. @end example
  9317. @item
  9318. Apply a 3 seconds saturation fade-out effect starting at 5 seconds:
  9319. @example
  9320. hue="s=max(0\, min(1\, (8-t)/3))"
  9321. @end example
  9322. The general fade-out expression can be written as:
  9323. @example
  9324. hue="s=max(0\, min(1\, (START+DURATION-t)/DURATION))"
  9325. @end example
  9326. @end itemize
  9327. @subsection Commands
  9328. This filter supports the following commands:
  9329. @table @option
  9330. @item b
  9331. @item s
  9332. @item h
  9333. @item H
  9334. Modify the hue and/or the saturation and/or brightness of the input video.
  9335. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  9336. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  9337. value.
  9338. @end table
  9339. @section hysteresis
  9340. Grow first stream into second stream by connecting components.
  9341. This makes it possible to build more robust edge masks.
  9342. This filter accepts the following options:
  9343. @table @option
  9344. @item planes
  9345. Set which planes will be processed as bitmap, unprocessed planes will be
  9346. copied from first stream.
  9347. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  9348. @item threshold
  9349. Set threshold which is used in filtering. If pixel component value is higher than
  9350. this value filter algorithm for connecting components is activated.
  9351. By default value is 0.
  9352. @end table
  9353. The @code{hysteresis} filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  9354. @section idet
  9355. Detect video interlacing type.
  9356. This filter tries to detect if the input frames are interlaced, progressive,
  9357. top or bottom field first. It will also try to detect fields that are
  9358. repeated between adjacent frames (a sign of telecine).
  9359. Single frame detection considers only immediately adjacent frames when classifying each frame.
  9360. Multiple frame detection incorporates the classification history of previous frames.
  9361. The filter will log these metadata values:
  9362. @table @option
  9363. @item single.current_frame
  9364. Detected type of current frame using single-frame detection. One of:
  9365. ``tff'' (top field first), ``bff'' (bottom field first),
  9366. ``progressive'', or ``undetermined''
  9367. @item single.tff
  9368. Cumulative number of frames detected as top field first using single-frame detection.
  9369. @item multiple.tff
  9370. Cumulative number of frames detected as top field first using multiple-frame detection.
  9371. @item single.bff
  9372. Cumulative number of frames detected as bottom field first using single-frame detection.
  9373. @item multiple.current_frame
  9374. Detected type of current frame using multiple-frame detection. One of:
  9375. ``tff'' (top field first), ``bff'' (bottom field first),
  9376. ``progressive'', or ``undetermined''
  9377. @item multiple.bff
  9378. Cumulative number of frames detected as bottom field first using multiple-frame detection.
  9379. @item single.progressive
  9380. Cumulative number of frames detected as progressive using single-frame detection.
  9381. @item multiple.progressive
  9382. Cumulative number of frames detected as progressive using multiple-frame detection.
  9383. @item single.undetermined
  9384. Cumulative number of frames that could not be classified using single-frame detection.
  9385. @item multiple.undetermined
  9386. Cumulative number of frames that could not be classified using multiple-frame detection.
  9387. @item repeated.current_frame
  9388. Which field in the current frame is repeated from the last. One of ``neither'', ``top'', or ``bottom''.
  9389. @item repeated.neither
  9390. Cumulative number of frames with no repeated field.
  9391. @item repeated.top
  9392. Cumulative number of frames with the top field repeated from the previous frame's top field.
  9393. @item repeated.bottom
  9394. Cumulative number of frames with the bottom field repeated from the previous frame's bottom field.
  9395. @end table
  9396. The filter accepts the following options:
  9397. @table @option
  9398. @item intl_thres
  9399. Set interlacing threshold.
  9400. @item prog_thres
  9401. Set progressive threshold.
  9402. @item rep_thres
  9403. Threshold for repeated field detection.
  9404. @item half_life
  9405. Number of frames after which a given frame's contribution to the
  9406. statistics is halved (i.e., it contributes only 0.5 to its
  9407. classification). The default of 0 means that all frames seen are given
  9408. full weight of 1.0 forever.
  9409. @item analyze_interlaced_flag
  9410. When this is not 0 then idet will use the specified number of frames to determine
  9411. if the interlaced flag is accurate, it will not count undetermined frames.
  9412. If the flag is found to be accurate it will be used without any further
  9413. computations, if it is found to be inaccurate it will be cleared without any
  9414. further computations. This allows inserting the idet filter as a low computational
  9415. method to clean up the interlaced flag
  9416. @end table
  9417. @section il
  9418. Deinterleave or interleave fields.
  9419. This filter allows one to process interlaced images fields without
  9420. deinterlacing them. Deinterleaving splits the input frame into 2
  9421. fields (so called half pictures). Odd lines are moved to the top
  9422. half of the output image, even lines to the bottom half.
  9423. You can process (filter) them independently and then re-interleave them.
  9424. The filter accepts the following options:
  9425. @table @option
  9426. @item luma_mode, l
  9427. @item chroma_mode, c
  9428. @item alpha_mode, a
  9429. Available values for @var{luma_mode}, @var{chroma_mode} and
  9430. @var{alpha_mode} are:
  9431. @table @samp
  9432. @item none
  9433. Do nothing.
  9434. @item deinterleave, d
  9435. Deinterleave fields, placing one above the other.
  9436. @item interleave, i
  9437. Interleave fields. Reverse the effect of deinterleaving.
  9438. @end table
  9439. Default value is @code{none}.
  9440. @item luma_swap, ls
  9441. @item chroma_swap, cs
  9442. @item alpha_swap, as
  9443. Swap luma/chroma/alpha fields. Exchange even & odd lines. Default value is @code{0}.
  9444. @end table
  9445. @subsection Commands
  9446. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  9447. @section inflate
  9448. Apply inflate effect to the video.
  9449. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) average by taking into account
  9450. only values higher than the pixel.
  9451. It accepts the following options:
  9452. @table @option
  9453. @item threshold0
  9454. @item threshold1
  9455. @item threshold2
  9456. @item threshold3
  9457. Limit the maximum change for each plane, default is 65535.
  9458. If 0, plane will remain unchanged.
  9459. @end table
  9460. @subsection Commands
  9461. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  9462. @section interlace
  9463. Simple interlacing filter from progressive contents. This interleaves upper (or
  9464. lower) lines from odd frames with lower (or upper) lines from even frames,
  9465. halving the frame rate and preserving image height.
  9466. @example
  9467. Original Original New Frame
  9468. Frame 'j' Frame 'j+1' (tff)
  9469. ========== =========== ==================
  9470. Line 0 --------------------> Frame 'j' Line 0
  9471. Line 1 Line 1 ----> Frame 'j+1' Line 1
  9472. Line 2 ---------------------> Frame 'j' Line 2
  9473. Line 3 Line 3 ----> Frame 'j+1' Line 3
  9474. ... ... ...
  9475. New Frame + 1 will be generated by Frame 'j+2' and Frame 'j+3' and so on
  9476. @end example
  9477. It accepts the following optional parameters:
  9478. @table @option
  9479. @item scan
  9480. This determines whether the interlaced frame is taken from the even
  9481. (tff - default) or odd (bff) lines of the progressive frame.
  9482. @item lowpass
  9483. Vertical lowpass filter to avoid twitter interlacing and
  9484. reduce moire patterns.
  9485. @table @samp
  9486. @item 0, off
  9487. Disable vertical lowpass filter
  9488. @item 1, linear
  9489. Enable linear filter (default)
  9490. @item 2, complex
  9491. Enable complex filter. This will slightly less reduce twitter and moire
  9492. but better retain detail and subjective sharpness impression.
  9493. @end table
  9494. @end table
  9495. @section kerndeint
  9496. Deinterlace input video by applying Donald Graft's adaptive kernel
  9497. deinterling. Work on interlaced parts of a video to produce
  9498. progressive frames.
  9499. The description of the accepted parameters follows.
  9500. @table @option
  9501. @item thresh
  9502. Set the threshold which affects the filter's tolerance when
  9503. determining if a pixel line must be processed. It must be an integer
  9504. in the range [0,255] and defaults to 10. A value of 0 will result in
  9505. applying the process on every pixels.
  9506. @item map
  9507. Paint pixels exceeding the threshold value to white if set to 1.
  9508. Default is 0.
  9509. @item order
  9510. Set the fields order. Swap fields if set to 1, leave fields alone if
  9511. 0. Default is 0.
  9512. @item sharp
  9513. Enable additional sharpening if set to 1. Default is 0.
  9514. @item twoway
  9515. Enable twoway sharpening if set to 1. Default is 0.
  9516. @end table
  9517. @subsection Examples
  9518. @itemize
  9519. @item
  9520. Apply default values:
  9521. @example
  9522. kerndeint=thresh=10:map=0:order=0:sharp=0:twoway=0
  9523. @end example
  9524. @item
  9525. Enable additional sharpening:
  9526. @example
  9527. kerndeint=sharp=1
  9528. @end example
  9529. @item
  9530. Paint processed pixels in white:
  9531. @example
  9532. kerndeint=map=1
  9533. @end example
  9534. @end itemize
  9535. @section lagfun
  9536. Slowly update darker pixels.
  9537. This filter makes short flashes of light appear longer.
  9538. This filter accepts the following options:
  9539. @table @option
  9540. @item decay
  9541. Set factor for decaying. Default is .95. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  9542. @item planes
  9543. Set which planes to filter. Default is all. Allowed range is from 0 to 15.
  9544. @end table
  9545. @section lenscorrection
  9546. Correct radial lens distortion
  9547. This filter can be used to correct for radial distortion as can result from the use
  9548. of wide angle lenses, and thereby re-rectify the image. To find the right parameters
  9549. one can use tools available for example as part of opencv or simply trial-and-error.
  9550. To use opencv use the calibration sample (under samples/cpp) from the opencv sources
  9551. and extract the k1 and k2 coefficients from the resulting matrix.
  9552. Note that effectively the same filter is available in the open-source tools Krita and
  9553. Digikam from the KDE project.
  9554. In contrast to the @ref{vignette} filter, which can also be used to compensate lens errors,
  9555. this filter corrects the distortion of the image, whereas @ref{vignette} corrects the
  9556. brightness distribution, so you may want to use both filters together in certain
  9557. cases, though you will have to take care of ordering, i.e. whether vignetting should
  9558. be applied before or after lens correction.
  9559. @subsection Options
  9560. The filter accepts the following options:
  9561. @table @option
  9562. @item cx
  9563. Relative x-coordinate of the focal point of the image, and thereby the center of the
  9564. distortion. This value has a range [0,1] and is expressed as fractions of the image
  9565. width. Default is 0.5.
  9566. @item cy
  9567. Relative y-coordinate of the focal point of the image, and thereby the center of the
  9568. distortion. This value has a range [0,1] and is expressed as fractions of the image
  9569. height. Default is 0.5.
  9570. @item k1
  9571. Coefficient of the quadratic correction term. This value has a range [-1,1]. 0 means
  9572. no correction. Default is 0.
  9573. @item k2
  9574. Coefficient of the double quadratic correction term. This value has a range [-1,1].
  9575. 0 means no correction. Default is 0.
  9576. @end table
  9577. The formula that generates the correction is:
  9578. @var{r_src} = @var{r_tgt} * (1 + @var{k1} * (@var{r_tgt} / @var{r_0})^2 + @var{k2} * (@var{r_tgt} / @var{r_0})^4)
  9579. where @var{r_0} is halve of the image diagonal and @var{r_src} and @var{r_tgt} are the
  9580. distances from the focal point in the source and target images, respectively.
  9581. @section lensfun
  9582. Apply lens correction via the lensfun library (@url{http://lensfun.sourceforge.net/}).
  9583. The @code{lensfun} filter requires the camera make, camera model, and lens model
  9584. to apply the lens correction. The filter will load the lensfun database and
  9585. query it to find the corresponding camera and lens entries in the database. As
  9586. long as these entries can be found with the given options, the filter can
  9587. perform corrections on frames. Note that incomplete strings will result in the
  9588. filter choosing the best match with the given options, and the filter will
  9589. output the chosen camera and lens models (logged with level "info"). You must
  9590. provide the make, camera model, and lens model as they are required.
  9591. The filter accepts the following options:
  9592. @table @option
  9593. @item make
  9594. The make of the camera (for example, "Canon"). This option is required.
  9595. @item model
  9596. The model of the camera (for example, "Canon EOS 100D"). This option is
  9597. required.
  9598. @item lens_model
  9599. The model of the lens (for example, "Canon EF-S 18-55mm f/3.5-5.6 IS STM"). This
  9600. option is required.
  9601. @item mode
  9602. The type of correction to apply. The following values are valid options:
  9603. @table @samp
  9604. @item vignetting
  9605. Enables fixing lens vignetting.
  9606. @item geometry
  9607. Enables fixing lens geometry. This is the default.
  9608. @item subpixel
  9609. Enables fixing chromatic aberrations.
  9610. @item vig_geo
  9611. Enables fixing lens vignetting and lens geometry.
  9612. @item vig_subpixel
  9613. Enables fixing lens vignetting and chromatic aberrations.
  9614. @item distortion
  9615. Enables fixing both lens geometry and chromatic aberrations.
  9616. @item all
  9617. Enables all possible corrections.
  9618. @end table
  9619. @item focal_length
  9620. The focal length of the image/video (zoom; expected constant for video). For
  9621. example, a 18--55mm lens has focal length range of [18--55], so a value in that
  9622. range should be chosen when using that lens. Default 18.
  9623. @item aperture
  9624. The aperture of the image/video (expected constant for video). Note that
  9625. aperture is only used for vignetting correction. Default 3.5.
  9626. @item focus_distance
  9627. The focus distance of the image/video (expected constant for video). Note that
  9628. focus distance is only used for vignetting and only slightly affects the
  9629. vignetting correction process. If unknown, leave it at the default value (which
  9630. is 1000).
  9631. @item scale
  9632. The scale factor which is applied after transformation. After correction the
  9633. video is no longer necessarily rectangular. This parameter controls how much of
  9634. the resulting image is visible. The value 0 means that a value will be chosen
  9635. automatically such that there is little or no unmapped area in the output
  9636. image. 1.0 means that no additional scaling is done. Lower values may result
  9637. in more of the corrected image being visible, while higher values may avoid
  9638. unmapped areas in the output.
  9639. @item target_geometry
  9640. The target geometry of the output image/video. The following values are valid
  9641. options:
  9642. @table @samp
  9643. @item rectilinear (default)
  9644. @item fisheye
  9645. @item panoramic
  9646. @item equirectangular
  9647. @item fisheye_orthographic
  9648. @item fisheye_stereographic
  9649. @item fisheye_equisolid
  9650. @item fisheye_thoby
  9651. @end table
  9652. @item reverse
  9653. Apply the reverse of image correction (instead of correcting distortion, apply
  9654. it).
  9655. @item interpolation
  9656. The type of interpolation used when correcting distortion. The following values
  9657. are valid options:
  9658. @table @samp
  9659. @item nearest
  9660. @item linear (default)
  9661. @item lanczos
  9662. @end table
  9663. @end table
  9664. @subsection Examples
  9665. @itemize
  9666. @item
  9667. Apply lens correction with make "Canon", camera model "Canon EOS 100D", and lens
  9668. model "Canon EF-S 18-55mm f/3.5-5.6 IS STM" with focal length of "18" and
  9669. aperture of "8.0".
  9670. @example
  9671. ffmpeg -i input.mov -vf lensfun=make=Canon:model="Canon EOS 100D":lens_model="Canon EF-S 18-55mm f/3.5-5.6 IS STM":focal_length=18:aperture=8 -c:v h264 -b:v 8000k output.mov
  9672. @end example
  9673. @item
  9674. Apply the same as before, but only for the first 5 seconds of video.
  9675. @example
  9676. ffmpeg -i input.mov -vf lensfun=make=Canon:model="Canon EOS 100D":lens_model="Canon EF-S 18-55mm f/3.5-5.6 IS STM":focal_length=18:aperture=8:enable='lte(t\,5)' -c:v h264 -b:v 8000k output.mov
  9677. @end example
  9678. @end itemize
  9679. @section libvmaf
  9680. Obtain the VMAF (Video Multi-Method Assessment Fusion)
  9681. score between two input videos.
  9682. The obtained VMAF score is printed through the logging system.
  9683. It requires Netflix's vmaf library (libvmaf) as a pre-requisite.
  9684. After installing the library it can be enabled using:
  9685. @code{./configure --enable-libvmaf --enable-version3}.
  9686. If no model path is specified it uses the default model: @code{vmaf_v0.6.1.pkl}.
  9687. The filter has following options:
  9688. @table @option
  9689. @item model_path
  9690. Set the model path which is to be used for SVM.
  9691. Default value: @code{"/usr/local/share/model/vmaf_v0.6.1.pkl"}
  9692. @item log_path
  9693. Set the file path to be used to store logs.
  9694. @item log_fmt
  9695. Set the format of the log file (xml or json).
  9696. @item enable_transform
  9697. This option can enable/disable the @code{score_transform} applied to the final predicted VMAF score,
  9698. if you have specified score_transform option in the input parameter file passed to @code{run_vmaf_training.py}
  9699. Default value: @code{false}
  9700. @item phone_model
  9701. Invokes the phone model which will generate VMAF scores higher than in the
  9702. regular model, which is more suitable for laptop, TV, etc. viewing conditions.
  9703. Default value: @code{false}
  9704. @item psnr
  9705. Enables computing psnr along with vmaf.
  9706. Default value: @code{false}
  9707. @item ssim
  9708. Enables computing ssim along with vmaf.
  9709. Default value: @code{false}
  9710. @item ms_ssim
  9711. Enables computing ms_ssim along with vmaf.
  9712. Default value: @code{false}
  9713. @item pool
  9714. Set the pool method to be used for computing vmaf.
  9715. Options are @code{min}, @code{harmonic_mean} or @code{mean} (default).
  9716. @item n_threads
  9717. Set number of threads to be used when computing vmaf.
  9718. Default value: @code{0}, which makes use of all available logical processors.
  9719. @item n_subsample
  9720. Set interval for frame subsampling used when computing vmaf.
  9721. Default value: @code{1}
  9722. @item enable_conf_interval
  9723. Enables confidence interval.
  9724. Default value: @code{false}
  9725. @end table
  9726. This filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  9727. @subsection Examples
  9728. @itemize
  9729. @item
  9730. On the below examples the input file @file{main.mpg} being processed is
  9731. compared with the reference file @file{ref.mpg}.
  9732. @example
  9733. ffmpeg -i main.mpg -i ref.mpg -lavfi libvmaf -f null -
  9734. @end example
  9735. @item
  9736. Example with options:
  9737. @example
  9738. ffmpeg -i main.mpg -i ref.mpg -lavfi libvmaf="psnr=1:log_fmt=json" -f null -
  9739. @end example
  9740. @item
  9741. Example with options and different containers:
  9742. @example
  9743. ffmpeg -i main.mpg -i ref.mkv -lavfi "[0:v]settb=AVTB,setpts=PTS-STARTPTS[main];[1:v]settb=AVTB,setpts=PTS-STARTPTS[ref];[main][ref]libvmaf=psnr=1:log_fmt=json" -f null -
  9744. @end example
  9745. @end itemize
  9746. @section limiter
  9747. Limits the pixel components values to the specified range [min, max].
  9748. The filter accepts the following options:
  9749. @table @option
  9750. @item min
  9751. Lower bound. Defaults to the lowest allowed value for the input.
  9752. @item max
  9753. Upper bound. Defaults to the highest allowed value for the input.
  9754. @item planes
  9755. Specify which planes will be processed. Defaults to all available.
  9756. @end table
  9757. @section loop
  9758. Loop video frames.
  9759. The filter accepts the following options:
  9760. @table @option
  9761. @item loop
  9762. Set the number of loops. Setting this value to -1 will result in infinite loops.
  9763. Default is 0.
  9764. @item size
  9765. Set maximal size in number of frames. Default is 0.
  9766. @item start
  9767. Set first frame of loop. Default is 0.
  9768. @end table
  9769. @subsection Examples
  9770. @itemize
  9771. @item
  9772. Loop single first frame infinitely:
  9773. @example
  9774. loop=loop=-1:size=1:start=0
  9775. @end example
  9776. @item
  9777. Loop single first frame 10 times:
  9778. @example
  9779. loop=loop=10:size=1:start=0
  9780. @end example
  9781. @item
  9782. Loop 10 first frames 5 times:
  9783. @example
  9784. loop=loop=5:size=10:start=0
  9785. @end example
  9786. @end itemize
  9787. @section lut1d
  9788. Apply a 1D LUT to an input video.
  9789. The filter accepts the following options:
  9790. @table @option
  9791. @item file
  9792. Set the 1D LUT file name.
  9793. Currently supported formats:
  9794. @table @samp
  9795. @item cube
  9796. Iridas
  9797. @item csp
  9798. cineSpace
  9799. @end table
  9800. @item interp
  9801. Select interpolation mode.
  9802. Available values are:
  9803. @table @samp
  9804. @item nearest
  9805. Use values from the nearest defined point.
  9806. @item linear
  9807. Interpolate values using the linear interpolation.
  9808. @item cosine
  9809. Interpolate values using the cosine interpolation.
  9810. @item cubic
  9811. Interpolate values using the cubic interpolation.
  9812. @item spline
  9813. Interpolate values using the spline interpolation.
  9814. @end table
  9815. @end table
  9816. @anchor{lut3d}
  9817. @section lut3d
  9818. Apply a 3D LUT to an input video.
  9819. The filter accepts the following options:
  9820. @table @option
  9821. @item file
  9822. Set the 3D LUT file name.
  9823. Currently supported formats:
  9824. @table @samp
  9825. @item 3dl
  9826. AfterEffects
  9827. @item cube
  9828. Iridas
  9829. @item dat
  9830. DaVinci
  9831. @item m3d
  9832. Pandora
  9833. @item csp
  9834. cineSpace
  9835. @end table
  9836. @item interp
  9837. Select interpolation mode.
  9838. Available values are:
  9839. @table @samp
  9840. @item nearest
  9841. Use values from the nearest defined point.
  9842. @item trilinear
  9843. Interpolate values using the 8 points defining a cube.
  9844. @item tetrahedral
  9845. Interpolate values using a tetrahedron.
  9846. @end table
  9847. @end table
  9848. @section lumakey
  9849. Turn certain luma values into transparency.
  9850. The filter accepts the following options:
  9851. @table @option
  9852. @item threshold
  9853. Set the luma which will be used as base for transparency.
  9854. Default value is @code{0}.
  9855. @item tolerance
  9856. Set the range of luma values to be keyed out.
  9857. Default value is @code{0.01}.
  9858. @item softness
  9859. Set the range of softness. Default value is @code{0}.
  9860. Use this to control gradual transition from zero to full transparency.
  9861. @end table
  9862. @subsection Commands
  9863. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options.
  9864. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  9865. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  9866. value.
  9867. @section lut, lutrgb, lutyuv
  9868. Compute a look-up table for binding each pixel component input value
  9869. to an output value, and apply it to the input video.
  9870. @var{lutyuv} applies a lookup table to a YUV input video, @var{lutrgb}
  9871. to an RGB input video.
  9872. These filters accept the following parameters:
  9873. @table @option
  9874. @item c0
  9875. set first pixel component expression
  9876. @item c1
  9877. set second pixel component expression
  9878. @item c2
  9879. set third pixel component expression
  9880. @item c3
  9881. set fourth pixel component expression, corresponds to the alpha component
  9882. @item r
  9883. set red component expression
  9884. @item g
  9885. set green component expression
  9886. @item b
  9887. set blue component expression
  9888. @item a
  9889. alpha component expression
  9890. @item y
  9891. set Y/luminance component expression
  9892. @item u
  9893. set U/Cb component expression
  9894. @item v
  9895. set V/Cr component expression
  9896. @end table
  9897. Each of them specifies the expression to use for computing the lookup table for
  9898. the corresponding pixel component values.
  9899. The exact component associated to each of the @var{c*} options depends on the
  9900. format in input.
  9901. The @var{lut} filter requires either YUV or RGB pixel formats in input,
  9902. @var{lutrgb} requires RGB pixel formats in input, and @var{lutyuv} requires YUV.
  9903. The expressions can contain the following constants and functions:
  9904. @table @option
  9905. @item w
  9906. @item h
  9907. The input width and height.
  9908. @item val
  9909. The input value for the pixel component.
  9910. @item clipval
  9911. The input value, clipped to the @var{minval}-@var{maxval} range.
  9912. @item maxval
  9913. The maximum value for the pixel component.
  9914. @item minval
  9915. The minimum value for the pixel component.
  9916. @item negval
  9917. The negated value for the pixel component value, clipped to the
  9918. @var{minval}-@var{maxval} range; it corresponds to the expression
  9919. "maxval-clipval+minval".
  9920. @item clip(val)
  9921. The computed value in @var{val}, clipped to the
  9922. @var{minval}-@var{maxval} range.
  9923. @item gammaval(gamma)
  9924. The computed gamma correction value of the pixel component value,
  9925. clipped to the @var{minval}-@var{maxval} range. It corresponds to the
  9926. expression
  9927. "pow((clipval-minval)/(maxval-minval)\,@var{gamma})*(maxval-minval)+minval"
  9928. @end table
  9929. All expressions default to "val".
  9930. @subsection Examples
  9931. @itemize
  9932. @item
  9933. Negate input video:
  9934. @example
  9935. lutrgb="r=maxval+minval-val:g=maxval+minval-val:b=maxval+minval-val"
  9936. lutyuv="y=maxval+minval-val:u=maxval+minval-val:v=maxval+minval-val"
  9937. @end example
  9938. The above is the same as:
  9939. @example
  9940. lutrgb="r=negval:g=negval:b=negval"
  9941. lutyuv="y=negval:u=negval:v=negval"
  9942. @end example
  9943. @item
  9944. Negate luminance:
  9945. @example
  9946. lutyuv=y=negval
  9947. @end example
  9948. @item
  9949. Remove chroma components, turning the video into a graytone image:
  9950. @example
  9951. lutyuv="u=128:v=128"
  9952. @end example
  9953. @item
  9954. Apply a luma burning effect:
  9955. @example
  9956. lutyuv="y=2*val"
  9957. @end example
  9958. @item
  9959. Remove green and blue components:
  9960. @example
  9961. lutrgb="g=0:b=0"
  9962. @end example
  9963. @item
  9964. Set a constant alpha channel value on input:
  9965. @example
  9966. format=rgba,lutrgb=a="maxval-minval/2"
  9967. @end example
  9968. @item
  9969. Correct luminance gamma by a factor of 0.5:
  9970. @example
  9971. lutyuv=y=gammaval(0.5)
  9972. @end example
  9973. @item
  9974. Discard least significant bits of luma:
  9975. @example
  9976. lutyuv=y='bitand(val, 128+64+32)'
  9977. @end example
  9978. @item
  9979. Technicolor like effect:
  9980. @example
  9981. lutyuv=u='(val-maxval/2)*2+maxval/2':v='(val-maxval/2)*2+maxval/2'
  9982. @end example
  9983. @end itemize
  9984. @section lut2, tlut2
  9985. The @code{lut2} filter takes two input streams and outputs one
  9986. stream.
  9987. The @code{tlut2} (time lut2) filter takes two consecutive frames
  9988. from one single stream.
  9989. This filter accepts the following parameters:
  9990. @table @option
  9991. @item c0
  9992. set first pixel component expression
  9993. @item c1
  9994. set second pixel component expression
  9995. @item c2
  9996. set third pixel component expression
  9997. @item c3
  9998. set fourth pixel component expression, corresponds to the alpha component
  9999. @item d
  10000. set output bit depth, only available for @code{lut2} filter. By default is 0,
  10001. which means bit depth is automatically picked from first input format.
  10002. @end table
  10003. The @code{lut2} filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  10004. Each of them specifies the expression to use for computing the lookup table for
  10005. the corresponding pixel component values.
  10006. The exact component associated to each of the @var{c*} options depends on the
  10007. format in inputs.
  10008. The expressions can contain the following constants:
  10009. @table @option
  10010. @item w
  10011. @item h
  10012. The input width and height.
  10013. @item x
  10014. The first input value for the pixel component.
  10015. @item y
  10016. The second input value for the pixel component.
  10017. @item bdx
  10018. The first input video bit depth.
  10019. @item bdy
  10020. The second input video bit depth.
  10021. @end table
  10022. All expressions default to "x".
  10023. @subsection Examples
  10024. @itemize
  10025. @item
  10026. Highlight differences between two RGB video streams:
  10027. @example
  10028. lut2='ifnot(x-y,0,pow(2,bdx)-1):ifnot(x-y,0,pow(2,bdx)-1):ifnot(x-y,0,pow(2,bdx)-1)'
  10029. @end example
  10030. @item
  10031. Highlight differences between two YUV video streams:
  10032. @example
  10033. lut2='ifnot(x-y,0,pow(2,bdx)-1):ifnot(x-y,pow(2,bdx-1),pow(2,bdx)-1):ifnot(x-y,pow(2,bdx-1),pow(2,bdx)-1)'
  10034. @end example
  10035. @item
  10036. Show max difference between two video streams:
  10037. @example
  10038. lut2='if(lt(x,y),0,if(gt(x,y),pow(2,bdx)-1,pow(2,bdx-1))):if(lt(x,y),0,if(gt(x,y),pow(2,bdx)-1,pow(2,bdx-1))):if(lt(x,y),0,if(gt(x,y),pow(2,bdx)-1,pow(2,bdx-1)))'
  10039. @end example
  10040. @end itemize
  10041. @section maskedclamp
  10042. Clamp the first input stream with the second input and third input stream.
  10043. Returns the value of first stream to be between second input
  10044. stream - @code{undershoot} and third input stream + @code{overshoot}.
  10045. This filter accepts the following options:
  10046. @table @option
  10047. @item undershoot
  10048. Default value is @code{0}.
  10049. @item overshoot
  10050. Default value is @code{0}.
  10051. @item planes
  10052. Set which planes will be processed as bitmap, unprocessed planes will be
  10053. copied from first stream.
  10054. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  10055. @end table
  10056. @section maskedmax
  10057. Merge the second and third input stream into output stream using absolute differences
  10058. between second input stream and first input stream and absolute difference between
  10059. third input stream and first input stream. The picked value will be from second input
  10060. stream if second absolute difference is greater than first one or from third input stream
  10061. otherwise.
  10062. This filter accepts the following options:
  10063. @table @option
  10064. @item planes
  10065. Set which planes will be processed as bitmap, unprocessed planes will be
  10066. copied from first stream.
  10067. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  10068. @end table
  10069. @section maskedmerge
  10070. Merge the first input stream with the second input stream using per pixel
  10071. weights in the third input stream.
  10072. A value of 0 in the third stream pixel component means that pixel component
  10073. from first stream is returned unchanged, while maximum value (eg. 255 for
  10074. 8-bit videos) means that pixel component from second stream is returned
  10075. unchanged. Intermediate values define the amount of merging between both
  10076. input stream's pixel components.
  10077. This filter accepts the following options:
  10078. @table @option
  10079. @item planes
  10080. Set which planes will be processed as bitmap, unprocessed planes will be
  10081. copied from first stream.
  10082. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  10083. @end table
  10084. @section maskedmin
  10085. Merge the second and third input stream into output stream using absolute differences
  10086. between second input stream and first input stream and absolute difference between
  10087. third input stream and first input stream. The picked value will be from second input
  10088. stream if second absolute difference is less than first one or from third input stream
  10089. otherwise.
  10090. This filter accepts the following options:
  10091. @table @option
  10092. @item planes
  10093. Set which planes will be processed as bitmap, unprocessed planes will be
  10094. copied from first stream.
  10095. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  10096. @end table
  10097. @section maskfun
  10098. Create mask from input video.
  10099. For example it is useful to create motion masks after @code{tblend} filter.
  10100. This filter accepts the following options:
  10101. @table @option
  10102. @item low
  10103. Set low threshold. Any pixel component lower or exact than this value will be set to 0.
  10104. @item high
  10105. Set high threshold. Any pixel component higher than this value will be set to max value
  10106. allowed for current pixel format.
  10107. @item planes
  10108. Set planes to filter, by default all available planes are filtered.
  10109. @item fill
  10110. Fill all frame pixels with this value.
  10111. @item sum
  10112. Set max average pixel value for frame. If sum of all pixel components is higher that this
  10113. average, output frame will be completely filled with value set by @var{fill} option.
  10114. Typically useful for scene changes when used in combination with @code{tblend} filter.
  10115. @end table
  10116. @section mcdeint
  10117. Apply motion-compensation deinterlacing.
  10118. It needs one field per frame as input and must thus be used together
  10119. with yadif=1/3 or equivalent.
  10120. This filter accepts the following options:
  10121. @table @option
  10122. @item mode
  10123. Set the deinterlacing mode.
  10124. It accepts one of the following values:
  10125. @table @samp
  10126. @item fast
  10127. @item medium
  10128. @item slow
  10129. use iterative motion estimation
  10130. @item extra_slow
  10131. like @samp{slow}, but use multiple reference frames.
  10132. @end table
  10133. Default value is @samp{fast}.
  10134. @item parity
  10135. Set the picture field parity assumed for the input video. It must be
  10136. one of the following values:
  10137. @table @samp
  10138. @item 0, tff
  10139. assume top field first
  10140. @item 1, bff
  10141. assume bottom field first
  10142. @end table
  10143. Default value is @samp{bff}.
  10144. @item qp
  10145. Set per-block quantization parameter (QP) used by the internal
  10146. encoder.
  10147. Higher values should result in a smoother motion vector field but less
  10148. optimal individual vectors. Default value is 1.
  10149. @end table
  10150. @section median
  10151. Pick median pixel from certain rectangle defined by radius.
  10152. This filter accepts the following options:
  10153. @table @option
  10154. @item radius
  10155. Set horizontal radius size. Default value is @code{1}.
  10156. Allowed range is integer from 1 to 127.
  10157. @item planes
  10158. Set which planes to process. Default is @code{15}, which is all available planes.
  10159. @item radiusV
  10160. Set vertical radius size. Default value is @code{0}.
  10161. Allowed range is integer from 0 to 127.
  10162. If it is 0, value will be picked from horizontal @code{radius} option.
  10163. @item percentile
  10164. Set median percentile. Default value is @code{0.5}.
  10165. Default value of @code{0.5} will pick always median values, while @code{0} will pick
  10166. minimum values, and @code{1} maximum values.
  10167. @end table
  10168. @subsection Commands
  10169. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options.
  10170. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  10171. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  10172. value.
  10173. @section mergeplanes
  10174. Merge color channel components from several video streams.
  10175. The filter accepts up to 4 input streams, and merge selected input
  10176. planes to the output video.
  10177. This filter accepts the following options:
  10178. @table @option
  10179. @item mapping
  10180. Set input to output plane mapping. Default is @code{0}.
  10181. The mappings is specified as a bitmap. It should be specified as a
  10182. hexadecimal number in the form 0xAa[Bb[Cc[Dd]]]. 'Aa' describes the
  10183. mapping for the first plane of the output stream. 'A' sets the number of
  10184. the input stream to use (from 0 to 3), and 'a' the plane number of the
  10185. corresponding input to use (from 0 to 3). The rest of the mappings is
  10186. similar, 'Bb' describes the mapping for the output stream second
  10187. plane, 'Cc' describes the mapping for the output stream third plane and
  10188. 'Dd' describes the mapping for the output stream fourth plane.
  10189. @item format
  10190. Set output pixel format. Default is @code{yuva444p}.
  10191. @end table
  10192. @subsection Examples
  10193. @itemize
  10194. @item
  10195. Merge three gray video streams of same width and height into single video stream:
  10196. @example
  10197. [a0][a1][a2]mergeplanes=0x001020:yuv444p
  10198. @end example
  10199. @item
  10200. Merge 1st yuv444p stream and 2nd gray video stream into yuva444p video stream:
  10201. @example
  10202. [a0][a1]mergeplanes=0x00010210:yuva444p
  10203. @end example
  10204. @item
  10205. Swap Y and A plane in yuva444p stream:
  10206. @example
  10207. format=yuva444p,mergeplanes=0x03010200:yuva444p
  10208. @end example
  10209. @item
  10210. Swap U and V plane in yuv420p stream:
  10211. @example
  10212. format=yuv420p,mergeplanes=0x000201:yuv420p
  10213. @end example
  10214. @item
  10215. Cast a rgb24 clip to yuv444p:
  10216. @example
  10217. format=rgb24,mergeplanes=0x000102:yuv444p
  10218. @end example
  10219. @end itemize
  10220. @section mestimate
  10221. Estimate and export motion vectors using block matching algorithms.
  10222. Motion vectors are stored in frame side data to be used by other filters.
  10223. This filter accepts the following options:
  10224. @table @option
  10225. @item method
  10226. Specify the motion estimation method. Accepts one of the following values:
  10227. @table @samp
  10228. @item esa
  10229. Exhaustive search algorithm.
  10230. @item tss
  10231. Three step search algorithm.
  10232. @item tdls
  10233. Two dimensional logarithmic search algorithm.
  10234. @item ntss
  10235. New three step search algorithm.
  10236. @item fss
  10237. Four step search algorithm.
  10238. @item ds
  10239. Diamond search algorithm.
  10240. @item hexbs
  10241. Hexagon-based search algorithm.
  10242. @item epzs
  10243. Enhanced predictive zonal search algorithm.
  10244. @item umh
  10245. Uneven multi-hexagon search algorithm.
  10246. @end table
  10247. Default value is @samp{esa}.
  10248. @item mb_size
  10249. Macroblock size. Default @code{16}.
  10250. @item search_param
  10251. Search parameter. Default @code{7}.
  10252. @end table
  10253. @section midequalizer
  10254. Apply Midway Image Equalization effect using two video streams.
  10255. Midway Image Equalization adjusts a pair of images to have the same
  10256. histogram, while maintaining their dynamics as much as possible. It's
  10257. useful for e.g. matching exposures from a pair of stereo cameras.
  10258. This filter has two inputs and one output, which must be of same pixel format, but
  10259. may be of different sizes. The output of filter is first input adjusted with
  10260. midway histogram of both inputs.
  10261. This filter accepts the following option:
  10262. @table @option
  10263. @item planes
  10264. Set which planes to process. Default is @code{15}, which is all available planes.
  10265. @end table
  10266. @section minterpolate
  10267. Convert the video to specified frame rate using motion interpolation.
  10268. This filter accepts the following options:
  10269. @table @option
  10270. @item fps
  10271. Specify the output frame rate. This can be rational e.g. @code{60000/1001}. Frames are dropped if @var{fps} is lower than source fps. Default @code{60}.
  10272. @item mi_mode
  10273. Motion interpolation mode. Following values are accepted:
  10274. @table @samp
  10275. @item dup
  10276. Duplicate previous or next frame for interpolating new ones.
  10277. @item blend
  10278. Blend source frames. Interpolated frame is mean of previous and next frames.
  10279. @item mci
  10280. Motion compensated interpolation. Following options are effective when this mode is selected:
  10281. @table @samp
  10282. @item mc_mode
  10283. Motion compensation mode. Following values are accepted:
  10284. @table @samp
  10285. @item obmc
  10286. Overlapped block motion compensation.
  10287. @item aobmc
  10288. Adaptive overlapped block motion compensation. Window weighting coefficients are controlled adaptively according to the reliabilities of the neighboring motion vectors to reduce oversmoothing.
  10289. @end table
  10290. Default mode is @samp{obmc}.
  10291. @item me_mode
  10292. Motion estimation mode. Following values are accepted:
  10293. @table @samp
  10294. @item bidir
  10295. Bidirectional motion estimation. Motion vectors are estimated for each source frame in both forward and backward directions.
  10296. @item bilat
  10297. Bilateral motion estimation. Motion vectors are estimated directly for interpolated frame.
  10298. @end table
  10299. Default mode is @samp{bilat}.
  10300. @item me
  10301. The algorithm to be used for motion estimation. Following values are accepted:
  10302. @table @samp
  10303. @item esa
  10304. Exhaustive search algorithm.
  10305. @item tss
  10306. Three step search algorithm.
  10307. @item tdls
  10308. Two dimensional logarithmic search algorithm.
  10309. @item ntss
  10310. New three step search algorithm.
  10311. @item fss
  10312. Four step search algorithm.
  10313. @item ds
  10314. Diamond search algorithm.
  10315. @item hexbs
  10316. Hexagon-based search algorithm.
  10317. @item epzs
  10318. Enhanced predictive zonal search algorithm.
  10319. @item umh
  10320. Uneven multi-hexagon search algorithm.
  10321. @end table
  10322. Default algorithm is @samp{epzs}.
  10323. @item mb_size
  10324. Macroblock size. Default @code{16}.
  10325. @item search_param
  10326. Motion estimation search parameter. Default @code{32}.
  10327. @item vsbmc
  10328. Enable variable-size block motion compensation. Motion estimation is applied with smaller block sizes at object boundaries in order to make the them less blur. Default is @code{0} (disabled).
  10329. @end table
  10330. @end table
  10331. @item scd
  10332. Scene change detection method. Scene change leads motion vectors to be in random direction. Scene change detection replace interpolated frames by duplicate ones. May not be needed for other modes. Following values are accepted:
  10333. @table @samp
  10334. @item none
  10335. Disable scene change detection.
  10336. @item fdiff
  10337. Frame difference. Corresponding pixel values are compared and if it satisfies @var{scd_threshold} scene change is detected.
  10338. @end table
  10339. Default method is @samp{fdiff}.
  10340. @item scd_threshold
  10341. Scene change detection threshold. Default is @code{5.0}.
  10342. @end table
  10343. @section mix
  10344. Mix several video input streams into one video stream.
  10345. A description of the accepted options follows.
  10346. @table @option
  10347. @item nb_inputs
  10348. The number of inputs. If unspecified, it defaults to 2.
  10349. @item weights
  10350. Specify weight of each input video stream as sequence.
  10351. Each weight is separated by space. If number of weights
  10352. is smaller than number of @var{frames} last specified
  10353. weight will be used for all remaining unset weights.
  10354. @item scale
  10355. Specify scale, if it is set it will be multiplied with sum
  10356. of each weight multiplied with pixel values to give final destination
  10357. pixel value. By default @var{scale} is auto scaled to sum of weights.
  10358. @item duration
  10359. Specify how end of stream is determined.
  10360. @table @samp
  10361. @item longest
  10362. The duration of the longest input. (default)
  10363. @item shortest
  10364. The duration of the shortest input.
  10365. @item first
  10366. The duration of the first input.
  10367. @end table
  10368. @end table
  10369. @section mpdecimate
  10370. Drop frames that do not differ greatly from the previous frame in
  10371. order to reduce frame rate.
  10372. The main use of this filter is for very-low-bitrate encoding
  10373. (e.g. streaming over dialup modem), but it could in theory be used for
  10374. fixing movies that were inverse-telecined incorrectly.
  10375. A description of the accepted options follows.
  10376. @table @option
  10377. @item max
  10378. Set the maximum number of consecutive frames which can be dropped (if
  10379. positive), or the minimum interval between dropped frames (if
  10380. negative). If the value is 0, the frame is dropped disregarding the
  10381. number of previous sequentially dropped frames.
  10382. Default value is 0.
  10383. @item hi
  10384. @item lo
  10385. @item frac
  10386. Set the dropping threshold values.
  10387. Values for @option{hi} and @option{lo} are for 8x8 pixel blocks and
  10388. represent actual pixel value differences, so a threshold of 64
  10389. corresponds to 1 unit of difference for each pixel, or the same spread
  10390. out differently over the block.
  10391. A frame is a candidate for dropping if no 8x8 blocks differ by more
  10392. than a threshold of @option{hi}, and if no more than @option{frac} blocks (1
  10393. meaning the whole image) differ by more than a threshold of @option{lo}.
  10394. Default value for @option{hi} is 64*12, default value for @option{lo} is
  10395. 64*5, and default value for @option{frac} is 0.33.
  10396. @end table
  10397. @section negate
  10398. Negate (invert) the input video.
  10399. It accepts the following option:
  10400. @table @option
  10401. @item negate_alpha
  10402. With value 1, it negates the alpha component, if present. Default value is 0.
  10403. @end table
  10404. @anchor{nlmeans}
  10405. @section nlmeans
  10406. Denoise frames using Non-Local Means algorithm.
  10407. Each pixel is adjusted by looking for other pixels with similar contexts. This
  10408. context similarity is defined by comparing their surrounding patches of size
  10409. @option{p}x@option{p}. Patches are searched in an area of @option{r}x@option{r}
  10410. around the pixel.
  10411. Note that the research area defines centers for patches, which means some
  10412. patches will be made of pixels outside that research area.
  10413. The filter accepts the following options.
  10414. @table @option
  10415. @item s
  10416. Set denoising strength. Default is 1.0. Must be in range [1.0, 30.0].
  10417. @item p
  10418. Set patch size. Default is 7. Must be odd number in range [0, 99].
  10419. @item pc
  10420. Same as @option{p} but for chroma planes.
  10421. The default value is @var{0} and means automatic.
  10422. @item r
  10423. Set research size. Default is 15. Must be odd number in range [0, 99].
  10424. @item rc
  10425. Same as @option{r} but for chroma planes.
  10426. The default value is @var{0} and means automatic.
  10427. @end table
  10428. @section nnedi
  10429. Deinterlace video using neural network edge directed interpolation.
  10430. This filter accepts the following options:
  10431. @table @option
  10432. @item weights
  10433. Mandatory option, without binary file filter can not work.
  10434. Currently file can be found here:
  10435. https://github.com/dubhater/vapoursynth-nnedi3/blob/master/src/nnedi3_weights.bin
  10436. @item deint
  10437. Set which frames to deinterlace, by default it is @code{all}.
  10438. Can be @code{all} or @code{interlaced}.
  10439. @item field
  10440. Set mode of operation.
  10441. Can be one of the following:
  10442. @table @samp
  10443. @item af
  10444. Use frame flags, both fields.
  10445. @item a
  10446. Use frame flags, single field.
  10447. @item t
  10448. Use top field only.
  10449. @item b
  10450. Use bottom field only.
  10451. @item tf
  10452. Use both fields, top first.
  10453. @item bf
  10454. Use both fields, bottom first.
  10455. @end table
  10456. @item planes
  10457. Set which planes to process, by default filter process all frames.
  10458. @item nsize
  10459. Set size of local neighborhood around each pixel, used by the predictor neural
  10460. network.
  10461. Can be one of the following:
  10462. @table @samp
  10463. @item s8x6
  10464. @item s16x6
  10465. @item s32x6
  10466. @item s48x6
  10467. @item s8x4
  10468. @item s16x4
  10469. @item s32x4
  10470. @end table
  10471. @item nns
  10472. Set the number of neurons in predictor neural network.
  10473. Can be one of the following:
  10474. @table @samp
  10475. @item n16
  10476. @item n32
  10477. @item n64
  10478. @item n128
  10479. @item n256
  10480. @end table
  10481. @item qual
  10482. Controls the number of different neural network predictions that are blended
  10483. together to compute the final output value. Can be @code{fast}, default or
  10484. @code{slow}.
  10485. @item etype
  10486. Set which set of weights to use in the predictor.
  10487. Can be one of the following:
  10488. @table @samp
  10489. @item a
  10490. weights trained to minimize absolute error
  10491. @item s
  10492. weights trained to minimize squared error
  10493. @end table
  10494. @item pscrn
  10495. Controls whether or not the prescreener neural network is used to decide
  10496. which pixels should be processed by the predictor neural network and which
  10497. can be handled by simple cubic interpolation.
  10498. The prescreener is trained to know whether cubic interpolation will be
  10499. sufficient for a pixel or whether it should be predicted by the predictor nn.
  10500. The computational complexity of the prescreener nn is much less than that of
  10501. the predictor nn. Since most pixels can be handled by cubic interpolation,
  10502. using the prescreener generally results in much faster processing.
  10503. The prescreener is pretty accurate, so the difference between using it and not
  10504. using it is almost always unnoticeable.
  10505. Can be one of the following:
  10506. @table @samp
  10507. @item none
  10508. @item original
  10509. @item new
  10510. @end table
  10511. Default is @code{new}.
  10512. @item fapprox
  10513. Set various debugging flags.
  10514. @end table
  10515. @section noformat
  10516. Force libavfilter not to use any of the specified pixel formats for the
  10517. input to the next filter.
  10518. It accepts the following parameters:
  10519. @table @option
  10520. @item pix_fmts
  10521. A '|'-separated list of pixel format names, such as
  10522. pix_fmts=yuv420p|monow|rgb24".
  10523. @end table
  10524. @subsection Examples
  10525. @itemize
  10526. @item
  10527. Force libavfilter to use a format different from @var{yuv420p} for the
  10528. input to the vflip filter:
  10529. @example
  10530. noformat=pix_fmts=yuv420p,vflip
  10531. @end example
  10532. @item
  10533. Convert the input video to any of the formats not contained in the list:
  10534. @example
  10535. noformat=yuv420p|yuv444p|yuv410p
  10536. @end example
  10537. @end itemize
  10538. @section noise
  10539. Add noise on video input frame.
  10540. The filter accepts the following options:
  10541. @table @option
  10542. @item all_seed
  10543. @item c0_seed
  10544. @item c1_seed
  10545. @item c2_seed
  10546. @item c3_seed
  10547. Set noise seed for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
  10548. of @var{all_seed}. Default value is @code{123457}.
  10549. @item all_strength, alls
  10550. @item c0_strength, c0s
  10551. @item c1_strength, c1s
  10552. @item c2_strength, c2s
  10553. @item c3_strength, c3s
  10554. Set noise strength for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
  10555. @var{all_strength}. Default value is @code{0}. Allowed range is [0, 100].
  10556. @item all_flags, allf
  10557. @item c0_flags, c0f
  10558. @item c1_flags, c1f
  10559. @item c2_flags, c2f
  10560. @item c3_flags, c3f
  10561. Set pixel component flags or set flags for all components if @var{all_flags}.
  10562. Available values for component flags are:
  10563. @table @samp
  10564. @item a
  10565. averaged temporal noise (smoother)
  10566. @item p
  10567. mix random noise with a (semi)regular pattern
  10568. @item t
  10569. temporal noise (noise pattern changes between frames)
  10570. @item u
  10571. uniform noise (gaussian otherwise)
  10572. @end table
  10573. @end table
  10574. @subsection Examples
  10575. Add temporal and uniform noise to input video:
  10576. @example
  10577. noise=alls=20:allf=t+u
  10578. @end example
  10579. @section normalize
  10580. Normalize RGB video (aka histogram stretching, contrast stretching).
  10581. See: https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Normalization_(image_processing)
  10582. For each channel of each frame, the filter computes the input range and maps
  10583. it linearly to the user-specified output range. The output range defaults
  10584. to the full dynamic range from pure black to pure white.
  10585. Temporal smoothing can be used on the input range to reduce flickering (rapid
  10586. changes in brightness) caused when small dark or bright objects enter or leave
  10587. the scene. This is similar to the auto-exposure (automatic gain control) on a
  10588. video camera, and, like a video camera, it may cause a period of over- or
  10589. under-exposure of the video.
  10590. The R,G,B channels can be normalized independently, which may cause some
  10591. color shifting, or linked together as a single channel, which prevents
  10592. color shifting. Linked normalization preserves hue. Independent normalization
  10593. does not, so it can be used to remove some color casts. Independent and linked
  10594. normalization can be combined in any ratio.
  10595. The normalize filter accepts the following options:
  10596. @table @option
  10597. @item blackpt
  10598. @item whitept
  10599. Colors which define the output range. The minimum input value is mapped to
  10600. the @var{blackpt}. The maximum input value is mapped to the @var{whitept}.
  10601. The defaults are black and white respectively. Specifying white for
  10602. @var{blackpt} and black for @var{whitept} will give color-inverted,
  10603. normalized video. Shades of grey can be used to reduce the dynamic range
  10604. (contrast). Specifying saturated colors here can create some interesting
  10605. effects.
  10606. @item smoothing
  10607. The number of previous frames to use for temporal smoothing. The input range
  10608. of each channel is smoothed using a rolling average over the current frame
  10609. and the @var{smoothing} previous frames. The default is 0 (no temporal
  10610. smoothing).
  10611. @item independence
  10612. Controls the ratio of independent (color shifting) channel normalization to
  10613. linked (color preserving) normalization. 0.0 is fully linked, 1.0 is fully
  10614. independent. Defaults to 1.0 (fully independent).
  10615. @item strength
  10616. Overall strength of the filter. 1.0 is full strength. 0.0 is a rather
  10617. expensive no-op. Defaults to 1.0 (full strength).
  10618. @end table
  10619. @subsection Commands
  10620. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options, excluding @var{smoothing} option.
  10621. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  10622. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  10623. value.
  10624. @subsection Examples
  10625. Stretch video contrast to use the full dynamic range, with no temporal
  10626. smoothing; may flicker depending on the source content:
  10627. @example
  10628. normalize=blackpt=black:whitept=white:smoothing=0
  10629. @end example
  10630. As above, but with 50 frames of temporal smoothing; flicker should be
  10631. reduced, depending on the source content:
  10632. @example
  10633. normalize=blackpt=black:whitept=white:smoothing=50
  10634. @end example
  10635. As above, but with hue-preserving linked channel normalization:
  10636. @example
  10637. normalize=blackpt=black:whitept=white:smoothing=50:independence=0
  10638. @end example
  10639. As above, but with half strength:
  10640. @example
  10641. normalize=blackpt=black:whitept=white:smoothing=50:independence=0:strength=0.5
  10642. @end example
  10643. Map the darkest input color to red, the brightest input color to cyan:
  10644. @example
  10645. normalize=blackpt=red:whitept=cyan
  10646. @end example
  10647. @section null
  10648. Pass the video source unchanged to the output.
  10649. @section ocr
  10650. Optical Character Recognition
  10651. This filter uses Tesseract for optical character recognition. To enable
  10652. compilation of this filter, you need to configure FFmpeg with
  10653. @code{--enable-libtesseract}.
  10654. It accepts the following options:
  10655. @table @option
  10656. @item datapath
  10657. Set datapath to tesseract data. Default is to use whatever was
  10658. set at installation.
  10659. @item language
  10660. Set language, default is "eng".
  10661. @item whitelist
  10662. Set character whitelist.
  10663. @item blacklist
  10664. Set character blacklist.
  10665. @end table
  10666. The filter exports recognized text as the frame metadata @code{lavfi.ocr.text}.
  10667. The filter exports confidence of recognized words as the frame metadata @code{lavfi.ocr.confidence}.
  10668. @section ocv
  10669. Apply a video transform using libopencv.
  10670. To enable this filter, install the libopencv library and headers and
  10671. configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-libopencv}.
  10672. It accepts the following parameters:
  10673. @table @option
  10674. @item filter_name
  10675. The name of the libopencv filter to apply.
  10676. @item filter_params
  10677. The parameters to pass to the libopencv filter. If not specified, the default
  10678. values are assumed.
  10679. @end table
  10680. Refer to the official libopencv documentation for more precise
  10681. information:
  10682. @url{http://docs.opencv.org/master/modules/imgproc/doc/filtering.html}
  10683. Several libopencv filters are supported; see the following subsections.
  10684. @anchor{dilate}
  10685. @subsection dilate
  10686. Dilate an image by using a specific structuring element.
  10687. It corresponds to the libopencv function @code{cvDilate}.
  10688. It accepts the parameters: @var{struct_el}|@var{nb_iterations}.
  10689. @var{struct_el} represents a structuring element, and has the syntax:
  10690. @var{cols}x@var{rows}+@var{anchor_x}x@var{anchor_y}/@var{shape}
  10691. @var{cols} and @var{rows} represent the number of columns and rows of
  10692. the structuring element, @var{anchor_x} and @var{anchor_y} the anchor
  10693. point, and @var{shape} the shape for the structuring element. @var{shape}
  10694. must be "rect", "cross", "ellipse", or "custom".
  10695. If the value for @var{shape} is "custom", it must be followed by a
  10696. string of the form "=@var{filename}". The file with name
  10697. @var{filename} is assumed to represent a binary image, with each
  10698. printable character corresponding to a bright pixel. When a custom
  10699. @var{shape} is used, @var{cols} and @var{rows} are ignored, the number
  10700. or columns and rows of the read file are assumed instead.
  10701. The default value for @var{struct_el} is "3x3+0x0/rect".
  10702. @var{nb_iterations} specifies the number of times the transform is
  10703. applied to the image, and defaults to 1.
  10704. Some examples:
  10705. @example
  10706. # Use the default values
  10707. ocv=dilate
  10708. # Dilate using a structuring element with a 5x5 cross, iterating two times
  10709. ocv=filter_name=dilate:filter_params=5x5+2x2/cross|2
  10710. # Read the shape from the file diamond.shape, iterating two times.
  10711. # The file diamond.shape may contain a pattern of characters like this
  10712. # *
  10713. # ***
  10714. # *****
  10715. # ***
  10716. # *
  10717. # The specified columns and rows are ignored
  10718. # but the anchor point coordinates are not
  10719. ocv=dilate:0x0+2x2/custom=diamond.shape|2
  10720. @end example
  10721. @subsection erode
  10722. Erode an image by using a specific structuring element.
  10723. It corresponds to the libopencv function @code{cvErode}.
  10724. It accepts the parameters: @var{struct_el}:@var{nb_iterations},
  10725. with the same syntax and semantics as the @ref{dilate} filter.
  10726. @subsection smooth
  10727. Smooth the input video.
  10728. The filter takes the following parameters:
  10729. @var{type}|@var{param1}|@var{param2}|@var{param3}|@var{param4}.
  10730. @var{type} is the type of smooth filter to apply, and must be one of
  10731. the following values: "blur", "blur_no_scale", "median", "gaussian",
  10732. or "bilateral". The default value is "gaussian".
  10733. The meaning of @var{param1}, @var{param2}, @var{param3}, and @var{param4}
  10734. depends on the smooth type. @var{param1} and
  10735. @var{param2} accept integer positive values or 0. @var{param3} and
  10736. @var{param4} accept floating point values.
  10737. The default value for @var{param1} is 3. The default value for the
  10738. other parameters is 0.
  10739. These parameters correspond to the parameters assigned to the
  10740. libopencv function @code{cvSmooth}.
  10741. @section oscilloscope
  10742. 2D Video Oscilloscope.
  10743. Useful to measure spatial impulse, step responses, chroma delays, etc.
  10744. It accepts the following parameters:
  10745. @table @option
  10746. @item x
  10747. Set scope center x position.
  10748. @item y
  10749. Set scope center y position.
  10750. @item s
  10751. Set scope size, relative to frame diagonal.
  10752. @item t
  10753. Set scope tilt/rotation.
  10754. @item o
  10755. Set trace opacity.
  10756. @item tx
  10757. Set trace center x position.
  10758. @item ty
  10759. Set trace center y position.
  10760. @item tw
  10761. Set trace width, relative to width of frame.
  10762. @item th
  10763. Set trace height, relative to height of frame.
  10764. @item c
  10765. Set which components to trace. By default it traces first three components.
  10766. @item g
  10767. Draw trace grid. By default is enabled.
  10768. @item st
  10769. Draw some statistics. By default is enabled.
  10770. @item sc
  10771. Draw scope. By default is enabled.
  10772. @end table
  10773. @subsection Commands
  10774. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options.
  10775. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  10776. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  10777. value.
  10778. @subsection Examples
  10779. @itemize
  10780. @item
  10781. Inspect full first row of video frame.
  10782. @example
  10783. oscilloscope=x=0.5:y=0:s=1
  10784. @end example
  10785. @item
  10786. Inspect full last row of video frame.
  10787. @example
  10788. oscilloscope=x=0.5:y=1:s=1
  10789. @end example
  10790. @item
  10791. Inspect full 5th line of video frame of height 1080.
  10792. @example
  10793. oscilloscope=x=0.5:y=5/1080:s=1
  10794. @end example
  10795. @item
  10796. Inspect full last column of video frame.
  10797. @example
  10798. oscilloscope=x=1:y=0.5:s=1:t=1
  10799. @end example
  10800. @end itemize
  10801. @anchor{overlay}
  10802. @section overlay
  10803. Overlay one video on top of another.
  10804. It takes two inputs and has one output. The first input is the "main"
  10805. video on which the second input is overlaid.
  10806. It accepts the following parameters:
  10807. A description of the accepted options follows.
  10808. @table @option
  10809. @item x
  10810. @item y
  10811. Set the expression for the x and y coordinates of the overlaid video
  10812. on the main video. Default value is "0" for both expressions. In case
  10813. the expression is invalid, it is set to a huge value (meaning that the
  10814. overlay will not be displayed within the output visible area).
  10815. @item eof_action
  10816. See @ref{framesync}.
  10817. @item eval
  10818. Set when the expressions for @option{x}, and @option{y} are evaluated.
  10819. It accepts the following values:
  10820. @table @samp
  10821. @item init
  10822. only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or
  10823. when a command is processed
  10824. @item frame
  10825. evaluate expressions for each incoming frame
  10826. @end table
  10827. Default value is @samp{frame}.
  10828. @item shortest
  10829. See @ref{framesync}.
  10830. @item format
  10831. Set the format for the output video.
  10832. It accepts the following values:
  10833. @table @samp
  10834. @item yuv420
  10835. force YUV420 output
  10836. @item yuv422
  10837. force YUV422 output
  10838. @item yuv444
  10839. force YUV444 output
  10840. @item rgb
  10841. force packed RGB output
  10842. @item gbrp
  10843. force planar RGB output
  10844. @item auto
  10845. automatically pick format
  10846. @end table
  10847. Default value is @samp{yuv420}.
  10848. @item repeatlast
  10849. See @ref{framesync}.
  10850. @item alpha
  10851. Set format of alpha of the overlaid video, it can be @var{straight} or
  10852. @var{premultiplied}. Default is @var{straight}.
  10853. @end table
  10854. The @option{x}, and @option{y} expressions can contain the following
  10855. parameters.
  10856. @table @option
  10857. @item main_w, W
  10858. @item main_h, H
  10859. The main input width and height.
  10860. @item overlay_w, w
  10861. @item overlay_h, h
  10862. The overlay input width and height.
  10863. @item x
  10864. @item y
  10865. The computed values for @var{x} and @var{y}. They are evaluated for
  10866. each new frame.
  10867. @item hsub
  10868. @item vsub
  10869. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values of the output
  10870. format. For example for the pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and
  10871. @var{vsub} is 1.
  10872. @item n
  10873. the number of input frame, starting from 0
  10874. @item pos
  10875. the position in the file of the input frame, NAN if unknown
  10876. @item t
  10877. The timestamp, expressed in seconds. It's NAN if the input timestamp is unknown.
  10878. @end table
  10879. This filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  10880. Note that the @var{n}, @var{pos}, @var{t} variables are available only
  10881. when evaluation is done @emph{per frame}, and will evaluate to NAN
  10882. when @option{eval} is set to @samp{init}.
  10883. Be aware that frames are taken from each input video in timestamp
  10884. order, hence, if their initial timestamps differ, it is a good idea
  10885. to pass the two inputs through a @var{setpts=PTS-STARTPTS} filter to
  10886. have them begin in the same zero timestamp, as the example for
  10887. the @var{movie} filter does.
  10888. You can chain together more overlays but you should test the
  10889. efficiency of such approach.
  10890. @subsection Commands
  10891. This filter supports the following commands:
  10892. @table @option
  10893. @item x
  10894. @item y
  10895. Modify the x and y of the overlay input.
  10896. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  10897. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  10898. value.
  10899. @end table
  10900. @subsection Examples
  10901. @itemize
  10902. @item
  10903. Draw the overlay at 10 pixels from the bottom right corner of the main
  10904. video:
  10905. @example
  10906. overlay=main_w-overlay_w-10:main_h-overlay_h-10
  10907. @end example
  10908. Using named options the example above becomes:
  10909. @example
  10910. overlay=x=main_w-overlay_w-10:y=main_h-overlay_h-10
  10911. @end example
  10912. @item
  10913. Insert a transparent PNG logo in the bottom left corner of the input,
  10914. using the @command{ffmpeg} tool with the @code{-filter_complex} option:
  10915. @example
  10916. ffmpeg -i input -i logo -filter_complex 'overlay=10:main_h-overlay_h-10' output
  10917. @end example
  10918. @item
  10919. Insert 2 different transparent PNG logos (second logo on bottom
  10920. right corner) using the @command{ffmpeg} tool:
  10921. @example
  10922. ffmpeg -i input -i logo1 -i logo2 -filter_complex 'overlay=x=10:y=H-h-10,overlay=x=W-w-10:y=H-h-10' output
  10923. @end example
  10924. @item
  10925. Add a transparent color layer on top of the main video; @code{WxH}
  10926. must specify the size of the main input to the overlay filter:
  10927. @example
  10928. color=color=red@@.3:size=WxH [over]; [in][over] overlay [out]
  10929. @end example
  10930. @item
  10931. Play an original video and a filtered version (here with the deshake
  10932. filter) side by side using the @command{ffplay} tool:
  10933. @example
  10934. ffplay input.avi -vf 'split[a][b]; [a]pad=iw*2:ih[src]; [b]deshake[filt]; [src][filt]overlay=w'
  10935. @end example
  10936. The above command is the same as:
  10937. @example
  10938. ffplay input.avi -vf 'split[b], pad=iw*2[src], [b]deshake, [src]overlay=w'
  10939. @end example
  10940. @item
  10941. Make a sliding overlay appearing from the left to the right top part of the
  10942. screen starting since time 2:
  10943. @example
  10944. overlay=x='if(gte(t,2), -w+(t-2)*20, NAN)':y=0
  10945. @end example
  10946. @item
  10947. Compose output by putting two input videos side to side:
  10948. @example
  10949. ffmpeg -i left.avi -i right.avi -filter_complex "
  10950. nullsrc=size=200x100 [background];
  10951. [0:v] setpts=PTS-STARTPTS, scale=100x100 [left];
  10952. [1:v] setpts=PTS-STARTPTS, scale=100x100 [right];
  10953. [background][left] overlay=shortest=1 [background+left];
  10954. [background+left][right] overlay=shortest=1:x=100 [left+right]
  10955. "
  10956. @end example
  10957. @item
  10958. Mask 10-20 seconds of a video by applying the delogo filter to a section
  10959. @example
  10960. ffmpeg -i test.avi -codec:v:0 wmv2 -ar 11025 -b:v 9000k
  10961. -vf '[in]split[split_main][split_delogo];[split_delogo]trim=start=360:end=371,delogo=0:0:640:480[delogoed];[split_main][delogoed]overlay=eof_action=pass[out]'
  10962. masked.avi
  10963. @end example
  10964. @item
  10965. Chain several overlays in cascade:
  10966. @example
  10967. nullsrc=s=200x200 [bg];
  10968. testsrc=s=100x100, split=4 [in0][in1][in2][in3];
  10969. [in0] lutrgb=r=0, [bg] overlay=0:0 [mid0];
  10970. [in1] lutrgb=g=0, [mid0] overlay=100:0 [mid1];
  10971. [in2] lutrgb=b=0, [mid1] overlay=0:100 [mid2];
  10972. [in3] null, [mid2] overlay=100:100 [out0]
  10973. @end example
  10974. @end itemize
  10975. @anchor{overlay_cuda}
  10976. @section overlay_cuda
  10977. Overlay one video on top of another.
  10978. This is the CUDA cariant of the @ref{overlay} filter.
  10979. It only accepts CUDA frames. The underlying input pixel formats have to match.
  10980. It takes two inputs and has one output. The first input is the "main"
  10981. video on which the second input is overlaid.
  10982. It accepts the following parameters:
  10983. @table @option
  10984. @item x
  10985. @item y
  10986. Set the x and y coordinates of the overlaid video on the main video.
  10987. Default value is "0" for both expressions.
  10988. @item eof_action
  10989. See @ref{framesync}.
  10990. @item shortest
  10991. See @ref{framesync}.
  10992. @item repeatlast
  10993. See @ref{framesync}.
  10994. @end table
  10995. This filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  10996. @section owdenoise
  10997. Apply Overcomplete Wavelet denoiser.
  10998. The filter accepts the following options:
  10999. @table @option
  11000. @item depth
  11001. Set depth.
  11002. Larger depth values will denoise lower frequency components more, but
  11003. slow down filtering.
  11004. Must be an int in the range 8-16, default is @code{8}.
  11005. @item luma_strength, ls
  11006. Set luma strength.
  11007. Must be a double value in the range 0-1000, default is @code{1.0}.
  11008. @item chroma_strength, cs
  11009. Set chroma strength.
  11010. Must be a double value in the range 0-1000, default is @code{1.0}.
  11011. @end table
  11012. @anchor{pad}
  11013. @section pad
  11014. Add paddings to the input image, and place the original input at the
  11015. provided @var{x}, @var{y} coordinates.
  11016. It accepts the following parameters:
  11017. @table @option
  11018. @item width, w
  11019. @item height, h
  11020. Specify an expression for the size of the output image with the
  11021. paddings added. If the value for @var{width} or @var{height} is 0, the
  11022. corresponding input size is used for the output.
  11023. The @var{width} expression can reference the value set by the
  11024. @var{height} expression, and vice versa.
  11025. The default value of @var{width} and @var{height} is 0.
  11026. @item x
  11027. @item y
  11028. Specify the offsets to place the input image at within the padded area,
  11029. with respect to the top/left border of the output image.
  11030. The @var{x} expression can reference the value set by the @var{y}
  11031. expression, and vice versa.
  11032. The default value of @var{x} and @var{y} is 0.
  11033. If @var{x} or @var{y} evaluate to a negative number, they'll be changed
  11034. so the input image is centered on the padded area.
  11035. @item color
  11036. Specify the color of the padded area. For the syntax of this option,
  11037. check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils
  11038. manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  11039. The default value of @var{color} is "black".
  11040. @item eval
  11041. Specify when to evaluate @var{width}, @var{height}, @var{x} and @var{y} expression.
  11042. It accepts the following values:
  11043. @table @samp
  11044. @item init
  11045. Only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or when
  11046. a command is processed.
  11047. @item frame
  11048. Evaluate expressions for each incoming frame.
  11049. @end table
  11050. Default value is @samp{init}.
  11051. @item aspect
  11052. Pad to aspect instead to a resolution.
  11053. @end table
  11054. The value for the @var{width}, @var{height}, @var{x}, and @var{y}
  11055. options are expressions containing the following constants:
  11056. @table @option
  11057. @item in_w
  11058. @item in_h
  11059. The input video width and height.
  11060. @item iw
  11061. @item ih
  11062. These are the same as @var{in_w} and @var{in_h}.
  11063. @item out_w
  11064. @item out_h
  11065. The output width and height (the size of the padded area), as
  11066. specified by the @var{width} and @var{height} expressions.
  11067. @item ow
  11068. @item oh
  11069. These are the same as @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}.
  11070. @item x
  11071. @item y
  11072. The x and y offsets as specified by the @var{x} and @var{y}
  11073. expressions, or NAN if not yet specified.
  11074. @item a
  11075. same as @var{iw} / @var{ih}
  11076. @item sar
  11077. input sample aspect ratio
  11078. @item dar
  11079. input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{iw} / @var{ih}) * @var{sar}
  11080. @item hsub
  11081. @item vsub
  11082. The horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  11083. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  11084. @end table
  11085. @subsection Examples
  11086. @itemize
  11087. @item
  11088. Add paddings with the color "violet" to the input video. The output video
  11089. size is 640x480, and the top-left corner of the input video is placed at
  11090. column 0, row 40
  11091. @example
  11092. pad=640:480:0:40:violet
  11093. @end example
  11094. The example above is equivalent to the following command:
  11095. @example
  11096. pad=width=640:height=480:x=0:y=40:color=violet
  11097. @end example
  11098. @item
  11099. Pad the input to get an output with dimensions increased by 3/2,
  11100. and put the input video at the center of the padded area:
  11101. @example
  11102. pad="3/2*iw:3/2*ih:(ow-iw)/2:(oh-ih)/2"
  11103. @end example
  11104. @item
  11105. Pad the input to get a squared output with size equal to the maximum
  11106. value between the input width and height, and put the input video at
  11107. the center of the padded area:
  11108. @example
  11109. pad="max(iw\,ih):ow:(ow-iw)/2:(oh-ih)/2"
  11110. @end example
  11111. @item
  11112. Pad the input to get a final w/h ratio of 16:9:
  11113. @example
  11114. pad="ih*16/9:ih:(ow-iw)/2:(oh-ih)/2"
  11115. @end example
  11116. @item
  11117. In case of anamorphic video, in order to set the output display aspect
  11118. correctly, it is necessary to use @var{sar} in the expression,
  11119. according to the relation:
  11120. @example
  11121. (ih * X / ih) * sar = output_dar
  11122. X = output_dar / sar
  11123. @end example
  11124. Thus the previous example needs to be modified to:
  11125. @example
  11126. pad="ih*16/9/sar:ih:(ow-iw)/2:(oh-ih)/2"
  11127. @end example
  11128. @item
  11129. Double the output size and put the input video in the bottom-right
  11130. corner of the output padded area:
  11131. @example
  11132. pad="2*iw:2*ih:ow-iw:oh-ih"
  11133. @end example
  11134. @end itemize
  11135. @anchor{palettegen}
  11136. @section palettegen
  11137. Generate one palette for a whole video stream.
  11138. It accepts the following options:
  11139. @table @option
  11140. @item max_colors
  11141. Set the maximum number of colors to quantize in the palette.
  11142. Note: the palette will still contain 256 colors; the unused palette entries
  11143. will be black.
  11144. @item reserve_transparent
  11145. Create a palette of 255 colors maximum and reserve the last one for
  11146. transparency. Reserving the transparency color is useful for GIF optimization.
  11147. If not set, the maximum of colors in the palette will be 256. You probably want
  11148. to disable this option for a standalone image.
  11149. Set by default.
  11150. @item transparency_color
  11151. Set the color that will be used as background for transparency.
  11152. @item stats_mode
  11153. Set statistics mode.
  11154. It accepts the following values:
  11155. @table @samp
  11156. @item full
  11157. Compute full frame histograms.
  11158. @item diff
  11159. Compute histograms only for the part that differs from previous frame. This
  11160. might be relevant to give more importance to the moving part of your input if
  11161. the background is static.
  11162. @item single
  11163. Compute new histogram for each frame.
  11164. @end table
  11165. Default value is @var{full}.
  11166. @end table
  11167. The filter also exports the frame metadata @code{lavfi.color_quant_ratio}
  11168. (@code{nb_color_in / nb_color_out}) which you can use to evaluate the degree of
  11169. color quantization of the palette. This information is also visible at
  11170. @var{info} logging level.
  11171. @subsection Examples
  11172. @itemize
  11173. @item
  11174. Generate a representative palette of a given video using @command{ffmpeg}:
  11175. @example
  11176. ffmpeg -i input.mkv -vf palettegen palette.png
  11177. @end example
  11178. @end itemize
  11179. @section paletteuse
  11180. Use a palette to downsample an input video stream.
  11181. The filter takes two inputs: one video stream and a palette. The palette must
  11182. be a 256 pixels image.
  11183. It accepts the following options:
  11184. @table @option
  11185. @item dither
  11186. Select dithering mode. Available algorithms are:
  11187. @table @samp
  11188. @item bayer
  11189. Ordered 8x8 bayer dithering (deterministic)
  11190. @item heckbert
  11191. Dithering as defined by Paul Heckbert in 1982 (simple error diffusion).
  11192. Note: this dithering is sometimes considered "wrong" and is included as a
  11193. reference.
  11194. @item floyd_steinberg
  11195. Floyd and Steingberg dithering (error diffusion)
  11196. @item sierra2
  11197. Frankie Sierra dithering v2 (error diffusion)
  11198. @item sierra2_4a
  11199. Frankie Sierra dithering v2 "Lite" (error diffusion)
  11200. @end table
  11201. Default is @var{sierra2_4a}.
  11202. @item bayer_scale
  11203. When @var{bayer} dithering is selected, this option defines the scale of the
  11204. pattern (how much the crosshatch pattern is visible). A low value means more
  11205. visible pattern for less banding, and higher value means less visible pattern
  11206. at the cost of more banding.
  11207. The option must be an integer value in the range [0,5]. Default is @var{2}.
  11208. @item diff_mode
  11209. If set, define the zone to process
  11210. @table @samp
  11211. @item rectangle
  11212. Only the changing rectangle will be reprocessed. This is similar to GIF
  11213. cropping/offsetting compression mechanism. This option can be useful for speed
  11214. if only a part of the image is changing, and has use cases such as limiting the
  11215. scope of the error diffusal @option{dither} to the rectangle that bounds the
  11216. moving scene (it leads to more deterministic output if the scene doesn't change
  11217. much, and as a result less moving noise and better GIF compression).
  11218. @end table
  11219. Default is @var{none}.
  11220. @item new
  11221. Take new palette for each output frame.
  11222. @item alpha_threshold
  11223. Sets the alpha threshold for transparency. Alpha values above this threshold
  11224. will be treated as completely opaque, and values below this threshold will be
  11225. treated as completely transparent.
  11226. The option must be an integer value in the range [0,255]. Default is @var{128}.
  11227. @end table
  11228. @subsection Examples
  11229. @itemize
  11230. @item
  11231. Use a palette (generated for example with @ref{palettegen}) to encode a GIF
  11232. using @command{ffmpeg}:
  11233. @example
  11234. ffmpeg -i input.mkv -i palette.png -lavfi paletteuse output.gif
  11235. @end example
  11236. @end itemize
  11237. @section perspective
  11238. Correct perspective of video not recorded perpendicular to the screen.
  11239. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  11240. @table @option
  11241. @item x0
  11242. @item y0
  11243. @item x1
  11244. @item y1
  11245. @item x2
  11246. @item y2
  11247. @item x3
  11248. @item y3
  11249. Set coordinates expression for top left, top right, bottom left and bottom right corners.
  11250. Default values are @code{0:0:W:0:0:H:W:H} with which perspective will remain unchanged.
  11251. If the @code{sense} option is set to @code{source}, then the specified points will be sent
  11252. to the corners of the destination. If the @code{sense} option is set to @code{destination},
  11253. then the corners of the source will be sent to the specified coordinates.
  11254. The expressions can use the following variables:
  11255. @table @option
  11256. @item W
  11257. @item H
  11258. the width and height of video frame.
  11259. @item in
  11260. Input frame count.
  11261. @item on
  11262. Output frame count.
  11263. @end table
  11264. @item interpolation
  11265. Set interpolation for perspective correction.
  11266. It accepts the following values:
  11267. @table @samp
  11268. @item linear
  11269. @item cubic
  11270. @end table
  11271. Default value is @samp{linear}.
  11272. @item sense
  11273. Set interpretation of coordinate options.
  11274. It accepts the following values:
  11275. @table @samp
  11276. @item 0, source
  11277. Send point in the source specified by the given coordinates to
  11278. the corners of the destination.
  11279. @item 1, destination
  11280. Send the corners of the source to the point in the destination specified
  11281. by the given coordinates.
  11282. Default value is @samp{source}.
  11283. @end table
  11284. @item eval
  11285. Set when the expressions for coordinates @option{x0,y0,...x3,y3} are evaluated.
  11286. It accepts the following values:
  11287. @table @samp
  11288. @item init
  11289. only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or
  11290. when a command is processed
  11291. @item frame
  11292. evaluate expressions for each incoming frame
  11293. @end table
  11294. Default value is @samp{init}.
  11295. @end table
  11296. @section phase
  11297. Delay interlaced video by one field time so that the field order changes.
  11298. The intended use is to fix PAL movies that have been captured with the
  11299. opposite field order to the film-to-video transfer.
  11300. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  11301. @table @option
  11302. @item mode
  11303. Set phase mode.
  11304. It accepts the following values:
  11305. @table @samp
  11306. @item t
  11307. Capture field order top-first, transfer bottom-first.
  11308. Filter will delay the bottom field.
  11309. @item b
  11310. Capture field order bottom-first, transfer top-first.
  11311. Filter will delay the top field.
  11312. @item p
  11313. Capture and transfer with the same field order. This mode only exists
  11314. for the documentation of the other options to refer to, but if you
  11315. actually select it, the filter will faithfully do nothing.
  11316. @item a
  11317. Capture field order determined automatically by field flags, transfer
  11318. opposite.
  11319. Filter selects among @samp{t} and @samp{b} modes on a frame by frame
  11320. basis using field flags. If no field information is available,
  11321. then this works just like @samp{u}.
  11322. @item u
  11323. Capture unknown or varying, transfer opposite.
  11324. Filter selects among @samp{t} and @samp{b} on a frame by frame basis by
  11325. analyzing the images and selecting the alternative that produces best
  11326. match between the fields.
  11327. @item T
  11328. Capture top-first, transfer unknown or varying.
  11329. Filter selects among @samp{t} and @samp{p} using image analysis.
  11330. @item B
  11331. Capture bottom-first, transfer unknown or varying.
  11332. Filter selects among @samp{b} and @samp{p} using image analysis.
  11333. @item A
  11334. Capture determined by field flags, transfer unknown or varying.
  11335. Filter selects among @samp{t}, @samp{b} and @samp{p} using field flags and
  11336. image analysis. If no field information is available, then this works just
  11337. like @samp{U}. This is the default mode.
  11338. @item U
  11339. Both capture and transfer unknown or varying.
  11340. Filter selects among @samp{t}, @samp{b} and @samp{p} using image analysis only.
  11341. @end table
  11342. @end table
  11343. @section photosensitivity
  11344. Reduce various flashes in video, so to help users with epilepsy.
  11345. It accepts the following options:
  11346. @table @option
  11347. @item frames, f
  11348. Set how many frames to use when filtering. Default is 30.
  11349. @item threshold, t
  11350. Set detection threshold factor. Default is 1.
  11351. Lower is stricter.
  11352. @item skip
  11353. Set how many pixels to skip when sampling frames. Default is 1.
  11354. Allowed range is from 1 to 1024.
  11355. @item bypass
  11356. Leave frames unchanged. Default is disabled.
  11357. @end table
  11358. @section pixdesctest
  11359. Pixel format descriptor test filter, mainly useful for internal
  11360. testing. The output video should be equal to the input video.
  11361. For example:
  11362. @example
  11363. format=monow, pixdesctest
  11364. @end example
  11365. can be used to test the monowhite pixel format descriptor definition.
  11366. @section pixscope
  11367. Display sample values of color channels. Mainly useful for checking color
  11368. and levels. Minimum supported resolution is 640x480.
  11369. The filters accept the following options:
  11370. @table @option
  11371. @item x
  11372. Set scope X position, relative offset on X axis.
  11373. @item y
  11374. Set scope Y position, relative offset on Y axis.
  11375. @item w
  11376. Set scope width.
  11377. @item h
  11378. Set scope height.
  11379. @item o
  11380. Set window opacity. This window also holds statistics about pixel area.
  11381. @item wx
  11382. Set window X position, relative offset on X axis.
  11383. @item wy
  11384. Set window Y position, relative offset on Y axis.
  11385. @end table
  11386. @section pp
  11387. Enable the specified chain of postprocessing subfilters using libpostproc. This
  11388. library should be automatically selected with a GPL build (@code{--enable-gpl}).
  11389. Subfilters must be separated by '/' and can be disabled by prepending a '-'.
  11390. Each subfilter and some options have a short and a long name that can be used
  11391. interchangeably, i.e. dr/dering are the same.
  11392. The filters accept the following options:
  11393. @table @option
  11394. @item subfilters
  11395. Set postprocessing subfilters string.
  11396. @end table
  11397. All subfilters share common options to determine their scope:
  11398. @table @option
  11399. @item a/autoq
  11400. Honor the quality commands for this subfilter.
  11401. @item c/chrom
  11402. Do chrominance filtering, too (default).
  11403. @item y/nochrom
  11404. Do luminance filtering only (no chrominance).
  11405. @item n/noluma
  11406. Do chrominance filtering only (no luminance).
  11407. @end table
  11408. These options can be appended after the subfilter name, separated by a '|'.
  11409. Available subfilters are:
  11410. @table @option
  11411. @item hb/hdeblock[|difference[|flatness]]
  11412. Horizontal deblocking filter
  11413. @table @option
  11414. @item difference
  11415. Difference factor where higher values mean more deblocking (default: @code{32}).
  11416. @item flatness
  11417. Flatness threshold where lower values mean more deblocking (default: @code{39}).
  11418. @end table
  11419. @item vb/vdeblock[|difference[|flatness]]
  11420. Vertical deblocking filter
  11421. @table @option
  11422. @item difference
  11423. Difference factor where higher values mean more deblocking (default: @code{32}).
  11424. @item flatness
  11425. Flatness threshold where lower values mean more deblocking (default: @code{39}).
  11426. @end table
  11427. @item ha/hadeblock[|difference[|flatness]]
  11428. Accurate horizontal deblocking filter
  11429. @table @option
  11430. @item difference
  11431. Difference factor where higher values mean more deblocking (default: @code{32}).
  11432. @item flatness
  11433. Flatness threshold where lower values mean more deblocking (default: @code{39}).
  11434. @end table
  11435. @item va/vadeblock[|difference[|flatness]]
  11436. Accurate vertical deblocking filter
  11437. @table @option
  11438. @item difference
  11439. Difference factor where higher values mean more deblocking (default: @code{32}).
  11440. @item flatness
  11441. Flatness threshold where lower values mean more deblocking (default: @code{39}).
  11442. @end table
  11443. @end table
  11444. The horizontal and vertical deblocking filters share the difference and
  11445. flatness values so you cannot set different horizontal and vertical
  11446. thresholds.
  11447. @table @option
  11448. @item h1/x1hdeblock
  11449. Experimental horizontal deblocking filter
  11450. @item v1/x1vdeblock
  11451. Experimental vertical deblocking filter
  11452. @item dr/dering
  11453. Deringing filter
  11454. @item tn/tmpnoise[|threshold1[|threshold2[|threshold3]]], temporal noise reducer
  11455. @table @option
  11456. @item threshold1
  11457. larger -> stronger filtering
  11458. @item threshold2
  11459. larger -> stronger filtering
  11460. @item threshold3
  11461. larger -> stronger filtering
  11462. @end table
  11463. @item al/autolevels[:f/fullyrange], automatic brightness / contrast correction
  11464. @table @option
  11465. @item f/fullyrange
  11466. Stretch luminance to @code{0-255}.
  11467. @end table
  11468. @item lb/linblenddeint
  11469. Linear blend deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given block by
  11470. filtering all lines with a @code{(1 2 1)} filter.
  11471. @item li/linipoldeint
  11472. Linear interpolating deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given block by
  11473. linearly interpolating every second line.
  11474. @item ci/cubicipoldeint
  11475. Cubic interpolating deinterlacing filter deinterlaces the given block by
  11476. cubically interpolating every second line.
  11477. @item md/mediandeint
  11478. Median deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given block by applying a
  11479. median filter to every second line.
  11480. @item fd/ffmpegdeint
  11481. FFmpeg deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given block by filtering every
  11482. second line with a @code{(-1 4 2 4 -1)} filter.
  11483. @item l5/lowpass5
  11484. Vertically applied FIR lowpass deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given
  11485. block by filtering all lines with a @code{(-1 2 6 2 -1)} filter.
  11486. @item fq/forceQuant[|quantizer]
  11487. Overrides the quantizer table from the input with the constant quantizer you
  11488. specify.
  11489. @table @option
  11490. @item quantizer
  11491. Quantizer to use
  11492. @end table
  11493. @item de/default
  11494. Default pp filter combination (@code{hb|a,vb|a,dr|a})
  11495. @item fa/fast
  11496. Fast pp filter combination (@code{h1|a,v1|a,dr|a})
  11497. @item ac
  11498. High quality pp filter combination (@code{ha|a|128|7,va|a,dr|a})
  11499. @end table
  11500. @subsection Examples
  11501. @itemize
  11502. @item
  11503. Apply horizontal and vertical deblocking, deringing and automatic
  11504. brightness/contrast:
  11505. @example
  11506. pp=hb/vb/dr/al
  11507. @end example
  11508. @item
  11509. Apply default filters without brightness/contrast correction:
  11510. @example
  11511. pp=de/-al
  11512. @end example
  11513. @item
  11514. Apply default filters and temporal denoiser:
  11515. @example
  11516. pp=default/tmpnoise|1|2|3
  11517. @end example
  11518. @item
  11519. Apply deblocking on luminance only, and switch vertical deblocking on or off
  11520. automatically depending on available CPU time:
  11521. @example
  11522. pp=hb|y/vb|a
  11523. @end example
  11524. @end itemize
  11525. @section pp7
  11526. Apply Postprocessing filter 7. It is variant of the @ref{spp} filter,
  11527. similar to spp = 6 with 7 point DCT, where only the center sample is
  11528. used after IDCT.
  11529. The filter accepts the following options:
  11530. @table @option
  11531. @item qp
  11532. Force a constant quantization parameter. It accepts an integer in range
  11533. 0 to 63. If not set, the filter will use the QP from the video stream
  11534. (if available).
  11535. @item mode
  11536. Set thresholding mode. Available modes are:
  11537. @table @samp
  11538. @item hard
  11539. Set hard thresholding.
  11540. @item soft
  11541. Set soft thresholding (better de-ringing effect, but likely blurrier).
  11542. @item medium
  11543. Set medium thresholding (good results, default).
  11544. @end table
  11545. @end table
  11546. @section premultiply
  11547. Apply alpha premultiply effect to input video stream using first plane
  11548. of second stream as alpha.
  11549. Both streams must have same dimensions and same pixel format.
  11550. The filter accepts the following option:
  11551. @table @option
  11552. @item planes
  11553. Set which planes will be processed, unprocessed planes will be copied.
  11554. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  11555. @item inplace
  11556. Do not require 2nd input for processing, instead use alpha plane from input stream.
  11557. @end table
  11558. @section prewitt
  11559. Apply prewitt operator to input video stream.
  11560. The filter accepts the following option:
  11561. @table @option
  11562. @item planes
  11563. Set which planes will be processed, unprocessed planes will be copied.
  11564. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  11565. @item scale
  11566. Set value which will be multiplied with filtered result.
  11567. @item delta
  11568. Set value which will be added to filtered result.
  11569. @end table
  11570. @section pseudocolor
  11571. Alter frame colors in video with pseudocolors.
  11572. This filter accepts the following options:
  11573. @table @option
  11574. @item c0
  11575. set pixel first component expression
  11576. @item c1
  11577. set pixel second component expression
  11578. @item c2
  11579. set pixel third component expression
  11580. @item c3
  11581. set pixel fourth component expression, corresponds to the alpha component
  11582. @item i
  11583. set component to use as base for altering colors
  11584. @end table
  11585. Each of them specifies the expression to use for computing the lookup table for
  11586. the corresponding pixel component values.
  11587. The expressions can contain the following constants and functions:
  11588. @table @option
  11589. @item w
  11590. @item h
  11591. The input width and height.
  11592. @item val
  11593. The input value for the pixel component.
  11594. @item ymin, umin, vmin, amin
  11595. The minimum allowed component value.
  11596. @item ymax, umax, vmax, amax
  11597. The maximum allowed component value.
  11598. @end table
  11599. All expressions default to "val".
  11600. @subsection Examples
  11601. @itemize
  11602. @item
  11603. Change too high luma values to gradient:
  11604. @example
  11605. pseudocolor="'if(between(val,ymax,amax),lerp(ymin,ymax,(val-ymax)/(amax-ymax)),-1):if(between(val,ymax,amax),lerp(umax,umin,(val-ymax)/(amax-ymax)),-1):if(between(val,ymax,amax),lerp(vmin,vmax,(val-ymax)/(amax-ymax)),-1):-1'"
  11606. @end example
  11607. @end itemize
  11608. @section psnr
  11609. Obtain the average, maximum and minimum PSNR (Peak Signal to Noise
  11610. Ratio) between two input videos.
  11611. This filter takes in input two input videos, the first input is
  11612. considered the "main" source and is passed unchanged to the
  11613. output. The second input is used as a "reference" video for computing
  11614. the PSNR.
  11615. Both video inputs must have the same resolution and pixel format for
  11616. this filter to work correctly. Also it assumes that both inputs
  11617. have the same number of frames, which are compared one by one.
  11618. The obtained average PSNR is printed through the logging system.
  11619. The filter stores the accumulated MSE (mean squared error) of each
  11620. frame, and at the end of the processing it is averaged across all frames
  11621. equally, and the following formula is applied to obtain the PSNR:
  11622. @example
  11623. PSNR = 10*log10(MAX^2/MSE)
  11624. @end example
  11625. Where MAX is the average of the maximum values of each component of the
  11626. image.
  11627. The description of the accepted parameters follows.
  11628. @table @option
  11629. @item stats_file, f
  11630. If specified the filter will use the named file to save the PSNR of
  11631. each individual frame. When filename equals "-" the data is sent to
  11632. standard output.
  11633. @item stats_version
  11634. Specifies which version of the stats file format to use. Details of
  11635. each format are written below.
  11636. Default value is 1.
  11637. @item stats_add_max
  11638. Determines whether the max value is output to the stats log.
  11639. Default value is 0.
  11640. Requires stats_version >= 2. If this is set and stats_version < 2,
  11641. the filter will return an error.
  11642. @end table
  11643. This filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  11644. The file printed if @var{stats_file} is selected, contains a sequence of
  11645. key/value pairs of the form @var{key}:@var{value} for each compared
  11646. couple of frames.
  11647. If a @var{stats_version} greater than 1 is specified, a header line precedes
  11648. the list of per-frame-pair stats, with key value pairs following the frame
  11649. format with the following parameters:
  11650. @table @option
  11651. @item psnr_log_version
  11652. The version of the log file format. Will match @var{stats_version}.
  11653. @item fields
  11654. A comma separated list of the per-frame-pair parameters included in
  11655. the log.
  11656. @end table
  11657. A description of each shown per-frame-pair parameter follows:
  11658. @table @option
  11659. @item n
  11660. sequential number of the input frame, starting from 1
  11661. @item mse_avg
  11662. Mean Square Error pixel-by-pixel average difference of the compared
  11663. frames, averaged over all the image components.
  11664. @item mse_y, mse_u, mse_v, mse_r, mse_g, mse_b, mse_a
  11665. Mean Square Error pixel-by-pixel average difference of the compared
  11666. frames for the component specified by the suffix.
  11667. @item psnr_y, psnr_u, psnr_v, psnr_r, psnr_g, psnr_b, psnr_a
  11668. Peak Signal to Noise ratio of the compared frames for the component
  11669. specified by the suffix.
  11670. @item max_avg, max_y, max_u, max_v
  11671. Maximum allowed value for each channel, and average over all
  11672. channels.
  11673. @end table
  11674. @subsection Examples
  11675. @itemize
  11676. @item
  11677. For example:
  11678. @example
  11679. movie=ref_movie.mpg, setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [main];
  11680. [main][ref] psnr="stats_file=stats.log" [out]
  11681. @end example
  11682. On this example the input file being processed is compared with the
  11683. reference file @file{ref_movie.mpg}. The PSNR of each individual frame
  11684. is stored in @file{stats.log}.
  11685. @item
  11686. Another example with different containers:
  11687. @example
  11688. ffmpeg -i main.mpg -i ref.mkv -lavfi "[0:v]settb=AVTB,setpts=PTS-STARTPTS[main];[1:v]settb=AVTB,setpts=PTS-STARTPTS[ref];[main][ref]psnr" -f null -
  11689. @end example
  11690. @end itemize
  11691. @anchor{pullup}
  11692. @section pullup
  11693. Pulldown reversal (inverse telecine) filter, capable of handling mixed
  11694. hard-telecine, 24000/1001 fps progressive, and 30000/1001 fps progressive
  11695. content.
  11696. The pullup filter is designed to take advantage of future context in making
  11697. its decisions. This filter is stateless in the sense that it does not lock
  11698. onto a pattern to follow, but it instead looks forward to the following
  11699. fields in order to identify matches and rebuild progressive frames.
  11700. To produce content with an even framerate, insert the fps filter after
  11701. pullup, use @code{fps=24000/1001} if the input frame rate is 29.97fps,
  11702. @code{fps=24} for 30fps and the (rare) telecined 25fps input.
  11703. The filter accepts the following options:
  11704. @table @option
  11705. @item jl
  11706. @item jr
  11707. @item jt
  11708. @item jb
  11709. These options set the amount of "junk" to ignore at the left, right, top, and
  11710. bottom of the image, respectively. Left and right are in units of 8 pixels,
  11711. while top and bottom are in units of 2 lines.
  11712. The default is 8 pixels on each side.
  11713. @item sb
  11714. Set the strict breaks. Setting this option to 1 will reduce the chances of
  11715. filter generating an occasional mismatched frame, but it may also cause an
  11716. excessive number of frames to be dropped during high motion sequences.
  11717. Conversely, setting it to -1 will make filter match fields more easily.
  11718. This may help processing of video where there is slight blurring between
  11719. the fields, but may also cause there to be interlaced frames in the output.
  11720. Default value is @code{0}.
  11721. @item mp
  11722. Set the metric plane to use. It accepts the following values:
  11723. @table @samp
  11724. @item l
  11725. Use luma plane.
  11726. @item u
  11727. Use chroma blue plane.
  11728. @item v
  11729. Use chroma red plane.
  11730. @end table
  11731. This option may be set to use chroma plane instead of the default luma plane
  11732. for doing filter's computations. This may improve accuracy on very clean
  11733. source material, but more likely will decrease accuracy, especially if there
  11734. is chroma noise (rainbow effect) or any grayscale video.
  11735. The main purpose of setting @option{mp} to a chroma plane is to reduce CPU
  11736. load and make pullup usable in realtime on slow machines.
  11737. @end table
  11738. For best results (without duplicated frames in the output file) it is
  11739. necessary to change the output frame rate. For example, to inverse
  11740. telecine NTSC input:
  11741. @example
  11742. ffmpeg -i input -vf pullup -r 24000/1001 ...
  11743. @end example
  11744. @section qp
  11745. Change video quantization parameters (QP).
  11746. The filter accepts the following option:
  11747. @table @option
  11748. @item qp
  11749. Set expression for quantization parameter.
  11750. @end table
  11751. The expression is evaluated through the eval API and can contain, among others,
  11752. the following constants:
  11753. @table @var
  11754. @item known
  11755. 1 if index is not 129, 0 otherwise.
  11756. @item qp
  11757. Sequential index starting from -129 to 128.
  11758. @end table
  11759. @subsection Examples
  11760. @itemize
  11761. @item
  11762. Some equation like:
  11763. @example
  11764. qp=2+2*sin(PI*qp)
  11765. @end example
  11766. @end itemize
  11767. @section random
  11768. Flush video frames from internal cache of frames into a random order.
  11769. No frame is discarded.
  11770. Inspired by @ref{frei0r} nervous filter.
  11771. @table @option
  11772. @item frames
  11773. Set size in number of frames of internal cache, in range from @code{2} to
  11774. @code{512}. Default is @code{30}.
  11775. @item seed
  11776. Set seed for random number generator, must be an integer included between
  11777. @code{0} and @code{UINT32_MAX}. If not specified, or if explicitly set to
  11778. less than @code{0}, the filter will try to use a good random seed on a
  11779. best effort basis.
  11780. @end table
  11781. @section readeia608
  11782. Read closed captioning (EIA-608) information from the top lines of a video frame.
  11783. This filter adds frame metadata for @code{lavfi.readeia608.X.cc} and
  11784. @code{lavfi.readeia608.X.line}, where @code{X} is the number of the identified line
  11785. with EIA-608 data (starting from 0). A description of each metadata value follows:
  11786. @table @option
  11787. @item lavfi.readeia608.X.cc
  11788. The two bytes stored as EIA-608 data (printed in hexadecimal).
  11789. @item lavfi.readeia608.X.line
  11790. The number of the line on which the EIA-608 data was identified and read.
  11791. @end table
  11792. This filter accepts the following options:
  11793. @table @option
  11794. @item scan_min
  11795. Set the line to start scanning for EIA-608 data. Default is @code{0}.
  11796. @item scan_max
  11797. Set the line to end scanning for EIA-608 data. Default is @code{29}.
  11798. @item spw
  11799. Set the ratio of width reserved for sync code detection.
  11800. Default is @code{0.27}. Allowed range is @code{[0.1 - 0.7]}.
  11801. @item chp
  11802. Enable checking the parity bit. In the event of a parity error, the filter will output
  11803. @code{0x00} for that character. Default is false.
  11804. @item lp
  11805. Lowpass lines prior to further processing. Default is enabled.
  11806. @end table
  11807. @subsection Examples
  11808. @itemize
  11809. @item
  11810. Output a csv with presentation time and the first two lines of identified EIA-608 captioning data.
  11811. @example
  11812. ffprobe -f lavfi -i movie=captioned_video.mov,readeia608 -show_entries frame=pkt_pts_time:frame_tags=lavfi.readeia608.0.cc,lavfi.readeia608.1.cc -of csv
  11813. @end example
  11814. @end itemize
  11815. @section readvitc
  11816. Read vertical interval timecode (VITC) information from the top lines of a
  11817. video frame.
  11818. The filter adds frame metadata key @code{lavfi.readvitc.tc_str} with the
  11819. timecode value, if a valid timecode has been detected. Further metadata key
  11820. @code{lavfi.readvitc.found} is set to 0/1 depending on whether
  11821. timecode data has been found or not.
  11822. This filter accepts the following options:
  11823. @table @option
  11824. @item scan_max
  11825. Set the maximum number of lines to scan for VITC data. If the value is set to
  11826. @code{-1} the full video frame is scanned. Default is @code{45}.
  11827. @item thr_b
  11828. Set the luma threshold for black. Accepts float numbers in the range [0.0,1.0],
  11829. default value is @code{0.2}. The value must be equal or less than @code{thr_w}.
  11830. @item thr_w
  11831. Set the luma threshold for white. Accepts float numbers in the range [0.0,1.0],
  11832. default value is @code{0.6}. The value must be equal or greater than @code{thr_b}.
  11833. @end table
  11834. @subsection Examples
  11835. @itemize
  11836. @item
  11837. Detect and draw VITC data onto the video frame; if no valid VITC is detected,
  11838. draw @code{--:--:--:--} as a placeholder:
  11839. @example
  11840. ffmpeg -i input.avi -filter:v 'readvitc,drawtext=fontfile=FreeMono.ttf:text=%@{metadata\\:lavfi.readvitc.tc_str\\:--\\\\\\:--\\\\\\:--\\\\\\:--@}:x=(w-tw)/2:y=400-ascent'
  11841. @end example
  11842. @end itemize
  11843. @section remap
  11844. Remap pixels using 2nd: Xmap and 3rd: Ymap input video stream.
  11845. Destination pixel at position (X, Y) will be picked from source (x, y) position
  11846. where x = Xmap(X, Y) and y = Ymap(X, Y). If mapping values are out of range, zero
  11847. value for pixel will be used for destination pixel.
  11848. Xmap and Ymap input video streams must be of same dimensions. Output video stream
  11849. will have Xmap/Ymap video stream dimensions.
  11850. Xmap and Ymap input video streams are 16bit depth, single channel.
  11851. @table @option
  11852. @item format
  11853. Specify pixel format of output from this filter. Can be @code{color} or @code{gray}.
  11854. Default is @code{color}.
  11855. @item fill
  11856. Specify the color of the unmapped pixels. For the syntax of this option,
  11857. check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils
  11858. manual,ffmpeg-utils}. Default color is @code{black}.
  11859. @end table
  11860. @section removegrain
  11861. The removegrain filter is a spatial denoiser for progressive video.
  11862. @table @option
  11863. @item m0
  11864. Set mode for the first plane.
  11865. @item m1
  11866. Set mode for the second plane.
  11867. @item m2
  11868. Set mode for the third plane.
  11869. @item m3
  11870. Set mode for the fourth plane.
  11871. @end table
  11872. Range of mode is from 0 to 24. Description of each mode follows:
  11873. @table @var
  11874. @item 0
  11875. Leave input plane unchanged. Default.
  11876. @item 1
  11877. Clips the pixel with the minimum and maximum of the 8 neighbour pixels.
  11878. @item 2
  11879. Clips the pixel with the second minimum and maximum of the 8 neighbour pixels.
  11880. @item 3
  11881. Clips the pixel with the third minimum and maximum of the 8 neighbour pixels.
  11882. @item 4
  11883. Clips the pixel with the fourth minimum and maximum of the 8 neighbour pixels.
  11884. This is equivalent to a median filter.
  11885. @item 5
  11886. Line-sensitive clipping giving the minimal change.
  11887. @item 6
  11888. Line-sensitive clipping, intermediate.
  11889. @item 7
  11890. Line-sensitive clipping, intermediate.
  11891. @item 8
  11892. Line-sensitive clipping, intermediate.
  11893. @item 9
  11894. Line-sensitive clipping on a line where the neighbours pixels are the closest.
  11895. @item 10
  11896. Replaces the target pixel with the closest neighbour.
  11897. @item 11
  11898. [1 2 1] horizontal and vertical kernel blur.
  11899. @item 12
  11900. Same as mode 11.
  11901. @item 13
  11902. Bob mode, interpolates top field from the line where the neighbours
  11903. pixels are the closest.
  11904. @item 14
  11905. Bob mode, interpolates bottom field from the line where the neighbours
  11906. pixels are the closest.
  11907. @item 15
  11908. Bob mode, interpolates top field. Same as 13 but with a more complicated
  11909. interpolation formula.
  11910. @item 16
  11911. Bob mode, interpolates bottom field. Same as 14 but with a more complicated
  11912. interpolation formula.
  11913. @item 17
  11914. Clips the pixel with the minimum and maximum of respectively the maximum and
  11915. minimum of each pair of opposite neighbour pixels.
  11916. @item 18
  11917. Line-sensitive clipping using opposite neighbours whose greatest distance from
  11918. the current pixel is minimal.
  11919. @item 19
  11920. Replaces the pixel with the average of its 8 neighbours.
  11921. @item 20
  11922. Averages the 9 pixels ([1 1 1] horizontal and vertical blur).
  11923. @item 21
  11924. Clips pixels using the averages of opposite neighbour.
  11925. @item 22
  11926. Same as mode 21 but simpler and faster.
  11927. @item 23
  11928. Small edge and halo removal, but reputed useless.
  11929. @item 24
  11930. Similar as 23.
  11931. @end table
  11932. @section removelogo
  11933. Suppress a TV station logo, using an image file to determine which
  11934. pixels comprise the logo. It works by filling in the pixels that
  11935. comprise the logo with neighboring pixels.
  11936. The filter accepts the following options:
  11937. @table @option
  11938. @item filename, f
  11939. Set the filter bitmap file, which can be any image format supported by
  11940. libavformat. The width and height of the image file must match those of the
  11941. video stream being processed.
  11942. @end table
  11943. Pixels in the provided bitmap image with a value of zero are not
  11944. considered part of the logo, non-zero pixels are considered part of
  11945. the logo. If you use white (255) for the logo and black (0) for the
  11946. rest, you will be safe. For making the filter bitmap, it is
  11947. recommended to take a screen capture of a black frame with the logo
  11948. visible, and then using a threshold filter followed by the erode
  11949. filter once or twice.
  11950. If needed, little splotches can be fixed manually. Remember that if
  11951. logo pixels are not covered, the filter quality will be much
  11952. reduced. Marking too many pixels as part of the logo does not hurt as
  11953. much, but it will increase the amount of blurring needed to cover over
  11954. the image and will destroy more information than necessary, and extra
  11955. pixels will slow things down on a large logo.
  11956. @section repeatfields
  11957. This filter uses the repeat_field flag from the Video ES headers and hard repeats
  11958. fields based on its value.
  11959. @section reverse
  11960. Reverse a video clip.
  11961. Warning: This filter requires memory to buffer the entire clip, so trimming
  11962. is suggested.
  11963. @subsection Examples
  11964. @itemize
  11965. @item
  11966. Take the first 5 seconds of a clip, and reverse it.
  11967. @example
  11968. trim=end=5,reverse
  11969. @end example
  11970. @end itemize
  11971. @section rgbashift
  11972. Shift R/G/B/A pixels horizontally and/or vertically.
  11973. The filter accepts the following options:
  11974. @table @option
  11975. @item rh
  11976. Set amount to shift red horizontally.
  11977. @item rv
  11978. Set amount to shift red vertically.
  11979. @item gh
  11980. Set amount to shift green horizontally.
  11981. @item gv
  11982. Set amount to shift green vertically.
  11983. @item bh
  11984. Set amount to shift blue horizontally.
  11985. @item bv
  11986. Set amount to shift blue vertically.
  11987. @item ah
  11988. Set amount to shift alpha horizontally.
  11989. @item av
  11990. Set amount to shift alpha vertically.
  11991. @item edge
  11992. Set edge mode, can be @var{smear}, default, or @var{warp}.
  11993. @end table
  11994. @subsection Commands
  11995. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  11996. @section roberts
  11997. Apply roberts cross operator to input video stream.
  11998. The filter accepts the following option:
  11999. @table @option
  12000. @item planes
  12001. Set which planes will be processed, unprocessed planes will be copied.
  12002. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  12003. @item scale
  12004. Set value which will be multiplied with filtered result.
  12005. @item delta
  12006. Set value which will be added to filtered result.
  12007. @end table
  12008. @section rotate
  12009. Rotate video by an arbitrary angle expressed in radians.
  12010. The filter accepts the following options:
  12011. A description of the optional parameters follows.
  12012. @table @option
  12013. @item angle, a
  12014. Set an expression for the angle by which to rotate the input video
  12015. clockwise, expressed as a number of radians. A negative value will
  12016. result in a counter-clockwise rotation. By default it is set to "0".
  12017. This expression is evaluated for each frame.
  12018. @item out_w, ow
  12019. Set the output width expression, default value is "iw".
  12020. This expression is evaluated just once during configuration.
  12021. @item out_h, oh
  12022. Set the output height expression, default value is "ih".
  12023. This expression is evaluated just once during configuration.
  12024. @item bilinear
  12025. Enable bilinear interpolation if set to 1, a value of 0 disables
  12026. it. Default value is 1.
  12027. @item fillcolor, c
  12028. Set the color used to fill the output area not covered by the rotated
  12029. image. For the general syntax of this option, check the
  12030. @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  12031. If the special value "none" is selected then no
  12032. background is printed (useful for example if the background is never shown).
  12033. Default value is "black".
  12034. @end table
  12035. The expressions for the angle and the output size can contain the
  12036. following constants and functions:
  12037. @table @option
  12038. @item n
  12039. sequential number of the input frame, starting from 0. It is always NAN
  12040. before the first frame is filtered.
  12041. @item t
  12042. time in seconds of the input frame, it is set to 0 when the filter is
  12043. configured. It is always NAN before the first frame is filtered.
  12044. @item hsub
  12045. @item vsub
  12046. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  12047. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  12048. @item in_w, iw
  12049. @item in_h, ih
  12050. the input video width and height
  12051. @item out_w, ow
  12052. @item out_h, oh
  12053. the output width and height, that is the size of the padded area as
  12054. specified by the @var{width} and @var{height} expressions
  12055. @item rotw(a)
  12056. @item roth(a)
  12057. the minimal width/height required for completely containing the input
  12058. video rotated by @var{a} radians.
  12059. These are only available when computing the @option{out_w} and
  12060. @option{out_h} expressions.
  12061. @end table
  12062. @subsection Examples
  12063. @itemize
  12064. @item
  12065. Rotate the input by PI/6 radians clockwise:
  12066. @example
  12067. rotate=PI/6
  12068. @end example
  12069. @item
  12070. Rotate the input by PI/6 radians counter-clockwise:
  12071. @example
  12072. rotate=-PI/6
  12073. @end example
  12074. @item
  12075. Rotate the input by 45 degrees clockwise:
  12076. @example
  12077. rotate=45*PI/180
  12078. @end example
  12079. @item
  12080. Apply a constant rotation with period T, starting from an angle of PI/3:
  12081. @example
  12082. rotate=PI/3+2*PI*t/T
  12083. @end example
  12084. @item
  12085. Make the input video rotation oscillating with a period of T
  12086. seconds and an amplitude of A radians:
  12087. @example
  12088. rotate=A*sin(2*PI/T*t)
  12089. @end example
  12090. @item
  12091. Rotate the video, output size is chosen so that the whole rotating
  12092. input video is always completely contained in the output:
  12093. @example
  12094. rotate='2*PI*t:ow=hypot(iw,ih):oh=ow'
  12095. @end example
  12096. @item
  12097. Rotate the video, reduce the output size so that no background is ever
  12098. shown:
  12099. @example
  12100. rotate=2*PI*t:ow='min(iw,ih)/sqrt(2)':oh=ow:c=none
  12101. @end example
  12102. @end itemize
  12103. @subsection Commands
  12104. The filter supports the following commands:
  12105. @table @option
  12106. @item a, angle
  12107. Set the angle expression.
  12108. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  12109. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  12110. value.
  12111. @end table
  12112. @section sab
  12113. Apply Shape Adaptive Blur.
  12114. The filter accepts the following options:
  12115. @table @option
  12116. @item luma_radius, lr
  12117. Set luma blur filter strength, must be a value in range 0.1-4.0, default
  12118. value is 1.0. A greater value will result in a more blurred image, and
  12119. in slower processing.
  12120. @item luma_pre_filter_radius, lpfr
  12121. Set luma pre-filter radius, must be a value in the 0.1-2.0 range, default
  12122. value is 1.0.
  12123. @item luma_strength, ls
  12124. Set luma maximum difference between pixels to still be considered, must
  12125. be a value in the 0.1-100.0 range, default value is 1.0.
  12126. @item chroma_radius, cr
  12127. Set chroma blur filter strength, must be a value in range -0.9-4.0. A
  12128. greater value will result in a more blurred image, and in slower
  12129. processing.
  12130. @item chroma_pre_filter_radius, cpfr
  12131. Set chroma pre-filter radius, must be a value in the -0.9-2.0 range.
  12132. @item chroma_strength, cs
  12133. Set chroma maximum difference between pixels to still be considered,
  12134. must be a value in the -0.9-100.0 range.
  12135. @end table
  12136. Each chroma option value, if not explicitly specified, is set to the
  12137. corresponding luma option value.
  12138. @anchor{scale}
  12139. @section scale
  12140. Scale (resize) the input video, using the libswscale library.
  12141. The scale filter forces the output display aspect ratio to be the same
  12142. of the input, by changing the output sample aspect ratio.
  12143. If the input image format is different from the format requested by
  12144. the next filter, the scale filter will convert the input to the
  12145. requested format.
  12146. @subsection Options
  12147. The filter accepts the following options, or any of the options
  12148. supported by the libswscale scaler.
  12149. See @ref{scaler_options,,the ffmpeg-scaler manual,ffmpeg-scaler} for
  12150. the complete list of scaler options.
  12151. @table @option
  12152. @item width, w
  12153. @item height, h
  12154. Set the output video dimension expression. Default value is the input
  12155. dimension.
  12156. If the @var{width} or @var{w} value is 0, the input width is used for
  12157. the output. If the @var{height} or @var{h} value is 0, the input height
  12158. is used for the output.
  12159. If one and only one of the values is -n with n >= 1, the scale filter
  12160. will use a value that maintains the aspect ratio of the input image,
  12161. calculated from the other specified dimension. After that it will,
  12162. however, make sure that the calculated dimension is divisible by n and
  12163. adjust the value if necessary.
  12164. If both values are -n with n >= 1, the behavior will be identical to
  12165. both values being set to 0 as previously detailed.
  12166. See below for the list of accepted constants for use in the dimension
  12167. expression.
  12168. @item eval
  12169. Specify when to evaluate @var{width} and @var{height} expression. It accepts the following values:
  12170. @table @samp
  12171. @item init
  12172. Only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or when a command is processed.
  12173. @item frame
  12174. Evaluate expressions for each incoming frame.
  12175. @end table
  12176. Default value is @samp{init}.
  12177. @item interl
  12178. Set the interlacing mode. It accepts the following values:
  12179. @table @samp
  12180. @item 1
  12181. Force interlaced aware scaling.
  12182. @item 0
  12183. Do not apply interlaced scaling.
  12184. @item -1
  12185. Select interlaced aware scaling depending on whether the source frames
  12186. are flagged as interlaced or not.
  12187. @end table
  12188. Default value is @samp{0}.
  12189. @item flags
  12190. Set libswscale scaling flags. See
  12191. @ref{sws_flags,,the ffmpeg-scaler manual,ffmpeg-scaler} for the
  12192. complete list of values. If not explicitly specified the filter applies
  12193. the default flags.
  12194. @item param0, param1
  12195. Set libswscale input parameters for scaling algorithms that need them. See
  12196. @ref{sws_params,,the ffmpeg-scaler manual,ffmpeg-scaler} for the
  12197. complete documentation. If not explicitly specified the filter applies
  12198. empty parameters.
  12199. @item size, s
  12200. Set the video size. For the syntax of this option, check the
  12201. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  12202. @item in_color_matrix
  12203. @item out_color_matrix
  12204. Set in/output YCbCr color space type.
  12205. This allows the autodetected value to be overridden as well as allows forcing
  12206. a specific value used for the output and encoder.
  12207. If not specified, the color space type depends on the pixel format.
  12208. Possible values:
  12209. @table @samp
  12210. @item auto
  12211. Choose automatically.
  12212. @item bt709
  12213. Format conforming to International Telecommunication Union (ITU)
  12214. Recommendation BT.709.
  12215. @item fcc
  12216. Set color space conforming to the United States Federal Communications
  12217. Commission (FCC) Code of Federal Regulations (CFR) Title 47 (2003) 73.682 (a).
  12218. @item bt601
  12219. @item bt470
  12220. @item smpte170m
  12221. Set color space conforming to:
  12222. @itemize
  12223. @item
  12224. ITU Radiocommunication Sector (ITU-R) Recommendation BT.601
  12225. @item
  12226. ITU-R Rec. BT.470-6 (1998) Systems B, B1, and G
  12227. @item
  12228. Society of Motion Picture and Television Engineers (SMPTE) ST 170:2004
  12229. @end itemize
  12230. @item smpte240m
  12231. Set color space conforming to SMPTE ST 240:1999.
  12232. @item bt2020
  12233. Set color space conforming to ITU-R BT.2020 non-constant luminance system.
  12234. @end table
  12235. @item in_range
  12236. @item out_range
  12237. Set in/output YCbCr sample range.
  12238. This allows the autodetected value to be overridden as well as allows forcing
  12239. a specific value used for the output and encoder. If not specified, the
  12240. range depends on the pixel format. Possible values:
  12241. @table @samp
  12242. @item auto/unknown
  12243. Choose automatically.
  12244. @item jpeg/full/pc
  12245. Set full range (0-255 in case of 8-bit luma).
  12246. @item mpeg/limited/tv
  12247. Set "MPEG" range (16-235 in case of 8-bit luma).
  12248. @end table
  12249. @item force_original_aspect_ratio
  12250. Enable decreasing or increasing output video width or height if necessary to
  12251. keep the original aspect ratio. Possible values:
  12252. @table @samp
  12253. @item disable
  12254. Scale the video as specified and disable this feature.
  12255. @item decrease
  12256. The output video dimensions will automatically be decreased if needed.
  12257. @item increase
  12258. The output video dimensions will automatically be increased if needed.
  12259. @end table
  12260. One useful instance of this option is that when you know a specific device's
  12261. maximum allowed resolution, you can use this to limit the output video to
  12262. that, while retaining the aspect ratio. For example, device A allows
  12263. 1280x720 playback, and your video is 1920x800. Using this option (set it to
  12264. decrease) and specifying 1280x720 to the command line makes the output
  12265. 1280x533.
  12266. Please note that this is a different thing than specifying -1 for @option{w}
  12267. or @option{h}, you still need to specify the output resolution for this option
  12268. to work.
  12269. @item force_divisible_by
  12270. Ensures that both the output dimensions, width and height, are divisible by the
  12271. given integer when used together with @option{force_original_aspect_ratio}. This
  12272. works similar to using @code{-n} in the @option{w} and @option{h} options.
  12273. This option respects the value set for @option{force_original_aspect_ratio},
  12274. increasing or decreasing the resolution accordingly. The video's aspect ratio
  12275. may be slightly modified.
  12276. This option can be handy if you need to have a video fit within or exceed
  12277. a defined resolution using @option{force_original_aspect_ratio} but also have
  12278. encoder restrictions on width or height divisibility.
  12279. @end table
  12280. The values of the @option{w} and @option{h} options are expressions
  12281. containing the following constants:
  12282. @table @var
  12283. @item in_w
  12284. @item in_h
  12285. The input width and height
  12286. @item iw
  12287. @item ih
  12288. These are the same as @var{in_w} and @var{in_h}.
  12289. @item out_w
  12290. @item out_h
  12291. The output (scaled) width and height
  12292. @item ow
  12293. @item oh
  12294. These are the same as @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}
  12295. @item a
  12296. The same as @var{iw} / @var{ih}
  12297. @item sar
  12298. input sample aspect ratio
  12299. @item dar
  12300. The input display aspect ratio. Calculated from @code{(iw / ih) * sar}.
  12301. @item hsub
  12302. @item vsub
  12303. horizontal and vertical input chroma subsample values. For example for the
  12304. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  12305. @item ohsub
  12306. @item ovsub
  12307. horizontal and vertical output chroma subsample values. For example for the
  12308. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  12309. @item n
  12310. The (sequential) number of the input frame, starting from 0.
  12311. Only available with @code{eval=frame}.
  12312. @item t
  12313. The presentation timestamp of the input frame, expressed as a number of
  12314. seconds. Only available with @code{eval=frame}.
  12315. @item pos
  12316. The position (byte offset) of the frame in the input stream, or NaN if
  12317. this information is unavailable and/or meaningless (for example in case of synthetic video).
  12318. Only available with @code{eval=frame}.
  12319. @end table
  12320. @subsection Examples
  12321. @itemize
  12322. @item
  12323. Scale the input video to a size of 200x100
  12324. @example
  12325. scale=w=200:h=100
  12326. @end example
  12327. This is equivalent to:
  12328. @example
  12329. scale=200:100
  12330. @end example
  12331. or:
  12332. @example
  12333. scale=200x100
  12334. @end example
  12335. @item
  12336. Specify a size abbreviation for the output size:
  12337. @example
  12338. scale=qcif
  12339. @end example
  12340. which can also be written as:
  12341. @example
  12342. scale=size=qcif
  12343. @end example
  12344. @item
  12345. Scale the input to 2x:
  12346. @example
  12347. scale=w=2*iw:h=2*ih
  12348. @end example
  12349. @item
  12350. The above is the same as:
  12351. @example
  12352. scale=2*in_w:2*in_h
  12353. @end example
  12354. @item
  12355. Scale the input to 2x with forced interlaced scaling:
  12356. @example
  12357. scale=2*iw:2*ih:interl=1
  12358. @end example
  12359. @item
  12360. Scale the input to half size:
  12361. @example
  12362. scale=w=iw/2:h=ih/2
  12363. @end example
  12364. @item
  12365. Increase the width, and set the height to the same size:
  12366. @example
  12367. scale=3/2*iw:ow
  12368. @end example
  12369. @item
  12370. Seek Greek harmony:
  12371. @example
  12372. scale=iw:1/PHI*iw
  12373. scale=ih*PHI:ih
  12374. @end example
  12375. @item
  12376. Increase the height, and set the width to 3/2 of the height:
  12377. @example
  12378. scale=w=3/2*oh:h=3/5*ih
  12379. @end example
  12380. @item
  12381. Increase the size, making the size a multiple of the chroma
  12382. subsample values:
  12383. @example
  12384. scale="trunc(3/2*iw/hsub)*hsub:trunc(3/2*ih/vsub)*vsub"
  12385. @end example
  12386. @item
  12387. Increase the width to a maximum of 500 pixels,
  12388. keeping the same aspect ratio as the input:
  12389. @example
  12390. scale=w='min(500\, iw*3/2):h=-1'
  12391. @end example
  12392. @item
  12393. Make pixels square by combining scale and setsar:
  12394. @example
  12395. scale='trunc(ih*dar):ih',setsar=1/1
  12396. @end example
  12397. @item
  12398. Make pixels square by combining scale and setsar,
  12399. making sure the resulting resolution is even (required by some codecs):
  12400. @example
  12401. scale='trunc(ih*dar/2)*2:trunc(ih/2)*2',setsar=1/1
  12402. @end example
  12403. @end itemize
  12404. @subsection Commands
  12405. This filter supports the following commands:
  12406. @table @option
  12407. @item width, w
  12408. @item height, h
  12409. Set the output video dimension expression.
  12410. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  12411. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  12412. value.
  12413. @end table
  12414. @section scale_npp
  12415. Use the NVIDIA Performance Primitives (libnpp) to perform scaling and/or pixel
  12416. format conversion on CUDA video frames. Setting the output width and height
  12417. works in the same way as for the @var{scale} filter.
  12418. The following additional options are accepted:
  12419. @table @option
  12420. @item format
  12421. The pixel format of the output CUDA frames. If set to the string "same" (the
  12422. default), the input format will be kept. Note that automatic format negotiation
  12423. and conversion is not yet supported for hardware frames
  12424. @item interp_algo
  12425. The interpolation algorithm used for resizing. One of the following:
  12426. @table @option
  12427. @item nn
  12428. Nearest neighbour.
  12429. @item linear
  12430. @item cubic
  12431. @item cubic2p_bspline
  12432. 2-parameter cubic (B=1, C=0)
  12433. @item cubic2p_catmullrom
  12434. 2-parameter cubic (B=0, C=1/2)
  12435. @item cubic2p_b05c03
  12436. 2-parameter cubic (B=1/2, C=3/10)
  12437. @item super
  12438. Supersampling
  12439. @item lanczos
  12440. @end table
  12441. @item force_original_aspect_ratio
  12442. Enable decreasing or increasing output video width or height if necessary to
  12443. keep the original aspect ratio. Possible values:
  12444. @table @samp
  12445. @item disable
  12446. Scale the video as specified and disable this feature.
  12447. @item decrease
  12448. The output video dimensions will automatically be decreased if needed.
  12449. @item increase
  12450. The output video dimensions will automatically be increased if needed.
  12451. @end table
  12452. One useful instance of this option is that when you know a specific device's
  12453. maximum allowed resolution, you can use this to limit the output video to
  12454. that, while retaining the aspect ratio. For example, device A allows
  12455. 1280x720 playback, and your video is 1920x800. Using this option (set it to
  12456. decrease) and specifying 1280x720 to the command line makes the output
  12457. 1280x533.
  12458. Please note that this is a different thing than specifying -1 for @option{w}
  12459. or @option{h}, you still need to specify the output resolution for this option
  12460. to work.
  12461. @item force_divisible_by
  12462. Ensures that both the output dimensions, width and height, are divisible by the
  12463. given integer when used together with @option{force_original_aspect_ratio}. This
  12464. works similar to using @code{-n} in the @option{w} and @option{h} options.
  12465. This option respects the value set for @option{force_original_aspect_ratio},
  12466. increasing or decreasing the resolution accordingly. The video's aspect ratio
  12467. may be slightly modified.
  12468. This option can be handy if you need to have a video fit within or exceed
  12469. a defined resolution using @option{force_original_aspect_ratio} but also have
  12470. encoder restrictions on width or height divisibility.
  12471. @end table
  12472. @section scale2ref
  12473. Scale (resize) the input video, based on a reference video.
  12474. See the scale filter for available options, scale2ref supports the same but
  12475. uses the reference video instead of the main input as basis. scale2ref also
  12476. supports the following additional constants for the @option{w} and
  12477. @option{h} options:
  12478. @table @var
  12479. @item main_w
  12480. @item main_h
  12481. The main input video's width and height
  12482. @item main_a
  12483. The same as @var{main_w} / @var{main_h}
  12484. @item main_sar
  12485. The main input video's sample aspect ratio
  12486. @item main_dar, mdar
  12487. The main input video's display aspect ratio. Calculated from
  12488. @code{(main_w / main_h) * main_sar}.
  12489. @item main_hsub
  12490. @item main_vsub
  12491. The main input video's horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values.
  12492. For example for the pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub}
  12493. is 1.
  12494. @item main_n
  12495. The (sequential) number of the main input frame, starting from 0.
  12496. Only available with @code{eval=frame}.
  12497. @item main_t
  12498. The presentation timestamp of the main input frame, expressed as a number of
  12499. seconds. Only available with @code{eval=frame}.
  12500. @item main_pos
  12501. The position (byte offset) of the frame in the main input stream, or NaN if
  12502. this information is unavailable and/or meaningless (for example in case of synthetic video).
  12503. Only available with @code{eval=frame}.
  12504. @end table
  12505. @subsection Examples
  12506. @itemize
  12507. @item
  12508. Scale a subtitle stream (b) to match the main video (a) in size before overlaying
  12509. @example
  12510. 'scale2ref[b][a];[a][b]overlay'
  12511. @end example
  12512. @item
  12513. Scale a logo to 1/10th the height of a video, while preserving its display aspect ratio.
  12514. @example
  12515. [logo-in][video-in]scale2ref=w=oh*mdar:h=ih/10[logo-out][video-out]
  12516. @end example
  12517. @end itemize
  12518. @subsection Commands
  12519. This filter supports the following commands:
  12520. @table @option
  12521. @item width, w
  12522. @item height, h
  12523. Set the output video dimension expression.
  12524. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  12525. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  12526. value.
  12527. @end table
  12528. @section scroll
  12529. Scroll input video horizontally and/or vertically by constant speed.
  12530. The filter accepts the following options:
  12531. @table @option
  12532. @item horizontal, h
  12533. Set the horizontal scrolling speed. Default is 0. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  12534. Negative values changes scrolling direction.
  12535. @item vertical, v
  12536. Set the vertical scrolling speed. Default is 0. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  12537. Negative values changes scrolling direction.
  12538. @item hpos
  12539. Set the initial horizontal scrolling position. Default is 0. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  12540. @item vpos
  12541. Set the initial vertical scrolling position. Default is 0. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  12542. @end table
  12543. @subsection Commands
  12544. This filter supports the following @ref{commands}:
  12545. @table @option
  12546. @item horizontal, h
  12547. Set the horizontal scrolling speed.
  12548. @item vertical, v
  12549. Set the vertical scrolling speed.
  12550. @end table
  12551. @anchor{selectivecolor}
  12552. @section selectivecolor
  12553. Adjust cyan, magenta, yellow and black (CMYK) to certain ranges of colors (such
  12554. as "reds", "yellows", "greens", "cyans", ...). The adjustment range is defined
  12555. by the "purity" of the color (that is, how saturated it already is).
  12556. This filter is similar to the Adobe Photoshop Selective Color tool.
  12557. The filter accepts the following options:
  12558. @table @option
  12559. @item correction_method
  12560. Select color correction method.
  12561. Available values are:
  12562. @table @samp
  12563. @item absolute
  12564. Specified adjustments are applied "as-is" (added/subtracted to original pixel
  12565. component value).
  12566. @item relative
  12567. Specified adjustments are relative to the original component value.
  12568. @end table
  12569. Default is @code{absolute}.
  12570. @item reds
  12571. Adjustments for red pixels (pixels where the red component is the maximum)
  12572. @item yellows
  12573. Adjustments for yellow pixels (pixels where the blue component is the minimum)
  12574. @item greens
  12575. Adjustments for green pixels (pixels where the green component is the maximum)
  12576. @item cyans
  12577. Adjustments for cyan pixels (pixels where the red component is the minimum)
  12578. @item blues
  12579. Adjustments for blue pixels (pixels where the blue component is the maximum)
  12580. @item magentas
  12581. Adjustments for magenta pixels (pixels where the green component is the minimum)
  12582. @item whites
  12583. Adjustments for white pixels (pixels where all components are greater than 128)
  12584. @item neutrals
  12585. Adjustments for all pixels except pure black and pure white
  12586. @item blacks
  12587. Adjustments for black pixels (pixels where all components are lesser than 128)
  12588. @item psfile
  12589. Specify a Photoshop selective color file (@code{.asv}) to import the settings from.
  12590. @end table
  12591. All the adjustment settings (@option{reds}, @option{yellows}, ...) accept up to
  12592. 4 space separated floating point adjustment values in the [-1,1] range,
  12593. respectively to adjust the amount of cyan, magenta, yellow and black for the
  12594. pixels of its range.
  12595. @subsection Examples
  12596. @itemize
  12597. @item
  12598. Increase cyan by 50% and reduce yellow by 33% in every green areas, and
  12599. increase magenta by 27% in blue areas:
  12600. @example
  12601. selectivecolor=greens=.5 0 -.33 0:blues=0 .27
  12602. @end example
  12603. @item
  12604. Use a Photoshop selective color preset:
  12605. @example
  12606. selectivecolor=psfile=MySelectiveColorPresets/Misty.asv
  12607. @end example
  12608. @end itemize
  12609. @anchor{separatefields}
  12610. @section separatefields
  12611. The @code{separatefields} takes a frame-based video input and splits
  12612. each frame into its components fields, producing a new half height clip
  12613. with twice the frame rate and twice the frame count.
  12614. This filter use field-dominance information in frame to decide which
  12615. of each pair of fields to place first in the output.
  12616. If it gets it wrong use @ref{setfield} filter before @code{separatefields} filter.
  12617. @section setdar, setsar
  12618. The @code{setdar} filter sets the Display Aspect Ratio for the filter
  12619. output video.
  12620. This is done by changing the specified Sample (aka Pixel) Aspect
  12621. Ratio, according to the following equation:
  12622. @example
  12623. @var{DAR} = @var{HORIZONTAL_RESOLUTION} / @var{VERTICAL_RESOLUTION} * @var{SAR}
  12624. @end example
  12625. Keep in mind that the @code{setdar} filter does not modify the pixel
  12626. dimensions of the video frame. Also, the display aspect ratio set by
  12627. this filter may be changed by later filters in the filterchain,
  12628. e.g. in case of scaling or if another "setdar" or a "setsar" filter is
  12629. applied.
  12630. The @code{setsar} filter sets the Sample (aka Pixel) Aspect Ratio for
  12631. the filter output video.
  12632. Note that as a consequence of the application of this filter, the
  12633. output display aspect ratio will change according to the equation
  12634. above.
  12635. Keep in mind that the sample aspect ratio set by the @code{setsar}
  12636. filter may be changed by later filters in the filterchain, e.g. if
  12637. another "setsar" or a "setdar" filter is applied.
  12638. It accepts the following parameters:
  12639. @table @option
  12640. @item r, ratio, dar (@code{setdar} only), sar (@code{setsar} only)
  12641. Set the aspect ratio used by the filter.
  12642. The parameter can be a floating point number string, an expression, or
  12643. a string of the form @var{num}:@var{den}, where @var{num} and
  12644. @var{den} are the numerator and denominator of the aspect ratio. If
  12645. the parameter is not specified, it is assumed the value "0".
  12646. In case the form "@var{num}:@var{den}" is used, the @code{:} character
  12647. should be escaped.
  12648. @item max
  12649. Set the maximum integer value to use for expressing numerator and
  12650. denominator when reducing the expressed aspect ratio to a rational.
  12651. Default value is @code{100}.
  12652. @end table
  12653. The parameter @var{sar} is an expression containing
  12654. the following constants:
  12655. @table @option
  12656. @item E, PI, PHI
  12657. These are approximated values for the mathematical constants e
  12658. (Euler's number), pi (Greek pi), and phi (the golden ratio).
  12659. @item w, h
  12660. The input width and height.
  12661. @item a
  12662. These are the same as @var{w} / @var{h}.
  12663. @item sar
  12664. The input sample aspect ratio.
  12665. @item dar
  12666. The input display aspect ratio. It is the same as
  12667. (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}.
  12668. @item hsub, vsub
  12669. Horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example, for the
  12670. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  12671. @end table
  12672. @subsection Examples
  12673. @itemize
  12674. @item
  12675. To change the display aspect ratio to 16:9, specify one of the following:
  12676. @example
  12677. setdar=dar=1.77777
  12678. setdar=dar=16/9
  12679. @end example
  12680. @item
  12681. To change the sample aspect ratio to 10:11, specify:
  12682. @example
  12683. setsar=sar=10/11
  12684. @end example
  12685. @item
  12686. To set a display aspect ratio of 16:9, and specify a maximum integer value of
  12687. 1000 in the aspect ratio reduction, use the command:
  12688. @example
  12689. setdar=ratio=16/9:max=1000
  12690. @end example
  12691. @end itemize
  12692. @anchor{setfield}
  12693. @section setfield
  12694. Force field for the output video frame.
  12695. The @code{setfield} filter marks the interlace type field for the
  12696. output frames. It does not change the input frame, but only sets the
  12697. corresponding property, which affects how the frame is treated by
  12698. following filters (e.g. @code{fieldorder} or @code{yadif}).
  12699. The filter accepts the following options:
  12700. @table @option
  12701. @item mode
  12702. Available values are:
  12703. @table @samp
  12704. @item auto
  12705. Keep the same field property.
  12706. @item bff
  12707. Mark the frame as bottom-field-first.
  12708. @item tff
  12709. Mark the frame as top-field-first.
  12710. @item prog
  12711. Mark the frame as progressive.
  12712. @end table
  12713. @end table
  12714. @anchor{setparams}
  12715. @section setparams
  12716. Force frame parameter for the output video frame.
  12717. The @code{setparams} filter marks interlace and color range for the
  12718. output frames. It does not change the input frame, but only sets the
  12719. corresponding property, which affects how the frame is treated by
  12720. filters/encoders.
  12721. @table @option
  12722. @item field_mode
  12723. Available values are:
  12724. @table @samp
  12725. @item auto
  12726. Keep the same field property (default).
  12727. @item bff
  12728. Mark the frame as bottom-field-first.
  12729. @item tff
  12730. Mark the frame as top-field-first.
  12731. @item prog
  12732. Mark the frame as progressive.
  12733. @end table
  12734. @item range
  12735. Available values are:
  12736. @table @samp
  12737. @item auto
  12738. Keep the same color range property (default).
  12739. @item unspecified, unknown
  12740. Mark the frame as unspecified color range.
  12741. @item limited, tv, mpeg
  12742. Mark the frame as limited range.
  12743. @item full, pc, jpeg
  12744. Mark the frame as full range.
  12745. @end table
  12746. @item color_primaries
  12747. Set the color primaries.
  12748. Available values are:
  12749. @table @samp
  12750. @item auto
  12751. Keep the same color primaries property (default).
  12752. @item bt709
  12753. @item unknown
  12754. @item bt470m
  12755. @item bt470bg
  12756. @item smpte170m
  12757. @item smpte240m
  12758. @item film
  12759. @item bt2020
  12760. @item smpte428
  12761. @item smpte431
  12762. @item smpte432
  12763. @item jedec-p22
  12764. @end table
  12765. @item color_trc
  12766. Set the color transfer.
  12767. Available values are:
  12768. @table @samp
  12769. @item auto
  12770. Keep the same color trc property (default).
  12771. @item bt709
  12772. @item unknown
  12773. @item bt470m
  12774. @item bt470bg
  12775. @item smpte170m
  12776. @item smpte240m
  12777. @item linear
  12778. @item log100
  12779. @item log316
  12780. @item iec61966-2-4
  12781. @item bt1361e
  12782. @item iec61966-2-1
  12783. @item bt2020-10
  12784. @item bt2020-12
  12785. @item smpte2084
  12786. @item smpte428
  12787. @item arib-std-b67
  12788. @end table
  12789. @item colorspace
  12790. Set the colorspace.
  12791. Available values are:
  12792. @table @samp
  12793. @item auto
  12794. Keep the same colorspace property (default).
  12795. @item gbr
  12796. @item bt709
  12797. @item unknown
  12798. @item fcc
  12799. @item bt470bg
  12800. @item smpte170m
  12801. @item smpte240m
  12802. @item ycgco
  12803. @item bt2020nc
  12804. @item bt2020c
  12805. @item smpte2085
  12806. @item chroma-derived-nc
  12807. @item chroma-derived-c
  12808. @item ictcp
  12809. @end table
  12810. @end table
  12811. @section showinfo
  12812. Show a line containing various information for each input video frame.
  12813. The input video is not modified.
  12814. This filter supports the following options:
  12815. @table @option
  12816. @item checksum
  12817. Calculate checksums of each plane. By default enabled.
  12818. @end table
  12819. The shown line contains a sequence of key/value pairs of the form
  12820. @var{key}:@var{value}.
  12821. The following values are shown in the output:
  12822. @table @option
  12823. @item n
  12824. The (sequential) number of the input frame, starting from 0.
  12825. @item pts
  12826. The Presentation TimeStamp of the input frame, expressed as a number of
  12827. time base units. The time base unit depends on the filter input pad.
  12828. @item pts_time
  12829. The Presentation TimeStamp of the input frame, expressed as a number of
  12830. seconds.
  12831. @item pos
  12832. The position of the frame in the input stream, or -1 if this information is
  12833. unavailable and/or meaningless (for example in case of synthetic video).
  12834. @item fmt
  12835. The pixel format name.
  12836. @item sar
  12837. The sample aspect ratio of the input frame, expressed in the form
  12838. @var{num}/@var{den}.
  12839. @item s
  12840. The size of the input frame. For the syntax of this option, check the
  12841. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  12842. @item i
  12843. The type of interlaced mode ("P" for "progressive", "T" for top field first, "B"
  12844. for bottom field first).
  12845. @item iskey
  12846. This is 1 if the frame is a key frame, 0 otherwise.
  12847. @item type
  12848. The picture type of the input frame ("I" for an I-frame, "P" for a
  12849. P-frame, "B" for a B-frame, or "?" for an unknown type).
  12850. Also refer to the documentation of the @code{AVPictureType} enum and of
  12851. the @code{av_get_picture_type_char} function defined in
  12852. @file{libavutil/avutil.h}.
  12853. @item checksum
  12854. The Adler-32 checksum (printed in hexadecimal) of all the planes of the input frame.
  12855. @item plane_checksum
  12856. The Adler-32 checksum (printed in hexadecimal) of each plane of the input frame,
  12857. expressed in the form "[@var{c0} @var{c1} @var{c2} @var{c3}]".
  12858. @item mean
  12859. The mean value of pixels in each plane of the input frame, expressed in the form
  12860. "[@var{mean0} @var{mean1} @var{mean2} @var{mean3}]".
  12861. @item stdev
  12862. The standard deviation of pixel values in each plane of the input frame, expressed
  12863. in the form "[@var{stdev0} @var{stdev1} @var{stdev2} @var{stdev3}]".
  12864. @end table
  12865. @section showpalette
  12866. Displays the 256 colors palette of each frame. This filter is only relevant for
  12867. @var{pal8} pixel format frames.
  12868. It accepts the following option:
  12869. @table @option
  12870. @item s
  12871. Set the size of the box used to represent one palette color entry. Default is
  12872. @code{30} (for a @code{30x30} pixel box).
  12873. @end table
  12874. @section shuffleframes
  12875. Reorder and/or duplicate and/or drop video frames.
  12876. It accepts the following parameters:
  12877. @table @option
  12878. @item mapping
  12879. Set the destination indexes of input frames.
  12880. This is space or '|' separated list of indexes that maps input frames to output
  12881. frames. Number of indexes also sets maximal value that each index may have.
  12882. '-1' index have special meaning and that is to drop frame.
  12883. @end table
  12884. The first frame has the index 0. The default is to keep the input unchanged.
  12885. @subsection Examples
  12886. @itemize
  12887. @item
  12888. Swap second and third frame of every three frames of the input:
  12889. @example
  12890. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf "shuffleframes=0 2 1" OUTPUT
  12891. @end example
  12892. @item
  12893. Swap 10th and 1st frame of every ten frames of the input:
  12894. @example
  12895. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf "shuffleframes=9 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 0" OUTPUT
  12896. @end example
  12897. @end itemize
  12898. @section shuffleplanes
  12899. Reorder and/or duplicate video planes.
  12900. It accepts the following parameters:
  12901. @table @option
  12902. @item map0
  12903. The index of the input plane to be used as the first output plane.
  12904. @item map1
  12905. The index of the input plane to be used as the second output plane.
  12906. @item map2
  12907. The index of the input plane to be used as the third output plane.
  12908. @item map3
  12909. The index of the input plane to be used as the fourth output plane.
  12910. @end table
  12911. The first plane has the index 0. The default is to keep the input unchanged.
  12912. @subsection Examples
  12913. @itemize
  12914. @item
  12915. Swap the second and third planes of the input:
  12916. @example
  12917. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf shuffleplanes=0:2:1:3 OUTPUT
  12918. @end example
  12919. @end itemize
  12920. @anchor{signalstats}
  12921. @section signalstats
  12922. Evaluate various visual metrics that assist in determining issues associated
  12923. with the digitization of analog video media.
  12924. By default the filter will log these metadata values:
  12925. @table @option
  12926. @item YMIN
  12927. Display the minimal Y value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  12928. range of [0-255].
  12929. @item YLOW
  12930. Display the Y value at the 10% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  12931. range of [0-255].
  12932. @item YAVG
  12933. Display the average Y value within the input frame. Expressed in range of
  12934. [0-255].
  12935. @item YHIGH
  12936. Display the Y value at the 90% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  12937. range of [0-255].
  12938. @item YMAX
  12939. Display the maximum Y value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  12940. range of [0-255].
  12941. @item UMIN
  12942. Display the minimal U value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  12943. range of [0-255].
  12944. @item ULOW
  12945. Display the U value at the 10% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  12946. range of [0-255].
  12947. @item UAVG
  12948. Display the average U value within the input frame. Expressed in range of
  12949. [0-255].
  12950. @item UHIGH
  12951. Display the U value at the 90% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  12952. range of [0-255].
  12953. @item UMAX
  12954. Display the maximum U value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  12955. range of [0-255].
  12956. @item VMIN
  12957. Display the minimal V value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  12958. range of [0-255].
  12959. @item VLOW
  12960. Display the V value at the 10% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  12961. range of [0-255].
  12962. @item VAVG
  12963. Display the average V value within the input frame. Expressed in range of
  12964. [0-255].
  12965. @item VHIGH
  12966. Display the V value at the 90% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  12967. range of [0-255].
  12968. @item VMAX
  12969. Display the maximum V value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  12970. range of [0-255].
  12971. @item SATMIN
  12972. Display the minimal saturation value contained within the input frame.
  12973. Expressed in range of [0-~181.02].
  12974. @item SATLOW
  12975. Display the saturation value at the 10% percentile within the input frame.
  12976. Expressed in range of [0-~181.02].
  12977. @item SATAVG
  12978. Display the average saturation value within the input frame. Expressed in range
  12979. of [0-~181.02].
  12980. @item SATHIGH
  12981. Display the saturation value at the 90% percentile within the input frame.
  12982. Expressed in range of [0-~181.02].
  12983. @item SATMAX
  12984. Display the maximum saturation value contained within the input frame.
  12985. Expressed in range of [0-~181.02].
  12986. @item HUEMED
  12987. Display the median value for hue within the input frame. Expressed in range of
  12988. [0-360].
  12989. @item HUEAVG
  12990. Display the average value for hue within the input frame. Expressed in range of
  12991. [0-360].
  12992. @item YDIF
  12993. Display the average of sample value difference between all values of the Y
  12994. plane in the current frame and corresponding values of the previous input frame.
  12995. Expressed in range of [0-255].
  12996. @item UDIF
  12997. Display the average of sample value difference between all values of the U
  12998. plane in the current frame and corresponding values of the previous input frame.
  12999. Expressed in range of [0-255].
  13000. @item VDIF
  13001. Display the average of sample value difference between all values of the V
  13002. plane in the current frame and corresponding values of the previous input frame.
  13003. Expressed in range of [0-255].
  13004. @item YBITDEPTH
  13005. Display bit depth of Y plane in current frame.
  13006. Expressed in range of [0-16].
  13007. @item UBITDEPTH
  13008. Display bit depth of U plane in current frame.
  13009. Expressed in range of [0-16].
  13010. @item VBITDEPTH
  13011. Display bit depth of V plane in current frame.
  13012. Expressed in range of [0-16].
  13013. @end table
  13014. The filter accepts the following options:
  13015. @table @option
  13016. @item stat
  13017. @item out
  13018. @option{stat} specify an additional form of image analysis.
  13019. @option{out} output video with the specified type of pixel highlighted.
  13020. Both options accept the following values:
  13021. @table @samp
  13022. @item tout
  13023. Identify @var{temporal outliers} pixels. A @var{temporal outlier} is a pixel
  13024. unlike the neighboring pixels of the same field. Examples of temporal outliers
  13025. include the results of video dropouts, head clogs, or tape tracking issues.
  13026. @item vrep
  13027. Identify @var{vertical line repetition}. Vertical line repetition includes
  13028. similar rows of pixels within a frame. In born-digital video vertical line
  13029. repetition is common, but this pattern is uncommon in video digitized from an
  13030. analog source. When it occurs in video that results from the digitization of an
  13031. analog source it can indicate concealment from a dropout compensator.
  13032. @item brng
  13033. Identify pixels that fall outside of legal broadcast range.
  13034. @end table
  13035. @item color, c
  13036. Set the highlight color for the @option{out} option. The default color is
  13037. yellow.
  13038. @end table
  13039. @subsection Examples
  13040. @itemize
  13041. @item
  13042. Output data of various video metrics:
  13043. @example
  13044. ffprobe -f lavfi movie=example.mov,signalstats="stat=tout+vrep+brng" -show_frames
  13045. @end example
  13046. @item
  13047. Output specific data about the minimum and maximum values of the Y plane per frame:
  13048. @example
  13049. ffprobe -f lavfi movie=example.mov,signalstats -show_entries frame_tags=lavfi.signalstats.YMAX,lavfi.signalstats.YMIN
  13050. @end example
  13051. @item
  13052. Playback video while highlighting pixels that are outside of broadcast range in red.
  13053. @example
  13054. ffplay example.mov -vf signalstats="out=brng:color=red"
  13055. @end example
  13056. @item
  13057. Playback video with signalstats metadata drawn over the frame.
  13058. @example
  13059. ffplay example.mov -vf signalstats=stat=brng+vrep+tout,drawtext=fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:textfile=signalstat_drawtext.txt
  13060. @end example
  13061. The contents of signalstat_drawtext.txt used in the command are:
  13062. @example
  13063. time %@{pts:hms@}
  13064. Y (%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.YMIN@}-%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.YMAX@})
  13065. U (%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.UMIN@}-%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.UMAX@})
  13066. V (%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.VMIN@}-%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.VMAX@})
  13067. saturation maximum: %@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.SATMAX@}
  13068. @end example
  13069. @end itemize
  13070. @anchor{signature}
  13071. @section signature
  13072. Calculates the MPEG-7 Video Signature. The filter can handle more than one
  13073. input. In this case the matching between the inputs can be calculated additionally.
  13074. The filter always passes through the first input. The signature of each stream can
  13075. be written into a file.
  13076. It accepts the following options:
  13077. @table @option
  13078. @item detectmode
  13079. Enable or disable the matching process.
  13080. Available values are:
  13081. @table @samp
  13082. @item off
  13083. Disable the calculation of a matching (default).
  13084. @item full
  13085. Calculate the matching for the whole video and output whether the whole video
  13086. matches or only parts.
  13087. @item fast
  13088. Calculate only until a matching is found or the video ends. Should be faster in
  13089. some cases.
  13090. @end table
  13091. @item nb_inputs
  13092. Set the number of inputs. The option value must be a non negative integer.
  13093. Default value is 1.
  13094. @item filename
  13095. Set the path to which the output is written. If there is more than one input,
  13096. the path must be a prototype, i.e. must contain %d or %0nd (where n is a positive
  13097. integer), that will be replaced with the input number. If no filename is
  13098. specified, no output will be written. This is the default.
  13099. @item format
  13100. Choose the output format.
  13101. Available values are:
  13102. @table @samp
  13103. @item binary
  13104. Use the specified binary representation (default).
  13105. @item xml
  13106. Use the specified xml representation.
  13107. @end table
  13108. @item th_d
  13109. Set threshold to detect one word as similar. The option value must be an integer
  13110. greater than zero. The default value is 9000.
  13111. @item th_dc
  13112. Set threshold to detect all words as similar. The option value must be an integer
  13113. greater than zero. The default value is 60000.
  13114. @item th_xh
  13115. Set threshold to detect frames as similar. The option value must be an integer
  13116. greater than zero. The default value is 116.
  13117. @item th_di
  13118. Set the minimum length of a sequence in frames to recognize it as matching
  13119. sequence. The option value must be a non negative integer value.
  13120. The default value is 0.
  13121. @item th_it
  13122. Set the minimum relation, that matching frames to all frames must have.
  13123. The option value must be a double value between 0 and 1. The default value is 0.5.
  13124. @end table
  13125. @subsection Examples
  13126. @itemize
  13127. @item
  13128. To calculate the signature of an input video and store it in signature.bin:
  13129. @example
  13130. ffmpeg -i input.mkv -vf signature=filename=signature.bin -map 0:v -f null -
  13131. @end example
  13132. @item
  13133. To detect whether two videos match and store the signatures in XML format in
  13134. signature0.xml and signature1.xml:
  13135. @example
  13136. ffmpeg -i input1.mkv -i input2.mkv -filter_complex "[0:v][1:v] signature=nb_inputs=2:detectmode=full:format=xml:filename=signature%d.xml" -map :v -f null -
  13137. @end example
  13138. @end itemize
  13139. @anchor{smartblur}
  13140. @section smartblur
  13141. Blur the input video without impacting the outlines.
  13142. It accepts the following options:
  13143. @table @option
  13144. @item luma_radius, lr
  13145. Set the luma radius. The option value must be a float number in
  13146. the range [0.1,5.0] that specifies the variance of the gaussian filter
  13147. used to blur the image (slower if larger). Default value is 1.0.
  13148. @item luma_strength, ls
  13149. Set the luma strength. The option value must be a float number
  13150. in the range [-1.0,1.0] that configures the blurring. A value included
  13151. in [0.0,1.0] will blur the image whereas a value included in
  13152. [-1.0,0.0] will sharpen the image. Default value is 1.0.
  13153. @item luma_threshold, lt
  13154. Set the luma threshold used as a coefficient to determine
  13155. whether a pixel should be blurred or not. The option value must be an
  13156. integer in the range [-30,30]. A value of 0 will filter all the image,
  13157. a value included in [0,30] will filter flat areas and a value included
  13158. in [-30,0] will filter edges. Default value is 0.
  13159. @item chroma_radius, cr
  13160. Set the chroma radius. The option value must be a float number in
  13161. the range [0.1,5.0] that specifies the variance of the gaussian filter
  13162. used to blur the image (slower if larger). Default value is @option{luma_radius}.
  13163. @item chroma_strength, cs
  13164. Set the chroma strength. The option value must be a float number
  13165. in the range [-1.0,1.0] that configures the blurring. A value included
  13166. in [0.0,1.0] will blur the image whereas a value included in
  13167. [-1.0,0.0] will sharpen the image. Default value is @option{luma_strength}.
  13168. @item chroma_threshold, ct
  13169. Set the chroma threshold used as a coefficient to determine
  13170. whether a pixel should be blurred or not. The option value must be an
  13171. integer in the range [-30,30]. A value of 0 will filter all the image,
  13172. a value included in [0,30] will filter flat areas and a value included
  13173. in [-30,0] will filter edges. Default value is @option{luma_threshold}.
  13174. @end table
  13175. If a chroma option is not explicitly set, the corresponding luma value
  13176. is set.
  13177. @section sobel
  13178. Apply sobel operator to input video stream.
  13179. The filter accepts the following option:
  13180. @table @option
  13181. @item planes
  13182. Set which planes will be processed, unprocessed planes will be copied.
  13183. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  13184. @item scale
  13185. Set value which will be multiplied with filtered result.
  13186. @item delta
  13187. Set value which will be added to filtered result.
  13188. @end table
  13189. @anchor{spp}
  13190. @section spp
  13191. Apply a simple postprocessing filter that compresses and decompresses the image
  13192. at several (or - in the case of @option{quality} level @code{6} - all) shifts
  13193. and average the results.
  13194. The filter accepts the following options:
  13195. @table @option
  13196. @item quality
  13197. Set quality. This option defines the number of levels for averaging. It accepts
  13198. an integer in the range 0-6. If set to @code{0}, the filter will have no
  13199. effect. A value of @code{6} means the higher quality. For each increment of
  13200. that value the speed drops by a factor of approximately 2. Default value is
  13201. @code{3}.
  13202. @item qp
  13203. Force a constant quantization parameter. If not set, the filter will use the QP
  13204. from the video stream (if available).
  13205. @item mode
  13206. Set thresholding mode. Available modes are:
  13207. @table @samp
  13208. @item hard
  13209. Set hard thresholding (default).
  13210. @item soft
  13211. Set soft thresholding (better de-ringing effect, but likely blurrier).
  13212. @end table
  13213. @item use_bframe_qp
  13214. Enable the use of the QP from the B-Frames if set to @code{1}. Using this
  13215. option may cause flicker since the B-Frames have often larger QP. Default is
  13216. @code{0} (not enabled).
  13217. @end table
  13218. @subsection Commands
  13219. This filter supports the following commands:
  13220. @table @option
  13221. @item quality, level
  13222. Set quality level. The value @code{max} can be used to set the maximum level,
  13223. currently @code{6}.
  13224. @end table
  13225. @anchor{sr}
  13226. @section sr
  13227. Scale the input by applying one of the super-resolution methods based on
  13228. convolutional neural networks. Supported models:
  13229. @itemize
  13230. @item
  13231. Super-Resolution Convolutional Neural Network model (SRCNN).
  13232. See @url{https://arxiv.org/abs/1501.00092}.
  13233. @item
  13234. Efficient Sub-Pixel Convolutional Neural Network model (ESPCN).
  13235. See @url{https://arxiv.org/abs/1609.05158}.
  13236. @end itemize
  13237. Training scripts as well as scripts for model file (.pb) saving can be found at
  13238. @url{https://github.com/XueweiMeng/sr/tree/sr_dnn_native}. Original repository
  13239. is at @url{https://github.com/HighVoltageRocknRoll/sr.git}.
  13240. Native model files (.model) can be generated from TensorFlow model
  13241. files (.pb) by using tools/python/convert.py
  13242. The filter accepts the following options:
  13243. @table @option
  13244. @item dnn_backend
  13245. Specify which DNN backend to use for model loading and execution. This option accepts
  13246. the following values:
  13247. @table @samp
  13248. @item native
  13249. Native implementation of DNN loading and execution.
  13250. @item tensorflow
  13251. TensorFlow backend. To enable this backend you
  13252. need to install the TensorFlow for C library (see
  13253. @url{https://www.tensorflow.org/install/install_c}) and configure FFmpeg with
  13254. @code{--enable-libtensorflow}
  13255. @end table
  13256. Default value is @samp{native}.
  13257. @item model
  13258. Set path to model file specifying network architecture and its parameters.
  13259. Note that different backends use different file formats. TensorFlow backend
  13260. can load files for both formats, while native backend can load files for only
  13261. its format.
  13262. @item scale_factor
  13263. Set scale factor for SRCNN model. Allowed values are @code{2}, @code{3} and @code{4}.
  13264. Default value is @code{2}. Scale factor is necessary for SRCNN model, because it accepts
  13265. input upscaled using bicubic upscaling with proper scale factor.
  13266. @end table
  13267. This feature can also be finished with @ref{dnn_processing} filter.
  13268. @section ssim
  13269. Obtain the SSIM (Structural SImilarity Metric) between two input videos.
  13270. This filter takes in input two input videos, the first input is
  13271. considered the "main" source and is passed unchanged to the
  13272. output. The second input is used as a "reference" video for computing
  13273. the SSIM.
  13274. Both video inputs must have the same resolution and pixel format for
  13275. this filter to work correctly. Also it assumes that both inputs
  13276. have the same number of frames, which are compared one by one.
  13277. The filter stores the calculated SSIM of each frame.
  13278. The description of the accepted parameters follows.
  13279. @table @option
  13280. @item stats_file, f
  13281. If specified the filter will use the named file to save the SSIM of
  13282. each individual frame. When filename equals "-" the data is sent to
  13283. standard output.
  13284. @end table
  13285. The file printed if @var{stats_file} is selected, contains a sequence of
  13286. key/value pairs of the form @var{key}:@var{value} for each compared
  13287. couple of frames.
  13288. A description of each shown parameter follows:
  13289. @table @option
  13290. @item n
  13291. sequential number of the input frame, starting from 1
  13292. @item Y, U, V, R, G, B
  13293. SSIM of the compared frames for the component specified by the suffix.
  13294. @item All
  13295. SSIM of the compared frames for the whole frame.
  13296. @item dB
  13297. Same as above but in dB representation.
  13298. @end table
  13299. This filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  13300. @subsection Examples
  13301. @itemize
  13302. @item
  13303. For example:
  13304. @example
  13305. movie=ref_movie.mpg, setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [main];
  13306. [main][ref] ssim="stats_file=stats.log" [out]
  13307. @end example
  13308. On this example the input file being processed is compared with the
  13309. reference file @file{ref_movie.mpg}. The SSIM of each individual frame
  13310. is stored in @file{stats.log}.
  13311. @item
  13312. Another example with both psnr and ssim at same time:
  13313. @example
  13314. ffmpeg -i main.mpg -i ref.mpg -lavfi "ssim;[0:v][1:v]psnr" -f null -
  13315. @end example
  13316. @item
  13317. Another example with different containers:
  13318. @example
  13319. ffmpeg -i main.mpg -i ref.mkv -lavfi "[0:v]settb=AVTB,setpts=PTS-STARTPTS[main];[1:v]settb=AVTB,setpts=PTS-STARTPTS[ref];[main][ref]ssim" -f null -
  13320. @end example
  13321. @end itemize
  13322. @section stereo3d
  13323. Convert between different stereoscopic image formats.
  13324. The filters accept the following options:
  13325. @table @option
  13326. @item in
  13327. Set stereoscopic image format of input.
  13328. Available values for input image formats are:
  13329. @table @samp
  13330. @item sbsl
  13331. side by side parallel (left eye left, right eye right)
  13332. @item sbsr
  13333. side by side crosseye (right eye left, left eye right)
  13334. @item sbs2l
  13335. side by side parallel with half width resolution
  13336. (left eye left, right eye right)
  13337. @item sbs2r
  13338. side by side crosseye with half width resolution
  13339. (right eye left, left eye right)
  13340. @item abl
  13341. @item tbl
  13342. above-below (left eye above, right eye below)
  13343. @item abr
  13344. @item tbr
  13345. above-below (right eye above, left eye below)
  13346. @item ab2l
  13347. @item tb2l
  13348. above-below with half height resolution
  13349. (left eye above, right eye below)
  13350. @item ab2r
  13351. @item tb2r
  13352. above-below with half height resolution
  13353. (right eye above, left eye below)
  13354. @item al
  13355. alternating frames (left eye first, right eye second)
  13356. @item ar
  13357. alternating frames (right eye first, left eye second)
  13358. @item irl
  13359. interleaved rows (left eye has top row, right eye starts on next row)
  13360. @item irr
  13361. interleaved rows (right eye has top row, left eye starts on next row)
  13362. @item icl
  13363. interleaved columns, left eye first
  13364. @item icr
  13365. interleaved columns, right eye first
  13366. Default value is @samp{sbsl}.
  13367. @end table
  13368. @item out
  13369. Set stereoscopic image format of output.
  13370. @table @samp
  13371. @item sbsl
  13372. side by side parallel (left eye left, right eye right)
  13373. @item sbsr
  13374. side by side crosseye (right eye left, left eye right)
  13375. @item sbs2l
  13376. side by side parallel with half width resolution
  13377. (left eye left, right eye right)
  13378. @item sbs2r
  13379. side by side crosseye with half width resolution
  13380. (right eye left, left eye right)
  13381. @item abl
  13382. @item tbl
  13383. above-below (left eye above, right eye below)
  13384. @item abr
  13385. @item tbr
  13386. above-below (right eye above, left eye below)
  13387. @item ab2l
  13388. @item tb2l
  13389. above-below with half height resolution
  13390. (left eye above, right eye below)
  13391. @item ab2r
  13392. @item tb2r
  13393. above-below with half height resolution
  13394. (right eye above, left eye below)
  13395. @item al
  13396. alternating frames (left eye first, right eye second)
  13397. @item ar
  13398. alternating frames (right eye first, left eye second)
  13399. @item irl
  13400. interleaved rows (left eye has top row, right eye starts on next row)
  13401. @item irr
  13402. interleaved rows (right eye has top row, left eye starts on next row)
  13403. @item arbg
  13404. anaglyph red/blue gray
  13405. (red filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
  13406. @item argg
  13407. anaglyph red/green gray
  13408. (red filter on left eye, green filter on right eye)
  13409. @item arcg
  13410. anaglyph red/cyan gray
  13411. (red filter on left eye, cyan filter on right eye)
  13412. @item arch
  13413. anaglyph red/cyan half colored
  13414. (red filter on left eye, cyan filter on right eye)
  13415. @item arcc
  13416. anaglyph red/cyan color
  13417. (red filter on left eye, cyan filter on right eye)
  13418. @item arcd
  13419. anaglyph red/cyan color optimized with the least squares projection of dubois
  13420. (red filter on left eye, cyan filter on right eye)
  13421. @item agmg
  13422. anaglyph green/magenta gray
  13423. (green filter on left eye, magenta filter on right eye)
  13424. @item agmh
  13425. anaglyph green/magenta half colored
  13426. (green filter on left eye, magenta filter on right eye)
  13427. @item agmc
  13428. anaglyph green/magenta colored
  13429. (green filter on left eye, magenta filter on right eye)
  13430. @item agmd
  13431. anaglyph green/magenta color optimized with the least squares projection of dubois
  13432. (green filter on left eye, magenta filter on right eye)
  13433. @item aybg
  13434. anaglyph yellow/blue gray
  13435. (yellow filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
  13436. @item aybh
  13437. anaglyph yellow/blue half colored
  13438. (yellow filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
  13439. @item aybc
  13440. anaglyph yellow/blue colored
  13441. (yellow filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
  13442. @item aybd
  13443. anaglyph yellow/blue color optimized with the least squares projection of dubois
  13444. (yellow filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
  13445. @item ml
  13446. mono output (left eye only)
  13447. @item mr
  13448. mono output (right eye only)
  13449. @item chl
  13450. checkerboard, left eye first
  13451. @item chr
  13452. checkerboard, right eye first
  13453. @item icl
  13454. interleaved columns, left eye first
  13455. @item icr
  13456. interleaved columns, right eye first
  13457. @item hdmi
  13458. HDMI frame pack
  13459. @end table
  13460. Default value is @samp{arcd}.
  13461. @end table
  13462. @subsection Examples
  13463. @itemize
  13464. @item
  13465. Convert input video from side by side parallel to anaglyph yellow/blue dubois:
  13466. @example
  13467. stereo3d=sbsl:aybd
  13468. @end example
  13469. @item
  13470. Convert input video from above below (left eye above, right eye below) to side by side crosseye.
  13471. @example
  13472. stereo3d=abl:sbsr
  13473. @end example
  13474. @end itemize
  13475. @section streamselect, astreamselect
  13476. Select video or audio streams.
  13477. The filter accepts the following options:
  13478. @table @option
  13479. @item inputs
  13480. Set number of inputs. Default is 2.
  13481. @item map
  13482. Set input indexes to remap to outputs.
  13483. @end table
  13484. @subsection Commands
  13485. The @code{streamselect} and @code{astreamselect} filter supports the following
  13486. commands:
  13487. @table @option
  13488. @item map
  13489. Set input indexes to remap to outputs.
  13490. @end table
  13491. @subsection Examples
  13492. @itemize
  13493. @item
  13494. Select first 5 seconds 1st stream and rest of time 2nd stream:
  13495. @example
  13496. sendcmd='5.0 streamselect map 1',streamselect=inputs=2:map=0
  13497. @end example
  13498. @item
  13499. Same as above, but for audio:
  13500. @example
  13501. asendcmd='5.0 astreamselect map 1',astreamselect=inputs=2:map=0
  13502. @end example
  13503. @end itemize
  13504. @anchor{subtitles}
  13505. @section subtitles
  13506. Draw subtitles on top of input video using the libass library.
  13507. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  13508. @code{--enable-libass}. This filter also requires a build with libavcodec and
  13509. libavformat to convert the passed subtitles file to ASS (Advanced Substation
  13510. Alpha) subtitles format.
  13511. The filter accepts the following options:
  13512. @table @option
  13513. @item filename, f
  13514. Set the filename of the subtitle file to read. It must be specified.
  13515. @item original_size
  13516. Specify the size of the original video, the video for which the ASS file
  13517. was composed. For the syntax of this option, check the
  13518. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  13519. Due to a misdesign in ASS aspect ratio arithmetic, this is necessary to
  13520. correctly scale the fonts if the aspect ratio has been changed.
  13521. @item fontsdir
  13522. Set a directory path containing fonts that can be used by the filter.
  13523. These fonts will be used in addition to whatever the font provider uses.
  13524. @item alpha
  13525. Process alpha channel, by default alpha channel is untouched.
  13526. @item charenc
  13527. Set subtitles input character encoding. @code{subtitles} filter only. Only
  13528. useful if not UTF-8.
  13529. @item stream_index, si
  13530. Set subtitles stream index. @code{subtitles} filter only.
  13531. @item force_style
  13532. Override default style or script info parameters of the subtitles. It accepts a
  13533. string containing ASS style format @code{KEY=VALUE} couples separated by ",".
  13534. @end table
  13535. If the first key is not specified, it is assumed that the first value
  13536. specifies the @option{filename}.
  13537. For example, to render the file @file{sub.srt} on top of the input
  13538. video, use the command:
  13539. @example
  13540. subtitles=sub.srt
  13541. @end example
  13542. which is equivalent to:
  13543. @example
  13544. subtitles=filename=sub.srt
  13545. @end example
  13546. To render the default subtitles stream from file @file{video.mkv}, use:
  13547. @example
  13548. subtitles=video.mkv
  13549. @end example
  13550. To render the second subtitles stream from that file, use:
  13551. @example
  13552. subtitles=video.mkv:si=1
  13553. @end example
  13554. To make the subtitles stream from @file{sub.srt} appear in 80% transparent blue
  13555. @code{DejaVu Serif}, use:
  13556. @example
  13557. subtitles=sub.srt:force_style='FontName=DejaVu Serif,PrimaryColour=&HCCFF0000'
  13558. @end example
  13559. @section super2xsai
  13560. Scale the input by 2x and smooth using the Super2xSaI (Scale and
  13561. Interpolate) pixel art scaling algorithm.
  13562. Useful for enlarging pixel art images without reducing sharpness.
  13563. @section swaprect
  13564. Swap two rectangular objects in video.
  13565. This filter accepts the following options:
  13566. @table @option
  13567. @item w
  13568. Set object width.
  13569. @item h
  13570. Set object height.
  13571. @item x1
  13572. Set 1st rect x coordinate.
  13573. @item y1
  13574. Set 1st rect y coordinate.
  13575. @item x2
  13576. Set 2nd rect x coordinate.
  13577. @item y2
  13578. Set 2nd rect y coordinate.
  13579. All expressions are evaluated once for each frame.
  13580. @end table
  13581. The all options are expressions containing the following constants:
  13582. @table @option
  13583. @item w
  13584. @item h
  13585. The input width and height.
  13586. @item a
  13587. same as @var{w} / @var{h}
  13588. @item sar
  13589. input sample aspect ratio
  13590. @item dar
  13591. input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}
  13592. @item n
  13593. The number of the input frame, starting from 0.
  13594. @item t
  13595. The timestamp expressed in seconds. It's NAN if the input timestamp is unknown.
  13596. @item pos
  13597. the position in the file of the input frame, NAN if unknown
  13598. @end table
  13599. @section swapuv
  13600. Swap U & V plane.
  13601. @section tblend
  13602. Blend successive video frames.
  13603. See @ref{blend}
  13604. @section telecine
  13605. Apply telecine process to the video.
  13606. This filter accepts the following options:
  13607. @table @option
  13608. @item first_field
  13609. @table @samp
  13610. @item top, t
  13611. top field first
  13612. @item bottom, b
  13613. bottom field first
  13614. The default value is @code{top}.
  13615. @end table
  13616. @item pattern
  13617. A string of numbers representing the pulldown pattern you wish to apply.
  13618. The default value is @code{23}.
  13619. @end table
  13620. @example
  13621. Some typical patterns:
  13622. NTSC output (30i):
  13623. 27.5p: 32222
  13624. 24p: 23 (classic)
  13625. 24p: 2332 (preferred)
  13626. 20p: 33
  13627. 18p: 334
  13628. 16p: 3444
  13629. PAL output (25i):
  13630. 27.5p: 12222
  13631. 24p: 222222222223 ("Euro pulldown")
  13632. 16.67p: 33
  13633. 16p: 33333334
  13634. @end example
  13635. @section thistogram
  13636. Compute and draw a color distribution histogram for the input video across time.
  13637. Unlike @ref{histogram} video filter which only shows histogram of single input frame
  13638. at certain time, this filter shows also past histograms of number of frames defined
  13639. by @code{width} option.
  13640. The computed histogram is a representation of the color component
  13641. distribution in an image.
  13642. The filter accepts the following options:
  13643. @table @option
  13644. @item width, w
  13645. Set width of single color component output. Default value is @code{0}.
  13646. Value of @code{0} means width will be picked from input video.
  13647. This also set number of passed histograms to keep.
  13648. Allowed range is [0, 8192].
  13649. @item display_mode, d
  13650. Set display mode.
  13651. It accepts the following values:
  13652. @table @samp
  13653. @item stack
  13654. Per color component graphs are placed below each other.
  13655. @item parade
  13656. Per color component graphs are placed side by side.
  13657. @item overlay
  13658. Presents information identical to that in the @code{parade}, except
  13659. that the graphs representing color components are superimposed directly
  13660. over one another.
  13661. @end table
  13662. Default is @code{stack}.
  13663. @item levels_mode, m
  13664. Set mode. Can be either @code{linear}, or @code{logarithmic}.
  13665. Default is @code{linear}.
  13666. @item components, c
  13667. Set what color components to display.
  13668. Default is @code{7}.
  13669. @item bgopacity, b
  13670. Set background opacity. Default is @code{0.9}.
  13671. @item envelope, e
  13672. Show envelope. Default is disabled.
  13673. @item ecolor, ec
  13674. Set envelope color. Default is @code{gold}.
  13675. @end table
  13676. @section threshold
  13677. Apply threshold effect to video stream.
  13678. This filter needs four video streams to perform thresholding.
  13679. First stream is stream we are filtering.
  13680. Second stream is holding threshold values, third stream is holding min values,
  13681. and last, fourth stream is holding max values.
  13682. The filter accepts the following option:
  13683. @table @option
  13684. @item planes
  13685. Set which planes will be processed, unprocessed planes will be copied.
  13686. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  13687. @end table
  13688. For example if first stream pixel's component value is less then threshold value
  13689. of pixel component from 2nd threshold stream, third stream value will picked,
  13690. otherwise fourth stream pixel component value will be picked.
  13691. Using color source filter one can perform various types of thresholding:
  13692. @subsection Examples
  13693. @itemize
  13694. @item
  13695. Binary threshold, using gray color as threshold:
  13696. @example
  13697. ffmpeg -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=gray -f lavfi -i color=black -f lavfi -i color=white -lavfi threshold output.avi
  13698. @end example
  13699. @item
  13700. Inverted binary threshold, using gray color as threshold:
  13701. @example
  13702. ffmpeg -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=gray -f lavfi -i color=white -f lavfi -i color=black -lavfi threshold output.avi
  13703. @end example
  13704. @item
  13705. Truncate binary threshold, using gray color as threshold:
  13706. @example
  13707. ffmpeg -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=gray -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=gray -lavfi threshold output.avi
  13708. @end example
  13709. @item
  13710. Threshold to zero, using gray color as threshold:
  13711. @example
  13712. ffmpeg -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=gray -f lavfi -i color=white -i 320x240.avi -lavfi threshold output.avi
  13713. @end example
  13714. @item
  13715. Inverted threshold to zero, using gray color as threshold:
  13716. @example
  13717. ffmpeg -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=gray -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=white -lavfi threshold output.avi
  13718. @end example
  13719. @end itemize
  13720. @section thumbnail
  13721. Select the most representative frame in a given sequence of consecutive frames.
  13722. The filter accepts the following options:
  13723. @table @option
  13724. @item n
  13725. Set the frames batch size to analyze; in a set of @var{n} frames, the filter
  13726. will pick one of them, and then handle the next batch of @var{n} frames until
  13727. the end. Default is @code{100}.
  13728. @end table
  13729. Since the filter keeps track of the whole frames sequence, a bigger @var{n}
  13730. value will result in a higher memory usage, so a high value is not recommended.
  13731. @subsection Examples
  13732. @itemize
  13733. @item
  13734. Extract one picture each 50 frames:
  13735. @example
  13736. thumbnail=50
  13737. @end example
  13738. @item
  13739. Complete example of a thumbnail creation with @command{ffmpeg}:
  13740. @example
  13741. ffmpeg -i in.avi -vf thumbnail,scale=300:200 -frames:v 1 out.png
  13742. @end example
  13743. @end itemize
  13744. @section tile
  13745. Tile several successive frames together.
  13746. The filter accepts the following options:
  13747. @table @option
  13748. @item layout
  13749. Set the grid size (i.e. the number of lines and columns). For the syntax of
  13750. this option, check the
  13751. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  13752. @item nb_frames
  13753. Set the maximum number of frames to render in the given area. It must be less
  13754. than or equal to @var{w}x@var{h}. The default value is @code{0}, meaning all
  13755. the area will be used.
  13756. @item margin
  13757. Set the outer border margin in pixels.
  13758. @item padding
  13759. Set the inner border thickness (i.e. the number of pixels between frames). For
  13760. more advanced padding options (such as having different values for the edges),
  13761. refer to the pad video filter.
  13762. @item color
  13763. Specify the color of the unused area. For the syntax of this option, check the
  13764. @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  13765. The default value of @var{color} is "black".
  13766. @item overlap
  13767. Set the number of frames to overlap when tiling several successive frames together.
  13768. The value must be between @code{0} and @var{nb_frames - 1}.
  13769. @item init_padding
  13770. Set the number of frames to initially be empty before displaying first output frame.
  13771. This controls how soon will one get first output frame.
  13772. The value must be between @code{0} and @var{nb_frames - 1}.
  13773. @end table
  13774. @subsection Examples
  13775. @itemize
  13776. @item
  13777. Produce 8x8 PNG tiles of all keyframes (@option{-skip_frame nokey}) in a movie:
  13778. @example
  13779. ffmpeg -skip_frame nokey -i file.avi -vf 'scale=128:72,tile=8x8' -an -vsync 0 keyframes%03d.png
  13780. @end example
  13781. The @option{-vsync 0} is necessary to prevent @command{ffmpeg} from
  13782. duplicating each output frame to accommodate the originally detected frame
  13783. rate.
  13784. @item
  13785. Display @code{5} pictures in an area of @code{3x2} frames,
  13786. with @code{7} pixels between them, and @code{2} pixels of initial margin, using
  13787. mixed flat and named options:
  13788. @example
  13789. tile=3x2:nb_frames=5:padding=7:margin=2
  13790. @end example
  13791. @end itemize
  13792. @section tinterlace
  13793. Perform various types of temporal field interlacing.
  13794. Frames are counted starting from 1, so the first input frame is
  13795. considered odd.
  13796. The filter accepts the following options:
  13797. @table @option
  13798. @item mode
  13799. Specify the mode of the interlacing. This option can also be specified
  13800. as a value alone. See below for a list of values for this option.
  13801. Available values are:
  13802. @table @samp
  13803. @item merge, 0
  13804. Move odd frames into the upper field, even into the lower field,
  13805. generating a double height frame at half frame rate.
  13806. @example
  13807. ------> time
  13808. Input:
  13809. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  13810. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13811. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13812. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13813. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13814. Output:
  13815. 11111 33333
  13816. 22222 44444
  13817. 11111 33333
  13818. 22222 44444
  13819. 11111 33333
  13820. 22222 44444
  13821. 11111 33333
  13822. 22222 44444
  13823. @end example
  13824. @item drop_even, 1
  13825. Only output odd frames, even frames are dropped, generating a frame with
  13826. unchanged height at half frame rate.
  13827. @example
  13828. ------> time
  13829. Input:
  13830. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  13831. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13832. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13833. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13834. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13835. Output:
  13836. 11111 33333
  13837. 11111 33333
  13838. 11111 33333
  13839. 11111 33333
  13840. @end example
  13841. @item drop_odd, 2
  13842. Only output even frames, odd frames are dropped, generating a frame with
  13843. unchanged height at half frame rate.
  13844. @example
  13845. ------> time
  13846. Input:
  13847. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  13848. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13849. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13850. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13851. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13852. Output:
  13853. 22222 44444
  13854. 22222 44444
  13855. 22222 44444
  13856. 22222 44444
  13857. @end example
  13858. @item pad, 3
  13859. Expand each frame to full height, but pad alternate lines with black,
  13860. generating a frame with double height at the same input frame rate.
  13861. @example
  13862. ------> time
  13863. Input:
  13864. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  13865. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13866. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13867. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13868. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13869. Output:
  13870. 11111 ..... 33333 .....
  13871. ..... 22222 ..... 44444
  13872. 11111 ..... 33333 .....
  13873. ..... 22222 ..... 44444
  13874. 11111 ..... 33333 .....
  13875. ..... 22222 ..... 44444
  13876. 11111 ..... 33333 .....
  13877. ..... 22222 ..... 44444
  13878. @end example
  13879. @item interleave_top, 4
  13880. Interleave the upper field from odd frames with the lower field from
  13881. even frames, generating a frame with unchanged height at half frame rate.
  13882. @example
  13883. ------> time
  13884. Input:
  13885. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  13886. 11111<- 22222 33333<- 44444
  13887. 11111 22222<- 33333 44444<-
  13888. 11111<- 22222 33333<- 44444
  13889. 11111 22222<- 33333 44444<-
  13890. Output:
  13891. 11111 33333
  13892. 22222 44444
  13893. 11111 33333
  13894. 22222 44444
  13895. @end example
  13896. @item interleave_bottom, 5
  13897. Interleave the lower field from odd frames with the upper field from
  13898. even frames, generating a frame with unchanged height at half frame rate.
  13899. @example
  13900. ------> time
  13901. Input:
  13902. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  13903. 11111 22222<- 33333 44444<-
  13904. 11111<- 22222 33333<- 44444
  13905. 11111 22222<- 33333 44444<-
  13906. 11111<- 22222 33333<- 44444
  13907. Output:
  13908. 22222 44444
  13909. 11111 33333
  13910. 22222 44444
  13911. 11111 33333
  13912. @end example
  13913. @item interlacex2, 6
  13914. Double frame rate with unchanged height. Frames are inserted each
  13915. containing the second temporal field from the previous input frame and
  13916. the first temporal field from the next input frame. This mode relies on
  13917. the top_field_first flag. Useful for interlaced video displays with no
  13918. field synchronisation.
  13919. @example
  13920. ------> time
  13921. Input:
  13922. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  13923. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13924. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13925. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13926. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13927. Output:
  13928. 11111 22222 22222 33333 33333 44444 44444
  13929. 11111 11111 22222 22222 33333 33333 44444
  13930. 11111 22222 22222 33333 33333 44444 44444
  13931. 11111 11111 22222 22222 33333 33333 44444
  13932. @end example
  13933. @item mergex2, 7
  13934. Move odd frames into the upper field, even into the lower field,
  13935. generating a double height frame at same frame rate.
  13936. @example
  13937. ------> time
  13938. Input:
  13939. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  13940. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13941. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13942. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13943. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13944. Output:
  13945. 11111 33333 33333 55555
  13946. 22222 22222 44444 44444
  13947. 11111 33333 33333 55555
  13948. 22222 22222 44444 44444
  13949. 11111 33333 33333 55555
  13950. 22222 22222 44444 44444
  13951. 11111 33333 33333 55555
  13952. 22222 22222 44444 44444
  13953. @end example
  13954. @end table
  13955. Numeric values are deprecated but are accepted for backward
  13956. compatibility reasons.
  13957. Default mode is @code{merge}.
  13958. @item flags
  13959. Specify flags influencing the filter process.
  13960. Available value for @var{flags} is:
  13961. @table @option
  13962. @item low_pass_filter, vlpf
  13963. Enable linear vertical low-pass filtering in the filter.
  13964. Vertical low-pass filtering is required when creating an interlaced
  13965. destination from a progressive source which contains high-frequency
  13966. vertical detail. Filtering will reduce interlace 'twitter' and Moire
  13967. patterning.
  13968. @item complex_filter, cvlpf
  13969. Enable complex vertical low-pass filtering.
  13970. This will slightly less reduce interlace 'twitter' and Moire
  13971. patterning but better retain detail and subjective sharpness impression.
  13972. @item bypass_il
  13973. Bypass already interlaced frames, only adjust the frame rate.
  13974. @end table
  13975. Vertical low-pass filtering and bypassing already interlaced frames can only be
  13976. enabled for @option{mode} @var{interleave_top} and @var{interleave_bottom}.
  13977. @end table
  13978. @section tmix
  13979. Mix successive video frames.
  13980. A description of the accepted options follows.
  13981. @table @option
  13982. @item frames
  13983. The number of successive frames to mix. If unspecified, it defaults to 3.
  13984. @item weights
  13985. Specify weight of each input video frame.
  13986. Each weight is separated by space. If number of weights is smaller than
  13987. number of @var{frames} last specified weight will be used for all remaining
  13988. unset weights.
  13989. @item scale
  13990. Specify scale, if it is set it will be multiplied with sum
  13991. of each weight multiplied with pixel values to give final destination
  13992. pixel value. By default @var{scale} is auto scaled to sum of weights.
  13993. @end table
  13994. @subsection Examples
  13995. @itemize
  13996. @item
  13997. Average 7 successive frames:
  13998. @example
  13999. tmix=frames=7:weights="1 1 1 1 1 1 1"
  14000. @end example
  14001. @item
  14002. Apply simple temporal convolution:
  14003. @example
  14004. tmix=frames=3:weights="-1 3 -1"
  14005. @end example
  14006. @item
  14007. Similar as above but only showing temporal differences:
  14008. @example
  14009. tmix=frames=3:weights="-1 2 -1":scale=1
  14010. @end example
  14011. @end itemize
  14012. @anchor{tonemap}
  14013. @section tonemap
  14014. Tone map colors from different dynamic ranges.
  14015. This filter expects data in single precision floating point, as it needs to
  14016. operate on (and can output) out-of-range values. Another filter, such as
  14017. @ref{zscale}, is needed to convert the resulting frame to a usable format.
  14018. The tonemapping algorithms implemented only work on linear light, so input
  14019. data should be linearized beforehand (and possibly correctly tagged).
  14020. @example
  14021. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf zscale=transfer=linear,tonemap=clip,zscale=transfer=bt709,format=yuv420p OUTPUT
  14022. @end example
  14023. @subsection Options
  14024. The filter accepts the following options.
  14025. @table @option
  14026. @item tonemap
  14027. Set the tone map algorithm to use.
  14028. Possible values are:
  14029. @table @var
  14030. @item none
  14031. Do not apply any tone map, only desaturate overbright pixels.
  14032. @item clip
  14033. Hard-clip any out-of-range values. Use it for perfect color accuracy for
  14034. in-range values, while distorting out-of-range values.
  14035. @item linear
  14036. Stretch the entire reference gamut to a linear multiple of the display.
  14037. @item gamma
  14038. Fit a logarithmic transfer between the tone curves.
  14039. @item reinhard
  14040. Preserve overall image brightness with a simple curve, using nonlinear
  14041. contrast, which results in flattening details and degrading color accuracy.
  14042. @item hable
  14043. Preserve both dark and bright details better than @var{reinhard}, at the cost
  14044. of slightly darkening everything. Use it when detail preservation is more
  14045. important than color and brightness accuracy.
  14046. @item mobius
  14047. Smoothly map out-of-range values, while retaining contrast and colors for
  14048. in-range material as much as possible. Use it when color accuracy is more
  14049. important than detail preservation.
  14050. @end table
  14051. Default is none.
  14052. @item param
  14053. Tune the tone mapping algorithm.
  14054. This affects the following algorithms:
  14055. @table @var
  14056. @item none
  14057. Ignored.
  14058. @item linear
  14059. Specifies the scale factor to use while stretching.
  14060. Default to 1.0.
  14061. @item gamma
  14062. Specifies the exponent of the function.
  14063. Default to 1.8.
  14064. @item clip
  14065. Specify an extra linear coefficient to multiply into the signal before clipping.
  14066. Default to 1.0.
  14067. @item reinhard
  14068. Specify the local contrast coefficient at the display peak.
  14069. Default to 0.5, which means that in-gamut values will be about half as bright
  14070. as when clipping.
  14071. @item hable
  14072. Ignored.
  14073. @item mobius
  14074. Specify the transition point from linear to mobius transform. Every value
  14075. below this point is guaranteed to be mapped 1:1. The higher the value, the
  14076. more accurate the result will be, at the cost of losing bright details.
  14077. Default to 0.3, which due to the steep initial slope still preserves in-range
  14078. colors fairly accurately.
  14079. @end table
  14080. @item desat
  14081. Apply desaturation for highlights that exceed this level of brightness. The
  14082. higher the parameter, the more color information will be preserved. This
  14083. setting helps prevent unnaturally blown-out colors for super-highlights, by
  14084. (smoothly) turning into white instead. This makes images feel more natural,
  14085. at the cost of reducing information about out-of-range colors.
  14086. The default of 2.0 is somewhat conservative and will mostly just apply to
  14087. skies or directly sunlit surfaces. A setting of 0.0 disables this option.
  14088. This option works only if the input frame has a supported color tag.
  14089. @item peak
  14090. Override signal/nominal/reference peak with this value. Useful when the
  14091. embedded peak information in display metadata is not reliable or when tone
  14092. mapping from a lower range to a higher range.
  14093. @end table
  14094. @section tpad
  14095. Temporarily pad video frames.
  14096. The filter accepts the following options:
  14097. @table @option
  14098. @item start
  14099. Specify number of delay frames before input video stream.
  14100. @item stop
  14101. Specify number of padding frames after input video stream.
  14102. Set to -1 to pad indefinitely.
  14103. @item start_mode
  14104. Set kind of frames added to beginning of stream.
  14105. Can be either @var{add} or @var{clone}.
  14106. With @var{add} frames of solid-color are added.
  14107. With @var{clone} frames are clones of first frame.
  14108. @item stop_mode
  14109. Set kind of frames added to end of stream.
  14110. Can be either @var{add} or @var{clone}.
  14111. With @var{add} frames of solid-color are added.
  14112. With @var{clone} frames are clones of last frame.
  14113. @item start_duration, stop_duration
  14114. Specify the duration of the start/stop delay. See
  14115. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  14116. for the accepted syntax.
  14117. These options override @var{start} and @var{stop}.
  14118. @item color
  14119. Specify the color of the padded area. For the syntax of this option,
  14120. check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils
  14121. manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  14122. The default value of @var{color} is "black".
  14123. @end table
  14124. @anchor{transpose}
  14125. @section transpose
  14126. Transpose rows with columns in the input video and optionally flip it.
  14127. It accepts the following parameters:
  14128. @table @option
  14129. @item dir
  14130. Specify the transposition direction.
  14131. Can assume the following values:
  14132. @table @samp
  14133. @item 0, 4, cclock_flip
  14134. Rotate by 90 degrees counterclockwise and vertically flip (default), that is:
  14135. @example
  14136. L.R L.l
  14137. . . -> . .
  14138. l.r R.r
  14139. @end example
  14140. @item 1, 5, clock
  14141. Rotate by 90 degrees clockwise, that is:
  14142. @example
  14143. L.R l.L
  14144. . . -> . .
  14145. l.r r.R
  14146. @end example
  14147. @item 2, 6, cclock
  14148. Rotate by 90 degrees counterclockwise, that is:
  14149. @example
  14150. L.R R.r
  14151. . . -> . .
  14152. l.r L.l
  14153. @end example
  14154. @item 3, 7, clock_flip
  14155. Rotate by 90 degrees clockwise and vertically flip, that is:
  14156. @example
  14157. L.R r.R
  14158. . . -> . .
  14159. l.r l.L
  14160. @end example
  14161. @end table
  14162. For values between 4-7, the transposition is only done if the input
  14163. video geometry is portrait and not landscape. These values are
  14164. deprecated, the @code{passthrough} option should be used instead.
  14165. Numerical values are deprecated, and should be dropped in favor of
  14166. symbolic constants.
  14167. @item passthrough
  14168. Do not apply the transposition if the input geometry matches the one
  14169. specified by the specified value. It accepts the following values:
  14170. @table @samp
  14171. @item none
  14172. Always apply transposition.
  14173. @item portrait
  14174. Preserve portrait geometry (when @var{height} >= @var{width}).
  14175. @item landscape
  14176. Preserve landscape geometry (when @var{width} >= @var{height}).
  14177. @end table
  14178. Default value is @code{none}.
  14179. @end table
  14180. For example to rotate by 90 degrees clockwise and preserve portrait
  14181. layout:
  14182. @example
  14183. transpose=dir=1:passthrough=portrait
  14184. @end example
  14185. The command above can also be specified as:
  14186. @example
  14187. transpose=1:portrait
  14188. @end example
  14189. @section transpose_npp
  14190. Transpose rows with columns in the input video and optionally flip it.
  14191. For more in depth examples see the @ref{transpose} video filter, which shares mostly the same options.
  14192. It accepts the following parameters:
  14193. @table @option
  14194. @item dir
  14195. Specify the transposition direction.
  14196. Can assume the following values:
  14197. @table @samp
  14198. @item cclock_flip
  14199. Rotate by 90 degrees counterclockwise and vertically flip. (default)
  14200. @item clock
  14201. Rotate by 90 degrees clockwise.
  14202. @item cclock
  14203. Rotate by 90 degrees counterclockwise.
  14204. @item clock_flip
  14205. Rotate by 90 degrees clockwise and vertically flip.
  14206. @end table
  14207. @item passthrough
  14208. Do not apply the transposition if the input geometry matches the one
  14209. specified by the specified value. It accepts the following values:
  14210. @table @samp
  14211. @item none
  14212. Always apply transposition. (default)
  14213. @item portrait
  14214. Preserve portrait geometry (when @var{height} >= @var{width}).
  14215. @item landscape
  14216. Preserve landscape geometry (when @var{width} >= @var{height}).
  14217. @end table
  14218. @end table
  14219. @section trim
  14220. Trim the input so that the output contains one continuous subpart of the input.
  14221. It accepts the following parameters:
  14222. @table @option
  14223. @item start
  14224. Specify the time of the start of the kept section, i.e. the frame with the
  14225. timestamp @var{start} will be the first frame in the output.
  14226. @item end
  14227. Specify the time of the first frame that will be dropped, i.e. the frame
  14228. immediately preceding the one with the timestamp @var{end} will be the last
  14229. frame in the output.
  14230. @item start_pts
  14231. This is the same as @var{start}, except this option sets the start timestamp
  14232. in timebase units instead of seconds.
  14233. @item end_pts
  14234. This is the same as @var{end}, except this option sets the end timestamp
  14235. in timebase units instead of seconds.
  14236. @item duration
  14237. The maximum duration of the output in seconds.
  14238. @item start_frame
  14239. The number of the first frame that should be passed to the output.
  14240. @item end_frame
  14241. The number of the first frame that should be dropped.
  14242. @end table
  14243. @option{start}, @option{end}, and @option{duration} are expressed as time
  14244. duration specifications; see
  14245. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  14246. for the accepted syntax.
  14247. Note that the first two sets of the start/end options and the @option{duration}
  14248. option look at the frame timestamp, while the _frame variants simply count the
  14249. frames that pass through the filter. Also note that this filter does not modify
  14250. the timestamps. If you wish for the output timestamps to start at zero, insert a
  14251. setpts filter after the trim filter.
  14252. If multiple start or end options are set, this filter tries to be greedy and
  14253. keep all the frames that match at least one of the specified constraints. To keep
  14254. only the part that matches all the constraints at once, chain multiple trim
  14255. filters.
  14256. The defaults are such that all the input is kept. So it is possible to set e.g.
  14257. just the end values to keep everything before the specified time.
  14258. Examples:
  14259. @itemize
  14260. @item
  14261. Drop everything except the second minute of input:
  14262. @example
  14263. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf trim=60:120
  14264. @end example
  14265. @item
  14266. Keep only the first second:
  14267. @example
  14268. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf trim=duration=1
  14269. @end example
  14270. @end itemize
  14271. @section unpremultiply
  14272. Apply alpha unpremultiply effect to input video stream using first plane
  14273. of second stream as alpha.
  14274. Both streams must have same dimensions and same pixel format.
  14275. The filter accepts the following option:
  14276. @table @option
  14277. @item planes
  14278. Set which planes will be processed, unprocessed planes will be copied.
  14279. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  14280. If the format has 1 or 2 components, then luma is bit 0.
  14281. If the format has 3 or 4 components:
  14282. for RGB formats bit 0 is green, bit 1 is blue and bit 2 is red;
  14283. for YUV formats bit 0 is luma, bit 1 is chroma-U and bit 2 is chroma-V.
  14284. If present, the alpha channel is always the last bit.
  14285. @item inplace
  14286. Do not require 2nd input for processing, instead use alpha plane from input stream.
  14287. @end table
  14288. @anchor{unsharp}
  14289. @section unsharp
  14290. Sharpen or blur the input video.
  14291. It accepts the following parameters:
  14292. @table @option
  14293. @item luma_msize_x, lx
  14294. Set the luma matrix horizontal size. It must be an odd integer between
  14295. 3 and 23. The default value is 5.
  14296. @item luma_msize_y, ly
  14297. Set the luma matrix vertical size. It must be an odd integer between 3
  14298. and 23. The default value is 5.
  14299. @item luma_amount, la
  14300. Set the luma effect strength. It must be a floating point number, reasonable
  14301. values lay between -1.5 and 1.5.
  14302. Negative values will blur the input video, while positive values will
  14303. sharpen it, a value of zero will disable the effect.
  14304. Default value is 1.0.
  14305. @item chroma_msize_x, cx
  14306. Set the chroma matrix horizontal size. It must be an odd integer
  14307. between 3 and 23. The default value is 5.
  14308. @item chroma_msize_y, cy
  14309. Set the chroma matrix vertical size. It must be an odd integer
  14310. between 3 and 23. The default value is 5.
  14311. @item chroma_amount, ca
  14312. Set the chroma effect strength. It must be a floating point number, reasonable
  14313. values lay between -1.5 and 1.5.
  14314. Negative values will blur the input video, while positive values will
  14315. sharpen it, a value of zero will disable the effect.
  14316. Default value is 0.0.
  14317. @end table
  14318. All parameters are optional and default to the equivalent of the
  14319. string '5:5:1.0:5:5:0.0'.
  14320. @subsection Examples
  14321. @itemize
  14322. @item
  14323. Apply strong luma sharpen effect:
  14324. @example
  14325. unsharp=luma_msize_x=7:luma_msize_y=7:luma_amount=2.5
  14326. @end example
  14327. @item
  14328. Apply a strong blur of both luma and chroma parameters:
  14329. @example
  14330. unsharp=7:7:-2:7:7:-2
  14331. @end example
  14332. @end itemize
  14333. @section uspp
  14334. Apply ultra slow/simple postprocessing filter that compresses and decompresses
  14335. the image at several (or - in the case of @option{quality} level @code{8} - all)
  14336. shifts and average the results.
  14337. The way this differs from the behavior of spp is that uspp actually encodes &
  14338. decodes each case with libavcodec Snow, whereas spp uses a simplified intra only 8x8
  14339. DCT similar to MJPEG.
  14340. The filter accepts the following options:
  14341. @table @option
  14342. @item quality
  14343. Set quality. This option defines the number of levels for averaging. It accepts
  14344. an integer in the range 0-8. If set to @code{0}, the filter will have no
  14345. effect. A value of @code{8} means the higher quality. For each increment of
  14346. that value the speed drops by a factor of approximately 2. Default value is
  14347. @code{3}.
  14348. @item qp
  14349. Force a constant quantization parameter. If not set, the filter will use the QP
  14350. from the video stream (if available).
  14351. @end table
  14352. @section v360
  14353. Convert 360 videos between various formats.
  14354. The filter accepts the following options:
  14355. @table @option
  14356. @item input
  14357. @item output
  14358. Set format of the input/output video.
  14359. Available formats:
  14360. @table @samp
  14361. @item e
  14362. @item equirect
  14363. Equirectangular projection.
  14364. @item c3x2
  14365. @item c6x1
  14366. @item c1x6
  14367. Cubemap with 3x2/6x1/1x6 layout.
  14368. Format specific options:
  14369. @table @option
  14370. @item in_pad
  14371. @item out_pad
  14372. Set padding proportion for the input/output cubemap. Values in decimals.
  14373. Example values:
  14374. @table @samp
  14375. @item 0
  14376. No padding.
  14377. @item 0.01
  14378. 1% of face is padding. For example, with 1920x1280 resolution face size would be 640x640 and padding would be 3 pixels from each side. (640 * 0.01 = 6 pixels)
  14379. @end table
  14380. Default value is @b{@samp{0}}.
  14381. @item fin_pad
  14382. @item fout_pad
  14383. Set fixed padding for the input/output cubemap. Values in pixels.
  14384. Default value is @b{@samp{0}}. If greater than zero it overrides other padding options.
  14385. @item in_forder
  14386. @item out_forder
  14387. Set order of faces for the input/output cubemap. Choose one direction for each position.
  14388. Designation of directions:
  14389. @table @samp
  14390. @item r
  14391. right
  14392. @item l
  14393. left
  14394. @item u
  14395. up
  14396. @item d
  14397. down
  14398. @item f
  14399. forward
  14400. @item b
  14401. back
  14402. @end table
  14403. Default value is @b{@samp{rludfb}}.
  14404. @item in_frot
  14405. @item out_frot
  14406. Set rotation of faces for the input/output cubemap. Choose one angle for each position.
  14407. Designation of angles:
  14408. @table @samp
  14409. @item 0
  14410. 0 degrees clockwise
  14411. @item 1
  14412. 90 degrees clockwise
  14413. @item 2
  14414. 180 degrees clockwise
  14415. @item 3
  14416. 270 degrees clockwise
  14417. @end table
  14418. Default value is @b{@samp{000000}}.
  14419. @end table
  14420. @item eac
  14421. Equi-Angular Cubemap.
  14422. @item flat
  14423. @item gnomonic
  14424. @item rectilinear
  14425. Regular video.
  14426. Format specific options:
  14427. @table @option
  14428. @item h_fov
  14429. @item v_fov
  14430. @item d_fov
  14431. Set output horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.
  14432. If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.
  14433. @item ih_fov
  14434. @item iv_fov
  14435. @item id_fov
  14436. Set input horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.
  14437. If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.
  14438. @end table
  14439. @item dfisheye
  14440. Dual fisheye.
  14441. Format specific options:
  14442. @table @option
  14443. @item in_pad
  14444. @item out_pad
  14445. Set padding proportion. Values in decimals.
  14446. Example values:
  14447. @table @samp
  14448. @item 0
  14449. No padding.
  14450. @item 0.01
  14451. 1% padding.
  14452. @end table
  14453. Default value is @b{@samp{0}}.
  14454. @end table
  14455. @item barrel
  14456. @item fb
  14457. @item barrelsplit
  14458. Facebook's 360 formats.
  14459. @item sg
  14460. Stereographic format.
  14461. Format specific options:
  14462. @table @option
  14463. @item h_fov
  14464. @item v_fov
  14465. @item d_fov
  14466. Set output horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.
  14467. If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.
  14468. @item ih_fov
  14469. @item iv_fov
  14470. @item id_fov
  14471. Set input horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.
  14472. If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.
  14473. @end table
  14474. @item mercator
  14475. Mercator format.
  14476. @item ball
  14477. Ball format, gives significant distortion toward the back.
  14478. @item hammer
  14479. Hammer-Aitoff map projection format.
  14480. @item sinusoidal
  14481. Sinusoidal map projection format.
  14482. @item fisheye
  14483. Fisheye projection.
  14484. Format specific options:
  14485. @table @option
  14486. @item h_fov
  14487. @item v_fov
  14488. @item d_fov
  14489. Set output horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.
  14490. If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.
  14491. @item ih_fov
  14492. @item iv_fov
  14493. @item id_fov
  14494. Set input horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.
  14495. If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.
  14496. @end table
  14497. @item pannini
  14498. Pannini projection. @i{(output only)}
  14499. Format specific options:
  14500. @table @option
  14501. @item h_fov
  14502. Set pannini parameter.
  14503. @end table
  14504. @item cylindrical
  14505. Cylindrical projection.
  14506. Format specific options:
  14507. @table @option
  14508. @item h_fov
  14509. @item v_fov
  14510. @item d_fov
  14511. Set output horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.
  14512. If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.
  14513. @item ih_fov
  14514. @item iv_fov
  14515. @item id_fov
  14516. Set input horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.
  14517. If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.
  14518. @end table
  14519. @item perspective
  14520. Perspective projection. @i{(output only)}
  14521. Format specific options:
  14522. @table @option
  14523. @item v_fov
  14524. Set perspective parameter.
  14525. @end table
  14526. @item tetrahedron
  14527. Tetrahedron projection.
  14528. @item tsp
  14529. Truncated square pyramid projection.
  14530. @item he
  14531. @item hequirect
  14532. Half equirectangular projection.
  14533. @end table
  14534. @item interp
  14535. Set interpolation method.@*
  14536. @i{Note: more complex interpolation methods require much more memory to run.}
  14537. Available methods:
  14538. @table @samp
  14539. @item near
  14540. @item nearest
  14541. Nearest neighbour.
  14542. @item line
  14543. @item linear
  14544. Bilinear interpolation.
  14545. @item cube
  14546. @item cubic
  14547. Bicubic interpolation.
  14548. @item lanc
  14549. @item lanczos
  14550. Lanczos interpolation.
  14551. @item sp16
  14552. @item spline16
  14553. Spline16 interpolation.
  14554. @item gauss
  14555. @item gaussian
  14556. Gaussian interpolation.
  14557. @end table
  14558. Default value is @b{@samp{line}}.
  14559. @item w
  14560. @item h
  14561. Set the output video resolution.
  14562. Default resolution depends on formats.
  14563. @item in_stereo
  14564. @item out_stereo
  14565. Set the input/output stereo format.
  14566. @table @samp
  14567. @item 2d
  14568. 2D mono
  14569. @item sbs
  14570. Side by side
  14571. @item tb
  14572. Top bottom
  14573. @end table
  14574. Default value is @b{@samp{2d}} for input and output format.
  14575. @item yaw
  14576. @item pitch
  14577. @item roll
  14578. Set rotation for the output video. Values in degrees.
  14579. @item rorder
  14580. Set rotation order for the output video. Choose one item for each position.
  14581. @table @samp
  14582. @item y, Y
  14583. yaw
  14584. @item p, P
  14585. pitch
  14586. @item r, R
  14587. roll
  14588. @end table
  14589. Default value is @b{@samp{ypr}}.
  14590. @item h_flip
  14591. @item v_flip
  14592. @item d_flip
  14593. Flip the output video horizontally(swaps left-right)/vertically(swaps up-down)/in-depth(swaps back-forward). Boolean values.
  14594. @item ih_flip
  14595. @item iv_flip
  14596. Set if input video is flipped horizontally/vertically. Boolean values.
  14597. @item in_trans
  14598. Set if input video is transposed. Boolean value, by default disabled.
  14599. @item out_trans
  14600. Set if output video needs to be transposed. Boolean value, by default disabled.
  14601. @item alpha_mask
  14602. Build mask in alpha plane for all unmapped pixels by marking them fully transparent. Boolean value, by default disabled.
  14603. @end table
  14604. @subsection Examples
  14605. @itemize
  14606. @item
  14607. Convert equirectangular video to cubemap with 3x2 layout and 1% padding using bicubic interpolation:
  14608. @example
  14609. ffmpeg -i input.mkv -vf v360=e:c3x2:cubic:out_pad=0.01 output.mkv
  14610. @end example
  14611. @item
  14612. Extract back view of Equi-Angular Cubemap:
  14613. @example
  14614. ffmpeg -i input.mkv -vf v360=eac:flat:yaw=180 output.mkv
  14615. @end example
  14616. @item
  14617. Convert transposed and horizontally flipped Equi-Angular Cubemap in side-by-side stereo format to equirectangular top-bottom stereo format:
  14618. @example
  14619. v360=eac:equirect:in_stereo=sbs:in_trans=1:ih_flip=1:out_stereo=tb
  14620. @end example
  14621. @end itemize
  14622. @subsection Commands
  14623. This filter supports subset of above options as @ref{commands}.
  14624. @section vaguedenoiser
  14625. Apply a wavelet based denoiser.
  14626. It transforms each frame from the video input into the wavelet domain,
  14627. using Cohen-Daubechies-Feauveau 9/7. Then it applies some filtering to
  14628. the obtained coefficients. It does an inverse wavelet transform after.
  14629. Due to wavelet properties, it should give a nice smoothed result, and
  14630. reduced noise, without blurring picture features.
  14631. This filter accepts the following options:
  14632. @table @option
  14633. @item threshold
  14634. The filtering strength. The higher, the more filtered the video will be.
  14635. Hard thresholding can use a higher threshold than soft thresholding
  14636. before the video looks overfiltered. Default value is 2.
  14637. @item method
  14638. The filtering method the filter will use.
  14639. It accepts the following values:
  14640. @table @samp
  14641. @item hard
  14642. All values under the threshold will be zeroed.
  14643. @item soft
  14644. All values under the threshold will be zeroed. All values above will be
  14645. reduced by the threshold.
  14646. @item garrote
  14647. Scales or nullifies coefficients - intermediary between (more) soft and
  14648. (less) hard thresholding.
  14649. @end table
  14650. Default is garrote.
  14651. @item nsteps
  14652. Number of times, the wavelet will decompose the picture. Picture can't
  14653. be decomposed beyond a particular point (typically, 8 for a 640x480
  14654. frame - as 2^9 = 512 > 480). Valid values are integers between 1 and 32. Default value is 6.
  14655. @item percent
  14656. Partial of full denoising (limited coefficients shrinking), from 0 to 100. Default value is 85.
  14657. @item planes
  14658. A list of the planes to process. By default all planes are processed.
  14659. @end table
  14660. @section vectorscope
  14661. Display 2 color component values in the two dimensional graph (which is called
  14662. a vectorscope).
  14663. This filter accepts the following options:
  14664. @table @option
  14665. @item mode, m
  14666. Set vectorscope mode.
  14667. It accepts the following values:
  14668. @table @samp
  14669. @item gray
  14670. @item tint
  14671. Gray values are displayed on graph, higher brightness means more pixels have
  14672. same component color value on location in graph. This is the default mode.
  14673. @item color
  14674. Gray values are displayed on graph. Surrounding pixels values which are not
  14675. present in video frame are drawn in gradient of 2 color components which are
  14676. set by option @code{x} and @code{y}. The 3rd color component is static.
  14677. @item color2
  14678. Actual color components values present in video frame are displayed on graph.
  14679. @item color3
  14680. Similar as color2 but higher frequency of same values @code{x} and @code{y}
  14681. on graph increases value of another color component, which is luminance by
  14682. default values of @code{x} and @code{y}.
  14683. @item color4
  14684. Actual colors present in video frame are displayed on graph. If two different
  14685. colors map to same position on graph then color with higher value of component
  14686. not present in graph is picked.
  14687. @item color5
  14688. Gray values are displayed on graph. Similar to @code{color} but with 3rd color
  14689. component picked from radial gradient.
  14690. @end table
  14691. @item x
  14692. Set which color component will be represented on X-axis. Default is @code{1}.
  14693. @item y
  14694. Set which color component will be represented on Y-axis. Default is @code{2}.
  14695. @item intensity, i
  14696. Set intensity, used by modes: gray, color, color3 and color5 for increasing brightness
  14697. of color component which represents frequency of (X, Y) location in graph.
  14698. @item envelope, e
  14699. @table @samp
  14700. @item none
  14701. No envelope, this is default.
  14702. @item instant
  14703. Instant envelope, even darkest single pixel will be clearly highlighted.
  14704. @item peak
  14705. Hold maximum and minimum values presented in graph over time. This way you
  14706. can still spot out of range values without constantly looking at vectorscope.
  14707. @item peak+instant
  14708. Peak and instant envelope combined together.
  14709. @end table
  14710. @item graticule, g
  14711. Set what kind of graticule to draw.
  14712. @table @samp
  14713. @item none
  14714. @item green
  14715. @item color
  14716. @item invert
  14717. @end table
  14718. @item opacity, o
  14719. Set graticule opacity.
  14720. @item flags, f
  14721. Set graticule flags.
  14722. @table @samp
  14723. @item white
  14724. Draw graticule for white point.
  14725. @item black
  14726. Draw graticule for black point.
  14727. @item name
  14728. Draw color points short names.
  14729. @end table
  14730. @item bgopacity, b
  14731. Set background opacity.
  14732. @item lthreshold, l
  14733. Set low threshold for color component not represented on X or Y axis.
  14734. Values lower than this value will be ignored. Default is 0.
  14735. Note this value is multiplied with actual max possible value one pixel component
  14736. can have. So for 8-bit input and low threshold value of 0.1 actual threshold
  14737. is 0.1 * 255 = 25.
  14738. @item hthreshold, h
  14739. Set high threshold for color component not represented on X or Y axis.
  14740. Values higher than this value will be ignored. Default is 1.
  14741. Note this value is multiplied with actual max possible value one pixel component
  14742. can have. So for 8-bit input and high threshold value of 0.9 actual threshold
  14743. is 0.9 * 255 = 230.
  14744. @item colorspace, c
  14745. Set what kind of colorspace to use when drawing graticule.
  14746. @table @samp
  14747. @item auto
  14748. @item 601
  14749. @item 709
  14750. @end table
  14751. Default is auto.
  14752. @item tint0, t0
  14753. @item tint1, t1
  14754. Set color tint for gray/tint vectorscope mode. By default both options are zero.
  14755. This means no tint, and output will remain gray.
  14756. @end table
  14757. @anchor{vidstabdetect}
  14758. @section vidstabdetect
  14759. Analyze video stabilization/deshaking. Perform pass 1 of 2, see
  14760. @ref{vidstabtransform} for pass 2.
  14761. This filter generates a file with relative translation and rotation
  14762. transform information about subsequent frames, which is then used by
  14763. the @ref{vidstabtransform} filter.
  14764. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  14765. @code{--enable-libvidstab}.
  14766. This filter accepts the following options:
  14767. @table @option
  14768. @item result
  14769. Set the path to the file used to write the transforms information.
  14770. Default value is @file{transforms.trf}.
  14771. @item shakiness
  14772. Set how shaky the video is and how quick the camera is. It accepts an
  14773. integer in the range 1-10, a value of 1 means little shakiness, a
  14774. value of 10 means strong shakiness. Default value is 5.
  14775. @item accuracy
  14776. Set the accuracy of the detection process. It must be a value in the
  14777. range 1-15. A value of 1 means low accuracy, a value of 15 means high
  14778. accuracy. Default value is 15.
  14779. @item stepsize
  14780. Set stepsize of the search process. The region around minimum is
  14781. scanned with 1 pixel resolution. Default value is 6.
  14782. @item mincontrast
  14783. Set minimum contrast. Below this value a local measurement field is
  14784. discarded. Must be a floating point value in the range 0-1. Default
  14785. value is 0.3.
  14786. @item tripod
  14787. Set reference frame number for tripod mode.
  14788. If enabled, the motion of the frames is compared to a reference frame
  14789. in the filtered stream, identified by the specified number. The idea
  14790. is to compensate all movements in a more-or-less static scene and keep
  14791. the camera view absolutely still.
  14792. If set to 0, it is disabled. The frames are counted starting from 1.
  14793. @item show
  14794. Show fields and transforms in the resulting frames. It accepts an
  14795. integer in the range 0-2. Default value is 0, which disables any
  14796. visualization.
  14797. @end table
  14798. @subsection Examples
  14799. @itemize
  14800. @item
  14801. Use default values:
  14802. @example
  14803. vidstabdetect
  14804. @end example
  14805. @item
  14806. Analyze strongly shaky movie and put the results in file
  14807. @file{mytransforms.trf}:
  14808. @example
  14809. vidstabdetect=shakiness=10:accuracy=15:result="mytransforms.trf"
  14810. @end example
  14811. @item
  14812. Visualize the result of internal transformations in the resulting
  14813. video:
  14814. @example
  14815. vidstabdetect=show=1
  14816. @end example
  14817. @item
  14818. Analyze a video with medium shakiness using @command{ffmpeg}:
  14819. @example
  14820. ffmpeg -i input -vf vidstabdetect=shakiness=5:show=1 dummy.avi
  14821. @end example
  14822. @end itemize
  14823. @anchor{vidstabtransform}
  14824. @section vidstabtransform
  14825. Video stabilization/deshaking: pass 2 of 2,
  14826. see @ref{vidstabdetect} for pass 1.
  14827. Read a file with transform information for each frame and
  14828. apply/compensate them. Together with the @ref{vidstabdetect}
  14829. filter this can be used to deshake videos. See also
  14830. @url{http://public.hronopik.de/vid.stab}. It is important to also use
  14831. the @ref{unsharp} filter, see below.
  14832. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  14833. @code{--enable-libvidstab}.
  14834. @subsection Options
  14835. @table @option
  14836. @item input
  14837. Set path to the file used to read the transforms. Default value is
  14838. @file{transforms.trf}.
  14839. @item smoothing
  14840. Set the number of frames (value*2 + 1) used for lowpass filtering the
  14841. camera movements. Default value is 10.
  14842. For example a number of 10 means that 21 frames are used (10 in the
  14843. past and 10 in the future) to smoothen the motion in the video. A
  14844. larger value leads to a smoother video, but limits the acceleration of
  14845. the camera (pan/tilt movements). 0 is a special case where a static
  14846. camera is simulated.
  14847. @item optalgo
  14848. Set the camera path optimization algorithm.
  14849. Accepted values are:
  14850. @table @samp
  14851. @item gauss
  14852. gaussian kernel low-pass filter on camera motion (default)
  14853. @item avg
  14854. averaging on transformations
  14855. @end table
  14856. @item maxshift
  14857. Set maximal number of pixels to translate frames. Default value is -1,
  14858. meaning no limit.
  14859. @item maxangle
  14860. Set maximal angle in radians (degree*PI/180) to rotate frames. Default
  14861. value is -1, meaning no limit.
  14862. @item crop
  14863. Specify how to deal with borders that may be visible due to movement
  14864. compensation.
  14865. Available values are:
  14866. @table @samp
  14867. @item keep
  14868. keep image information from previous frame (default)
  14869. @item black
  14870. fill the border black
  14871. @end table
  14872. @item invert
  14873. Invert transforms if set to 1. Default value is 0.
  14874. @item relative
  14875. Consider transforms as relative to previous frame if set to 1,
  14876. absolute if set to 0. Default value is 0.
  14877. @item zoom
  14878. Set percentage to zoom. A positive value will result in a zoom-in
  14879. effect, a negative value in a zoom-out effect. Default value is 0 (no
  14880. zoom).
  14881. @item optzoom
  14882. Set optimal zooming to avoid borders.
  14883. Accepted values are:
  14884. @table @samp
  14885. @item 0
  14886. disabled
  14887. @item 1
  14888. optimal static zoom value is determined (only very strong movements
  14889. will lead to visible borders) (default)
  14890. @item 2
  14891. optimal adaptive zoom value is determined (no borders will be
  14892. visible), see @option{zoomspeed}
  14893. @end table
  14894. Note that the value given at zoom is added to the one calculated here.
  14895. @item zoomspeed
  14896. Set percent to zoom maximally each frame (enabled when
  14897. @option{optzoom} is set to 2). Range is from 0 to 5, default value is
  14898. 0.25.
  14899. @item interpol
  14900. Specify type of interpolation.
  14901. Available values are:
  14902. @table @samp
  14903. @item no
  14904. no interpolation
  14905. @item linear
  14906. linear only horizontal
  14907. @item bilinear
  14908. linear in both directions (default)
  14909. @item bicubic
  14910. cubic in both directions (slow)
  14911. @end table
  14912. @item tripod
  14913. Enable virtual tripod mode if set to 1, which is equivalent to
  14914. @code{relative=0:smoothing=0}. Default value is 0.
  14915. Use also @code{tripod} option of @ref{vidstabdetect}.
  14916. @item debug
  14917. Increase log verbosity if set to 1. Also the detected global motions
  14918. are written to the temporary file @file{global_motions.trf}. Default
  14919. value is 0.
  14920. @end table
  14921. @subsection Examples
  14922. @itemize
  14923. @item
  14924. Use @command{ffmpeg} for a typical stabilization with default values:
  14925. @example
  14926. ffmpeg -i inp.mpeg -vf vidstabtransform,unsharp=5:5:0.8:3:3:0.4 inp_stabilized.mpeg
  14927. @end example
  14928. Note the use of the @ref{unsharp} filter which is always recommended.
  14929. @item
  14930. Zoom in a bit more and load transform data from a given file:
  14931. @example
  14932. vidstabtransform=zoom=5:input="mytransforms.trf"
  14933. @end example
  14934. @item
  14935. Smoothen the video even more:
  14936. @example
  14937. vidstabtransform=smoothing=30
  14938. @end example
  14939. @end itemize
  14940. @section vflip
  14941. Flip the input video vertically.
  14942. For example, to vertically flip a video with @command{ffmpeg}:
  14943. @example
  14944. ffmpeg -i in.avi -vf "vflip" out.avi
  14945. @end example
  14946. @section vfrdet
  14947. Detect variable frame rate video.
  14948. This filter tries to detect if the input is variable or constant frame rate.
  14949. At end it will output number of frames detected as having variable delta pts,
  14950. and ones with constant delta pts.
  14951. If there was frames with variable delta, than it will also show min, max and
  14952. average delta encountered.
  14953. @section vibrance
  14954. Boost or alter saturation.
  14955. The filter accepts the following options:
  14956. @table @option
  14957. @item intensity
  14958. Set strength of boost if positive value or strength of alter if negative value.
  14959. Default is 0. Allowed range is from -2 to 2.
  14960. @item rbal
  14961. Set the red balance. Default is 1. Allowed range is from -10 to 10.
  14962. @item gbal
  14963. Set the green balance. Default is 1. Allowed range is from -10 to 10.
  14964. @item bbal
  14965. Set the blue balance. Default is 1. Allowed range is from -10 to 10.
  14966. @item rlum
  14967. Set the red luma coefficient.
  14968. @item glum
  14969. Set the green luma coefficient.
  14970. @item blum
  14971. Set the blue luma coefficient.
  14972. @item alternate
  14973. If @code{intensity} is negative and this is set to 1, colors will change,
  14974. otherwise colors will be less saturated, more towards gray.
  14975. @end table
  14976. @subsection Commands
  14977. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  14978. @anchor{vignette}
  14979. @section vignette
  14980. Make or reverse a natural vignetting effect.
  14981. The filter accepts the following options:
  14982. @table @option
  14983. @item angle, a
  14984. Set lens angle expression as a number of radians.
  14985. The value is clipped in the @code{[0,PI/2]} range.
  14986. Default value: @code{"PI/5"}
  14987. @item x0
  14988. @item y0
  14989. Set center coordinates expressions. Respectively @code{"w/2"} and @code{"h/2"}
  14990. by default.
  14991. @item mode
  14992. Set forward/backward mode.
  14993. Available modes are:
  14994. @table @samp
  14995. @item forward
  14996. The larger the distance from the central point, the darker the image becomes.
  14997. @item backward
  14998. The larger the distance from the central point, the brighter the image becomes.
  14999. This can be used to reverse a vignette effect, though there is no automatic
  15000. detection to extract the lens @option{angle} and other settings (yet). It can
  15001. also be used to create a burning effect.
  15002. @end table
  15003. Default value is @samp{forward}.
  15004. @item eval
  15005. Set evaluation mode for the expressions (@option{angle}, @option{x0}, @option{y0}).
  15006. It accepts the following values:
  15007. @table @samp
  15008. @item init
  15009. Evaluate expressions only once during the filter initialization.
  15010. @item frame
  15011. Evaluate expressions for each incoming frame. This is way slower than the
  15012. @samp{init} mode since it requires all the scalers to be re-computed, but it
  15013. allows advanced dynamic expressions.
  15014. @end table
  15015. Default value is @samp{init}.
  15016. @item dither
  15017. Set dithering to reduce the circular banding effects. Default is @code{1}
  15018. (enabled).
  15019. @item aspect
  15020. Set vignette aspect. This setting allows one to adjust the shape of the vignette.
  15021. Setting this value to the SAR of the input will make a rectangular vignetting
  15022. following the dimensions of the video.
  15023. Default is @code{1/1}.
  15024. @end table
  15025. @subsection Expressions
  15026. The @option{alpha}, @option{x0} and @option{y0} expressions can contain the
  15027. following parameters.
  15028. @table @option
  15029. @item w
  15030. @item h
  15031. input width and height
  15032. @item n
  15033. the number of input frame, starting from 0
  15034. @item pts
  15035. the PTS (Presentation TimeStamp) time of the filtered video frame, expressed in
  15036. @var{TB} units, NAN if undefined
  15037. @item r
  15038. frame rate of the input video, NAN if the input frame rate is unknown
  15039. @item t
  15040. the PTS (Presentation TimeStamp) of the filtered video frame,
  15041. expressed in seconds, NAN if undefined
  15042. @item tb
  15043. time base of the input video
  15044. @end table
  15045. @subsection Examples
  15046. @itemize
  15047. @item
  15048. Apply simple strong vignetting effect:
  15049. @example
  15050. vignette=PI/4
  15051. @end example
  15052. @item
  15053. Make a flickering vignetting:
  15054. @example
  15055. vignette='PI/4+random(1)*PI/50':eval=frame
  15056. @end example
  15057. @end itemize
  15058. @section vmafmotion
  15059. Obtain the average VMAF motion score of a video.
  15060. It is one of the component metrics of VMAF.
  15061. The obtained average motion score is printed through the logging system.
  15062. The filter accepts the following options:
  15063. @table @option
  15064. @item stats_file
  15065. If specified, the filter will use the named file to save the motion score of
  15066. each frame with respect to the previous frame.
  15067. When filename equals "-" the data is sent to standard output.
  15068. @end table
  15069. Example:
  15070. @example
  15071. ffmpeg -i ref.mpg -vf vmafmotion -f null -
  15072. @end example
  15073. @section vstack
  15074. Stack input videos vertically.
  15075. All streams must be of same pixel format and of same width.
  15076. Note that this filter is faster than using @ref{overlay} and @ref{pad} filter
  15077. to create same output.
  15078. The filter accepts the following options:
  15079. @table @option
  15080. @item inputs
  15081. Set number of input streams. Default is 2.
  15082. @item shortest
  15083. If set to 1, force the output to terminate when the shortest input
  15084. terminates. Default value is 0.
  15085. @end table
  15086. @section w3fdif
  15087. Deinterlace the input video ("w3fdif" stands for "Weston 3 Field
  15088. Deinterlacing Filter").
  15089. Based on the process described by Martin Weston for BBC R&D, and
  15090. implemented based on the de-interlace algorithm written by Jim
  15091. Easterbrook for BBC R&D, the Weston 3 field deinterlacing filter
  15092. uses filter coefficients calculated by BBC R&D.
  15093. This filter uses field-dominance information in frame to decide which
  15094. of each pair of fields to place first in the output.
  15095. If it gets it wrong use @ref{setfield} filter before @code{w3fdif} filter.
  15096. There are two sets of filter coefficients, so called "simple"
  15097. and "complex". Which set of filter coefficients is used can
  15098. be set by passing an optional parameter:
  15099. @table @option
  15100. @item filter
  15101. Set the interlacing filter coefficients. Accepts one of the following values:
  15102. @table @samp
  15103. @item simple
  15104. Simple filter coefficient set.
  15105. @item complex
  15106. More-complex filter coefficient set.
  15107. @end table
  15108. Default value is @samp{complex}.
  15109. @item deint
  15110. Specify which frames to deinterlace. Accepts one of the following values:
  15111. @table @samp
  15112. @item all
  15113. Deinterlace all frames,
  15114. @item interlaced
  15115. Only deinterlace frames marked as interlaced.
  15116. @end table
  15117. Default value is @samp{all}.
  15118. @end table
  15119. @section waveform
  15120. Video waveform monitor.
  15121. The waveform monitor plots color component intensity. By default luminance
  15122. only. Each column of the waveform corresponds to a column of pixels in the
  15123. source video.
  15124. It accepts the following options:
  15125. @table @option
  15126. @item mode, m
  15127. Can be either @code{row}, or @code{column}. Default is @code{column}.
  15128. In row mode, the graph on the left side represents color component value 0 and
  15129. the right side represents value = 255. In column mode, the top side represents
  15130. color component value = 0 and bottom side represents value = 255.
  15131. @item intensity, i
  15132. Set intensity. Smaller values are useful to find out how many values of the same
  15133. luminance are distributed across input rows/columns.
  15134. Default value is @code{0.04}. Allowed range is [0, 1].
  15135. @item mirror, r
  15136. Set mirroring mode. @code{0} means unmirrored, @code{1} means mirrored.
  15137. In mirrored mode, higher values will be represented on the left
  15138. side for @code{row} mode and at the top for @code{column} mode. Default is
  15139. @code{1} (mirrored).
  15140. @item display, d
  15141. Set display mode.
  15142. It accepts the following values:
  15143. @table @samp
  15144. @item overlay
  15145. Presents information identical to that in the @code{parade}, except
  15146. that the graphs representing color components are superimposed directly
  15147. over one another.
  15148. This display mode makes it easier to spot relative differences or similarities
  15149. in overlapping areas of the color components that are supposed to be identical,
  15150. such as neutral whites, grays, or blacks.
  15151. @item stack
  15152. Display separate graph for the color components side by side in
  15153. @code{row} mode or one below the other in @code{column} mode.
  15154. @item parade
  15155. Display separate graph for the color components side by side in
  15156. @code{column} mode or one below the other in @code{row} mode.
  15157. Using this display mode makes it easy to spot color casts in the highlights
  15158. and shadows of an image, by comparing the contours of the top and the bottom
  15159. graphs of each waveform. Since whites, grays, and blacks are characterized
  15160. by exactly equal amounts of red, green, and blue, neutral areas of the picture
  15161. should display three waveforms of roughly equal width/height. If not, the
  15162. correction is easy to perform by making level adjustments the three waveforms.
  15163. @end table
  15164. Default is @code{stack}.
  15165. @item components, c
  15166. Set which color components to display. Default is 1, which means only luminance
  15167. or red color component if input is in RGB colorspace. If is set for example to
  15168. 7 it will display all 3 (if) available color components.
  15169. @item envelope, e
  15170. @table @samp
  15171. @item none
  15172. No envelope, this is default.
  15173. @item instant
  15174. Instant envelope, minimum and maximum values presented in graph will be easily
  15175. visible even with small @code{step} value.
  15176. @item peak
  15177. Hold minimum and maximum values presented in graph across time. This way you
  15178. can still spot out of range values without constantly looking at waveforms.
  15179. @item peak+instant
  15180. Peak and instant envelope combined together.
  15181. @end table
  15182. @item filter, f
  15183. @table @samp
  15184. @item lowpass
  15185. No filtering, this is default.
  15186. @item flat
  15187. Luma and chroma combined together.
  15188. @item aflat
  15189. Similar as above, but shows difference between blue and red chroma.
  15190. @item xflat
  15191. Similar as above, but use different colors.
  15192. @item yflat
  15193. Similar as above, but again with different colors.
  15194. @item chroma
  15195. Displays only chroma.
  15196. @item color
  15197. Displays actual color value on waveform.
  15198. @item acolor
  15199. Similar as above, but with luma showing frequency of chroma values.
  15200. @end table
  15201. @item graticule, g
  15202. Set which graticule to display.
  15203. @table @samp
  15204. @item none
  15205. Do not display graticule.
  15206. @item green
  15207. Display green graticule showing legal broadcast ranges.
  15208. @item orange
  15209. Display orange graticule showing legal broadcast ranges.
  15210. @item invert
  15211. Display invert graticule showing legal broadcast ranges.
  15212. @end table
  15213. @item opacity, o
  15214. Set graticule opacity.
  15215. @item flags, fl
  15216. Set graticule flags.
  15217. @table @samp
  15218. @item numbers
  15219. Draw numbers above lines. By default enabled.
  15220. @item dots
  15221. Draw dots instead of lines.
  15222. @end table
  15223. @item scale, s
  15224. Set scale used for displaying graticule.
  15225. @table @samp
  15226. @item digital
  15227. @item millivolts
  15228. @item ire
  15229. @end table
  15230. Default is digital.
  15231. @item bgopacity, b
  15232. Set background opacity.
  15233. @item tint0, t0
  15234. @item tint1, t1
  15235. Set tint for output.
  15236. Only used with lowpass filter and when display is not overlay and input
  15237. pixel formats are not RGB.
  15238. @end table
  15239. @section weave, doubleweave
  15240. The @code{weave} takes a field-based video input and join
  15241. each two sequential fields into single frame, producing a new double
  15242. height clip with half the frame rate and half the frame count.
  15243. The @code{doubleweave} works same as @code{weave} but without
  15244. halving frame rate and frame count.
  15245. It accepts the following option:
  15246. @table @option
  15247. @item first_field
  15248. Set first field. Available values are:
  15249. @table @samp
  15250. @item top, t
  15251. Set the frame as top-field-first.
  15252. @item bottom, b
  15253. Set the frame as bottom-field-first.
  15254. @end table
  15255. @end table
  15256. @subsection Examples
  15257. @itemize
  15258. @item
  15259. Interlace video using @ref{select} and @ref{separatefields} filter:
  15260. @example
  15261. separatefields,select=eq(mod(n,4),0)+eq(mod(n,4),3),weave
  15262. @end example
  15263. @end itemize
  15264. @section xbr
  15265. Apply the xBR high-quality magnification filter which is designed for pixel
  15266. art. It follows a set of edge-detection rules, see
  15267. @url{https://forums.libretro.com/t/xbr-algorithm-tutorial/123}.
  15268. It accepts the following option:
  15269. @table @option
  15270. @item n
  15271. Set the scaling dimension: @code{2} for @code{2xBR}, @code{3} for
  15272. @code{3xBR} and @code{4} for @code{4xBR}.
  15273. Default is @code{3}.
  15274. @end table
  15275. @section xfade
  15276. Apply cross fade from one input video stream to another input video stream.
  15277. The cross fade is applied for specified duration.
  15278. The filter accepts the following options:
  15279. @table @option
  15280. @item transition
  15281. Set one of available transition effects:
  15282. @table @samp
  15283. @item custom
  15284. @item fade
  15285. @item wipeleft
  15286. @item wiperight
  15287. @item wipeup
  15288. @item wipedown
  15289. @item slideleft
  15290. @item slideright
  15291. @item slideup
  15292. @item slidedown
  15293. @item circlecrop
  15294. @item rectcrop
  15295. @item distance
  15296. @item fadeblack
  15297. @item fadewhite
  15298. @item radial
  15299. @item smoothleft
  15300. @item smoothright
  15301. @item smoothup
  15302. @item smoothdown
  15303. @item circleopen
  15304. @item circleclose
  15305. @item vertopen
  15306. @item vertclose
  15307. @item horzopen
  15308. @item horzclose
  15309. @item dissolve
  15310. @item pixelize
  15311. @item diagtl
  15312. @item diagtr
  15313. @item diagbl
  15314. @item diagbr
  15315. @end table
  15316. Default transition effect is fade.
  15317. @item duration
  15318. Set cross fade duration in seconds.
  15319. Default duration is 1 second.
  15320. @item offset
  15321. Set cross fade start relative to first input stream in seconds.
  15322. Default offset is 0.
  15323. @item expr
  15324. Set expression for custom transition effect.
  15325. The expressions can use the following variables and functions:
  15326. @table @option
  15327. @item X
  15328. @item Y
  15329. The coordinates of the current sample.
  15330. @item W
  15331. @item H
  15332. The width and height of the image.
  15333. @item P
  15334. Progress of transition effect.
  15335. @item PLANE
  15336. Currently processed plane.
  15337. @item A
  15338. Return value of first input at current location and plane.
  15339. @item B
  15340. Return value of second input at current location and plane.
  15341. @item a0(x, y)
  15342. @item a1(x, y)
  15343. @item a2(x, y)
  15344. @item a3(x, y)
  15345. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the
  15346. first/second/third/fourth component of first input.
  15347. @item b0(x, y)
  15348. @item b1(x, y)
  15349. @item b2(x, y)
  15350. @item b3(x, y)
  15351. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the
  15352. first/second/third/fourth component of second input.
  15353. @end table
  15354. @end table
  15355. @subsection Examples
  15356. @itemize
  15357. @item
  15358. Cross fade from one input video to another input video, with fade transition and duration of transition
  15359. of 2 seconds starting at offset of 5 seconds:
  15360. @example
  15361. ffmpeg -i first.mp4 -i second.mp4 -filter_complex xfade=transition=fade:duration=2:offset=5 output.mp4
  15362. @end example
  15363. @end itemize
  15364. @section xmedian
  15365. Pick median pixels from several input videos.
  15366. The filter accepts the following options:
  15367. @table @option
  15368. @item inputs
  15369. Set number of inputs.
  15370. Default is 3. Allowed range is from 3 to 255.
  15371. If number of inputs is even number, than result will be mean value between two median values.
  15372. @item planes
  15373. Set which planes to filter. Default value is @code{15}, by which all planes are processed.
  15374. @item percentile
  15375. Set median percentile. Default value is @code{0.5}.
  15376. Default value of @code{0.5} will pick always median values, while @code{0} will pick
  15377. minimum values, and @code{1} maximum values.
  15378. @end table
  15379. @section xstack
  15380. Stack video inputs into custom layout.
  15381. All streams must be of same pixel format.
  15382. The filter accepts the following options:
  15383. @table @option
  15384. @item inputs
  15385. Set number of input streams. Default is 2.
  15386. @item layout
  15387. Specify layout of inputs.
  15388. This option requires the desired layout configuration to be explicitly set by the user.
  15389. This sets position of each video input in output. Each input
  15390. is separated by '|'.
  15391. The first number represents the column, and the second number represents the row.
  15392. Numbers start at 0 and are separated by '_'. Optionally one can use wX and hX,
  15393. where X is video input from which to take width or height.
  15394. Multiple values can be used when separated by '+'. In such
  15395. case values are summed together.
  15396. Note that if inputs are of different sizes gaps may appear, as not all of
  15397. the output video frame will be filled. Similarly, videos can overlap each
  15398. other if their position doesn't leave enough space for the full frame of
  15399. adjoining videos.
  15400. For 2 inputs, a default layout of @code{0_0|w0_0} is set. In all other cases,
  15401. a layout must be set by the user.
  15402. @item shortest
  15403. If set to 1, force the output to terminate when the shortest input
  15404. terminates. Default value is 0.
  15405. @item fill
  15406. If set to valid color, all unused pixels will be filled with that color.
  15407. By default fill is set to none, so it is disabled.
  15408. @end table
  15409. @subsection Examples
  15410. @itemize
  15411. @item
  15412. Display 4 inputs into 2x2 grid.
  15413. Layout:
  15414. @example
  15415. input1(0, 0) | input3(w0, 0)
  15416. input2(0, h0) | input4(w0, h0)
  15417. @end example
  15418. @example
  15419. xstack=inputs=4:layout=0_0|0_h0|w0_0|w0_h0
  15420. @end example
  15421. Note that if inputs are of different sizes, gaps or overlaps may occur.
  15422. @item
  15423. Display 4 inputs into 1x4 grid.
  15424. Layout:
  15425. @example
  15426. input1(0, 0)
  15427. input2(0, h0)
  15428. input3(0, h0+h1)
  15429. input4(0, h0+h1+h2)
  15430. @end example
  15431. @example
  15432. xstack=inputs=4:layout=0_0|0_h0|0_h0+h1|0_h0+h1+h2
  15433. @end example
  15434. Note that if inputs are of different widths, unused space will appear.
  15435. @item
  15436. Display 9 inputs into 3x3 grid.
  15437. Layout:
  15438. @example
  15439. input1(0, 0) | input4(w0, 0) | input7(w0+w3, 0)
  15440. input2(0, h0) | input5(w0, h0) | input8(w0+w3, h0)
  15441. input3(0, h0+h1) | input6(w0, h0+h1) | input9(w0+w3, h0+h1)
  15442. @end example
  15443. @example
  15444. xstack=inputs=9:layout=0_0|0_h0|0_h0+h1|w0_0|w0_h0|w0_h0+h1|w0+w3_0|w0+w3_h0|w0+w3_h0+h1
  15445. @end example
  15446. Note that if inputs are of different sizes, gaps or overlaps may occur.
  15447. @item
  15448. Display 16 inputs into 4x4 grid.
  15449. Layout:
  15450. @example
  15451. input1(0, 0) | input5(w0, 0) | input9 (w0+w4, 0) | input13(w0+w4+w8, 0)
  15452. input2(0, h0) | input6(w0, h0) | input10(w0+w4, h0) | input14(w0+w4+w8, h0)
  15453. input3(0, h0+h1) | input7(w0, h0+h1) | input11(w0+w4, h0+h1) | input15(w0+w4+w8, h0+h1)
  15454. input4(0, h0+h1+h2)| input8(w0, h0+h1+h2)| input12(w0+w4, h0+h1+h2)| input16(w0+w4+w8, h0+h1+h2)
  15455. @end example
  15456. @example
  15457. xstack=inputs=16:layout=0_0|0_h0|0_h0+h1|0_h0+h1+h2|w0_0|w0_h0|w0_h0+h1|w0_h0+h1+h2|w0+w4_0|
  15458. w0+w4_h0|w0+w4_h0+h1|w0+w4_h0+h1+h2|w0+w4+w8_0|w0+w4+w8_h0|w0+w4+w8_h0+h1|w0+w4+w8_h0+h1+h2
  15459. @end example
  15460. Note that if inputs are of different sizes, gaps or overlaps may occur.
  15461. @end itemize
  15462. @anchor{yadif}
  15463. @section yadif
  15464. Deinterlace the input video ("yadif" means "yet another deinterlacing
  15465. filter").
  15466. It accepts the following parameters:
  15467. @table @option
  15468. @item mode
  15469. The interlacing mode to adopt. It accepts one of the following values:
  15470. @table @option
  15471. @item 0, send_frame
  15472. Output one frame for each frame.
  15473. @item 1, send_field
  15474. Output one frame for each field.
  15475. @item 2, send_frame_nospatial
  15476. Like @code{send_frame}, but it skips the spatial interlacing check.
  15477. @item 3, send_field_nospatial
  15478. Like @code{send_field}, but it skips the spatial interlacing check.
  15479. @end table
  15480. The default value is @code{send_frame}.
  15481. @item parity
  15482. The picture field parity assumed for the input interlaced video. It accepts one
  15483. of the following values:
  15484. @table @option
  15485. @item 0, tff
  15486. Assume the top field is first.
  15487. @item 1, bff
  15488. Assume the bottom field is first.
  15489. @item -1, auto
  15490. Enable automatic detection of field parity.
  15491. @end table
  15492. The default value is @code{auto}.
  15493. If the interlacing is unknown or the decoder does not export this information,
  15494. top field first will be assumed.
  15495. @item deint
  15496. Specify which frames to deinterlace. Accepts one of the following
  15497. values:
  15498. @table @option
  15499. @item 0, all
  15500. Deinterlace all frames.
  15501. @item 1, interlaced
  15502. Only deinterlace frames marked as interlaced.
  15503. @end table
  15504. The default value is @code{all}.
  15505. @end table
  15506. @section yadif_cuda
  15507. Deinterlace the input video using the @ref{yadif} algorithm, but implemented
  15508. in CUDA so that it can work as part of a GPU accelerated pipeline with nvdec
  15509. and/or nvenc.
  15510. It accepts the following parameters:
  15511. @table @option
  15512. @item mode
  15513. The interlacing mode to adopt. It accepts one of the following values:
  15514. @table @option
  15515. @item 0, send_frame
  15516. Output one frame for each frame.
  15517. @item 1, send_field
  15518. Output one frame for each field.
  15519. @item 2, send_frame_nospatial
  15520. Like @code{send_frame}, but it skips the spatial interlacing check.
  15521. @item 3, send_field_nospatial
  15522. Like @code{send_field}, but it skips the spatial interlacing check.
  15523. @end table
  15524. The default value is @code{send_frame}.
  15525. @item parity
  15526. The picture field parity assumed for the input interlaced video. It accepts one
  15527. of the following values:
  15528. @table @option
  15529. @item 0, tff
  15530. Assume the top field is first.
  15531. @item 1, bff
  15532. Assume the bottom field is first.
  15533. @item -1, auto
  15534. Enable automatic detection of field parity.
  15535. @end table
  15536. The default value is @code{auto}.
  15537. If the interlacing is unknown or the decoder does not export this information,
  15538. top field first will be assumed.
  15539. @item deint
  15540. Specify which frames to deinterlace. Accepts one of the following
  15541. values:
  15542. @table @option
  15543. @item 0, all
  15544. Deinterlace all frames.
  15545. @item 1, interlaced
  15546. Only deinterlace frames marked as interlaced.
  15547. @end table
  15548. The default value is @code{all}.
  15549. @end table
  15550. @section yaepblur
  15551. Apply blur filter while preserving edges ("yaepblur" means "yet another edge preserving blur filter").
  15552. The algorithm is described in
  15553. "J. S. Lee, Digital image enhancement and noise filtering by use of local statistics, IEEE Trans. Pattern Anal. Mach. Intell. PAMI-2, 1980."
  15554. It accepts the following parameters:
  15555. @table @option
  15556. @item radius, r
  15557. Set the window radius. Default value is 3.
  15558. @item planes, p
  15559. Set which planes to filter. Default is only the first plane.
  15560. @item sigma, s
  15561. Set blur strength. Default value is 128.
  15562. @end table
  15563. @subsection Commands
  15564. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options.
  15565. @section zoompan
  15566. Apply Zoom & Pan effect.
  15567. This filter accepts the following options:
  15568. @table @option
  15569. @item zoom, z
  15570. Set the zoom expression. Range is 1-10. Default is 1.
  15571. @item x
  15572. @item y
  15573. Set the x and y expression. Default is 0.
  15574. @item d
  15575. Set the duration expression in number of frames.
  15576. This sets for how many number of frames effect will last for
  15577. single input image.
  15578. @item s
  15579. Set the output image size, default is 'hd720'.
  15580. @item fps
  15581. Set the output frame rate, default is '25'.
  15582. @end table
  15583. Each expression can contain the following constants:
  15584. @table @option
  15585. @item in_w, iw
  15586. Input width.
  15587. @item in_h, ih
  15588. Input height.
  15589. @item out_w, ow
  15590. Output width.
  15591. @item out_h, oh
  15592. Output height.
  15593. @item in
  15594. Input frame count.
  15595. @item on
  15596. Output frame count.
  15597. @item x
  15598. @item y
  15599. Last calculated 'x' and 'y' position from 'x' and 'y' expression
  15600. for current input frame.
  15601. @item px
  15602. @item py
  15603. 'x' and 'y' of last output frame of previous input frame or 0 when there was
  15604. not yet such frame (first input frame).
  15605. @item zoom
  15606. Last calculated zoom from 'z' expression for current input frame.
  15607. @item pzoom
  15608. Last calculated zoom of last output frame of previous input frame.
  15609. @item duration
  15610. Number of output frames for current input frame. Calculated from 'd' expression
  15611. for each input frame.
  15612. @item pduration
  15613. number of output frames created for previous input frame
  15614. @item a
  15615. Rational number: input width / input height
  15616. @item sar
  15617. sample aspect ratio
  15618. @item dar
  15619. display aspect ratio
  15620. @end table
  15621. @subsection Examples
  15622. @itemize
  15623. @item
  15624. Zoom-in up to 1.5 and pan at same time to some spot near center of picture:
  15625. @example
  15626. zoompan=z='min(zoom+0.0015,1.5)':d=700:x='if(gte(zoom,1.5),x,x+1/a)':y='if(gte(zoom,1.5),y,y+1)':s=640x360
  15627. @end example
  15628. @item
  15629. Zoom-in up to 1.5 and pan always at center of picture:
  15630. @example
  15631. zoompan=z='min(zoom+0.0015,1.5)':d=700:x='iw/2-(iw/zoom/2)':y='ih/2-(ih/zoom/2)'
  15632. @end example
  15633. @item
  15634. Same as above but without pausing:
  15635. @example
  15636. zoompan=z='min(max(zoom,pzoom)+0.0015,1.5)':d=1:x='iw/2-(iw/zoom/2)':y='ih/2-(ih/zoom/2)'
  15637. @end example
  15638. @end itemize
  15639. @anchor{zscale}
  15640. @section zscale
  15641. Scale (resize) the input video, using the z.lib library:
  15642. @url{https://github.com/sekrit-twc/zimg}. To enable compilation of this
  15643. filter, you need to configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-libzimg}.
  15644. The zscale filter forces the output display aspect ratio to be the same
  15645. as the input, by changing the output sample aspect ratio.
  15646. If the input image format is different from the format requested by
  15647. the next filter, the zscale filter will convert the input to the
  15648. requested format.
  15649. @subsection Options
  15650. The filter accepts the following options.
  15651. @table @option
  15652. @item width, w
  15653. @item height, h
  15654. Set the output video dimension expression. Default value is the input
  15655. dimension.
  15656. If the @var{width} or @var{w} value is 0, the input width is used for
  15657. the output. If the @var{height} or @var{h} value is 0, the input height
  15658. is used for the output.
  15659. If one and only one of the values is -n with n >= 1, the zscale filter
  15660. will use a value that maintains the aspect ratio of the input image,
  15661. calculated from the other specified dimension. After that it will,
  15662. however, make sure that the calculated dimension is divisible by n and
  15663. adjust the value if necessary.
  15664. If both values are -n with n >= 1, the behavior will be identical to
  15665. both values being set to 0 as previously detailed.
  15666. See below for the list of accepted constants for use in the dimension
  15667. expression.
  15668. @item size, s
  15669. Set the video size. For the syntax of this option, check the
  15670. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  15671. @item dither, d
  15672. Set the dither type.
  15673. Possible values are:
  15674. @table @var
  15675. @item none
  15676. @item ordered
  15677. @item random
  15678. @item error_diffusion
  15679. @end table
  15680. Default is none.
  15681. @item filter, f
  15682. Set the resize filter type.
  15683. Possible values are:
  15684. @table @var
  15685. @item point
  15686. @item bilinear
  15687. @item bicubic
  15688. @item spline16
  15689. @item spline36
  15690. @item lanczos
  15691. @end table
  15692. Default is bilinear.
  15693. @item range, r
  15694. Set the color range.
  15695. Possible values are:
  15696. @table @var
  15697. @item input
  15698. @item limited
  15699. @item full
  15700. @end table
  15701. Default is same as input.
  15702. @item primaries, p
  15703. Set the color primaries.
  15704. Possible values are:
  15705. @table @var
  15706. @item input
  15707. @item 709
  15708. @item unspecified
  15709. @item 170m
  15710. @item 240m
  15711. @item 2020
  15712. @end table
  15713. Default is same as input.
  15714. @item transfer, t
  15715. Set the transfer characteristics.
  15716. Possible values are:
  15717. @table @var
  15718. @item input
  15719. @item 709
  15720. @item unspecified
  15721. @item 601
  15722. @item linear
  15723. @item 2020_10
  15724. @item 2020_12
  15725. @item smpte2084
  15726. @item iec61966-2-1
  15727. @item arib-std-b67
  15728. @end table
  15729. Default is same as input.
  15730. @item matrix, m
  15731. Set the colorspace matrix.
  15732. Possible value are:
  15733. @table @var
  15734. @item input
  15735. @item 709
  15736. @item unspecified
  15737. @item 470bg
  15738. @item 170m
  15739. @item 2020_ncl
  15740. @item 2020_cl
  15741. @end table
  15742. Default is same as input.
  15743. @item rangein, rin
  15744. Set the input color range.
  15745. Possible values are:
  15746. @table @var
  15747. @item input
  15748. @item limited
  15749. @item full
  15750. @end table
  15751. Default is same as input.
  15752. @item primariesin, pin
  15753. Set the input color primaries.
  15754. Possible values are:
  15755. @table @var
  15756. @item input
  15757. @item 709
  15758. @item unspecified
  15759. @item 170m
  15760. @item 240m
  15761. @item 2020
  15762. @end table
  15763. Default is same as input.
  15764. @item transferin, tin
  15765. Set the input transfer characteristics.
  15766. Possible values are:
  15767. @table @var
  15768. @item input
  15769. @item 709
  15770. @item unspecified
  15771. @item 601
  15772. @item linear
  15773. @item 2020_10
  15774. @item 2020_12
  15775. @end table
  15776. Default is same as input.
  15777. @item matrixin, min
  15778. Set the input colorspace matrix.
  15779. Possible value are:
  15780. @table @var
  15781. @item input
  15782. @item 709
  15783. @item unspecified
  15784. @item 470bg
  15785. @item 170m
  15786. @item 2020_ncl
  15787. @item 2020_cl
  15788. @end table
  15789. @item chromal, c
  15790. Set the output chroma location.
  15791. Possible values are:
  15792. @table @var
  15793. @item input
  15794. @item left
  15795. @item center
  15796. @item topleft
  15797. @item top
  15798. @item bottomleft
  15799. @item bottom
  15800. @end table
  15801. @item chromalin, cin
  15802. Set the input chroma location.
  15803. Possible values are:
  15804. @table @var
  15805. @item input
  15806. @item left
  15807. @item center
  15808. @item topleft
  15809. @item top
  15810. @item bottomleft
  15811. @item bottom
  15812. @end table
  15813. @item npl
  15814. Set the nominal peak luminance.
  15815. @end table
  15816. The values of the @option{w} and @option{h} options are expressions
  15817. containing the following constants:
  15818. @table @var
  15819. @item in_w
  15820. @item in_h
  15821. The input width and height
  15822. @item iw
  15823. @item ih
  15824. These are the same as @var{in_w} and @var{in_h}.
  15825. @item out_w
  15826. @item out_h
  15827. The output (scaled) width and height
  15828. @item ow
  15829. @item oh
  15830. These are the same as @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}
  15831. @item a
  15832. The same as @var{iw} / @var{ih}
  15833. @item sar
  15834. input sample aspect ratio
  15835. @item dar
  15836. The input display aspect ratio. Calculated from @code{(iw / ih) * sar}.
  15837. @item hsub
  15838. @item vsub
  15839. horizontal and vertical input chroma subsample values. For example for the
  15840. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  15841. @item ohsub
  15842. @item ovsub
  15843. horizontal and vertical output chroma subsample values. For example for the
  15844. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  15845. @end table
  15846. @subsection Commands
  15847. This filter supports the following commands:
  15848. @table @option
  15849. @item width, w
  15850. @item height, h
  15851. Set the output video dimension expression.
  15852. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  15853. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  15854. value.
  15855. @end table
  15856. @c man end VIDEO FILTERS
  15857. @chapter OpenCL Video Filters
  15858. @c man begin OPENCL VIDEO FILTERS
  15859. Below is a description of the currently available OpenCL video filters.
  15860. To enable compilation of these filters you need to configure FFmpeg with
  15861. @code{--enable-opencl}.
  15862. Running OpenCL filters requires you to initialize a hardware device and to pass that device to all filters in any filter graph.
  15863. @table @option
  15864. @item -init_hw_device opencl[=@var{name}][:@var{device}[,@var{key=value}...]]
  15865. Initialise a new hardware device of type @var{opencl} called @var{name}, using the
  15866. given device parameters.
  15867. @item -filter_hw_device @var{name}
  15868. Pass the hardware device called @var{name} to all filters in any filter graph.
  15869. @end table
  15870. For more detailed information see @url{https://www.ffmpeg.org/ffmpeg.html#Advanced-Video-options}
  15871. @itemize
  15872. @item
  15873. Example of choosing the first device on the second platform and running avgblur_opencl filter with default parameters on it.
  15874. @example
  15875. -init_hw_device opencl=gpu:1.0 -filter_hw_device gpu -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, avgblur_opencl, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15876. @end example
  15877. @end itemize
  15878. Since OpenCL filters are not able to access frame data in normal memory, all frame data needs to be uploaded(@ref{hwupload}) to hardware surfaces connected to the appropriate device before being used and then downloaded(@ref{hwdownload}) back to normal memory. Note that @ref{hwupload} will upload to a surface with the same layout as the software frame, so it may be necessary to add a @ref{format} filter immediately before to get the input into the right format and @ref{hwdownload} does not support all formats on the output - it may be necessary to insert an additional @ref{format} filter immediately following in the graph to get the output in a supported format.
  15879. @section avgblur_opencl
  15880. Apply average blur filter.
  15881. The filter accepts the following options:
  15882. @table @option
  15883. @item sizeX
  15884. Set horizontal radius size.
  15885. Range is @code{[1, 1024]} and default value is @code{1}.
  15886. @item planes
  15887. Set which planes to filter. Default value is @code{0xf}, by which all planes are processed.
  15888. @item sizeY
  15889. Set vertical radius size. Range is @code{[1, 1024]} and default value is @code{0}. If zero, @code{sizeX} value will be used.
  15890. @end table
  15891. @subsection Example
  15892. @itemize
  15893. @item
  15894. Apply average blur filter with horizontal and vertical size of 3, setting each pixel of the output to the average value of the 7x7 region centered on it in the input. For pixels on the edges of the image, the region does not extend beyond the image boundaries, and so out-of-range coordinates are not used in the calculations.
  15895. @example
  15896. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, avgblur_opencl=3, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15897. @end example
  15898. @end itemize
  15899. @section boxblur_opencl
  15900. Apply a boxblur algorithm to the input video.
  15901. It accepts the following parameters:
  15902. @table @option
  15903. @item luma_radius, lr
  15904. @item luma_power, lp
  15905. @item chroma_radius, cr
  15906. @item chroma_power, cp
  15907. @item alpha_radius, ar
  15908. @item alpha_power, ap
  15909. @end table
  15910. A description of the accepted options follows.
  15911. @table @option
  15912. @item luma_radius, lr
  15913. @item chroma_radius, cr
  15914. @item alpha_radius, ar
  15915. Set an expression for the box radius in pixels used for blurring the
  15916. corresponding input plane.
  15917. The radius value must be a non-negative number, and must not be
  15918. greater than the value of the expression @code{min(w,h)/2} for the
  15919. luma and alpha planes, and of @code{min(cw,ch)/2} for the chroma
  15920. planes.
  15921. Default value for @option{luma_radius} is "2". If not specified,
  15922. @option{chroma_radius} and @option{alpha_radius} default to the
  15923. corresponding value set for @option{luma_radius}.
  15924. The expressions can contain the following constants:
  15925. @table @option
  15926. @item w
  15927. @item h
  15928. The input width and height in pixels.
  15929. @item cw
  15930. @item ch
  15931. The input chroma image width and height in pixels.
  15932. @item hsub
  15933. @item vsub
  15934. The horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example, for the
  15935. pixel format "yuv422p", @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  15936. @end table
  15937. @item luma_power, lp
  15938. @item chroma_power, cp
  15939. @item alpha_power, ap
  15940. Specify how many times the boxblur filter is applied to the
  15941. corresponding plane.
  15942. Default value for @option{luma_power} is 2. If not specified,
  15943. @option{chroma_power} and @option{alpha_power} default to the
  15944. corresponding value set for @option{luma_power}.
  15945. A value of 0 will disable the effect.
  15946. @end table
  15947. @subsection Examples
  15948. Apply boxblur filter, setting each pixel of the output to the average value of box-radiuses @var{luma_radius}, @var{chroma_radius}, @var{alpha_radius} for each plane respectively. The filter will apply @var{luma_power}, @var{chroma_power}, @var{alpha_power} times onto the corresponding plane. For pixels on the edges of the image, the radius does not extend beyond the image boundaries, and so out-of-range coordinates are not used in the calculations.
  15949. @itemize
  15950. @item
  15951. Apply a boxblur filter with the luma, chroma, and alpha radius
  15952. set to 2 and luma, chroma, and alpha power set to 3. The filter will run 3 times with box-radius set to 2 for every plane of the image.
  15953. @example
  15954. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, boxblur_opencl=luma_radius=2:luma_power=3, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15955. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, boxblur_opencl=2:3, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15956. @end example
  15957. @item
  15958. Apply a boxblur filter with luma radius set to 2, luma_power to 1, chroma_radius to 4, chroma_power to 5, alpha_radius to 3 and alpha_power to 7.
  15959. For the luma plane, a 2x2 box radius will be run once.
  15960. For the chroma plane, a 4x4 box radius will be run 5 times.
  15961. For the alpha plane, a 3x3 box radius will be run 7 times.
  15962. @example
  15963. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, boxblur_opencl=2:1:4:5:3:7, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15964. @end example
  15965. @end itemize
  15966. @section colorkey_opencl
  15967. RGB colorspace color keying.
  15968. The filter accepts the following options:
  15969. @table @option
  15970. @item color
  15971. The color which will be replaced with transparency.
  15972. @item similarity
  15973. Similarity percentage with the key color.
  15974. 0.01 matches only the exact key color, while 1.0 matches everything.
  15975. @item blend
  15976. Blend percentage.
  15977. 0.0 makes pixels either fully transparent, or not transparent at all.
  15978. Higher values result in semi-transparent pixels, with a higher transparency
  15979. the more similar the pixels color is to the key color.
  15980. @end table
  15981. @subsection Examples
  15982. @itemize
  15983. @item
  15984. Make every semi-green pixel in the input transparent with some slight blending:
  15985. @example
  15986. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, colorkey_opencl=green:0.3:0.1, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15987. @end example
  15988. @end itemize
  15989. @section convolution_opencl
  15990. Apply convolution of 3x3, 5x5, 7x7 matrix.
  15991. The filter accepts the following options:
  15992. @table @option
  15993. @item 0m
  15994. @item 1m
  15995. @item 2m
  15996. @item 3m
  15997. Set matrix for each plane.
  15998. Matrix is sequence of 9, 25 or 49 signed numbers.
  15999. Default value for each plane is @code{0 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 0}.
  16000. @item 0rdiv
  16001. @item 1rdiv
  16002. @item 2rdiv
  16003. @item 3rdiv
  16004. Set multiplier for calculated value for each plane.
  16005. If unset or 0, it will be sum of all matrix elements.
  16006. The option value must be a float number greater or equal to @code{0.0}. Default value is @code{1.0}.
  16007. @item 0bias
  16008. @item 1bias
  16009. @item 2bias
  16010. @item 3bias
  16011. Set bias for each plane. This value is added to the result of the multiplication.
  16012. Useful for making the overall image brighter or darker.
  16013. The option value must be a float number greater or equal to @code{0.0}. Default value is @code{0.0}.
  16014. @end table
  16015. @subsection Examples
  16016. @itemize
  16017. @item
  16018. Apply sharpen:
  16019. @example
  16020. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, convolution_opencl=0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16021. @end example
  16022. @item
  16023. Apply blur:
  16024. @example
  16025. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, convolution_opencl=1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1/9:1/9:1/9:1/9, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16026. @end example
  16027. @item
  16028. Apply edge enhance:
  16029. @example
  16030. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, convolution_opencl=0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:5:1:1:1:0:128:128:128, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16031. @end example
  16032. @item
  16033. Apply edge detect:
  16034. @example
  16035. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, convolution_opencl=0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:5:5:5:1:0:128:128:128, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16036. @end example
  16037. @item
  16038. Apply laplacian edge detector which includes diagonals:
  16039. @example
  16040. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, convolution_opencl=1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:5:5:5:1:0:128:128:0, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16041. @end example
  16042. @item
  16043. Apply emboss:
  16044. @example
  16045. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, convolution_opencl=-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16046. @end example
  16047. @end itemize
  16048. @section erosion_opencl
  16049. Apply erosion effect to the video.
  16050. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) minimum.
  16051. It accepts the following options:
  16052. @table @option
  16053. @item threshold0
  16054. @item threshold1
  16055. @item threshold2
  16056. @item threshold3
  16057. Limit the maximum change for each plane. Range is @code{[0, 65535]} and default value is @code{65535}.
  16058. If @code{0}, plane will remain unchanged.
  16059. @item coordinates
  16060. Flag which specifies the pixel to refer to.
  16061. Range is @code{[0, 255]} and default value is @code{255}, i.e. all eight pixels are used.
  16062. Flags to local 3x3 coordinates region centered on @code{x}:
  16063. 1 2 3
  16064. 4 x 5
  16065. 6 7 8
  16066. @end table
  16067. @subsection Example
  16068. @itemize
  16069. @item
  16070. Apply erosion filter with threshold0 set to 30, threshold1 set 40, threshold2 set to 50 and coordinates set to 231, setting each pixel of the output to the local minimum between pixels: 1, 2, 3, 6, 7, 8 of the 3x3 region centered on it in the input. If the difference between input pixel and local minimum is more then threshold of the corresponding plane, output pixel will be set to input pixel - threshold of corresponding plane.
  16071. @example
  16072. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, erosion_opencl=30:40:50:coordinates=231, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16073. @end example
  16074. @end itemize
  16075. @section deshake_opencl
  16076. Feature-point based video stabilization filter.
  16077. The filter accepts the following options:
  16078. @table @option
  16079. @item tripod
  16080. Simulates a tripod by preventing any camera movement whatsoever from the original frame. Defaults to @code{0}.
  16081. @item debug
  16082. Whether or not additional debug info should be displayed, both in the processed output and in the console.
  16083. Note that in order to see console debug output you will also need to pass @code{-v verbose} to ffmpeg.
  16084. Viewing point matches in the output video is only supported for RGB input.
  16085. Defaults to @code{0}.
  16086. @item adaptive_crop
  16087. Whether or not to do a tiny bit of cropping at the borders to cut down on the amount of mirrored pixels.
  16088. Defaults to @code{1}.
  16089. @item refine_features
  16090. Whether or not feature points should be refined at a sub-pixel level.
  16091. This can be turned off for a slight performance gain at the cost of precision.
  16092. Defaults to @code{1}.
  16093. @item smooth_strength
  16094. The strength of the smoothing applied to the camera path from @code{0.0} to @code{1.0}.
  16095. @code{1.0} is the maximum smoothing strength while values less than that result in less smoothing.
  16096. @code{0.0} causes the filter to adaptively choose a smoothing strength on a per-frame basis.
  16097. Defaults to @code{0.0}.
  16098. @item smooth_window_multiplier
  16099. Controls the size of the smoothing window (the number of frames buffered to determine motion information from).
  16100. The size of the smoothing window is determined by multiplying the framerate of the video by this number.
  16101. Acceptable values range from @code{0.1} to @code{10.0}.
  16102. Larger values increase the amount of motion data available for determining how to smooth the camera path,
  16103. potentially improving smoothness, but also increase latency and memory usage.
  16104. Defaults to @code{2.0}.
  16105. @end table
  16106. @subsection Examples
  16107. @itemize
  16108. @item
  16109. Stabilize a video with a fixed, medium smoothing strength:
  16110. @example
  16111. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, deshake_opencl=smooth_strength=0.5, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16112. @end example
  16113. @item
  16114. Stabilize a video with debugging (both in console and in rendered video):
  16115. @example
  16116. -i INPUT -filter_complex "[0:v]format=rgba, hwupload, deshake_opencl=debug=1, hwdownload, format=rgba, format=yuv420p" -v verbose OUTPUT
  16117. @end example
  16118. @end itemize
  16119. @section dilation_opencl
  16120. Apply dilation effect to the video.
  16121. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) maximum.
  16122. It accepts the following options:
  16123. @table @option
  16124. @item threshold0
  16125. @item threshold1
  16126. @item threshold2
  16127. @item threshold3
  16128. Limit the maximum change for each plane. Range is @code{[0, 65535]} and default value is @code{65535}.
  16129. If @code{0}, plane will remain unchanged.
  16130. @item coordinates
  16131. Flag which specifies the pixel to refer to.
  16132. Range is @code{[0, 255]} and default value is @code{255}, i.e. all eight pixels are used.
  16133. Flags to local 3x3 coordinates region centered on @code{x}:
  16134. 1 2 3
  16135. 4 x 5
  16136. 6 7 8
  16137. @end table
  16138. @subsection Example
  16139. @itemize
  16140. @item
  16141. Apply dilation filter with threshold0 set to 30, threshold1 set 40, threshold2 set to 50 and coordinates set to 231, setting each pixel of the output to the local maximum between pixels: 1, 2, 3, 6, 7, 8 of the 3x3 region centered on it in the input. If the difference between input pixel and local maximum is more then threshold of the corresponding plane, output pixel will be set to input pixel + threshold of corresponding plane.
  16142. @example
  16143. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, dilation_opencl=30:40:50:coordinates=231, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16144. @end example
  16145. @end itemize
  16146. @section nlmeans_opencl
  16147. Non-local Means denoise filter through OpenCL, this filter accepts same options as @ref{nlmeans}.
  16148. @section overlay_opencl
  16149. Overlay one video on top of another.
  16150. It takes two inputs and has one output. The first input is the "main" video on which the second input is overlaid.
  16151. This filter requires same memory layout for all the inputs. So, format conversion may be needed.
  16152. The filter accepts the following options:
  16153. @table @option
  16154. @item x
  16155. Set the x coordinate of the overlaid video on the main video.
  16156. Default value is @code{0}.
  16157. @item y
  16158. Set the y coordinate of the overlaid video on the main video.
  16159. Default value is @code{0}.
  16160. @end table
  16161. @subsection Examples
  16162. @itemize
  16163. @item
  16164. Overlay an image LOGO at the top-left corner of the INPUT video. Both inputs are yuv420p format.
  16165. @example
  16166. -i INPUT -i LOGO -filter_complex "[0:v]hwupload[a], [1:v]format=yuv420p, hwupload[b], [a][b]overlay_opencl, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16167. @end example
  16168. @item
  16169. The inputs have same memory layout for color channels , the overlay has additional alpha plane, like INPUT is yuv420p, and the LOGO is yuva420p.
  16170. @example
  16171. -i INPUT -i LOGO -filter_complex "[0:v]hwupload[a], [1:v]format=yuva420p, hwupload[b], [a][b]overlay_opencl, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16172. @end example
  16173. @end itemize
  16174. @section pad_opencl
  16175. Add paddings to the input image, and place the original input at the
  16176. provided @var{x}, @var{y} coordinates.
  16177. It accepts the following options:
  16178. @table @option
  16179. @item width, w
  16180. @item height, h
  16181. Specify an expression for the size of the output image with the
  16182. paddings added. If the value for @var{width} or @var{height} is 0, the
  16183. corresponding input size is used for the output.
  16184. The @var{width} expression can reference the value set by the
  16185. @var{height} expression, and vice versa.
  16186. The default value of @var{width} and @var{height} is 0.
  16187. @item x
  16188. @item y
  16189. Specify the offsets to place the input image at within the padded area,
  16190. with respect to the top/left border of the output image.
  16191. The @var{x} expression can reference the value set by the @var{y}
  16192. expression, and vice versa.
  16193. The default value of @var{x} and @var{y} is 0.
  16194. If @var{x} or @var{y} evaluate to a negative number, they'll be changed
  16195. so the input image is centered on the padded area.
  16196. @item color
  16197. Specify the color of the padded area. For the syntax of this option,
  16198. check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils
  16199. manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16200. @item aspect
  16201. Pad to an aspect instead to a resolution.
  16202. @end table
  16203. The value for the @var{width}, @var{height}, @var{x}, and @var{y}
  16204. options are expressions containing the following constants:
  16205. @table @option
  16206. @item in_w
  16207. @item in_h
  16208. The input video width and height.
  16209. @item iw
  16210. @item ih
  16211. These are the same as @var{in_w} and @var{in_h}.
  16212. @item out_w
  16213. @item out_h
  16214. The output width and height (the size of the padded area), as
  16215. specified by the @var{width} and @var{height} expressions.
  16216. @item ow
  16217. @item oh
  16218. These are the same as @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}.
  16219. @item x
  16220. @item y
  16221. The x and y offsets as specified by the @var{x} and @var{y}
  16222. expressions, or NAN if not yet specified.
  16223. @item a
  16224. same as @var{iw} / @var{ih}
  16225. @item sar
  16226. input sample aspect ratio
  16227. @item dar
  16228. input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{iw} / @var{ih}) * @var{sar}
  16229. @end table
  16230. @section prewitt_opencl
  16231. Apply the Prewitt operator (@url{https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Prewitt_operator}) to input video stream.
  16232. The filter accepts the following option:
  16233. @table @option
  16234. @item planes
  16235. Set which planes to filter. Default value is @code{0xf}, by which all planes are processed.
  16236. @item scale
  16237. Set value which will be multiplied with filtered result.
  16238. Range is @code{[0.0, 65535]} and default value is @code{1.0}.
  16239. @item delta
  16240. Set value which will be added to filtered result.
  16241. Range is @code{[-65535, 65535]} and default value is @code{0.0}.
  16242. @end table
  16243. @subsection Example
  16244. @itemize
  16245. @item
  16246. Apply the Prewitt operator with scale set to 2 and delta set to 10.
  16247. @example
  16248. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, prewitt_opencl=scale=2:delta=10, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16249. @end example
  16250. @end itemize
  16251. @anchor{program_opencl}
  16252. @section program_opencl
  16253. Filter video using an OpenCL program.
  16254. @table @option
  16255. @item source
  16256. OpenCL program source file.
  16257. @item kernel
  16258. Kernel name in program.
  16259. @item inputs
  16260. Number of inputs to the filter. Defaults to 1.
  16261. @item size, s
  16262. Size of output frames. Defaults to the same as the first input.
  16263. @end table
  16264. The @code{program_opencl} filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  16265. The program source file must contain a kernel function with the given name,
  16266. which will be run once for each plane of the output. Each run on a plane
  16267. gets enqueued as a separate 2D global NDRange with one work-item for each
  16268. pixel to be generated. The global ID offset for each work-item is therefore
  16269. the coordinates of a pixel in the destination image.
  16270. The kernel function needs to take the following arguments:
  16271. @itemize
  16272. @item
  16273. Destination image, @var{__write_only image2d_t}.
  16274. This image will become the output; the kernel should write all of it.
  16275. @item
  16276. Frame index, @var{unsigned int}.
  16277. This is a counter starting from zero and increasing by one for each frame.
  16278. @item
  16279. Source images, @var{__read_only image2d_t}.
  16280. These are the most recent images on each input. The kernel may read from
  16281. them to generate the output, but they can't be written to.
  16282. @end itemize
  16283. Example programs:
  16284. @itemize
  16285. @item
  16286. Copy the input to the output (output must be the same size as the input).
  16287. @verbatim
  16288. __kernel void copy(__write_only image2d_t destination,
  16289. unsigned int index,
  16290. __read_only image2d_t source)
  16291. {
  16292. const sampler_t sampler = CLK_NORMALIZED_COORDS_FALSE;
  16293. int2 location = (int2)(get_global_id(0), get_global_id(1));
  16294. float4 value = read_imagef(source, sampler, location);
  16295. write_imagef(destination, location, value);
  16296. }
  16297. @end verbatim
  16298. @item
  16299. Apply a simple transformation, rotating the input by an amount increasing
  16300. with the index counter. Pixel values are linearly interpolated by the
  16301. sampler, and the output need not have the same dimensions as the input.
  16302. @verbatim
  16303. __kernel void rotate_image(__write_only image2d_t dst,
  16304. unsigned int index,
  16305. __read_only image2d_t src)
  16306. {
  16307. const sampler_t sampler = (CLK_NORMALIZED_COORDS_FALSE |
  16308. CLK_FILTER_LINEAR);
  16309. float angle = (float)index / 100.0f;
  16310. float2 dst_dim = convert_float2(get_image_dim(dst));
  16311. float2 src_dim = convert_float2(get_image_dim(src));
  16312. float2 dst_cen = dst_dim / 2.0f;
  16313. float2 src_cen = src_dim / 2.0f;
  16314. int2 dst_loc = (int2)(get_global_id(0), get_global_id(1));
  16315. float2 dst_pos = convert_float2(dst_loc) - dst_cen;
  16316. float2 src_pos = {
  16317. cos(angle) * dst_pos.x - sin(angle) * dst_pos.y,
  16318. sin(angle) * dst_pos.x + cos(angle) * dst_pos.y
  16319. };
  16320. src_pos = src_pos * src_dim / dst_dim;
  16321. float2 src_loc = src_pos + src_cen;
  16322. if (src_loc.x < 0.0f || src_loc.y < 0.0f ||
  16323. src_loc.x > src_dim.x || src_loc.y > src_dim.y)
  16324. write_imagef(dst, dst_loc, 0.5f);
  16325. else
  16326. write_imagef(dst, dst_loc, read_imagef(src, sampler, src_loc));
  16327. }
  16328. @end verbatim
  16329. @item
  16330. Blend two inputs together, with the amount of each input used varying
  16331. with the index counter.
  16332. @verbatim
  16333. __kernel void blend_images(__write_only image2d_t dst,
  16334. unsigned int index,
  16335. __read_only image2d_t src1,
  16336. __read_only image2d_t src2)
  16337. {
  16338. const sampler_t sampler = (CLK_NORMALIZED_COORDS_FALSE |
  16339. CLK_FILTER_LINEAR);
  16340. float blend = (cos((float)index / 50.0f) + 1.0f) / 2.0f;
  16341. int2 dst_loc = (int2)(get_global_id(0), get_global_id(1));
  16342. int2 src1_loc = dst_loc * get_image_dim(src1) / get_image_dim(dst);
  16343. int2 src2_loc = dst_loc * get_image_dim(src2) / get_image_dim(dst);
  16344. float4 val1 = read_imagef(src1, sampler, src1_loc);
  16345. float4 val2 = read_imagef(src2, sampler, src2_loc);
  16346. write_imagef(dst, dst_loc, val1 * blend + val2 * (1.0f - blend));
  16347. }
  16348. @end verbatim
  16349. @end itemize
  16350. @section roberts_opencl
  16351. Apply the Roberts cross operator (@url{https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Roberts_cross}) to input video stream.
  16352. The filter accepts the following option:
  16353. @table @option
  16354. @item planes
  16355. Set which planes to filter. Default value is @code{0xf}, by which all planes are processed.
  16356. @item scale
  16357. Set value which will be multiplied with filtered result.
  16358. Range is @code{[0.0, 65535]} and default value is @code{1.0}.
  16359. @item delta
  16360. Set value which will be added to filtered result.
  16361. Range is @code{[-65535, 65535]} and default value is @code{0.0}.
  16362. @end table
  16363. @subsection Example
  16364. @itemize
  16365. @item
  16366. Apply the Roberts cross operator with scale set to 2 and delta set to 10
  16367. @example
  16368. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, roberts_opencl=scale=2:delta=10, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16369. @end example
  16370. @end itemize
  16371. @section sobel_opencl
  16372. Apply the Sobel operator (@url{https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Sobel_operator}) to input video stream.
  16373. The filter accepts the following option:
  16374. @table @option
  16375. @item planes
  16376. Set which planes to filter. Default value is @code{0xf}, by which all planes are processed.
  16377. @item scale
  16378. Set value which will be multiplied with filtered result.
  16379. Range is @code{[0.0, 65535]} and default value is @code{1.0}.
  16380. @item delta
  16381. Set value which will be added to filtered result.
  16382. Range is @code{[-65535, 65535]} and default value is @code{0.0}.
  16383. @end table
  16384. @subsection Example
  16385. @itemize
  16386. @item
  16387. Apply sobel operator with scale set to 2 and delta set to 10
  16388. @example
  16389. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, sobel_opencl=scale=2:delta=10, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16390. @end example
  16391. @end itemize
  16392. @section tonemap_opencl
  16393. Perform HDR(PQ/HLG) to SDR conversion with tone-mapping.
  16394. It accepts the following parameters:
  16395. @table @option
  16396. @item tonemap
  16397. Specify the tone-mapping operator to be used. Same as tonemap option in @ref{tonemap}.
  16398. @item param
  16399. Tune the tone mapping algorithm. same as param option in @ref{tonemap}.
  16400. @item desat
  16401. Apply desaturation for highlights that exceed this level of brightness. The
  16402. higher the parameter, the more color information will be preserved. This
  16403. setting helps prevent unnaturally blown-out colors for super-highlights, by
  16404. (smoothly) turning into white instead. This makes images feel more natural,
  16405. at the cost of reducing information about out-of-range colors.
  16406. The default value is 0.5, and the algorithm here is a little different from
  16407. the cpu version tonemap currently. A setting of 0.0 disables this option.
  16408. @item threshold
  16409. The tonemapping algorithm parameters is fine-tuned per each scene. And a threshold
  16410. is used to detect whether the scene has changed or not. If the distance between
  16411. the current frame average brightness and the current running average exceeds
  16412. a threshold value, we would re-calculate scene average and peak brightness.
  16413. The default value is 0.2.
  16414. @item format
  16415. Specify the output pixel format.
  16416. Currently supported formats are:
  16417. @table @var
  16418. @item p010
  16419. @item nv12
  16420. @end table
  16421. @item range, r
  16422. Set the output color range.
  16423. Possible values are:
  16424. @table @var
  16425. @item tv/mpeg
  16426. @item pc/jpeg
  16427. @end table
  16428. Default is same as input.
  16429. @item primaries, p
  16430. Set the output color primaries.
  16431. Possible values are:
  16432. @table @var
  16433. @item bt709
  16434. @item bt2020
  16435. @end table
  16436. Default is same as input.
  16437. @item transfer, t
  16438. Set the output transfer characteristics.
  16439. Possible values are:
  16440. @table @var
  16441. @item bt709
  16442. @item bt2020
  16443. @end table
  16444. Default is bt709.
  16445. @item matrix, m
  16446. Set the output colorspace matrix.
  16447. Possible value are:
  16448. @table @var
  16449. @item bt709
  16450. @item bt2020
  16451. @end table
  16452. Default is same as input.
  16453. @end table
  16454. @subsection Example
  16455. @itemize
  16456. @item
  16457. Convert HDR(PQ/HLG) video to bt2020-transfer-characteristic p010 format using linear operator.
  16458. @example
  16459. -i INPUT -vf "format=p010,hwupload,tonemap_opencl=t=bt2020:tonemap=linear:format=p010,hwdownload,format=p010" OUTPUT
  16460. @end example
  16461. @end itemize
  16462. @section unsharp_opencl
  16463. Sharpen or blur the input video.
  16464. It accepts the following parameters:
  16465. @table @option
  16466. @item luma_msize_x, lx
  16467. Set the luma matrix horizontal size.
  16468. Range is @code{[1, 23]} and default value is @code{5}.
  16469. @item luma_msize_y, ly
  16470. Set the luma matrix vertical size.
  16471. Range is @code{[1, 23]} and default value is @code{5}.
  16472. @item luma_amount, la
  16473. Set the luma effect strength.
  16474. Range is @code{[-10, 10]} and default value is @code{1.0}.
  16475. Negative values will blur the input video, while positive values will
  16476. sharpen it, a value of zero will disable the effect.
  16477. @item chroma_msize_x, cx
  16478. Set the chroma matrix horizontal size.
  16479. Range is @code{[1, 23]} and default value is @code{5}.
  16480. @item chroma_msize_y, cy
  16481. Set the chroma matrix vertical size.
  16482. Range is @code{[1, 23]} and default value is @code{5}.
  16483. @item chroma_amount, ca
  16484. Set the chroma effect strength.
  16485. Range is @code{[-10, 10]} and default value is @code{0.0}.
  16486. Negative values will blur the input video, while positive values will
  16487. sharpen it, a value of zero will disable the effect.
  16488. @end table
  16489. All parameters are optional and default to the equivalent of the
  16490. string '5:5:1.0:5:5:0.0'.
  16491. @subsection Examples
  16492. @itemize
  16493. @item
  16494. Apply strong luma sharpen effect:
  16495. @example
  16496. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, unsharp_opencl=luma_msize_x=7:luma_msize_y=7:luma_amount=2.5, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16497. @end example
  16498. @item
  16499. Apply a strong blur of both luma and chroma parameters:
  16500. @example
  16501. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, unsharp_opencl=7:7:-2:7:7:-2, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16502. @end example
  16503. @end itemize
  16504. @section xfade_opencl
  16505. Cross fade two videos with custom transition effect by using OpenCL.
  16506. It accepts the following options:
  16507. @table @option
  16508. @item transition
  16509. Set one of possible transition effects.
  16510. @table @option
  16511. @item custom
  16512. Select custom transition effect, the actual transition description
  16513. will be picked from source and kernel options.
  16514. @item fade
  16515. @item wipeleft
  16516. @item wiperight
  16517. @item wipeup
  16518. @item wipedown
  16519. @item slideleft
  16520. @item slideright
  16521. @item slideup
  16522. @item slidedown
  16523. Default transition is fade.
  16524. @end table
  16525. @item source
  16526. OpenCL program source file for custom transition.
  16527. @item kernel
  16528. Set name of kernel to use for custom transition from program source file.
  16529. @item duration
  16530. Set duration of video transition.
  16531. @item offset
  16532. Set time of start of transition relative to first video.
  16533. @end table
  16534. The program source file must contain a kernel function with the given name,
  16535. which will be run once for each plane of the output. Each run on a plane
  16536. gets enqueued as a separate 2D global NDRange with one work-item for each
  16537. pixel to be generated. The global ID offset for each work-item is therefore
  16538. the coordinates of a pixel in the destination image.
  16539. The kernel function needs to take the following arguments:
  16540. @itemize
  16541. @item
  16542. Destination image, @var{__write_only image2d_t}.
  16543. This image will become the output; the kernel should write all of it.
  16544. @item
  16545. First Source image, @var{__read_only image2d_t}.
  16546. Second Source image, @var{__read_only image2d_t}.
  16547. These are the most recent images on each input. The kernel may read from
  16548. them to generate the output, but they can't be written to.
  16549. @item
  16550. Transition progress, @var{float}. This value is always between 0 and 1 inclusive.
  16551. @end itemize
  16552. Example programs:
  16553. @itemize
  16554. @item
  16555. Apply dots curtain transition effect:
  16556. @verbatim
  16557. __kernel void blend_images(__write_only image2d_t dst,
  16558. __read_only image2d_t src1,
  16559. __read_only image2d_t src2,
  16560. float progress)
  16561. {
  16562. const sampler_t sampler = (CLK_NORMALIZED_COORDS_FALSE |
  16563. CLK_FILTER_LINEAR);
  16564. int2 p = (int2)(get_global_id(0), get_global_id(1));
  16565. float2 rp = (float2)(get_global_id(0), get_global_id(1));
  16566. float2 dim = (float2)(get_image_dim(src1).x, get_image_dim(src1).y);
  16567. rp = rp / dim;
  16568. float2 dots = (float2)(20.0, 20.0);
  16569. float2 center = (float2)(0,0);
  16570. float2 unused;
  16571. float4 val1 = read_imagef(src1, sampler, p);
  16572. float4 val2 = read_imagef(src2, sampler, p);
  16573. bool next = distance(fract(rp * dots, &unused), (float2)(0.5, 0.5)) < (progress / distance(rp, center));
  16574. write_imagef(dst, p, next ? val1 : val2);
  16575. }
  16576. @end verbatim
  16577. @end itemize
  16578. @c man end OPENCL VIDEO FILTERS
  16579. @chapter VAAPI Video Filters
  16580. @c man begin VAAPI VIDEO FILTERS
  16581. VAAPI Video filters are usually used with VAAPI decoder and VAAPI encoder. Below is a description of VAAPI video filters.
  16582. To enable compilation of these filters you need to configure FFmpeg with
  16583. @code{--enable-vaapi}.
  16584. To use vaapi filters, you need to setup the vaapi device correctly. For more information, please read @url{https://trac.ffmpeg.org/wiki/Hardware/VAAPI}
  16585. @section tonemap_vaapi
  16586. Perform HDR(High Dynamic Range) to SDR(Standard Dynamic Range) conversion with tone-mapping.
  16587. It maps the dynamic range of HDR10 content to the SDR content.
  16588. It currently only accepts HDR10 as input.
  16589. It accepts the following parameters:
  16590. @table @option
  16591. @item format
  16592. Specify the output pixel format.
  16593. Currently supported formats are:
  16594. @table @var
  16595. @item p010
  16596. @item nv12
  16597. @end table
  16598. Default is nv12.
  16599. @item primaries, p
  16600. Set the output color primaries.
  16601. Default is same as input.
  16602. @item transfer, t
  16603. Set the output transfer characteristics.
  16604. Default is bt709.
  16605. @item matrix, m
  16606. Set the output colorspace matrix.
  16607. Default is same as input.
  16608. @end table
  16609. @subsection Example
  16610. @itemize
  16611. @item
  16612. Convert HDR(HDR10) video to bt2020-transfer-characteristic p010 format
  16613. @example
  16614. tonemap_vaapi=format=p010:t=bt2020-10
  16615. @end example
  16616. @end itemize
  16617. @c man end VAAPI VIDEO FILTERS
  16618. @chapter Video Sources
  16619. @c man begin VIDEO SOURCES
  16620. Below is a description of the currently available video sources.
  16621. @section buffer
  16622. Buffer video frames, and make them available to the filter chain.
  16623. This source is mainly intended for a programmatic use, in particular
  16624. through the interface defined in @file{libavfilter/vsrc_buffer.h}.
  16625. It accepts the following parameters:
  16626. @table @option
  16627. @item video_size
  16628. Specify the size (width and height) of the buffered video frames. For the
  16629. syntax of this option, check the
  16630. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16631. @item width
  16632. The input video width.
  16633. @item height
  16634. The input video height.
  16635. @item pix_fmt
  16636. A string representing the pixel format of the buffered video frames.
  16637. It may be a number corresponding to a pixel format, or a pixel format
  16638. name.
  16639. @item time_base
  16640. Specify the timebase assumed by the timestamps of the buffered frames.
  16641. @item frame_rate
  16642. Specify the frame rate expected for the video stream.
  16643. @item pixel_aspect, sar
  16644. The sample (pixel) aspect ratio of the input video.
  16645. @item sws_param
  16646. This option is deprecated and ignored. Prepend @code{sws_flags=@var{flags};}
  16647. to the filtergraph description to specify swscale flags for automatically
  16648. inserted scalers. See @ref{Filtergraph syntax}.
  16649. @item hw_frames_ctx
  16650. When using a hardware pixel format, this should be a reference to an
  16651. AVHWFramesContext describing input frames.
  16652. @end table
  16653. For example:
  16654. @example
  16655. buffer=width=320:height=240:pix_fmt=yuv410p:time_base=1/24:sar=1
  16656. @end example
  16657. will instruct the source to accept video frames with size 320x240 and
  16658. with format "yuv410p", assuming 1/24 as the timestamps timebase and
  16659. square pixels (1:1 sample aspect ratio).
  16660. Since the pixel format with name "yuv410p" corresponds to the number 6
  16661. (check the enum AVPixelFormat definition in @file{libavutil/pixfmt.h}),
  16662. this example corresponds to:
  16663. @example
  16664. buffer=size=320x240:pixfmt=6:time_base=1/24:pixel_aspect=1/1
  16665. @end example
  16666. Alternatively, the options can be specified as a flat string, but this
  16667. syntax is deprecated:
  16668. @var{width}:@var{height}:@var{pix_fmt}:@var{time_base.num}:@var{time_base.den}:@var{pixel_aspect.num}:@var{pixel_aspect.den}
  16669. @section cellauto
  16670. Create a pattern generated by an elementary cellular automaton.
  16671. The initial state of the cellular automaton can be defined through the
  16672. @option{filename} and @option{pattern} options. If such options are
  16673. not specified an initial state is created randomly.
  16674. At each new frame a new row in the video is filled with the result of
  16675. the cellular automaton next generation. The behavior when the whole
  16676. frame is filled is defined by the @option{scroll} option.
  16677. This source accepts the following options:
  16678. @table @option
  16679. @item filename, f
  16680. Read the initial cellular automaton state, i.e. the starting row, from
  16681. the specified file.
  16682. In the file, each non-whitespace character is considered an alive
  16683. cell, a newline will terminate the row, and further characters in the
  16684. file will be ignored.
  16685. @item pattern, p
  16686. Read the initial cellular automaton state, i.e. the starting row, from
  16687. the specified string.
  16688. Each non-whitespace character in the string is considered an alive
  16689. cell, a newline will terminate the row, and further characters in the
  16690. string will be ignored.
  16691. @item rate, r
  16692. Set the video rate, that is the number of frames generated per second.
  16693. Default is 25.
  16694. @item random_fill_ratio, ratio
  16695. Set the random fill ratio for the initial cellular automaton row. It
  16696. is a floating point number value ranging from 0 to 1, defaults to
  16697. 1/PHI.
  16698. This option is ignored when a file or a pattern is specified.
  16699. @item random_seed, seed
  16700. Set the seed for filling randomly the initial row, must be an integer
  16701. included between 0 and UINT32_MAX. If not specified, or if explicitly
  16702. set to -1, the filter will try to use a good random seed on a best
  16703. effort basis.
  16704. @item rule
  16705. Set the cellular automaton rule, it is a number ranging from 0 to 255.
  16706. Default value is 110.
  16707. @item size, s
  16708. Set the size of the output video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  16709. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16710. If @option{filename} or @option{pattern} is specified, the size is set
  16711. by default to the width of the specified initial state row, and the
  16712. height is set to @var{width} * PHI.
  16713. If @option{size} is set, it must contain the width of the specified
  16714. pattern string, and the specified pattern will be centered in the
  16715. larger row.
  16716. If a filename or a pattern string is not specified, the size value
  16717. defaults to "320x518" (used for a randomly generated initial state).
  16718. @item scroll
  16719. If set to 1, scroll the output upward when all the rows in the output
  16720. have been already filled. If set to 0, the new generated row will be
  16721. written over the top row just after the bottom row is filled.
  16722. Defaults to 1.
  16723. @item start_full, full
  16724. If set to 1, completely fill the output with generated rows before
  16725. outputting the first frame.
  16726. This is the default behavior, for disabling set the value to 0.
  16727. @item stitch
  16728. If set to 1, stitch the left and right row edges together.
  16729. This is the default behavior, for disabling set the value to 0.
  16730. @end table
  16731. @subsection Examples
  16732. @itemize
  16733. @item
  16734. Read the initial state from @file{pattern}, and specify an output of
  16735. size 200x400.
  16736. @example
  16737. cellauto=f=pattern:s=200x400
  16738. @end example
  16739. @item
  16740. Generate a random initial row with a width of 200 cells, with a fill
  16741. ratio of 2/3:
  16742. @example
  16743. cellauto=ratio=2/3:s=200x200
  16744. @end example
  16745. @item
  16746. Create a pattern generated by rule 18 starting by a single alive cell
  16747. centered on an initial row with width 100:
  16748. @example
  16749. cellauto=p=@@:s=100x400:full=0:rule=18
  16750. @end example
  16751. @item
  16752. Specify a more elaborated initial pattern:
  16753. @example
  16754. cellauto=p='@@@@ @@ @@@@':s=100x400:full=0:rule=18
  16755. @end example
  16756. @end itemize
  16757. @anchor{coreimagesrc}
  16758. @section coreimagesrc
  16759. Video source generated on GPU using Apple's CoreImage API on OSX.
  16760. This video source is a specialized version of the @ref{coreimage} video filter.
  16761. Use a core image generator at the beginning of the applied filterchain to
  16762. generate the content.
  16763. The coreimagesrc video source accepts the following options:
  16764. @table @option
  16765. @item list_generators
  16766. List all available generators along with all their respective options as well as
  16767. possible minimum and maximum values along with the default values.
  16768. @example
  16769. list_generators=true
  16770. @end example
  16771. @item size, s
  16772. Specify the size of the sourced video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  16773. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16774. The default value is @code{320x240}.
  16775. @item rate, r
  16776. Specify the frame rate of the sourced video, as the number of frames
  16777. generated per second. It has to be a string in the format
  16778. @var{frame_rate_num}/@var{frame_rate_den}, an integer number, a floating point
  16779. number or a valid video frame rate abbreviation. The default value is
  16780. "25".
  16781. @item sar
  16782. Set the sample aspect ratio of the sourced video.
  16783. @item duration, d
  16784. Set the duration of the sourced video. See
  16785. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  16786. for the accepted syntax.
  16787. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the video is
  16788. supposed to be generated forever.
  16789. @end table
  16790. Additionally, all options of the @ref{coreimage} video filter are accepted.
  16791. A complete filterchain can be used for further processing of the
  16792. generated input without CPU-HOST transfer. See @ref{coreimage} documentation
  16793. and examples for details.
  16794. @subsection Examples
  16795. @itemize
  16796. @item
  16797. Use CIQRCodeGenerator to create a QR code for the FFmpeg homepage,
  16798. given as complete and escaped command-line for Apple's standard bash shell:
  16799. @example
  16800. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i coreimagesrc=s=100x100:filter=CIQRCodeGenerator@@inputMessage=https\\\\\://FFmpeg.org/@@inputCorrectionLevel=H -frames:v 1 QRCode.png
  16801. @end example
  16802. This example is equivalent to the QRCode example of @ref{coreimage} without the
  16803. need for a nullsrc video source.
  16804. @end itemize
  16805. @section mandelbrot
  16806. Generate a Mandelbrot set fractal, and progressively zoom towards the
  16807. point specified with @var{start_x} and @var{start_y}.
  16808. This source accepts the following options:
  16809. @table @option
  16810. @item end_pts
  16811. Set the terminal pts value. Default value is 400.
  16812. @item end_scale
  16813. Set the terminal scale value.
  16814. Must be a floating point value. Default value is 0.3.
  16815. @item inner
  16816. Set the inner coloring mode, that is the algorithm used to draw the
  16817. Mandelbrot fractal internal region.
  16818. It shall assume one of the following values:
  16819. @table @option
  16820. @item black
  16821. Set black mode.
  16822. @item convergence
  16823. Show time until convergence.
  16824. @item mincol
  16825. Set color based on point closest to the origin of the iterations.
  16826. @item period
  16827. Set period mode.
  16828. @end table
  16829. Default value is @var{mincol}.
  16830. @item bailout
  16831. Set the bailout value. Default value is 10.0.
  16832. @item maxiter
  16833. Set the maximum of iterations performed by the rendering
  16834. algorithm. Default value is 7189.
  16835. @item outer
  16836. Set outer coloring mode.
  16837. It shall assume one of following values:
  16838. @table @option
  16839. @item iteration_count
  16840. Set iteration count mode.
  16841. @item normalized_iteration_count
  16842. set normalized iteration count mode.
  16843. @end table
  16844. Default value is @var{normalized_iteration_count}.
  16845. @item rate, r
  16846. Set frame rate, expressed as number of frames per second. Default
  16847. value is "25".
  16848. @item size, s
  16849. Set frame size. For the syntax of this option, check the @ref{video size syntax,,"Video
  16850. size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}. Default value is "640x480".
  16851. @item start_scale
  16852. Set the initial scale value. Default value is 3.0.
  16853. @item start_x
  16854. Set the initial x position. Must be a floating point value between
  16855. -100 and 100. Default value is -0.743643887037158704752191506114774.
  16856. @item start_y
  16857. Set the initial y position. Must be a floating point value between
  16858. -100 and 100. Default value is -0.131825904205311970493132056385139.
  16859. @end table
  16860. @section mptestsrc
  16861. Generate various test patterns, as generated by the MPlayer test filter.
  16862. The size of the generated video is fixed, and is 256x256.
  16863. This source is useful in particular for testing encoding features.
  16864. This source accepts the following options:
  16865. @table @option
  16866. @item rate, r
  16867. Specify the frame rate of the sourced video, as the number of frames
  16868. generated per second. It has to be a string in the format
  16869. @var{frame_rate_num}/@var{frame_rate_den}, an integer number, a floating point
  16870. number or a valid video frame rate abbreviation. The default value is
  16871. "25".
  16872. @item duration, d
  16873. Set the duration of the sourced video. See
  16874. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  16875. for the accepted syntax.
  16876. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the video is
  16877. supposed to be generated forever.
  16878. @item test, t
  16879. Set the number or the name of the test to perform. Supported tests are:
  16880. @table @option
  16881. @item dc_luma
  16882. @item dc_chroma
  16883. @item freq_luma
  16884. @item freq_chroma
  16885. @item amp_luma
  16886. @item amp_chroma
  16887. @item cbp
  16888. @item mv
  16889. @item ring1
  16890. @item ring2
  16891. @item all
  16892. @item max_frames, m
  16893. Set the maximum number of frames generated for each test, default value is 30.
  16894. @end table
  16895. Default value is "all", which will cycle through the list of all tests.
  16896. @end table
  16897. Some examples:
  16898. @example
  16899. mptestsrc=t=dc_luma
  16900. @end example
  16901. will generate a "dc_luma" test pattern.
  16902. @section frei0r_src
  16903. Provide a frei0r source.
  16904. To enable compilation of this filter you need to install the frei0r
  16905. header and configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-frei0r}.
  16906. This source accepts the following parameters:
  16907. @table @option
  16908. @item size
  16909. The size of the video to generate. For the syntax of this option, check the
  16910. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16911. @item framerate
  16912. The framerate of the generated video. It may be a string of the form
  16913. @var{num}/@var{den} or a frame rate abbreviation.
  16914. @item filter_name
  16915. The name to the frei0r source to load. For more information regarding frei0r and
  16916. how to set the parameters, read the @ref{frei0r} section in the video filters
  16917. documentation.
  16918. @item filter_params
  16919. A '|'-separated list of parameters to pass to the frei0r source.
  16920. @end table
  16921. For example, to generate a frei0r partik0l source with size 200x200
  16922. and frame rate 10 which is overlaid on the overlay filter main input:
  16923. @example
  16924. frei0r_src=size=200x200:framerate=10:filter_name=partik0l:filter_params=1234 [overlay]; [in][overlay] overlay
  16925. @end example
  16926. @section life
  16927. Generate a life pattern.
  16928. This source is based on a generalization of John Conway's life game.
  16929. The sourced input represents a life grid, each pixel represents a cell
  16930. which can be in one of two possible states, alive or dead. Every cell
  16931. interacts with its eight neighbours, which are the cells that are
  16932. horizontally, vertically, or diagonally adjacent.
  16933. At each interaction the grid evolves according to the adopted rule,
  16934. which specifies the number of neighbor alive cells which will make a
  16935. cell stay alive or born. The @option{rule} option allows one to specify
  16936. the rule to adopt.
  16937. This source accepts the following options:
  16938. @table @option
  16939. @item filename, f
  16940. Set the file from which to read the initial grid state. In the file,
  16941. each non-whitespace character is considered an alive cell, and newline
  16942. is used to delimit the end of each row.
  16943. If this option is not specified, the initial grid is generated
  16944. randomly.
  16945. @item rate, r
  16946. Set the video rate, that is the number of frames generated per second.
  16947. Default is 25.
  16948. @item random_fill_ratio, ratio
  16949. Set the random fill ratio for the initial random grid. It is a
  16950. floating point number value ranging from 0 to 1, defaults to 1/PHI.
  16951. It is ignored when a file is specified.
  16952. @item random_seed, seed
  16953. Set the seed for filling the initial random grid, must be an integer
  16954. included between 0 and UINT32_MAX. If not specified, or if explicitly
  16955. set to -1, the filter will try to use a good random seed on a best
  16956. effort basis.
  16957. @item rule
  16958. Set the life rule.
  16959. A rule can be specified with a code of the kind "S@var{NS}/B@var{NB}",
  16960. where @var{NS} and @var{NB} are sequences of numbers in the range 0-8,
  16961. @var{NS} specifies the number of alive neighbor cells which make a
  16962. live cell stay alive, and @var{NB} the number of alive neighbor cells
  16963. which make a dead cell to become alive (i.e. to "born").
  16964. "s" and "b" can be used in place of "S" and "B", respectively.
  16965. Alternatively a rule can be specified by an 18-bits integer. The 9
  16966. high order bits are used to encode the next cell state if it is alive
  16967. for each number of neighbor alive cells, the low order bits specify
  16968. the rule for "borning" new cells. Higher order bits encode for an
  16969. higher number of neighbor cells.
  16970. For example the number 6153 = @code{(12<<9)+9} specifies a stay alive
  16971. rule of 12 and a born rule of 9, which corresponds to "S23/B03".
  16972. Default value is "S23/B3", which is the original Conway's game of life
  16973. rule, and will keep a cell alive if it has 2 or 3 neighbor alive
  16974. cells, and will born a new cell if there are three alive cells around
  16975. a dead cell.
  16976. @item size, s
  16977. Set the size of the output video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  16978. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16979. If @option{filename} is specified, the size is set by default to the
  16980. same size of the input file. If @option{size} is set, it must contain
  16981. the size specified in the input file, and the initial grid defined in
  16982. that file is centered in the larger resulting area.
  16983. If a filename is not specified, the size value defaults to "320x240"
  16984. (used for a randomly generated initial grid).
  16985. @item stitch
  16986. If set to 1, stitch the left and right grid edges together, and the
  16987. top and bottom edges also. Defaults to 1.
  16988. @item mold
  16989. Set cell mold speed. If set, a dead cell will go from @option{death_color} to
  16990. @option{mold_color} with a step of @option{mold}. @option{mold} can have a
  16991. value from 0 to 255.
  16992. @item life_color
  16993. Set the color of living (or new born) cells.
  16994. @item death_color
  16995. Set the color of dead cells. If @option{mold} is set, this is the first color
  16996. used to represent a dead cell.
  16997. @item mold_color
  16998. Set mold color, for definitely dead and moldy cells.
  16999. For the syntax of these 3 color options, check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the
  17000. ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  17001. @end table
  17002. @subsection Examples
  17003. @itemize
  17004. @item
  17005. Read a grid from @file{pattern}, and center it on a grid of size
  17006. 300x300 pixels:
  17007. @example
  17008. life=f=pattern:s=300x300
  17009. @end example
  17010. @item
  17011. Generate a random grid of size 200x200, with a fill ratio of 2/3:
  17012. @example
  17013. life=ratio=2/3:s=200x200
  17014. @end example
  17015. @item
  17016. Specify a custom rule for evolving a randomly generated grid:
  17017. @example
  17018. life=rule=S14/B34
  17019. @end example
  17020. @item
  17021. Full example with slow death effect (mold) using @command{ffplay}:
  17022. @example
  17023. ffplay -f lavfi life=s=300x200:mold=10:r=60:ratio=0.1:death_color=#C83232:life_color=#00ff00,scale=1200:800:flags=16
  17024. @end example
  17025. @end itemize
  17026. @anchor{allrgb}
  17027. @anchor{allyuv}
  17028. @anchor{color}
  17029. @anchor{haldclutsrc}
  17030. @anchor{nullsrc}
  17031. @anchor{pal75bars}
  17032. @anchor{pal100bars}
  17033. @anchor{rgbtestsrc}
  17034. @anchor{smptebars}
  17035. @anchor{smptehdbars}
  17036. @anchor{testsrc}
  17037. @anchor{testsrc2}
  17038. @anchor{yuvtestsrc}
  17039. @section allrgb, allyuv, color, haldclutsrc, nullsrc, pal75bars, pal100bars, rgbtestsrc, smptebars, smptehdbars, testsrc, testsrc2, yuvtestsrc
  17040. The @code{allrgb} source returns frames of size 4096x4096 of all rgb colors.
  17041. The @code{allyuv} source returns frames of size 4096x4096 of all yuv colors.
  17042. The @code{color} source provides an uniformly colored input.
  17043. The @code{haldclutsrc} source provides an identity Hald CLUT. See also
  17044. @ref{haldclut} filter.
  17045. The @code{nullsrc} source returns unprocessed video frames. It is
  17046. mainly useful to be employed in analysis / debugging tools, or as the
  17047. source for filters which ignore the input data.
  17048. The @code{pal75bars} source generates a color bars pattern, based on
  17049. EBU PAL recommendations with 75% color levels.
  17050. The @code{pal100bars} source generates a color bars pattern, based on
  17051. EBU PAL recommendations with 100% color levels.
  17052. The @code{rgbtestsrc} source generates an RGB test pattern useful for
  17053. detecting RGB vs BGR issues. You should see a red, green and blue
  17054. stripe from top to bottom.
  17055. The @code{smptebars} source generates a color bars pattern, based on
  17056. the SMPTE Engineering Guideline EG 1-1990.
  17057. The @code{smptehdbars} source generates a color bars pattern, based on
  17058. the SMPTE RP 219-2002.
  17059. The @code{testsrc} source generates a test video pattern, showing a
  17060. color pattern, a scrolling gradient and a timestamp. This is mainly
  17061. intended for testing purposes.
  17062. The @code{testsrc2} source is similar to testsrc, but supports more
  17063. pixel formats instead of just @code{rgb24}. This allows using it as an
  17064. input for other tests without requiring a format conversion.
  17065. The @code{yuvtestsrc} source generates an YUV test pattern. You should
  17066. see a y, cb and cr stripe from top to bottom.
  17067. The sources accept the following parameters:
  17068. @table @option
  17069. @item level
  17070. Specify the level of the Hald CLUT, only available in the @code{haldclutsrc}
  17071. source. A level of @code{N} generates a picture of @code{N*N*N} by @code{N*N*N}
  17072. pixels to be used as identity matrix for 3D lookup tables. Each component is
  17073. coded on a @code{1/(N*N)} scale.
  17074. @item color, c
  17075. Specify the color of the source, only available in the @code{color}
  17076. source. For the syntax of this option, check the
  17077. @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  17078. @item size, s
  17079. Specify the size of the sourced video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  17080. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  17081. The default value is @code{320x240}.
  17082. This option is not available with the @code{allrgb}, @code{allyuv}, and
  17083. @code{haldclutsrc} filters.
  17084. @item rate, r
  17085. Specify the frame rate of the sourced video, as the number of frames
  17086. generated per second. It has to be a string in the format
  17087. @var{frame_rate_num}/@var{frame_rate_den}, an integer number, a floating point
  17088. number or a valid video frame rate abbreviation. The default value is
  17089. "25".
  17090. @item duration, d
  17091. Set the duration of the sourced video. See
  17092. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  17093. for the accepted syntax.
  17094. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the video is
  17095. supposed to be generated forever.
  17096. @item sar
  17097. Set the sample aspect ratio of the sourced video.
  17098. @item alpha
  17099. Specify the alpha (opacity) of the background, only available in the
  17100. @code{testsrc2} source. The value must be between 0 (fully transparent) and
  17101. 255 (fully opaque, the default).
  17102. @item decimals, n
  17103. Set the number of decimals to show in the timestamp, only available in the
  17104. @code{testsrc} source.
  17105. The displayed timestamp value will correspond to the original
  17106. timestamp value multiplied by the power of 10 of the specified
  17107. value. Default value is 0.
  17108. @end table
  17109. @subsection Examples
  17110. @itemize
  17111. @item
  17112. Generate a video with a duration of 5.3 seconds, with size
  17113. 176x144 and a frame rate of 10 frames per second:
  17114. @example
  17115. testsrc=duration=5.3:size=qcif:rate=10
  17116. @end example
  17117. @item
  17118. The following graph description will generate a red source
  17119. with an opacity of 0.2, with size "qcif" and a frame rate of 10
  17120. frames per second:
  17121. @example
  17122. color=c=red@@0.2:s=qcif:r=10
  17123. @end example
  17124. @item
  17125. If the input content is to be ignored, @code{nullsrc} can be used. The
  17126. following command generates noise in the luminance plane by employing
  17127. the @code{geq} filter:
  17128. @example
  17129. nullsrc=s=256x256, geq=random(1)*255:128:128
  17130. @end example
  17131. @end itemize
  17132. @subsection Commands
  17133. The @code{color} source supports the following commands:
  17134. @table @option
  17135. @item c, color
  17136. Set the color of the created image. Accepts the same syntax of the
  17137. corresponding @option{color} option.
  17138. @end table
  17139. @section openclsrc
  17140. Generate video using an OpenCL program.
  17141. @table @option
  17142. @item source
  17143. OpenCL program source file.
  17144. @item kernel
  17145. Kernel name in program.
  17146. @item size, s
  17147. Size of frames to generate. This must be set.
  17148. @item format
  17149. Pixel format to use for the generated frames. This must be set.
  17150. @item rate, r
  17151. Number of frames generated every second. Default value is '25'.
  17152. @end table
  17153. For details of how the program loading works, see the @ref{program_opencl}
  17154. filter.
  17155. Example programs:
  17156. @itemize
  17157. @item
  17158. Generate a colour ramp by setting pixel values from the position of the pixel
  17159. in the output image. (Note that this will work with all pixel formats, but
  17160. the generated output will not be the same.)
  17161. @verbatim
  17162. __kernel void ramp(__write_only image2d_t dst,
  17163. unsigned int index)
  17164. {
  17165. int2 loc = (int2)(get_global_id(0), get_global_id(1));
  17166. float4 val;
  17167. val.xy = val.zw = convert_float2(loc) / convert_float2(get_image_dim(dst));
  17168. write_imagef(dst, loc, val);
  17169. }
  17170. @end verbatim
  17171. @item
  17172. Generate a Sierpinski carpet pattern, panning by a single pixel each frame.
  17173. @verbatim
  17174. __kernel void sierpinski_carpet(__write_only image2d_t dst,
  17175. unsigned int index)
  17176. {
  17177. int2 loc = (int2)(get_global_id(0), get_global_id(1));
  17178. float4 value = 0.0f;
  17179. int x = loc.x + index;
  17180. int y = loc.y + index;
  17181. while (x > 0 || y > 0) {
  17182. if (x % 3 == 1 && y % 3 == 1) {
  17183. value = 1.0f;
  17184. break;
  17185. }
  17186. x /= 3;
  17187. y /= 3;
  17188. }
  17189. write_imagef(dst, loc, value);
  17190. }
  17191. @end verbatim
  17192. @end itemize
  17193. @section sierpinski
  17194. Generate a Sierpinski carpet/triangle fractal, and randomly pan around.
  17195. This source accepts the following options:
  17196. @table @option
  17197. @item size, s
  17198. Set frame size. For the syntax of this option, check the @ref{video size syntax,,"Video
  17199. size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}. Default value is "640x480".
  17200. @item rate, r
  17201. Set frame rate, expressed as number of frames per second. Default
  17202. value is "25".
  17203. @item seed
  17204. Set seed which is used for random panning.
  17205. @item jump
  17206. Set max jump for single pan destination. Allowed range is from 1 to 10000.
  17207. @item type
  17208. Set fractal type, can be default @code{carpet} or @code{triangle}.
  17209. @end table
  17210. @c man end VIDEO SOURCES
  17211. @chapter Video Sinks
  17212. @c man begin VIDEO SINKS
  17213. Below is a description of the currently available video sinks.
  17214. @section buffersink
  17215. Buffer video frames, and make them available to the end of the filter
  17216. graph.
  17217. This sink is mainly intended for programmatic use, in particular
  17218. through the interface defined in @file{libavfilter/buffersink.h}
  17219. or the options system.
  17220. It accepts a pointer to an AVBufferSinkContext structure, which
  17221. defines the incoming buffers' formats, to be passed as the opaque
  17222. parameter to @code{avfilter_init_filter} for initialization.
  17223. @section nullsink
  17224. Null video sink: do absolutely nothing with the input video. It is
  17225. mainly useful as a template and for use in analysis / debugging
  17226. tools.
  17227. @c man end VIDEO SINKS
  17228. @chapter Multimedia Filters
  17229. @c man begin MULTIMEDIA FILTERS
  17230. Below is a description of the currently available multimedia filters.
  17231. @section abitscope
  17232. Convert input audio to a video output, displaying the audio bit scope.
  17233. The filter accepts the following options:
  17234. @table @option
  17235. @item rate, r
  17236. Set frame rate, expressed as number of frames per second. Default
  17237. value is "25".
  17238. @item size, s
  17239. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  17240. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  17241. Default value is @code{1024x256}.
  17242. @item colors
  17243. Specify list of colors separated by space or by '|' which will be used to
  17244. draw channels. Unrecognized or missing colors will be replaced
  17245. by white color.
  17246. @end table
  17247. @section adrawgraph
  17248. Draw a graph using input audio metadata.
  17249. See @ref{drawgraph}
  17250. @section agraphmonitor
  17251. See @ref{graphmonitor}.
  17252. @section ahistogram
  17253. Convert input audio to a video output, displaying the volume histogram.
  17254. The filter accepts the following options:
  17255. @table @option
  17256. @item dmode
  17257. Specify how histogram is calculated.
  17258. It accepts the following values:
  17259. @table @samp
  17260. @item single
  17261. Use single histogram for all channels.
  17262. @item separate
  17263. Use separate histogram for each channel.
  17264. @end table
  17265. Default is @code{single}.
  17266. @item rate, r
  17267. Set frame rate, expressed as number of frames per second. Default
  17268. value is "25".
  17269. @item size, s
  17270. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  17271. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  17272. Default value is @code{hd720}.
  17273. @item scale
  17274. Set display scale.
  17275. It accepts the following values:
  17276. @table @samp
  17277. @item log
  17278. logarithmic
  17279. @item sqrt
  17280. square root
  17281. @item cbrt
  17282. cubic root
  17283. @item lin
  17284. linear
  17285. @item rlog
  17286. reverse logarithmic
  17287. @end table
  17288. Default is @code{log}.
  17289. @item ascale
  17290. Set amplitude scale.
  17291. It accepts the following values:
  17292. @table @samp
  17293. @item log
  17294. logarithmic
  17295. @item lin
  17296. linear
  17297. @end table
  17298. Default is @code{log}.
  17299. @item acount
  17300. Set how much frames to accumulate in histogram.
  17301. Default is 1. Setting this to -1 accumulates all frames.
  17302. @item rheight
  17303. Set histogram ratio of window height.
  17304. @item slide
  17305. Set sonogram sliding.
  17306. It accepts the following values:
  17307. @table @samp
  17308. @item replace
  17309. replace old rows with new ones.
  17310. @item scroll
  17311. scroll from top to bottom.
  17312. @end table
  17313. Default is @code{replace}.
  17314. @end table
  17315. @section aphasemeter
  17316. Measures phase of input audio, which is exported as metadata @code{lavfi.aphasemeter.phase},
  17317. representing mean phase of current audio frame. A video output can also be produced and is
  17318. enabled by default. The audio is passed through as first output.
  17319. Audio will be rematrixed to stereo if it has a different channel layout. Phase value is in
  17320. range @code{[-1, 1]} where @code{-1} means left and right channels are completely out of phase
  17321. and @code{1} means channels are in phase.
  17322. The filter accepts the following options, all related to its video output:
  17323. @table @option
  17324. @item rate, r
  17325. Set the output frame rate. Default value is @code{25}.
  17326. @item size, s
  17327. Set the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  17328. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  17329. Default value is @code{800x400}.
  17330. @item rc
  17331. @item gc
  17332. @item bc
  17333. Specify the red, green, blue contrast. Default values are @code{2},
  17334. @code{7} and @code{1}.
  17335. Allowed range is @code{[0, 255]}.
  17336. @item mpc
  17337. Set color which will be used for drawing median phase. If color is
  17338. @code{none} which is default, no median phase value will be drawn.
  17339. @item video
  17340. Enable video output. Default is enabled.
  17341. @end table
  17342. @section avectorscope
  17343. Convert input audio to a video output, representing the audio vector
  17344. scope.
  17345. The filter is used to measure the difference between channels of stereo
  17346. audio stream. A monaural signal, consisting of identical left and right
  17347. signal, results in straight vertical line. Any stereo separation is visible
  17348. as a deviation from this line, creating a Lissajous figure.
  17349. If the straight (or deviation from it) but horizontal line appears this
  17350. indicates that the left and right channels are out of phase.
  17351. The filter accepts the following options:
  17352. @table @option
  17353. @item mode, m
  17354. Set the vectorscope mode.
  17355. Available values are:
  17356. @table @samp
  17357. @item lissajous
  17358. Lissajous rotated by 45 degrees.
  17359. @item lissajous_xy
  17360. Same as above but not rotated.
  17361. @item polar
  17362. Shape resembling half of circle.
  17363. @end table
  17364. Default value is @samp{lissajous}.
  17365. @item size, s
  17366. Set the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  17367. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  17368. Default value is @code{400x400}.
  17369. @item rate, r
  17370. Set the output frame rate. Default value is @code{25}.
  17371. @item rc
  17372. @item gc
  17373. @item bc
  17374. @item ac
  17375. Specify the red, green, blue and alpha contrast. Default values are @code{40},
  17376. @code{160}, @code{80} and @code{255}.
  17377. Allowed range is @code{[0, 255]}.
  17378. @item rf
  17379. @item gf
  17380. @item bf
  17381. @item af
  17382. Specify the red, green, blue and alpha fade. Default values are @code{15},
  17383. @code{10}, @code{5} and @code{5}.
  17384. Allowed range is @code{[0, 255]}.
  17385. @item zoom
  17386. Set the zoom factor. Default value is @code{1}. Allowed range is @code{[0, 10]}.
  17387. Values lower than @var{1} will auto adjust zoom factor to maximal possible value.
  17388. @item draw
  17389. Set the vectorscope drawing mode.
  17390. Available values are:
  17391. @table @samp
  17392. @item dot
  17393. Draw dot for each sample.
  17394. @item line
  17395. Draw line between previous and current sample.
  17396. @end table
  17397. Default value is @samp{dot}.
  17398. @item scale
  17399. Specify amplitude scale of audio samples.
  17400. Available values are:
  17401. @table @samp
  17402. @item lin
  17403. Linear.
  17404. @item sqrt
  17405. Square root.
  17406. @item cbrt
  17407. Cubic root.
  17408. @item log
  17409. Logarithmic.
  17410. @end table
  17411. @item swap
  17412. Swap left channel axis with right channel axis.
  17413. @item mirror
  17414. Mirror axis.
  17415. @table @samp
  17416. @item none
  17417. No mirror.
  17418. @item x
  17419. Mirror only x axis.
  17420. @item y
  17421. Mirror only y axis.
  17422. @item xy
  17423. Mirror both axis.
  17424. @end table
  17425. @end table
  17426. @subsection Examples
  17427. @itemize
  17428. @item
  17429. Complete example using @command{ffplay}:
  17430. @example
  17431. ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=input.mp3, asplit [a][out1];
  17432. [a] avectorscope=zoom=1.3:rc=2:gc=200:bc=10:rf=1:gf=8:bf=7 [out0]'
  17433. @end example
  17434. @end itemize
  17435. @section bench, abench
  17436. Benchmark part of a filtergraph.
  17437. The filter accepts the following options:
  17438. @table @option
  17439. @item action
  17440. Start or stop a timer.
  17441. Available values are:
  17442. @table @samp
  17443. @item start
  17444. Get the current time, set it as frame metadata (using the key
  17445. @code{lavfi.bench.start_time}), and forward the frame to the next filter.
  17446. @item stop
  17447. Get the current time and fetch the @code{lavfi.bench.start_time} metadata from
  17448. the input frame metadata to get the time difference. Time difference, average,
  17449. maximum and minimum time (respectively @code{t}, @code{avg}, @code{max} and
  17450. @code{min}) are then printed. The timestamps are expressed in seconds.
  17451. @end table
  17452. @end table
  17453. @subsection Examples
  17454. @itemize
  17455. @item
  17456. Benchmark @ref{selectivecolor} filter:
  17457. @example
  17458. bench=start,selectivecolor=reds=-.2 .12 -.49,bench=stop
  17459. @end example
  17460. @end itemize
  17461. @section concat
  17462. Concatenate audio and video streams, joining them together one after the
  17463. other.
  17464. The filter works on segments of synchronized video and audio streams. All
  17465. segments must have the same number of streams of each type, and that will
  17466. also be the number of streams at output.
  17467. The filter accepts the following options:
  17468. @table @option
  17469. @item n
  17470. Set the number of segments. Default is 2.
  17471. @item v
  17472. Set the number of output video streams, that is also the number of video
  17473. streams in each segment. Default is 1.
  17474. @item a
  17475. Set the number of output audio streams, that is also the number of audio
  17476. streams in each segment. Default is 0.
  17477. @item unsafe
  17478. Activate unsafe mode: do not fail if segments have a different format.
  17479. @end table
  17480. The filter has @var{v}+@var{a} outputs: first @var{v} video outputs, then
  17481. @var{a} audio outputs.
  17482. There are @var{n}x(@var{v}+@var{a}) inputs: first the inputs for the first
  17483. segment, in the same order as the outputs, then the inputs for the second
  17484. segment, etc.
  17485. Related streams do not always have exactly the same duration, for various
  17486. reasons including codec frame size or sloppy authoring. For that reason,
  17487. related synchronized streams (e.g. a video and its audio track) should be
  17488. concatenated at once. The concat filter will use the duration of the longest
  17489. stream in each segment (except the last one), and if necessary pad shorter
  17490. audio streams with silence.
  17491. For this filter to work correctly, all segments must start at timestamp 0.
  17492. All corresponding streams must have the same parameters in all segments; the
  17493. filtering system will automatically select a common pixel format for video
  17494. streams, and a common sample format, sample rate and channel layout for
  17495. audio streams, but other settings, such as resolution, must be converted
  17496. explicitly by the user.
  17497. Different frame rates are acceptable but will result in variable frame rate
  17498. at output; be sure to configure the output file to handle it.
  17499. @subsection Examples
  17500. @itemize
  17501. @item
  17502. Concatenate an opening, an episode and an ending, all in bilingual version
  17503. (video in stream 0, audio in streams 1 and 2):
  17504. @example
  17505. ffmpeg -i opening.mkv -i episode.mkv -i ending.mkv -filter_complex \
  17506. '[0:0] [0:1] [0:2] [1:0] [1:1] [1:2] [2:0] [2:1] [2:2]
  17507. concat=n=3:v=1:a=2 [v] [a1] [a2]' \
  17508. -map '[v]' -map '[a1]' -map '[a2]' output.mkv
  17509. @end example
  17510. @item
  17511. Concatenate two parts, handling audio and video separately, using the
  17512. (a)movie sources, and adjusting the resolution:
  17513. @example
  17514. movie=part1.mp4, scale=512:288 [v1] ; amovie=part1.mp4 [a1] ;
  17515. movie=part2.mp4, scale=512:288 [v2] ; amovie=part2.mp4 [a2] ;
  17516. [v1] [v2] concat [outv] ; [a1] [a2] concat=v=0:a=1 [outa]
  17517. @end example
  17518. Note that a desync will happen at the stitch if the audio and video streams
  17519. do not have exactly the same duration in the first file.
  17520. @end itemize
  17521. @subsection Commands
  17522. This filter supports the following commands:
  17523. @table @option
  17524. @item next
  17525. Close the current segment and step to the next one
  17526. @end table
  17527. @anchor{ebur128}
  17528. @section ebur128
  17529. EBU R128 scanner filter. This filter takes an audio stream and analyzes its loudness
  17530. level. By default, it logs a message at a frequency of 10Hz with the
  17531. Momentary loudness (identified by @code{M}), Short-term loudness (@code{S}),
  17532. Integrated loudness (@code{I}) and Loudness Range (@code{LRA}).
  17533. The filter can only analyze streams which have a sampling rate of 48000 Hz and whose
  17534. sample format is double-precision floating point. The input stream will be converted to
  17535. this specification, if needed. Users may need to insert aformat and/or aresample filters
  17536. after this filter to obtain the original parameters.
  17537. The filter also has a video output (see the @var{video} option) with a real
  17538. time graph to observe the loudness evolution. The graphic contains the logged
  17539. message mentioned above, so it is not printed anymore when this option is set,
  17540. unless the verbose logging is set. The main graphing area contains the
  17541. short-term loudness (3 seconds of analysis), and the gauge on the right is for
  17542. the momentary loudness (400 milliseconds), but can optionally be configured
  17543. to instead display short-term loudness (see @var{gauge}).
  17544. The green area marks a +/- 1LU target range around the target loudness
  17545. (-23LUFS by default, unless modified through @var{target}).
  17546. More information about the Loudness Recommendation EBU R128 on
  17547. @url{http://tech.ebu.ch/loudness}.
  17548. The filter accepts the following options:
  17549. @table @option
  17550. @item video
  17551. Activate the video output. The audio stream is passed unchanged whether this
  17552. option is set or no. The video stream will be the first output stream if
  17553. activated. Default is @code{0}.
  17554. @item size
  17555. Set the video size. This option is for video only. For the syntax of this
  17556. option, check the
  17557. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  17558. Default and minimum resolution is @code{640x480}.
  17559. @item meter
  17560. Set the EBU scale meter. Default is @code{9}. Common values are @code{9} and
  17561. @code{18}, respectively for EBU scale meter +9 and EBU scale meter +18. Any
  17562. other integer value between this range is allowed.
  17563. @item metadata
  17564. Set metadata injection. If set to @code{1}, the audio input will be segmented
  17565. into 100ms output frames, each of them containing various loudness information
  17566. in metadata. All the metadata keys are prefixed with @code{lavfi.r128.}.
  17567. Default is @code{0}.
  17568. @item framelog
  17569. Force the frame logging level.
  17570. Available values are:
  17571. @table @samp
  17572. @item info
  17573. information logging level
  17574. @item verbose
  17575. verbose logging level
  17576. @end table
  17577. By default, the logging level is set to @var{info}. If the @option{video} or
  17578. the @option{metadata} options are set, it switches to @var{verbose}.
  17579. @item peak
  17580. Set peak mode(s).
  17581. Available modes can be cumulated (the option is a @code{flag} type). Possible
  17582. values are:
  17583. @table @samp
  17584. @item none
  17585. Disable any peak mode (default).
  17586. @item sample
  17587. Enable sample-peak mode.
  17588. Simple peak mode looking for the higher sample value. It logs a message
  17589. for sample-peak (identified by @code{SPK}).
  17590. @item true
  17591. Enable true-peak mode.
  17592. If enabled, the peak lookup is done on an over-sampled version of the input
  17593. stream for better peak accuracy. It logs a message for true-peak.
  17594. (identified by @code{TPK}) and true-peak per frame (identified by @code{FTPK}).
  17595. This mode requires a build with @code{libswresample}.
  17596. @end table
  17597. @item dualmono
  17598. Treat mono input files as "dual mono". If a mono file is intended for playback
  17599. on a stereo system, its EBU R128 measurement will be perceptually incorrect.
  17600. If set to @code{true}, this option will compensate for this effect.
  17601. Multi-channel input files are not affected by this option.
  17602. @item panlaw
  17603. Set a specific pan law to be used for the measurement of dual mono files.
  17604. This parameter is optional, and has a default value of -3.01dB.
  17605. @item target
  17606. Set a specific target level (in LUFS) used as relative zero in the visualization.
  17607. This parameter is optional and has a default value of -23LUFS as specified
  17608. by EBU R128. However, material published online may prefer a level of -16LUFS
  17609. (e.g. for use with podcasts or video platforms).
  17610. @item gauge
  17611. Set the value displayed by the gauge. Valid values are @code{momentary} and s
  17612. @code{shortterm}. By default the momentary value will be used, but in certain
  17613. scenarios it may be more useful to observe the short term value instead (e.g.
  17614. live mixing).
  17615. @item scale
  17616. Sets the display scale for the loudness. Valid parameters are @code{absolute}
  17617. (in LUFS) or @code{relative} (LU) relative to the target. This only affects the
  17618. video output, not the summary or continuous log output.
  17619. @end table
  17620. @subsection Examples
  17621. @itemize
  17622. @item
  17623. Real-time graph using @command{ffplay}, with a EBU scale meter +18:
  17624. @example
  17625. ffplay -f lavfi -i "amovie=input.mp3,ebur128=video=1:meter=18 [out0][out1]"
  17626. @end example
  17627. @item
  17628. Run an analysis with @command{ffmpeg}:
  17629. @example
  17630. ffmpeg -nostats -i input.mp3 -filter_complex ebur128 -f null -
  17631. @end example
  17632. @end itemize
  17633. @section interleave, ainterleave
  17634. Temporally interleave frames from several inputs.
  17635. @code{interleave} works with video inputs, @code{ainterleave} with audio.
  17636. These filters read frames from several inputs and send the oldest
  17637. queued frame to the output.
  17638. Input streams must have well defined, monotonically increasing frame
  17639. timestamp values.
  17640. In order to submit one frame to output, these filters need to enqueue
  17641. at least one frame for each input, so they cannot work in case one
  17642. input is not yet terminated and will not receive incoming frames.
  17643. For example consider the case when one input is a @code{select} filter
  17644. which always drops input frames. The @code{interleave} filter will keep
  17645. reading from that input, but it will never be able to send new frames
  17646. to output until the input sends an end-of-stream signal.
  17647. Also, depending on inputs synchronization, the filters will drop
  17648. frames in case one input receives more frames than the other ones, and
  17649. the queue is already filled.
  17650. These filters accept the following options:
  17651. @table @option
  17652. @item nb_inputs, n
  17653. Set the number of different inputs, it is 2 by default.
  17654. @end table
  17655. @subsection Examples
  17656. @itemize
  17657. @item
  17658. Interleave frames belonging to different streams using @command{ffmpeg}:
  17659. @example
  17660. ffmpeg -i bambi.avi -i pr0n.mkv -filter_complex "[0:v][1:v] interleave" out.avi
  17661. @end example
  17662. @item
  17663. Add flickering blur effect:
  17664. @example
  17665. select='if(gt(random(0), 0.2), 1, 2)':n=2 [tmp], boxblur=2:2, [tmp] interleave
  17666. @end example
  17667. @end itemize
  17668. @section metadata, ametadata
  17669. Manipulate frame metadata.
  17670. This filter accepts the following options:
  17671. @table @option
  17672. @item mode
  17673. Set mode of operation of the filter.
  17674. Can be one of the following:
  17675. @table @samp
  17676. @item select
  17677. If both @code{value} and @code{key} is set, select frames
  17678. which have such metadata. If only @code{key} is set, select
  17679. every frame that has such key in metadata.
  17680. @item add
  17681. Add new metadata @code{key} and @code{value}. If key is already available
  17682. do nothing.
  17683. @item modify
  17684. Modify value of already present key.
  17685. @item delete
  17686. If @code{value} is set, delete only keys that have such value.
  17687. Otherwise, delete key. If @code{key} is not set, delete all metadata values in
  17688. the frame.
  17689. @item print
  17690. Print key and its value if metadata was found. If @code{key} is not set print all
  17691. metadata values available in frame.
  17692. @end table
  17693. @item key
  17694. Set key used with all modes. Must be set for all modes except @code{print} and @code{delete}.
  17695. @item value
  17696. Set metadata value which will be used. This option is mandatory for
  17697. @code{modify} and @code{add} mode.
  17698. @item function
  17699. Which function to use when comparing metadata value and @code{value}.
  17700. Can be one of following:
  17701. @table @samp
  17702. @item same_str
  17703. Values are interpreted as strings, returns true if metadata value is same as @code{value}.
  17704. @item starts_with
  17705. Values are interpreted as strings, returns true if metadata value starts with
  17706. the @code{value} option string.
  17707. @item less
  17708. Values are interpreted as floats, returns true if metadata value is less than @code{value}.
  17709. @item equal
  17710. Values are interpreted as floats, returns true if @code{value} is equal with metadata value.
  17711. @item greater
  17712. Values are interpreted as floats, returns true if metadata value is greater than @code{value}.
  17713. @item expr
  17714. Values are interpreted as floats, returns true if expression from option @code{expr}
  17715. evaluates to true.
  17716. @item ends_with
  17717. Values are interpreted as strings, returns true if metadata value ends with
  17718. the @code{value} option string.
  17719. @end table
  17720. @item expr
  17721. Set expression which is used when @code{function} is set to @code{expr}.
  17722. The expression is evaluated through the eval API and can contain the following
  17723. constants:
  17724. @table @option
  17725. @item VALUE1
  17726. Float representation of @code{value} from metadata key.
  17727. @item VALUE2
  17728. Float representation of @code{value} as supplied by user in @code{value} option.
  17729. @end table
  17730. @item file
  17731. If specified in @code{print} mode, output is written to the named file. Instead of
  17732. plain filename any writable url can be specified. Filename ``-'' is a shorthand
  17733. for standard output. If @code{file} option is not set, output is written to the log
  17734. with AV_LOG_INFO loglevel.
  17735. @item direct
  17736. Reduces buffering in print mode when output is written to a URL set using @var{file}.
  17737. @end table
  17738. @subsection Examples
  17739. @itemize
  17740. @item
  17741. Print all metadata values for frames with key @code{lavfi.signalstats.YDIF} with values
  17742. between 0 and 1.
  17743. @example
  17744. signalstats,metadata=print:key=lavfi.signalstats.YDIF:value=0:function=expr:expr='between(VALUE1,0,1)'
  17745. @end example
  17746. @item
  17747. Print silencedetect output to file @file{metadata.txt}.
  17748. @example
  17749. silencedetect,ametadata=mode=print:file=metadata.txt
  17750. @end example
  17751. @item
  17752. Direct all metadata to a pipe with file descriptor 4.
  17753. @example
  17754. metadata=mode=print:file='pipe\:4'
  17755. @end example
  17756. @end itemize
  17757. @section perms, aperms
  17758. Set read/write permissions for the output frames.
  17759. These filters are mainly aimed at developers to test direct path in the
  17760. following filter in the filtergraph.
  17761. The filters accept the following options:
  17762. @table @option
  17763. @item mode
  17764. Select the permissions mode.
  17765. It accepts the following values:
  17766. @table @samp
  17767. @item none
  17768. Do nothing. This is the default.
  17769. @item ro
  17770. Set all the output frames read-only.
  17771. @item rw
  17772. Set all the output frames directly writable.
  17773. @item toggle
  17774. Make the frame read-only if writable, and writable if read-only.
  17775. @item random
  17776. Set each output frame read-only or writable randomly.
  17777. @end table
  17778. @item seed
  17779. Set the seed for the @var{random} mode, must be an integer included between
  17780. @code{0} and @code{UINT32_MAX}. If not specified, or if explicitly set to
  17781. @code{-1}, the filter will try to use a good random seed on a best effort
  17782. basis.
  17783. @end table
  17784. Note: in case of auto-inserted filter between the permission filter and the
  17785. following one, the permission might not be received as expected in that
  17786. following filter. Inserting a @ref{format} or @ref{aformat} filter before the
  17787. perms/aperms filter can avoid this problem.
  17788. @section realtime, arealtime
  17789. Slow down filtering to match real time approximately.
  17790. These filters will pause the filtering for a variable amount of time to
  17791. match the output rate with the input timestamps.
  17792. They are similar to the @option{re} option to @code{ffmpeg}.
  17793. They accept the following options:
  17794. @table @option
  17795. @item limit
  17796. Time limit for the pauses. Any pause longer than that will be considered
  17797. a timestamp discontinuity and reset the timer. Default is 2 seconds.
  17798. @item speed
  17799. Speed factor for processing. The value must be a float larger than zero.
  17800. Values larger than 1.0 will result in faster than realtime processing,
  17801. smaller will slow processing down. The @var{limit} is automatically adapted
  17802. accordingly. Default is 1.0.
  17803. A processing speed faster than what is possible without these filters cannot
  17804. be achieved.
  17805. @end table
  17806. @anchor{select}
  17807. @section select, aselect
  17808. Select frames to pass in output.
  17809. This filter accepts the following options:
  17810. @table @option
  17811. @item expr, e
  17812. Set expression, which is evaluated for each input frame.
  17813. If the expression is evaluated to zero, the frame is discarded.
  17814. If the evaluation result is negative or NaN, the frame is sent to the
  17815. first output; otherwise it is sent to the output with index
  17816. @code{ceil(val)-1}, assuming that the input index starts from 0.
  17817. For example a value of @code{1.2} corresponds to the output with index
  17818. @code{ceil(1.2)-1 = 2-1 = 1}, that is the second output.
  17819. @item outputs, n
  17820. Set the number of outputs. The output to which to send the selected
  17821. frame is based on the result of the evaluation. Default value is 1.
  17822. @end table
  17823. The expression can contain the following constants:
  17824. @table @option
  17825. @item n
  17826. The (sequential) number of the filtered frame, starting from 0.
  17827. @item selected_n
  17828. The (sequential) number of the selected frame, starting from 0.
  17829. @item prev_selected_n
  17830. The sequential number of the last selected frame. It's NAN if undefined.
  17831. @item TB
  17832. The timebase of the input timestamps.
  17833. @item pts
  17834. The PTS (Presentation TimeStamp) of the filtered video frame,
  17835. expressed in @var{TB} units. It's NAN if undefined.
  17836. @item t
  17837. The PTS of the filtered video frame,
  17838. expressed in seconds. It's NAN if undefined.
  17839. @item prev_pts
  17840. The PTS of the previously filtered video frame. It's NAN if undefined.
  17841. @item prev_selected_pts
  17842. The PTS of the last previously filtered video frame. It's NAN if undefined.
  17843. @item prev_selected_t
  17844. The PTS of the last previously selected video frame, expressed in seconds. It's NAN if undefined.
  17845. @item start_pts
  17846. The PTS of the first video frame in the video. It's NAN if undefined.
  17847. @item start_t
  17848. The time of the first video frame in the video. It's NAN if undefined.
  17849. @item pict_type @emph{(video only)}
  17850. The type of the filtered frame. It can assume one of the following
  17851. values:
  17852. @table @option
  17853. @item I
  17854. @item P
  17855. @item B
  17856. @item S
  17857. @item SI
  17858. @item SP
  17859. @item BI
  17860. @end table
  17861. @item interlace_type @emph{(video only)}
  17862. The frame interlace type. It can assume one of the following values:
  17863. @table @option
  17864. @item PROGRESSIVE
  17865. The frame is progressive (not interlaced).
  17866. @item TOPFIRST
  17867. The frame is top-field-first.
  17868. @item BOTTOMFIRST
  17869. The frame is bottom-field-first.
  17870. @end table
  17871. @item consumed_sample_n @emph{(audio only)}
  17872. the number of selected samples before the current frame
  17873. @item samples_n @emph{(audio only)}
  17874. the number of samples in the current frame
  17875. @item sample_rate @emph{(audio only)}
  17876. the input sample rate
  17877. @item key
  17878. This is 1 if the filtered frame is a key-frame, 0 otherwise.
  17879. @item pos
  17880. the position in the file of the filtered frame, -1 if the information
  17881. is not available (e.g. for synthetic video)
  17882. @item scene @emph{(video only)}
  17883. value between 0 and 1 to indicate a new scene; a low value reflects a low
  17884. probability for the current frame to introduce a new scene, while a higher
  17885. value means the current frame is more likely to be one (see the example below)
  17886. @item concatdec_select
  17887. The concat demuxer can select only part of a concat input file by setting an
  17888. inpoint and an outpoint, but the output packets may not be entirely contained
  17889. in the selected interval. By using this variable, it is possible to skip frames
  17890. generated by the concat demuxer which are not exactly contained in the selected
  17891. interval.
  17892. This works by comparing the frame pts against the @var{lavf.concat.start_time}
  17893. and the @var{lavf.concat.duration} packet metadata values which are also
  17894. present in the decoded frames.
  17895. The @var{concatdec_select} variable is -1 if the frame pts is at least
  17896. start_time and either the duration metadata is missing or the frame pts is less
  17897. than start_time + duration, 0 otherwise, and NaN if the start_time metadata is
  17898. missing.
  17899. That basically means that an input frame is selected if its pts is within the
  17900. interval set by the concat demuxer.
  17901. @end table
  17902. The default value of the select expression is "1".
  17903. @subsection Examples
  17904. @itemize
  17905. @item
  17906. Select all frames in input:
  17907. @example
  17908. select
  17909. @end example
  17910. The example above is the same as:
  17911. @example
  17912. select=1
  17913. @end example
  17914. @item
  17915. Skip all frames:
  17916. @example
  17917. select=0
  17918. @end example
  17919. @item
  17920. Select only I-frames:
  17921. @example
  17922. select='eq(pict_type\,I)'
  17923. @end example
  17924. @item
  17925. Select one frame every 100:
  17926. @example
  17927. select='not(mod(n\,100))'
  17928. @end example
  17929. @item
  17930. Select only frames contained in the 10-20 time interval:
  17931. @example
  17932. select=between(t\,10\,20)
  17933. @end example
  17934. @item
  17935. Select only I-frames contained in the 10-20 time interval:
  17936. @example
  17937. select=between(t\,10\,20)*eq(pict_type\,I)
  17938. @end example
  17939. @item
  17940. Select frames with a minimum distance of 10 seconds:
  17941. @example
  17942. select='isnan(prev_selected_t)+gte(t-prev_selected_t\,10)'
  17943. @end example
  17944. @item
  17945. Use aselect to select only audio frames with samples number > 100:
  17946. @example
  17947. aselect='gt(samples_n\,100)'
  17948. @end example
  17949. @item
  17950. Create a mosaic of the first scenes:
  17951. @example
  17952. ffmpeg -i video.avi -vf select='gt(scene\,0.4)',scale=160:120,tile -frames:v 1 preview.png
  17953. @end example
  17954. Comparing @var{scene} against a value between 0.3 and 0.5 is generally a sane
  17955. choice.
  17956. @item
  17957. Send even and odd frames to separate outputs, and compose them:
  17958. @example
  17959. select=n=2:e='mod(n, 2)+1' [odd][even]; [odd] pad=h=2*ih [tmp]; [tmp][even] overlay=y=h
  17960. @end example
  17961. @item
  17962. Select useful frames from an ffconcat file which is using inpoints and
  17963. outpoints but where the source files are not intra frame only.
  17964. @example
  17965. ffmpeg -copyts -vsync 0 -segment_time_metadata 1 -i input.ffconcat -vf select=concatdec_select -af aselect=concatdec_select output.avi
  17966. @end example
  17967. @end itemize
  17968. @section sendcmd, asendcmd
  17969. Send commands to filters in the filtergraph.
  17970. These filters read commands to be sent to other filters in the
  17971. filtergraph.
  17972. @code{sendcmd} must be inserted between two video filters,
  17973. @code{asendcmd} must be inserted between two audio filters, but apart
  17974. from that they act the same way.
  17975. The specification of commands can be provided in the filter arguments
  17976. with the @var{commands} option, or in a file specified by the
  17977. @var{filename} option.
  17978. These filters accept the following options:
  17979. @table @option
  17980. @item commands, c
  17981. Set the commands to be read and sent to the other filters.
  17982. @item filename, f
  17983. Set the filename of the commands to be read and sent to the other
  17984. filters.
  17985. @end table
  17986. @subsection Commands syntax
  17987. A commands description consists of a sequence of interval
  17988. specifications, comprising a list of commands to be executed when a
  17989. particular event related to that interval occurs. The occurring event
  17990. is typically the current frame time entering or leaving a given time
  17991. interval.
  17992. An interval is specified by the following syntax:
  17993. @example
  17994. @var{START}[-@var{END}] @var{COMMANDS};
  17995. @end example
  17996. The time interval is specified by the @var{START} and @var{END} times.
  17997. @var{END} is optional and defaults to the maximum time.
  17998. The current frame time is considered within the specified interval if
  17999. it is included in the interval [@var{START}, @var{END}), that is when
  18000. the time is greater or equal to @var{START} and is lesser than
  18001. @var{END}.
  18002. @var{COMMANDS} consists of a sequence of one or more command
  18003. specifications, separated by ",", relating to that interval. The
  18004. syntax of a command specification is given by:
  18005. @example
  18006. [@var{FLAGS}] @var{TARGET} @var{COMMAND} @var{ARG}
  18007. @end example
  18008. @var{FLAGS} is optional and specifies the type of events relating to
  18009. the time interval which enable sending the specified command, and must
  18010. be a non-null sequence of identifier flags separated by "+" or "|" and
  18011. enclosed between "[" and "]".
  18012. The following flags are recognized:
  18013. @table @option
  18014. @item enter
  18015. The command is sent when the current frame timestamp enters the
  18016. specified interval. In other words, the command is sent when the
  18017. previous frame timestamp was not in the given interval, and the
  18018. current is.
  18019. @item leave
  18020. The command is sent when the current frame timestamp leaves the
  18021. specified interval. In other words, the command is sent when the
  18022. previous frame timestamp was in the given interval, and the
  18023. current is not.
  18024. @item expr
  18025. The command @var{ARG} is interpreted as expression and result of
  18026. expression is passed as @var{ARG}.
  18027. The expression is evaluated through the eval API and can contain the following
  18028. constants:
  18029. @table @option
  18030. @item POS
  18031. Original position in the file of the frame, or undefined if undefined
  18032. for the current frame.
  18033. @item PTS
  18034. The presentation timestamp in input.
  18035. @item N
  18036. The count of the input frame for video or audio, starting from 0.
  18037. @item T
  18038. The time in seconds of the current frame.
  18039. @item TS
  18040. The start time in seconds of the current command interval.
  18041. @item TE
  18042. The end time in seconds of the current command interval.
  18043. @item TI
  18044. The interpolated time of the current command interval, TI = (T - TS) / (TE - TS).
  18045. @end table
  18046. @end table
  18047. If @var{FLAGS} is not specified, a default value of @code{[enter]} is
  18048. assumed.
  18049. @var{TARGET} specifies the target of the command, usually the name of
  18050. the filter class or a specific filter instance name.
  18051. @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of the command for the target filter.
  18052. @var{ARG} is optional and specifies the optional list of argument for
  18053. the given @var{COMMAND}.
  18054. Between one interval specification and another, whitespaces, or
  18055. sequences of characters starting with @code{#} until the end of line,
  18056. are ignored and can be used to annotate comments.
  18057. A simplified BNF description of the commands specification syntax
  18058. follows:
  18059. @example
  18060. @var{COMMAND_FLAG} ::= "enter" | "leave"
  18061. @var{COMMAND_FLAGS} ::= @var{COMMAND_FLAG} [(+|"|")@var{COMMAND_FLAG}]
  18062. @var{COMMAND} ::= ["[" @var{COMMAND_FLAGS} "]"] @var{TARGET} @var{COMMAND} [@var{ARG}]
  18063. @var{COMMANDS} ::= @var{COMMAND} [,@var{COMMANDS}]
  18064. @var{INTERVAL} ::= @var{START}[-@var{END}] @var{COMMANDS}
  18065. @var{INTERVALS} ::= @var{INTERVAL}[;@var{INTERVALS}]
  18066. @end example
  18067. @subsection Examples
  18068. @itemize
  18069. @item
  18070. Specify audio tempo change at second 4:
  18071. @example
  18072. asendcmd=c='4.0 atempo tempo 1.5',atempo
  18073. @end example
  18074. @item
  18075. Target a specific filter instance:
  18076. @example
  18077. asendcmd=c='4.0 atempo@@my tempo 1.5',atempo@@my
  18078. @end example
  18079. @item
  18080. Specify a list of drawtext and hue commands in a file.
  18081. @example
  18082. # show text in the interval 5-10
  18083. 5.0-10.0 [enter] drawtext reinit 'fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=hello world',
  18084. [leave] drawtext reinit 'fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=';
  18085. # desaturate the image in the interval 15-20
  18086. 15.0-20.0 [enter] hue s 0,
  18087. [enter] drawtext reinit 'fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=nocolor',
  18088. [leave] hue s 1,
  18089. [leave] drawtext reinit 'fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=color';
  18090. # apply an exponential saturation fade-out effect, starting from time 25
  18091. 25 [enter] hue s exp(25-t)
  18092. @end example
  18093. A filtergraph allowing to read and process the above command list
  18094. stored in a file @file{test.cmd}, can be specified with:
  18095. @example
  18096. sendcmd=f=test.cmd,drawtext=fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text='',hue
  18097. @end example
  18098. @end itemize
  18099. @anchor{setpts}
  18100. @section setpts, asetpts
  18101. Change the PTS (presentation timestamp) of the input frames.
  18102. @code{setpts} works on video frames, @code{asetpts} on audio frames.
  18103. This filter accepts the following options:
  18104. @table @option
  18105. @item expr
  18106. The expression which is evaluated for each frame to construct its timestamp.
  18107. @end table
  18108. The expression is evaluated through the eval API and can contain the following
  18109. constants:
  18110. @table @option
  18111. @item FRAME_RATE, FR
  18112. frame rate, only defined for constant frame-rate video
  18113. @item PTS
  18114. The presentation timestamp in input
  18115. @item N
  18116. The count of the input frame for video or the number of consumed samples,
  18117. not including the current frame for audio, starting from 0.
  18118. @item NB_CONSUMED_SAMPLES
  18119. The number of consumed samples, not including the current frame (only
  18120. audio)
  18121. @item NB_SAMPLES, S
  18122. The number of samples in the current frame (only audio)
  18123. @item SAMPLE_RATE, SR
  18124. The audio sample rate.
  18125. @item STARTPTS
  18126. The PTS of the first frame.
  18127. @item STARTT
  18128. the time in seconds of the first frame
  18129. @item INTERLACED
  18130. State whether the current frame is interlaced.
  18131. @item T
  18132. the time in seconds of the current frame
  18133. @item POS
  18134. original position in the file of the frame, or undefined if undefined
  18135. for the current frame
  18136. @item PREV_INPTS
  18137. The previous input PTS.
  18138. @item PREV_INT
  18139. previous input time in seconds
  18140. @item PREV_OUTPTS
  18141. The previous output PTS.
  18142. @item PREV_OUTT
  18143. previous output time in seconds
  18144. @item RTCTIME
  18145. The wallclock (RTC) time in microseconds. This is deprecated, use time(0)
  18146. instead.
  18147. @item RTCSTART
  18148. The wallclock (RTC) time at the start of the movie in microseconds.
  18149. @item TB
  18150. The timebase of the input timestamps.
  18151. @end table
  18152. @subsection Examples
  18153. @itemize
  18154. @item
  18155. Start counting PTS from zero
  18156. @example
  18157. setpts=PTS-STARTPTS
  18158. @end example
  18159. @item
  18160. Apply fast motion effect:
  18161. @example
  18162. setpts=0.5*PTS
  18163. @end example
  18164. @item
  18165. Apply slow motion effect:
  18166. @example
  18167. setpts=2.0*PTS
  18168. @end example
  18169. @item
  18170. Set fixed rate of 25 frames per second:
  18171. @example
  18172. setpts=N/(25*TB)
  18173. @end example
  18174. @item
  18175. Set fixed rate 25 fps with some jitter:
  18176. @example
  18177. setpts='1/(25*TB) * (N + 0.05 * sin(N*2*PI/25))'
  18178. @end example
  18179. @item
  18180. Apply an offset of 10 seconds to the input PTS:
  18181. @example
  18182. setpts=PTS+10/TB
  18183. @end example
  18184. @item
  18185. Generate timestamps from a "live source" and rebase onto the current timebase:
  18186. @example
  18187. setpts='(RTCTIME - RTCSTART) / (TB * 1000000)'
  18188. @end example
  18189. @item
  18190. Generate timestamps by counting samples:
  18191. @example
  18192. asetpts=N/SR/TB
  18193. @end example
  18194. @end itemize
  18195. @section setrange
  18196. Force color range for the output video frame.
  18197. The @code{setrange} filter marks the color range property for the
  18198. output frames. It does not change the input frame, but only sets the
  18199. corresponding property, which affects how the frame is treated by
  18200. following filters.
  18201. The filter accepts the following options:
  18202. @table @option
  18203. @item range
  18204. Available values are:
  18205. @table @samp
  18206. @item auto
  18207. Keep the same color range property.
  18208. @item unspecified, unknown
  18209. Set the color range as unspecified.
  18210. @item limited, tv, mpeg
  18211. Set the color range as limited.
  18212. @item full, pc, jpeg
  18213. Set the color range as full.
  18214. @end table
  18215. @end table
  18216. @section settb, asettb
  18217. Set the timebase to use for the output frames timestamps.
  18218. It is mainly useful for testing timebase configuration.
  18219. It accepts the following parameters:
  18220. @table @option
  18221. @item expr, tb
  18222. The expression which is evaluated into the output timebase.
  18223. @end table
  18224. The value for @option{tb} is an arithmetic expression representing a
  18225. rational. The expression can contain the constants "AVTB" (the default
  18226. timebase), "intb" (the input timebase) and "sr" (the sample rate,
  18227. audio only). Default value is "intb".
  18228. @subsection Examples
  18229. @itemize
  18230. @item
  18231. Set the timebase to 1/25:
  18232. @example
  18233. settb=expr=1/25
  18234. @end example
  18235. @item
  18236. Set the timebase to 1/10:
  18237. @example
  18238. settb=expr=0.1
  18239. @end example
  18240. @item
  18241. Set the timebase to 1001/1000:
  18242. @example
  18243. settb=1+0.001
  18244. @end example
  18245. @item
  18246. Set the timebase to 2*intb:
  18247. @example
  18248. settb=2*intb
  18249. @end example
  18250. @item
  18251. Set the default timebase value:
  18252. @example
  18253. settb=AVTB
  18254. @end example
  18255. @end itemize
  18256. @section showcqt
  18257. Convert input audio to a video output representing frequency spectrum
  18258. logarithmically using Brown-Puckette constant Q transform algorithm with
  18259. direct frequency domain coefficient calculation (but the transform itself
  18260. is not really constant Q, instead the Q factor is actually variable/clamped),
  18261. with musical tone scale, from E0 to D#10.
  18262. The filter accepts the following options:
  18263. @table @option
  18264. @item size, s
  18265. Specify the video size for the output. It must be even. For the syntax of this option,
  18266. check the @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  18267. Default value is @code{1920x1080}.
  18268. @item fps, rate, r
  18269. Set the output frame rate. Default value is @code{25}.
  18270. @item bar_h
  18271. Set the bargraph height. It must be even. Default value is @code{-1} which
  18272. computes the bargraph height automatically.
  18273. @item axis_h
  18274. Set the axis height. It must be even. Default value is @code{-1} which computes
  18275. the axis height automatically.
  18276. @item sono_h
  18277. Set the sonogram height. It must be even. Default value is @code{-1} which
  18278. computes the sonogram height automatically.
  18279. @item fullhd
  18280. Set the fullhd resolution. This option is deprecated, use @var{size}, @var{s}
  18281. instead. Default value is @code{1}.
  18282. @item sono_v, volume
  18283. Specify the sonogram volume expression. It can contain variables:
  18284. @table @option
  18285. @item bar_v
  18286. the @var{bar_v} evaluated expression
  18287. @item frequency, freq, f
  18288. the frequency where it is evaluated
  18289. @item timeclamp, tc
  18290. the value of @var{timeclamp} option
  18291. @end table
  18292. and functions:
  18293. @table @option
  18294. @item a_weighting(f)
  18295. A-weighting of equal loudness
  18296. @item b_weighting(f)
  18297. B-weighting of equal loudness
  18298. @item c_weighting(f)
  18299. C-weighting of equal loudness.
  18300. @end table
  18301. Default value is @code{16}.
  18302. @item bar_v, volume2
  18303. Specify the bargraph volume expression. It can contain variables:
  18304. @table @option
  18305. @item sono_v
  18306. the @var{sono_v} evaluated expression
  18307. @item frequency, freq, f
  18308. the frequency where it is evaluated
  18309. @item timeclamp, tc
  18310. the value of @var{timeclamp} option
  18311. @end table
  18312. and functions:
  18313. @table @option
  18314. @item a_weighting(f)
  18315. A-weighting of equal loudness
  18316. @item b_weighting(f)
  18317. B-weighting of equal loudness
  18318. @item c_weighting(f)
  18319. C-weighting of equal loudness.
  18320. @end table
  18321. Default value is @code{sono_v}.
  18322. @item sono_g, gamma
  18323. Specify the sonogram gamma. Lower gamma makes the spectrum more contrast,
  18324. higher gamma makes the spectrum having more range. Default value is @code{3}.
  18325. Acceptable range is @code{[1, 7]}.
  18326. @item bar_g, gamma2
  18327. Specify the bargraph gamma. Default value is @code{1}. Acceptable range is
  18328. @code{[1, 7]}.
  18329. @item bar_t
  18330. Specify the bargraph transparency level. Lower value makes the bargraph sharper.
  18331. Default value is @code{1}. Acceptable range is @code{[0, 1]}.
  18332. @item timeclamp, tc
  18333. Specify the transform timeclamp. At low frequency, there is trade-off between
  18334. accuracy in time domain and frequency domain. If timeclamp is lower,
  18335. event in time domain is represented more accurately (such as fast bass drum),
  18336. otherwise event in frequency domain is represented more accurately
  18337. (such as bass guitar). Acceptable range is @code{[0.002, 1]}. Default value is @code{0.17}.
  18338. @item attack
  18339. Set attack time in seconds. The default is @code{0} (disabled). Otherwise, it
  18340. limits future samples by applying asymmetric windowing in time domain, useful
  18341. when low latency is required. Accepted range is @code{[0, 1]}.
  18342. @item basefreq
  18343. Specify the transform base frequency. Default value is @code{20.01523126408007475},
  18344. which is frequency 50 cents below E0. Acceptable range is @code{[10, 100000]}.
  18345. @item endfreq
  18346. Specify the transform end frequency. Default value is @code{20495.59681441799654},
  18347. which is frequency 50 cents above D#10. Acceptable range is @code{[10, 100000]}.
  18348. @item coeffclamp
  18349. This option is deprecated and ignored.
  18350. @item tlength
  18351. Specify the transform length in time domain. Use this option to control accuracy
  18352. trade-off between time domain and frequency domain at every frequency sample.
  18353. It can contain variables:
  18354. @table @option
  18355. @item frequency, freq, f
  18356. the frequency where it is evaluated
  18357. @item timeclamp, tc
  18358. the value of @var{timeclamp} option.
  18359. @end table
  18360. Default value is @code{384*tc/(384+tc*f)}.
  18361. @item count
  18362. Specify the transform count for every video frame. Default value is @code{6}.
  18363. Acceptable range is @code{[1, 30]}.
  18364. @item fcount
  18365. Specify the transform count for every single pixel. Default value is @code{0},
  18366. which makes it computed automatically. Acceptable range is @code{[0, 10]}.
  18367. @item fontfile
  18368. Specify font file for use with freetype to draw the axis. If not specified,
  18369. use embedded font. Note that drawing with font file or embedded font is not
  18370. implemented with custom @var{basefreq} and @var{endfreq}, use @var{axisfile}
  18371. option instead.
  18372. @item font
  18373. Specify fontconfig pattern. This has lower priority than @var{fontfile}. The
  18374. @code{:} in the pattern may be replaced by @code{|} to avoid unnecessary
  18375. escaping.
  18376. @item fontcolor
  18377. Specify font color expression. This is arithmetic expression that should return
  18378. integer value 0xRRGGBB. It can contain variables:
  18379. @table @option
  18380. @item frequency, freq, f
  18381. the frequency where it is evaluated
  18382. @item timeclamp, tc
  18383. the value of @var{timeclamp} option
  18384. @end table
  18385. and functions:
  18386. @table @option
  18387. @item midi(f)
  18388. midi number of frequency f, some midi numbers: E0(16), C1(24), C2(36), A4(69)
  18389. @item r(x), g(x), b(x)
  18390. red, green, and blue value of intensity x.
  18391. @end table
  18392. Default value is @code{st(0, (midi(f)-59.5)/12);
  18393. st(1, if(between(ld(0),0,1), 0.5-0.5*cos(2*PI*ld(0)), 0));
  18394. r(1-ld(1)) + b(ld(1))}.
  18395. @item axisfile
  18396. Specify image file to draw the axis. This option override @var{fontfile} and
  18397. @var{fontcolor} option.
  18398. @item axis, text
  18399. Enable/disable drawing text to the axis. If it is set to @code{0}, drawing to
  18400. the axis is disabled, ignoring @var{fontfile} and @var{axisfile} option.
  18401. Default value is @code{1}.
  18402. @item csp
  18403. Set colorspace. The accepted values are:
  18404. @table @samp
  18405. @item unspecified
  18406. Unspecified (default)
  18407. @item bt709
  18408. BT.709
  18409. @item fcc
  18410. FCC
  18411. @item bt470bg
  18412. BT.470BG or BT.601-6 625
  18413. @item smpte170m
  18414. SMPTE-170M or BT.601-6 525
  18415. @item smpte240m
  18416. SMPTE-240M
  18417. @item bt2020ncl
  18418. BT.2020 with non-constant luminance
  18419. @end table
  18420. @item cscheme
  18421. Set spectrogram color scheme. This is list of floating point values with format
  18422. @code{left_r|left_g|left_b|right_r|right_g|right_b}.
  18423. The default is @code{1|0.5|0|0|0.5|1}.
  18424. @end table
  18425. @subsection Examples
  18426. @itemize
  18427. @item
  18428. Playing audio while showing the spectrum:
  18429. @example
  18430. ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=a.mp3, asplit [a][out1]; [a] showcqt [out0]'
  18431. @end example
  18432. @item
  18433. Same as above, but with frame rate 30 fps:
  18434. @example
  18435. ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=a.mp3, asplit [a][out1]; [a] showcqt=fps=30:count=5 [out0]'
  18436. @end example
  18437. @item
  18438. Playing at 1280x720:
  18439. @example
  18440. ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=a.mp3, asplit [a][out1]; [a] showcqt=s=1280x720:count=4 [out0]'
  18441. @end example
  18442. @item
  18443. Disable sonogram display:
  18444. @example
  18445. sono_h=0
  18446. @end example
  18447. @item
  18448. A1 and its harmonics: A1, A2, (near)E3, A3:
  18449. @example
  18450. ffplay -f lavfi 'aevalsrc=0.1*sin(2*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(4*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(6*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(8*PI*55*t),
  18451. asplit[a][out1]; [a] showcqt [out0]'
  18452. @end example
  18453. @item
  18454. Same as above, but with more accuracy in frequency domain:
  18455. @example
  18456. ffplay -f lavfi 'aevalsrc=0.1*sin(2*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(4*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(6*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(8*PI*55*t),
  18457. asplit[a][out1]; [a] showcqt=timeclamp=0.5 [out0]'
  18458. @end example
  18459. @item
  18460. Custom volume:
  18461. @example
  18462. bar_v=10:sono_v=bar_v*a_weighting(f)
  18463. @end example
  18464. @item
  18465. Custom gamma, now spectrum is linear to the amplitude.
  18466. @example
  18467. bar_g=2:sono_g=2
  18468. @end example
  18469. @item
  18470. Custom tlength equation:
  18471. @example
  18472. tc=0.33:tlength='st(0,0.17); 384*tc / (384 / ld(0) + tc*f /(1-ld(0))) + 384*tc / (tc*f / ld(0) + 384 /(1-ld(0)))'
  18473. @end example
  18474. @item
  18475. Custom fontcolor and fontfile, C-note is colored green, others are colored blue:
  18476. @example
  18477. fontcolor='if(mod(floor(midi(f)+0.5),12), 0x0000FF, g(1))':fontfile=myfont.ttf
  18478. @end example
  18479. @item
  18480. Custom font using fontconfig:
  18481. @example
  18482. font='Courier New,Monospace,mono|bold'
  18483. @end example
  18484. @item
  18485. Custom frequency range with custom axis using image file:
  18486. @example
  18487. axisfile=myaxis.png:basefreq=40:endfreq=10000
  18488. @end example
  18489. @end itemize
  18490. @section showfreqs
  18491. Convert input audio to video output representing the audio power spectrum.
  18492. Audio amplitude is on Y-axis while frequency is on X-axis.
  18493. The filter accepts the following options:
  18494. @table @option
  18495. @item size, s
  18496. Specify size of video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  18497. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  18498. Default is @code{1024x512}.
  18499. @item mode
  18500. Set display mode.
  18501. This set how each frequency bin will be represented.
  18502. It accepts the following values:
  18503. @table @samp
  18504. @item line
  18505. @item bar
  18506. @item dot
  18507. @end table
  18508. Default is @code{bar}.
  18509. @item ascale
  18510. Set amplitude scale.
  18511. It accepts the following values:
  18512. @table @samp
  18513. @item lin
  18514. Linear scale.
  18515. @item sqrt
  18516. Square root scale.
  18517. @item cbrt
  18518. Cubic root scale.
  18519. @item log
  18520. Logarithmic scale.
  18521. @end table
  18522. Default is @code{log}.
  18523. @item fscale
  18524. Set frequency scale.
  18525. It accepts the following values:
  18526. @table @samp
  18527. @item lin
  18528. Linear scale.
  18529. @item log
  18530. Logarithmic scale.
  18531. @item rlog
  18532. Reverse logarithmic scale.
  18533. @end table
  18534. Default is @code{lin}.
  18535. @item win_size
  18536. Set window size. Allowed range is from 16 to 65536.
  18537. Default is @code{2048}
  18538. @item win_func
  18539. Set windowing function.
  18540. It accepts the following values:
  18541. @table @samp
  18542. @item rect
  18543. @item bartlett
  18544. @item hanning
  18545. @item hamming
  18546. @item blackman
  18547. @item welch
  18548. @item flattop
  18549. @item bharris
  18550. @item bnuttall
  18551. @item bhann
  18552. @item sine
  18553. @item nuttall
  18554. @item lanczos
  18555. @item gauss
  18556. @item tukey
  18557. @item dolph
  18558. @item cauchy
  18559. @item parzen
  18560. @item poisson
  18561. @item bohman
  18562. @end table
  18563. Default is @code{hanning}.
  18564. @item overlap
  18565. Set window overlap. In range @code{[0, 1]}. Default is @code{1},
  18566. which means optimal overlap for selected window function will be picked.
  18567. @item averaging
  18568. Set time averaging. Setting this to 0 will display current maximal peaks.
  18569. Default is @code{1}, which means time averaging is disabled.
  18570. @item colors
  18571. Specify list of colors separated by space or by '|' which will be used to
  18572. draw channel frequencies. Unrecognized or missing colors will be replaced
  18573. by white color.
  18574. @item cmode
  18575. Set channel display mode.
  18576. It accepts the following values:
  18577. @table @samp
  18578. @item combined
  18579. @item separate
  18580. @end table
  18581. Default is @code{combined}.
  18582. @item minamp
  18583. Set minimum amplitude used in @code{log} amplitude scaler.
  18584. @end table
  18585. @section showspatial
  18586. Convert stereo input audio to a video output, representing the spatial relationship
  18587. between two channels.
  18588. The filter accepts the following options:
  18589. @table @option
  18590. @item size, s
  18591. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  18592. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  18593. Default value is @code{512x512}.
  18594. @item win_size
  18595. Set window size. Allowed range is from @var{1024} to @var{65536}. Default size is @var{4096}.
  18596. @item win_func
  18597. Set window function.
  18598. It accepts the following values:
  18599. @table @samp
  18600. @item rect
  18601. @item bartlett
  18602. @item hann
  18603. @item hanning
  18604. @item hamming
  18605. @item blackman
  18606. @item welch
  18607. @item flattop
  18608. @item bharris
  18609. @item bnuttall
  18610. @item bhann
  18611. @item sine
  18612. @item nuttall
  18613. @item lanczos
  18614. @item gauss
  18615. @item tukey
  18616. @item dolph
  18617. @item cauchy
  18618. @item parzen
  18619. @item poisson
  18620. @item bohman
  18621. @end table
  18622. Default value is @code{hann}.
  18623. @item overlap
  18624. Set ratio of overlap window. Default value is @code{0.5}.
  18625. When value is @code{1} overlap is set to recommended size for specific
  18626. window function currently used.
  18627. @end table
  18628. @anchor{showspectrum}
  18629. @section showspectrum
  18630. Convert input audio to a video output, representing the audio frequency
  18631. spectrum.
  18632. The filter accepts the following options:
  18633. @table @option
  18634. @item size, s
  18635. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  18636. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  18637. Default value is @code{640x512}.
  18638. @item slide
  18639. Specify how the spectrum should slide along the window.
  18640. It accepts the following values:
  18641. @table @samp
  18642. @item replace
  18643. the samples start again on the left when they reach the right
  18644. @item scroll
  18645. the samples scroll from right to left
  18646. @item fullframe
  18647. frames are only produced when the samples reach the right
  18648. @item rscroll
  18649. the samples scroll from left to right
  18650. @end table
  18651. Default value is @code{replace}.
  18652. @item mode
  18653. Specify display mode.
  18654. It accepts the following values:
  18655. @table @samp
  18656. @item combined
  18657. all channels are displayed in the same row
  18658. @item separate
  18659. all channels are displayed in separate rows
  18660. @end table
  18661. Default value is @samp{combined}.
  18662. @item color
  18663. Specify display color mode.
  18664. It accepts the following values:
  18665. @table @samp
  18666. @item channel
  18667. each channel is displayed in a separate color
  18668. @item intensity
  18669. each channel is displayed using the same color scheme
  18670. @item rainbow
  18671. each channel is displayed using the rainbow color scheme
  18672. @item moreland
  18673. each channel is displayed using the moreland color scheme
  18674. @item nebulae
  18675. each channel is displayed using the nebulae color scheme
  18676. @item fire
  18677. each channel is displayed using the fire color scheme
  18678. @item fiery
  18679. each channel is displayed using the fiery color scheme
  18680. @item fruit
  18681. each channel is displayed using the fruit color scheme
  18682. @item cool
  18683. each channel is displayed using the cool color scheme
  18684. @item magma
  18685. each channel is displayed using the magma color scheme
  18686. @item green
  18687. each channel is displayed using the green color scheme
  18688. @item viridis
  18689. each channel is displayed using the viridis color scheme
  18690. @item plasma
  18691. each channel is displayed using the plasma color scheme
  18692. @item cividis
  18693. each channel is displayed using the cividis color scheme
  18694. @item terrain
  18695. each channel is displayed using the terrain color scheme
  18696. @end table
  18697. Default value is @samp{channel}.
  18698. @item scale
  18699. Specify scale used for calculating intensity color values.
  18700. It accepts the following values:
  18701. @table @samp
  18702. @item lin
  18703. linear
  18704. @item sqrt
  18705. square root, default
  18706. @item cbrt
  18707. cubic root
  18708. @item log
  18709. logarithmic
  18710. @item 4thrt
  18711. 4th root
  18712. @item 5thrt
  18713. 5th root
  18714. @end table
  18715. Default value is @samp{sqrt}.
  18716. @item fscale
  18717. Specify frequency scale.
  18718. It accepts the following values:
  18719. @table @samp
  18720. @item lin
  18721. linear
  18722. @item log
  18723. logarithmic
  18724. @end table
  18725. Default value is @samp{lin}.
  18726. @item saturation
  18727. Set saturation modifier for displayed colors. Negative values provide
  18728. alternative color scheme. @code{0} is no saturation at all.
  18729. Saturation must be in [-10.0, 10.0] range.
  18730. Default value is @code{1}.
  18731. @item win_func
  18732. Set window function.
  18733. It accepts the following values:
  18734. @table @samp
  18735. @item rect
  18736. @item bartlett
  18737. @item hann
  18738. @item hanning
  18739. @item hamming
  18740. @item blackman
  18741. @item welch
  18742. @item flattop
  18743. @item bharris
  18744. @item bnuttall
  18745. @item bhann
  18746. @item sine
  18747. @item nuttall
  18748. @item lanczos
  18749. @item gauss
  18750. @item tukey
  18751. @item dolph
  18752. @item cauchy
  18753. @item parzen
  18754. @item poisson
  18755. @item bohman
  18756. @end table
  18757. Default value is @code{hann}.
  18758. @item orientation
  18759. Set orientation of time vs frequency axis. Can be @code{vertical} or
  18760. @code{horizontal}. Default is @code{vertical}.
  18761. @item overlap
  18762. Set ratio of overlap window. Default value is @code{0}.
  18763. When value is @code{1} overlap is set to recommended size for specific
  18764. window function currently used.
  18765. @item gain
  18766. Set scale gain for calculating intensity color values.
  18767. Default value is @code{1}.
  18768. @item data
  18769. Set which data to display. Can be @code{magnitude}, default or @code{phase}.
  18770. @item rotation
  18771. Set color rotation, must be in [-1.0, 1.0] range.
  18772. Default value is @code{0}.
  18773. @item start
  18774. Set start frequency from which to display spectrogram. Default is @code{0}.
  18775. @item stop
  18776. Set stop frequency to which to display spectrogram. Default is @code{0}.
  18777. @item fps
  18778. Set upper frame rate limit. Default is @code{auto}, unlimited.
  18779. @item legend
  18780. Draw time and frequency axes and legends. Default is disabled.
  18781. @end table
  18782. The usage is very similar to the showwaves filter; see the examples in that
  18783. section.
  18784. @subsection Examples
  18785. @itemize
  18786. @item
  18787. Large window with logarithmic color scaling:
  18788. @example
  18789. showspectrum=s=1280x480:scale=log
  18790. @end example
  18791. @item
  18792. Complete example for a colored and sliding spectrum per channel using @command{ffplay}:
  18793. @example
  18794. ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=input.mp3, asplit [a][out1];
  18795. [a] showspectrum=mode=separate:color=intensity:slide=1:scale=cbrt [out0]'
  18796. @end example
  18797. @end itemize
  18798. @section showspectrumpic
  18799. Convert input audio to a single video frame, representing the audio frequency
  18800. spectrum.
  18801. The filter accepts the following options:
  18802. @table @option
  18803. @item size, s
  18804. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  18805. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  18806. Default value is @code{4096x2048}.
  18807. @item mode
  18808. Specify display mode.
  18809. It accepts the following values:
  18810. @table @samp
  18811. @item combined
  18812. all channels are displayed in the same row
  18813. @item separate
  18814. all channels are displayed in separate rows
  18815. @end table
  18816. Default value is @samp{combined}.
  18817. @item color
  18818. Specify display color mode.
  18819. It accepts the following values:
  18820. @table @samp
  18821. @item channel
  18822. each channel is displayed in a separate color
  18823. @item intensity
  18824. each channel is displayed using the same color scheme
  18825. @item rainbow
  18826. each channel is displayed using the rainbow color scheme
  18827. @item moreland
  18828. each channel is displayed using the moreland color scheme
  18829. @item nebulae
  18830. each channel is displayed using the nebulae color scheme
  18831. @item fire
  18832. each channel is displayed using the fire color scheme
  18833. @item fiery
  18834. each channel is displayed using the fiery color scheme
  18835. @item fruit
  18836. each channel is displayed using the fruit color scheme
  18837. @item cool
  18838. each channel is displayed using the cool color scheme
  18839. @item magma
  18840. each channel is displayed using the magma color scheme
  18841. @item green
  18842. each channel is displayed using the green color scheme
  18843. @item viridis
  18844. each channel is displayed using the viridis color scheme
  18845. @item plasma
  18846. each channel is displayed using the plasma color scheme
  18847. @item cividis
  18848. each channel is displayed using the cividis color scheme
  18849. @item terrain
  18850. each channel is displayed using the terrain color scheme
  18851. @end table
  18852. Default value is @samp{intensity}.
  18853. @item scale
  18854. Specify scale used for calculating intensity color values.
  18855. It accepts the following values:
  18856. @table @samp
  18857. @item lin
  18858. linear
  18859. @item sqrt
  18860. square root, default
  18861. @item cbrt
  18862. cubic root
  18863. @item log
  18864. logarithmic
  18865. @item 4thrt
  18866. 4th root
  18867. @item 5thrt
  18868. 5th root
  18869. @end table
  18870. Default value is @samp{log}.
  18871. @item fscale
  18872. Specify frequency scale.
  18873. It accepts the following values:
  18874. @table @samp
  18875. @item lin
  18876. linear
  18877. @item log
  18878. logarithmic
  18879. @end table
  18880. Default value is @samp{lin}.
  18881. @item saturation
  18882. Set saturation modifier for displayed colors. Negative values provide
  18883. alternative color scheme. @code{0} is no saturation at all.
  18884. Saturation must be in [-10.0, 10.0] range.
  18885. Default value is @code{1}.
  18886. @item win_func
  18887. Set window function.
  18888. It accepts the following values:
  18889. @table @samp
  18890. @item rect
  18891. @item bartlett
  18892. @item hann
  18893. @item hanning
  18894. @item hamming
  18895. @item blackman
  18896. @item welch
  18897. @item flattop
  18898. @item bharris
  18899. @item bnuttall
  18900. @item bhann
  18901. @item sine
  18902. @item nuttall
  18903. @item lanczos
  18904. @item gauss
  18905. @item tukey
  18906. @item dolph
  18907. @item cauchy
  18908. @item parzen
  18909. @item poisson
  18910. @item bohman
  18911. @end table
  18912. Default value is @code{hann}.
  18913. @item orientation
  18914. Set orientation of time vs frequency axis. Can be @code{vertical} or
  18915. @code{horizontal}. Default is @code{vertical}.
  18916. @item gain
  18917. Set scale gain for calculating intensity color values.
  18918. Default value is @code{1}.
  18919. @item legend
  18920. Draw time and frequency axes and legends. Default is enabled.
  18921. @item rotation
  18922. Set color rotation, must be in [-1.0, 1.0] range.
  18923. Default value is @code{0}.
  18924. @item start
  18925. Set start frequency from which to display spectrogram. Default is @code{0}.
  18926. @item stop
  18927. Set stop frequency to which to display spectrogram. Default is @code{0}.
  18928. @end table
  18929. @subsection Examples
  18930. @itemize
  18931. @item
  18932. Extract an audio spectrogram of a whole audio track
  18933. in a 1024x1024 picture using @command{ffmpeg}:
  18934. @example
  18935. ffmpeg -i audio.flac -lavfi showspectrumpic=s=1024x1024 spectrogram.png
  18936. @end example
  18937. @end itemize
  18938. @section showvolume
  18939. Convert input audio volume to a video output.
  18940. The filter accepts the following options:
  18941. @table @option
  18942. @item rate, r
  18943. Set video rate.
  18944. @item b
  18945. Set border width, allowed range is [0, 5]. Default is 1.
  18946. @item w
  18947. Set channel width, allowed range is [80, 8192]. Default is 400.
  18948. @item h
  18949. Set channel height, allowed range is [1, 900]. Default is 20.
  18950. @item f
  18951. Set fade, allowed range is [0, 1]. Default is 0.95.
  18952. @item c
  18953. Set volume color expression.
  18954. The expression can use the following variables:
  18955. @table @option
  18956. @item VOLUME
  18957. Current max volume of channel in dB.
  18958. @item PEAK
  18959. Current peak.
  18960. @item CHANNEL
  18961. Current channel number, starting from 0.
  18962. @end table
  18963. @item t
  18964. If set, displays channel names. Default is enabled.
  18965. @item v
  18966. If set, displays volume values. Default is enabled.
  18967. @item o
  18968. Set orientation, can be horizontal: @code{h} or vertical: @code{v},
  18969. default is @code{h}.
  18970. @item s
  18971. Set step size, allowed range is [0, 5]. Default is 0, which means
  18972. step is disabled.
  18973. @item p
  18974. Set background opacity, allowed range is [0, 1]. Default is 0.
  18975. @item m
  18976. Set metering mode, can be peak: @code{p} or rms: @code{r},
  18977. default is @code{p}.
  18978. @item ds
  18979. Set display scale, can be linear: @code{lin} or log: @code{log},
  18980. default is @code{lin}.
  18981. @item dm
  18982. In second.
  18983. If set to > 0., display a line for the max level
  18984. in the previous seconds.
  18985. default is disabled: @code{0.}
  18986. @item dmc
  18987. The color of the max line. Use when @code{dm} option is set to > 0.
  18988. default is: @code{orange}
  18989. @end table
  18990. @section showwaves
  18991. Convert input audio to a video output, representing the samples waves.
  18992. The filter accepts the following options:
  18993. @table @option
  18994. @item size, s
  18995. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  18996. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  18997. Default value is @code{600x240}.
  18998. @item mode
  18999. Set display mode.
  19000. Available values are:
  19001. @table @samp
  19002. @item point
  19003. Draw a point for each sample.
  19004. @item line
  19005. Draw a vertical line for each sample.
  19006. @item p2p
  19007. Draw a point for each sample and a line between them.
  19008. @item cline
  19009. Draw a centered vertical line for each sample.
  19010. @end table
  19011. Default value is @code{point}.
  19012. @item n
  19013. Set the number of samples which are printed on the same column. A
  19014. larger value will decrease the frame rate. Must be a positive
  19015. integer. This option can be set only if the value for @var{rate}
  19016. is not explicitly specified.
  19017. @item rate, r
  19018. Set the (approximate) output frame rate. This is done by setting the
  19019. option @var{n}. Default value is "25".
  19020. @item split_channels
  19021. Set if channels should be drawn separately or overlap. Default value is 0.
  19022. @item colors
  19023. Set colors separated by '|' which are going to be used for drawing of each channel.
  19024. @item scale
  19025. Set amplitude scale.
  19026. Available values are:
  19027. @table @samp
  19028. @item lin
  19029. Linear.
  19030. @item log
  19031. Logarithmic.
  19032. @item sqrt
  19033. Square root.
  19034. @item cbrt
  19035. Cubic root.
  19036. @end table
  19037. Default is linear.
  19038. @item draw
  19039. Set the draw mode. This is mostly useful to set for high @var{n}.
  19040. Available values are:
  19041. @table @samp
  19042. @item scale
  19043. Scale pixel values for each drawn sample.
  19044. @item full
  19045. Draw every sample directly.
  19046. @end table
  19047. Default value is @code{scale}.
  19048. @end table
  19049. @subsection Examples
  19050. @itemize
  19051. @item
  19052. Output the input file audio and the corresponding video representation
  19053. at the same time:
  19054. @example
  19055. amovie=a.mp3,asplit[out0],showwaves[out1]
  19056. @end example
  19057. @item
  19058. Create a synthetic signal and show it with showwaves, forcing a
  19059. frame rate of 30 frames per second:
  19060. @example
  19061. aevalsrc=sin(1*2*PI*t)*sin(880*2*PI*t):cos(2*PI*200*t),asplit[out0],showwaves=r=30[out1]
  19062. @end example
  19063. @end itemize
  19064. @section showwavespic
  19065. Convert input audio to a single video frame, representing the samples waves.
  19066. The filter accepts the following options:
  19067. @table @option
  19068. @item size, s
  19069. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  19070. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  19071. Default value is @code{600x240}.
  19072. @item split_channels
  19073. Set if channels should be drawn separately or overlap. Default value is 0.
  19074. @item colors
  19075. Set colors separated by '|' which are going to be used for drawing of each channel.
  19076. @item scale
  19077. Set amplitude scale.
  19078. Available values are:
  19079. @table @samp
  19080. @item lin
  19081. Linear.
  19082. @item log
  19083. Logarithmic.
  19084. @item sqrt
  19085. Square root.
  19086. @item cbrt
  19087. Cubic root.
  19088. @end table
  19089. Default is linear.
  19090. @item draw
  19091. Set the draw mode.
  19092. Available values are:
  19093. @table @samp
  19094. @item scale
  19095. Scale pixel values for each drawn sample.
  19096. @item full
  19097. Draw every sample directly.
  19098. @end table
  19099. Default value is @code{scale}.
  19100. @end table
  19101. @subsection Examples
  19102. @itemize
  19103. @item
  19104. Extract a channel split representation of the wave form of a whole audio track
  19105. in a 1024x800 picture using @command{ffmpeg}:
  19106. @example
  19107. ffmpeg -i audio.flac -lavfi showwavespic=split_channels=1:s=1024x800 waveform.png
  19108. @end example
  19109. @end itemize
  19110. @section sidedata, asidedata
  19111. Delete frame side data, or select frames based on it.
  19112. This filter accepts the following options:
  19113. @table @option
  19114. @item mode
  19115. Set mode of operation of the filter.
  19116. Can be one of the following:
  19117. @table @samp
  19118. @item select
  19119. Select every frame with side data of @code{type}.
  19120. @item delete
  19121. Delete side data of @code{type}. If @code{type} is not set, delete all side
  19122. data in the frame.
  19123. @end table
  19124. @item type
  19125. Set side data type used with all modes. Must be set for @code{select} mode. For
  19126. the list of frame side data types, refer to the @code{AVFrameSideDataType} enum
  19127. in @file{libavutil/frame.h}. For example, to choose
  19128. @code{AV_FRAME_DATA_PANSCAN} side data, you must specify @code{PANSCAN}.
  19129. @end table
  19130. @section spectrumsynth
  19131. Synthesize audio from 2 input video spectrums, first input stream represents
  19132. magnitude across time and second represents phase across time.
  19133. The filter will transform from frequency domain as displayed in videos back
  19134. to time domain as presented in audio output.
  19135. This filter is primarily created for reversing processed @ref{showspectrum}
  19136. filter outputs, but can synthesize sound from other spectrograms too.
  19137. But in such case results are going to be poor if the phase data is not
  19138. available, because in such cases phase data need to be recreated, usually
  19139. it's just recreated from random noise.
  19140. For best results use gray only output (@code{channel} color mode in
  19141. @ref{showspectrum} filter) and @code{log} scale for magnitude video and
  19142. @code{lin} scale for phase video. To produce phase, for 2nd video, use
  19143. @code{data} option. Inputs videos should generally use @code{fullframe}
  19144. slide mode as that saves resources needed for decoding video.
  19145. The filter accepts the following options:
  19146. @table @option
  19147. @item sample_rate
  19148. Specify sample rate of output audio, the sample rate of audio from which
  19149. spectrum was generated may differ.
  19150. @item channels
  19151. Set number of channels represented in input video spectrums.
  19152. @item scale
  19153. Set scale which was used when generating magnitude input spectrum.
  19154. Can be @code{lin} or @code{log}. Default is @code{log}.
  19155. @item slide
  19156. Set slide which was used when generating inputs spectrums.
  19157. Can be @code{replace}, @code{scroll}, @code{fullframe} or @code{rscroll}.
  19158. Default is @code{fullframe}.
  19159. @item win_func
  19160. Set window function used for resynthesis.
  19161. @item overlap
  19162. Set window overlap. In range @code{[0, 1]}. Default is @code{1},
  19163. which means optimal overlap for selected window function will be picked.
  19164. @item orientation
  19165. Set orientation of input videos. Can be @code{vertical} or @code{horizontal}.
  19166. Default is @code{vertical}.
  19167. @end table
  19168. @subsection Examples
  19169. @itemize
  19170. @item
  19171. First create magnitude and phase videos from audio, assuming audio is stereo with 44100 sample rate,
  19172. then resynthesize videos back to audio with spectrumsynth:
  19173. @example
  19174. ffmpeg -i input.flac -lavfi showspectrum=mode=separate:scale=log:overlap=0.875:color=channel:slide=fullframe:data=magnitude -an -c:v rawvideo magnitude.nut
  19175. ffmpeg -i input.flac -lavfi showspectrum=mode=separate:scale=lin:overlap=0.875:color=channel:slide=fullframe:data=phase -an -c:v rawvideo phase.nut
  19176. ffmpeg -i magnitude.nut -i phase.nut -lavfi spectrumsynth=channels=2:sample_rate=44100:win_func=hann:overlap=0.875:slide=fullframe output.flac
  19177. @end example
  19178. @end itemize
  19179. @section split, asplit
  19180. Split input into several identical outputs.
  19181. @code{asplit} works with audio input, @code{split} with video.
  19182. The filter accepts a single parameter which specifies the number of outputs. If
  19183. unspecified, it defaults to 2.
  19184. @subsection Examples
  19185. @itemize
  19186. @item
  19187. Create two separate outputs from the same input:
  19188. @example
  19189. [in] split [out0][out1]
  19190. @end example
  19191. @item
  19192. To create 3 or more outputs, you need to specify the number of
  19193. outputs, like in:
  19194. @example
  19195. [in] asplit=3 [out0][out1][out2]
  19196. @end example
  19197. @item
  19198. Create two separate outputs from the same input, one cropped and
  19199. one padded:
  19200. @example
  19201. [in] split [splitout1][splitout2];
  19202. [splitout1] crop=100:100:0:0 [cropout];
  19203. [splitout2] pad=200:200:100:100 [padout];
  19204. @end example
  19205. @item
  19206. Create 5 copies of the input audio with @command{ffmpeg}:
  19207. @example
  19208. ffmpeg -i INPUT -filter_complex asplit=5 OUTPUT
  19209. @end example
  19210. @end itemize
  19211. @section zmq, azmq
  19212. Receive commands sent through a libzmq client, and forward them to
  19213. filters in the filtergraph.
  19214. @code{zmq} and @code{azmq} work as a pass-through filters. @code{zmq}
  19215. must be inserted between two video filters, @code{azmq} between two
  19216. audio filters. Both are capable to send messages to any filter type.
  19217. To enable these filters you need to install the libzmq library and
  19218. headers and configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-libzmq}.
  19219. For more information about libzmq see:
  19220. @url{http://www.zeromq.org/}
  19221. The @code{zmq} and @code{azmq} filters work as a libzmq server, which
  19222. receives messages sent through a network interface defined by the
  19223. @option{bind_address} (or the abbreviation "@option{b}") option.
  19224. Default value of this option is @file{tcp://localhost:5555}. You may
  19225. want to alter this value to your needs, but do not forget to escape any
  19226. ':' signs (see @ref{filtergraph escaping}).
  19227. The received message must be in the form:
  19228. @example
  19229. @var{TARGET} @var{COMMAND} [@var{ARG}]
  19230. @end example
  19231. @var{TARGET} specifies the target of the command, usually the name of
  19232. the filter class or a specific filter instance name. The default
  19233. filter instance name uses the pattern @samp{Parsed_<filter_name>_<index>},
  19234. but you can override this by using the @samp{filter_name@@id} syntax
  19235. (see @ref{Filtergraph syntax}).
  19236. @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of the command for the target filter.
  19237. @var{ARG} is optional and specifies the optional argument list for the
  19238. given @var{COMMAND}.
  19239. Upon reception, the message is processed and the corresponding command
  19240. is injected into the filtergraph. Depending on the result, the filter
  19241. will send a reply to the client, adopting the format:
  19242. @example
  19243. @var{ERROR_CODE} @var{ERROR_REASON}
  19244. @var{MESSAGE}
  19245. @end example
  19246. @var{MESSAGE} is optional.
  19247. @subsection Examples
  19248. Look at @file{tools/zmqsend} for an example of a zmq client which can
  19249. be used to send commands processed by these filters.
  19250. Consider the following filtergraph generated by @command{ffplay}.
  19251. In this example the last overlay filter has an instance name. All other
  19252. filters will have default instance names.
  19253. @example
  19254. ffplay -dumpgraph 1 -f lavfi "
  19255. color=s=100x100:c=red [l];
  19256. color=s=100x100:c=blue [r];
  19257. nullsrc=s=200x100, zmq [bg];
  19258. [bg][l] overlay [bg+l];
  19259. [bg+l][r] overlay@@my=x=100 "
  19260. @end example
  19261. To change the color of the left side of the video, the following
  19262. command can be used:
  19263. @example
  19264. echo Parsed_color_0 c yellow | tools/zmqsend
  19265. @end example
  19266. To change the right side:
  19267. @example
  19268. echo Parsed_color_1 c pink | tools/zmqsend
  19269. @end example
  19270. To change the position of the right side:
  19271. @example
  19272. echo overlay@@my x 150 | tools/zmqsend
  19273. @end example
  19274. @c man end MULTIMEDIA FILTERS
  19275. @chapter Multimedia Sources
  19276. @c man begin MULTIMEDIA SOURCES
  19277. Below is a description of the currently available multimedia sources.
  19278. @section amovie
  19279. This is the same as @ref{movie} source, except it selects an audio
  19280. stream by default.
  19281. @anchor{movie}
  19282. @section movie
  19283. Read audio and/or video stream(s) from a movie container.
  19284. It accepts the following parameters:
  19285. @table @option
  19286. @item filename
  19287. The name of the resource to read (not necessarily a file; it can also be a
  19288. device or a stream accessed through some protocol).
  19289. @item format_name, f
  19290. Specifies the format assumed for the movie to read, and can be either
  19291. the name of a container or an input device. If not specified, the
  19292. format is guessed from @var{movie_name} or by probing.
  19293. @item seek_point, sp
  19294. Specifies the seek point in seconds. The frames will be output
  19295. starting from this seek point. The parameter is evaluated with
  19296. @code{av_strtod}, so the numerical value may be suffixed by an IS
  19297. postfix. The default value is "0".
  19298. @item streams, s
  19299. Specifies the streams to read. Several streams can be specified,
  19300. separated by "+". The source will then have as many outputs, in the
  19301. same order. The syntax is explained in the @ref{Stream specifiers,,"Stream specifiers"
  19302. section in the ffmpeg manual,ffmpeg}. Two special names, "dv" and "da" specify
  19303. respectively the default (best suited) video and audio stream. Default
  19304. is "dv", or "da" if the filter is called as "amovie".
  19305. @item stream_index, si
  19306. Specifies the index of the video stream to read. If the value is -1,
  19307. the most suitable video stream will be automatically selected. The default
  19308. value is "-1". Deprecated. If the filter is called "amovie", it will select
  19309. audio instead of video.
  19310. @item loop
  19311. Specifies how many times to read the stream in sequence.
  19312. If the value is 0, the stream will be looped infinitely.
  19313. Default value is "1".
  19314. Note that when the movie is looped the source timestamps are not
  19315. changed, so it will generate non monotonically increasing timestamps.
  19316. @item discontinuity
  19317. Specifies the time difference between frames above which the point is
  19318. considered a timestamp discontinuity which is removed by adjusting the later
  19319. timestamps.
  19320. @end table
  19321. It allows overlaying a second video on top of the main input of
  19322. a filtergraph, as shown in this graph:
  19323. @example
  19324. input -----------> deltapts0 --> overlay --> output
  19325. ^
  19326. |
  19327. movie --> scale--> deltapts1 -------+
  19328. @end example
  19329. @subsection Examples
  19330. @itemize
  19331. @item
  19332. Skip 3.2 seconds from the start of the AVI file in.avi, and overlay it
  19333. on top of the input labelled "in":
  19334. @example
  19335. movie=in.avi:seek_point=3.2, scale=180:-1, setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [over];
  19336. [in] setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [main];
  19337. [main][over] overlay=16:16 [out]
  19338. @end example
  19339. @item
  19340. Read from a video4linux2 device, and overlay it on top of the input
  19341. labelled "in":
  19342. @example
  19343. movie=/dev/video0:f=video4linux2, scale=180:-1, setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [over];
  19344. [in] setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [main];
  19345. [main][over] overlay=16:16 [out]
  19346. @end example
  19347. @item
  19348. Read the first video stream and the audio stream with id 0x81 from
  19349. dvd.vob; the video is connected to the pad named "video" and the audio is
  19350. connected to the pad named "audio":
  19351. @example
  19352. movie=dvd.vob:s=v:0+#0x81 [video] [audio]
  19353. @end example
  19354. @end itemize
  19355. @subsection Commands
  19356. Both movie and amovie support the following commands:
  19357. @table @option
  19358. @item seek
  19359. Perform seek using "av_seek_frame".
  19360. The syntax is: seek @var{stream_index}|@var{timestamp}|@var{flags}
  19361. @itemize
  19362. @item
  19363. @var{stream_index}: If stream_index is -1, a default
  19364. stream is selected, and @var{timestamp} is automatically converted
  19365. from AV_TIME_BASE units to the stream specific time_base.
  19366. @item
  19367. @var{timestamp}: Timestamp in AVStream.time_base units
  19368. or, if no stream is specified, in AV_TIME_BASE units.
  19369. @item
  19370. @var{flags}: Flags which select direction and seeking mode.
  19371. @end itemize
  19372. @item get_duration
  19373. Get movie duration in AV_TIME_BASE units.
  19374. @end table
  19375. @c man end MULTIMEDIA SOURCES